1 //===--- SemaOverload.cpp - C++ Overloading -------------------------------===//
2 //
3 // Part of the LLVM Project, under the Apache License v2.0 with LLVM Exceptions.
4 // See https://llvm.org/LICENSE.txt for license information.
5 // SPDX-License-Identifier: Apache-2.0 WITH LLVM-exception
6 //
7 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
8 //
9 // This file provides Sema routines for C++ overloading.
10 //
11 //===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
12 
13 #include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
14 #include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
15 #include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
16 #include "clang/AST/DependenceFlags.h"
17 #include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
18 #include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
19 #include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
20 #include "clang/AST/TypeOrdering.h"
21 #include "clang/Basic/Diagnostic.h"
22 #include "clang/Basic/DiagnosticOptions.h"
23 #include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
24 #include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
25 #include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
26 #include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
27 #include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
28 #include "clang/Sema/Overload.h"
29 #include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
30 #include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
31 #include "clang/Sema/TemplateDeduction.h"
32 #include "llvm/ADT/DenseSet.h"
33 #include "llvm/ADT/Optional.h"
34 #include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
35 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
36 #include "llvm/ADT/SmallString.h"
37 #include <algorithm>
38 #include <cstdlib>
39 
40 using namespace clang;
41 using namespace sema;
42 
43 using AllowedExplicit = Sema::AllowedExplicit;
44 
45 static bool functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
46   return llvm::any_of(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
47     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
48   });
49 }
50 
51 /// A convenience routine for creating a decayed reference to a function.
52 static ExprResult
53 CreateFunctionRefExpr(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Fn, NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
54                       const Expr *Base, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
55                       SourceLocation Loc = SourceLocation(),
56                       const DeclarationNameLoc &LocInfo = DeclarationNameLoc()){
57   if (S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FoundDecl, Loc))
58     return ExprError();
59   // If FoundDecl is different from Fn (such as if one is a template
60   // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
61   // called on both.
62   // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
63   // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
64   // being used.
65   if (FoundDecl != Fn && S.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Fn, Loc))
66     return ExprError();
67   DeclRefExpr *DRE = new (S.Context)
68       DeclRefExpr(S.Context, Fn, false, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, Loc, LocInfo);
69   if (HadMultipleCandidates)
70     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(true);
71 
72   S.MarkDeclRefReferenced(DRE, Base);
73   if (auto *FPT = DRE->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
74     if (isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType())) {
75       S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT);
76       DRE->setType(Fn->getType());
77     }
78   }
79   return S.ImpCastExprToType(DRE, S.Context.getPointerType(DRE->getType()),
80                              CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
81 }
82 
83 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
84                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
85                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
86                                  bool CStyle,
87                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
88 
89 static bool IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
90                                                  QualType &ToType,
91                                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
92                                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
93                                                  bool CStyle);
94 static OverloadingResult
95 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
96                         UserDefinedConversionSequence& User,
97                         OverloadCandidateSet& Conversions,
98                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
99                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
100 
101 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
102 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
103                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
104                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
105 
106 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
107 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
108                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
109                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
110 
111 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
112 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
113                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
114                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2);
115 
116 /// GetConversionRank - Retrieve the implicit conversion rank
117 /// corresponding to the given implicit conversion kind.
118 ImplicitConversionRank clang::GetConversionRank(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
119   static const ImplicitConversionRank
120     Rank[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
121     ICR_Exact_Match,
122     ICR_Exact_Match,
123     ICR_Exact_Match,
124     ICR_Exact_Match,
125     ICR_Exact_Match,
126     ICR_Exact_Match,
127     ICR_Promotion,
128     ICR_Promotion,
129     ICR_Promotion,
130     ICR_Conversion,
131     ICR_Conversion,
132     ICR_Conversion,
133     ICR_Conversion,
134     ICR_Conversion,
135     ICR_Conversion,
136     ICR_Conversion,
137     ICR_Conversion,
138     ICR_Conversion,
139     ICR_Conversion,
140     ICR_Conversion,
141     ICR_OCL_Scalar_Widening,
142     ICR_Complex_Real_Conversion,
143     ICR_Conversion,
144     ICR_Conversion,
145     ICR_Writeback_Conversion,
146     ICR_Exact_Match, // NOTE(gbiv): This may not be completely right --
147                      // it was omitted by the patch that added
148                      // ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion
149     ICR_C_Conversion,
150     ICR_C_Conversion_Extension
151   };
152   return Rank[(int)Kind];
153 }
154 
155 /// GetImplicitConversionName - Return the name of this kind of
156 /// implicit conversion.
157 static const char* GetImplicitConversionName(ImplicitConversionKind Kind) {
158   static const char* const Name[(int)ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds] = {
159     "No conversion",
160     "Lvalue-to-rvalue",
161     "Array-to-pointer",
162     "Function-to-pointer",
163     "Function pointer conversion",
164     "Qualification",
165     "Integral promotion",
166     "Floating point promotion",
167     "Complex promotion",
168     "Integral conversion",
169     "Floating conversion",
170     "Complex conversion",
171     "Floating-integral conversion",
172     "Pointer conversion",
173     "Pointer-to-member conversion",
174     "Boolean conversion",
175     "Compatible-types conversion",
176     "Derived-to-base conversion",
177     "Vector conversion",
178     "SVE Vector conversion",
179     "Vector splat",
180     "Complex-real conversion",
181     "Block Pointer conversion",
182     "Transparent Union Conversion",
183     "Writeback conversion",
184     "OpenCL Zero Event Conversion",
185     "C specific type conversion",
186     "Incompatible pointer conversion"
187   };
188   return Name[Kind];
189 }
190 
191 /// StandardConversionSequence - Set the standard conversion
192 /// sequence to the identity conversion.
193 void StandardConversionSequence::setAsIdentityConversion() {
194   First = ICK_Identity;
195   Second = ICK_Identity;
196   Third = ICK_Identity;
197   DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
198   QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
199   ReferenceBinding = false;
200   DirectBinding = false;
201   IsLvalueReference = true;
202   BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
203   BindsToRvalue = false;
204   BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
205   ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
206   CopyConstructor = nullptr;
207 }
208 
209 /// getRank - Retrieve the rank of this standard conversion sequence
210 /// (C++ 13.3.3.1.1p3). The rank is the largest rank of each of the
211 /// implicit conversions.
212 ImplicitConversionRank StandardConversionSequence::getRank() const {
213   ImplicitConversionRank Rank = ICR_Exact_Match;
214   if  (GetConversionRank(First) > Rank)
215     Rank = GetConversionRank(First);
216   if  (GetConversionRank(Second) > Rank)
217     Rank = GetConversionRank(Second);
218   if  (GetConversionRank(Third) > Rank)
219     Rank = GetConversionRank(Third);
220   return Rank;
221 }
222 
223 /// isPointerConversionToBool - Determines whether this conversion is
224 /// a conversion of a pointer or pointer-to-member to bool. This is
225 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences
226 /// (C++ 13.3.3.2p4).
227 bool StandardConversionSequence::isPointerConversionToBool() const {
228   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
229   // array-to-pointer or function-to-pointer implicit conversions, so
230   // check for their presence as well as checking whether FromType is
231   // a pointer.
232   if (getToType(1)->isBooleanType() &&
233       (getFromType()->isPointerType() ||
234        getFromType()->isMemberPointerType() ||
235        getFromType()->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
236        getFromType()->isBlockPointerType() ||
237        First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer || First == ICK_Function_To_Pointer))
238     return true;
239 
240   return false;
241 }
242 
243 /// isPointerConversionToVoidPointer - Determines whether this
244 /// conversion is a conversion of a pointer to a void pointer. This is
245 /// used as part of the ranking of standard conversion sequences (C++
246 /// 13.3.3.2p4).
247 bool
248 StandardConversionSequence::
249 isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(ASTContext& Context) const {
250   QualType FromType = getFromType();
251   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
252 
253   // Note that FromType has not necessarily been transformed by the
254   // array-to-pointer implicit conversion, so check for its presence
255   // and redo the conversion to get a pointer.
256   if (First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
257     FromType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
258 
259   if (Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion && FromType->isAnyPointerType())
260     if (const PointerType* ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
261       return ToPtrType->getPointeeType()->isVoidType();
262 
263   return false;
264 }
265 
266 /// Skip any implicit casts which could be either part of a narrowing conversion
267 /// or after one in an implicit conversion.
268 static const Expr *IgnoreNarrowingConversion(ASTContext &Ctx,
269                                              const Expr *Converted) {
270   // We can have cleanups wrapping the converted expression; these need to be
271   // preserved so that destructors run if necessary.
272   if (auto *EWC = dyn_cast<ExprWithCleanups>(Converted)) {
273     Expr *Inner =
274         const_cast<Expr *>(IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, EWC->getSubExpr()));
275     return ExprWithCleanups::Create(Ctx, Inner, EWC->cleanupsHaveSideEffects(),
276                                     EWC->getObjects());
277   }
278 
279   while (auto *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Converted)) {
280     switch (ICE->getCastKind()) {
281     case CK_NoOp:
282     case CK_IntegralCast:
283     case CK_IntegralToBoolean:
284     case CK_IntegralToFloating:
285     case CK_BooleanToSignedIntegral:
286     case CK_FloatingToIntegral:
287     case CK_FloatingToBoolean:
288     case CK_FloatingCast:
289       Converted = ICE->getSubExpr();
290       continue;
291 
292     default:
293       return Converted;
294     }
295   }
296 
297   return Converted;
298 }
299 
300 /// Check if this standard conversion sequence represents a narrowing
301 /// conversion, according to C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7.
302 ///
303 /// \param Ctx  The AST context.
304 /// \param Converted  The result of applying this standard conversion sequence.
305 /// \param ConstantValue  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
306 ///        value of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
307 /// \param ConstantType  If this is an NK_Constant_Narrowing conversion, the
308 ///        type of the expression prior to the narrowing conversion.
309 /// \param IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion If true type-narrowing conversions
310 ///        from floating point types to integral types should be ignored.
311 NarrowingKind StandardConversionSequence::getNarrowingKind(
312     ASTContext &Ctx, const Expr *Converted, APValue &ConstantValue,
313     QualType &ConstantType, bool IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion) const {
314   assert(Ctx.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "narrowing check outside C++");
315 
316   // C++11 [dcl.init.list]p7:
317   //   A narrowing conversion is an implicit conversion ...
318   QualType FromType = getToType(0);
319   QualType ToType = getToType(1);
320 
321   // A conversion to an enumeration type is narrowing if the conversion to
322   // the underlying type is narrowing. This only arises for expressions of
323   // the form 'Enum{init}'.
324   if (auto *ET = ToType->getAs<EnumType>())
325     ToType = ET->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
326 
327   switch (Second) {
328   // 'bool' is an integral type; dispatch to the right place to handle it.
329   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
330     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType())
331       goto FloatingIntegralConversion;
332     if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
333       goto IntegralConversion;
334     // -- from a pointer type or pointer-to-member type to bool, or
335     return NK_Type_Narrowing;
336 
337   // -- from a floating-point type to an integer type, or
338   //
339   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to a floating-point
340   //    type, except where the source is a constant expression and the actual
341   //    value after conversion will fit into the target type and will produce
342   //    the original value when converted back to the original type, or
343   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
344   FloatingIntegralConversion:
345     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isIntegralType(Ctx)) {
346       return NK_Type_Narrowing;
347     } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
348                ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
349       if (IgnoreFloatToIntegralConversion)
350         return NK_Not_Narrowing;
351       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
352       assert(Initializer && "Unknown conversion expression");
353 
354       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
355       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
356         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
357 
358       if (Optional<llvm::APSInt> IntConstantValue =
359               Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx)) {
360         // Convert the integer to the floating type.
361         llvm::APFloat Result(Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType));
362         Result.convertFromAPInt(*IntConstantValue, IntConstantValue->isSigned(),
363                                 llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
364         // And back.
365         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = *IntConstantValue;
366         bool ignored;
367         Result.convertToInteger(ConvertedValue,
368                                 llvm::APFloat::rmTowardZero, &ignored);
369         // If the resulting value is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
370         if (*IntConstantValue != ConvertedValue) {
371           ConstantValue = APValue(*IntConstantValue);
372           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
373           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
374         }
375       } else {
376         // Variables are always narrowings.
377         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
378       }
379     }
380     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
381 
382   // -- from long double to double or float, or from double to float, except
383   //    where the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
384   //    conversion is within the range of values that can be represented (even
385   //    if it cannot be represented exactly), or
386   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
387     if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType() &&
388         Ctx.getFloatingTypeOrder(FromType, ToType) == 1) {
389       // FromType is larger than ToType.
390       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
391 
392       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
393       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
394         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
395 
396       if (Initializer->isCXX11ConstantExpr(Ctx, &ConstantValue)) {
397         // Constant!
398         assert(ConstantValue.isFloat());
399         llvm::APFloat FloatVal = ConstantValue.getFloat();
400         // Convert the source value into the target type.
401         bool ignored;
402         llvm::APFloat::opStatus ConvertStatus = FloatVal.convert(
403           Ctx.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType),
404           llvm::APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &ignored);
405         // If there was no overflow, the source value is within the range of
406         // values that can be represented.
407         if (ConvertStatus & llvm::APFloat::opOverflow) {
408           ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
409           return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
410         }
411       } else {
412         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
413       }
414     }
415     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
416 
417   // -- from an integer type or unscoped enumeration type to an integer type
418   //    that cannot represent all the values of the original type, except where
419   //    the source is a constant expression and the actual value after
420   //    conversion will fit into the target type and will produce the original
421   //    value when converted back to the original type.
422   case ICK_Integral_Conversion:
423   IntegralConversion: {
424     assert(FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
425     assert(ToType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType());
426     const bool FromSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
427     const unsigned FromWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(FromType);
428     const bool ToSigned = ToType->isSignedIntegerOrEnumerationType();
429     const unsigned ToWidth = Ctx.getIntWidth(ToType);
430 
431     if (FromWidth > ToWidth ||
432         (FromWidth == ToWidth && FromSigned != ToSigned) ||
433         (FromSigned && !ToSigned)) {
434       // Not all values of FromType can be represented in ToType.
435       const Expr *Initializer = IgnoreNarrowingConversion(Ctx, Converted);
436 
437       // If it's value-dependent, we can't tell whether it's narrowing.
438       if (Initializer->isValueDependent())
439         return NK_Dependent_Narrowing;
440 
441       Optional<llvm::APSInt> OptInitializerValue;
442       if (!(OptInitializerValue = Initializer->getIntegerConstantExpr(Ctx))) {
443         // Such conversions on variables are always narrowing.
444         return NK_Variable_Narrowing;
445       }
446       llvm::APSInt &InitializerValue = *OptInitializerValue;
447       bool Narrowing = false;
448       if (FromWidth < ToWidth) {
449         // Negative -> unsigned is narrowing. Otherwise, more bits is never
450         // narrowing.
451         if (InitializerValue.isSigned() && InitializerValue.isNegative())
452           Narrowing = true;
453       } else {
454         // Add a bit to the InitializerValue so we don't have to worry about
455         // signed vs. unsigned comparisons.
456         InitializerValue = InitializerValue.extend(
457           InitializerValue.getBitWidth() + 1);
458         // Convert the initializer to and from the target width and signed-ness.
459         llvm::APSInt ConvertedValue = InitializerValue;
460         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.trunc(ToWidth);
461         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(ToSigned);
462         ConvertedValue = ConvertedValue.extend(InitializerValue.getBitWidth());
463         ConvertedValue.setIsSigned(InitializerValue.isSigned());
464         // If the result is different, this was a narrowing conversion.
465         if (ConvertedValue != InitializerValue)
466           Narrowing = true;
467       }
468       if (Narrowing) {
469         ConstantType = Initializer->getType();
470         ConstantValue = APValue(InitializerValue);
471         return NK_Constant_Narrowing;
472       }
473     }
474     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
475   }
476 
477   default:
478     // Other kinds of conversions are not narrowings.
479     return NK_Not_Narrowing;
480   }
481 }
482 
483 /// dump - Print this standard conversion sequence to standard
484 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
485 LLVM_DUMP_METHOD void StandardConversionSequence::dump() const {
486   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
487   bool PrintedSomething = false;
488   if (First != ICK_Identity) {
489     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(First);
490     PrintedSomething = true;
491   }
492 
493   if (Second != ICK_Identity) {
494     if (PrintedSomething) {
495       OS << " -> ";
496     }
497     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Second);
498 
499     if (CopyConstructor) {
500       OS << " (by copy constructor)";
501     } else if (DirectBinding) {
502       OS << " (direct reference binding)";
503     } else if (ReferenceBinding) {
504       OS << " (reference binding)";
505     }
506     PrintedSomething = true;
507   }
508 
509   if (Third != ICK_Identity) {
510     if (PrintedSomething) {
511       OS << " -> ";
512     }
513     OS << GetImplicitConversionName(Third);
514     PrintedSomething = true;
515   }
516 
517   if (!PrintedSomething) {
518     OS << "No conversions required";
519   }
520 }
521 
522 /// dump - Print this user-defined conversion sequence to standard
523 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
524 void UserDefinedConversionSequence::dump() const {
525   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
526   if (Before.First || Before.Second || Before.Third) {
527     Before.dump();
528     OS << " -> ";
529   }
530   if (ConversionFunction)
531     OS << '\'' << *ConversionFunction << '\'';
532   else
533     OS << "aggregate initialization";
534   if (After.First || After.Second || After.Third) {
535     OS << " -> ";
536     After.dump();
537   }
538 }
539 
540 /// dump - Print this implicit conversion sequence to standard
541 /// error. Useful for debugging overloading issues.
542 void ImplicitConversionSequence::dump() const {
543   raw_ostream &OS = llvm::errs();
544   if (isStdInitializerListElement())
545     OS << "Worst std::initializer_list element conversion: ";
546   switch (ConversionKind) {
547   case StandardConversion:
548     OS << "Standard conversion: ";
549     Standard.dump();
550     break;
551   case UserDefinedConversion:
552     OS << "User-defined conversion: ";
553     UserDefined.dump();
554     break;
555   case EllipsisConversion:
556     OS << "Ellipsis conversion";
557     break;
558   case AmbiguousConversion:
559     OS << "Ambiguous conversion";
560     break;
561   case BadConversion:
562     OS << "Bad conversion";
563     break;
564   }
565 
566   OS << "\n";
567 }
568 
569 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::construct() {
570   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet();
571 }
572 
573 void AmbiguousConversionSequence::destruct() {
574   conversions().~ConversionSet();
575 }
576 
577 void
578 AmbiguousConversionSequence::copyFrom(const AmbiguousConversionSequence &O) {
579   FromTypePtr = O.FromTypePtr;
580   ToTypePtr = O.ToTypePtr;
581   new (&conversions()) ConversionSet(O.conversions());
582 }
583 
584 namespace {
585   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
586   // template argument information.
587   struct DFIArguments {
588     TemplateArgument FirstArg;
589     TemplateArgument SecondArg;
590   };
591   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store
592   // template parameter and template argument information.
593   struct DFIParamWithArguments : DFIArguments {
594     TemplateParameter Param;
595   };
596   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store template argument
597   // information and the index of the problematic call argument.
598   struct DFIDeducedMismatchArgs : DFIArguments {
599     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
600     unsigned CallArgIndex;
601   };
602   // Structure used by DeductionFailureInfo to store information about
603   // unsatisfied constraints.
604   struct CNSInfo {
605     TemplateArgumentList *TemplateArgs;
606     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
607   };
608 }
609 
610 /// Convert from Sema's representation of template deduction information
611 /// to the form used in overload-candidate information.
612 DeductionFailureInfo
613 clang::MakeDeductionFailureInfo(ASTContext &Context,
614                                 Sema::TemplateDeductionResult TDK,
615                                 TemplateDeductionInfo &Info) {
616   DeductionFailureInfo Result;
617   Result.Result = static_cast<unsigned>(TDK);
618   Result.HasDiagnostic = false;
619   switch (TDK) {
620   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
621   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
622   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
623   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
624   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
625   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
626     Result.Data = nullptr;
627     break;
628 
629   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
630   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
631     Result.Data = Info.Param.getOpaqueValue();
632     break;
633 
634   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
635   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
636     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
637     auto *Saved = new (Context) DFIDeducedMismatchArgs;
638     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
639     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
640     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
641     Saved->CallArgIndex = Info.CallArgIndex;
642     Result.Data = Saved;
643     break;
644   }
645 
646   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
647     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
648     DFIArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIArguments;
649     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
650     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
651     Result.Data = Saved;
652     break;
653   }
654 
655   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
656     // FIXME: It's slightly wasteful to allocate two TemplateArguments for this.
657   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
658   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
659     // FIXME: Should allocate from normal heap so that we can free this later.
660     DFIParamWithArguments *Saved = new (Context) DFIParamWithArguments;
661     Saved->Param = Info.Param;
662     Saved->FirstArg = Info.FirstArg;
663     Saved->SecondArg = Info.SecondArg;
664     Result.Data = Saved;
665     break;
666   }
667 
668   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
669     Result.Data = Info.take();
670     if (Info.hasSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
671       PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = new (Result.Diagnostic) PartialDiagnosticAt(
672           SourceLocation(), PartialDiagnostic::NullDiagnostic());
673       Info.takeSFINAEDiagnostic(*Diag);
674       Result.HasDiagnostic = true;
675     }
676     break;
677 
678   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
679     CNSInfo *Saved = new (Context) CNSInfo;
680     Saved->TemplateArgs = Info.take();
681     Saved->Satisfaction = Info.AssociatedConstraintsSatisfaction;
682     Result.Data = Saved;
683     break;
684   }
685 
686   case Sema::TDK_Success:
687   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
688     llvm_unreachable("not a deduction failure");
689   }
690 
691   return Result;
692 }
693 
694 void DeductionFailureInfo::Destroy() {
695   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
696   case Sema::TDK_Success:
697   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
698   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
699   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
700   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
701   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
702   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
703   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
704   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
705     break;
706 
707   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
708   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
709   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
710   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
711   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
712   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
713     // FIXME: Destroy the data?
714     Data = nullptr;
715     break;
716 
717   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
718     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
719     Data = nullptr;
720     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
721       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
722       HasDiagnostic = false;
723     }
724     break;
725 
726   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
727     // FIXME: Destroy the template argument list?
728     Data = nullptr;
729     if (PartialDiagnosticAt *Diag = getSFINAEDiagnostic()) {
730       Diag->~PartialDiagnosticAt();
731       HasDiagnostic = false;
732     }
733     break;
734 
735   // Unhandled
736   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
737     break;
738   }
739 }
740 
741 PartialDiagnosticAt *DeductionFailureInfo::getSFINAEDiagnostic() {
742   if (HasDiagnostic)
743     return static_cast<PartialDiagnosticAt*>(static_cast<void*>(Diagnostic));
744   return nullptr;
745 }
746 
747 TemplateParameter DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateParameter() {
748   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
749   case Sema::TDK_Success:
750   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
751   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
752   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
753   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
754   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
755   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
756   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
757   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
758   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
759   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
760   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
761     return TemplateParameter();
762 
763   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
764   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
765     return TemplateParameter::getFromOpaqueValue(Data);
766 
767   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
768   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
769   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
770     return static_cast<DFIParamWithArguments*>(Data)->Param;
771 
772   // Unhandled
773   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
774     break;
775   }
776 
777   return TemplateParameter();
778 }
779 
780 TemplateArgumentList *DeductionFailureInfo::getTemplateArgumentList() {
781   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
782   case Sema::TDK_Success:
783   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
784   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
785   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
786   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
787   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
788   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
789   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
790   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
791   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
792   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
793   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
794   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
795     return nullptr;
796 
797   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
798   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
799     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
800 
801   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
802     return static_cast<TemplateArgumentList*>(Data);
803 
804   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
805     return static_cast<CNSInfo*>(Data)->TemplateArgs;
806 
807   // Unhandled
808   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
809     break;
810   }
811 
812   return nullptr;
813 }
814 
815 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getFirstArg() {
816   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
817   case Sema::TDK_Success:
818   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
819   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
820   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
821   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
822   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
823   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
824   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
825   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
826   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
827   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
828     return nullptr;
829 
830   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
831   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
832   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
833   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
834   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
835   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
836     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->FirstArg;
837 
838   // Unhandled
839   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
840     break;
841   }
842 
843   return nullptr;
844 }
845 
846 const TemplateArgument *DeductionFailureInfo::getSecondArg() {
847   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
848   case Sema::TDK_Success:
849   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
850   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
851   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
852   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
853   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
854   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
855   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
856   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
857   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
858   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
859   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
860     return nullptr;
861 
862   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
863   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
864   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
865   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
866   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
867     return &static_cast<DFIArguments*>(Data)->SecondArg;
868 
869   // Unhandled
870   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
871     break;
872   }
873 
874   return nullptr;
875 }
876 
877 llvm::Optional<unsigned> DeductionFailureInfo::getCallArgIndex() {
878   switch (static_cast<Sema::TemplateDeductionResult>(Result)) {
879   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
880   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
881     return static_cast<DFIDeducedMismatchArgs*>(Data)->CallArgIndex;
882 
883   default:
884     return llvm::None;
885   }
886 }
887 
888 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
889     OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
890   if (!AllowRewrittenCandidates)
891     return false;
892   return Op == OO_EqualEqual || Op == OO_Spaceship;
893 }
894 
895 bool OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo::shouldAddReversed(
896     ASTContext &Ctx, const FunctionDecl *FD) {
897   if (!shouldAddReversed(FD->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator()))
898     return false;
899   // Don't bother adding a reversed candidate that can never be a better
900   // match than the non-reversed version.
901   return FD->getNumParams() != 2 ||
902          !Ctx.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FD->getParamDecl(0)->getType(),
903                                      FD->getParamDecl(1)->getType()) ||
904          FD->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
905 }
906 
907 void OverloadCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
908   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
909     for (auto &C : i->Conversions)
910       C.~ImplicitConversionSequence();
911     if (!i->Viable && i->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
912       i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
913   }
914 }
915 
916 void OverloadCandidateSet::clear(CandidateSetKind CSK) {
917   destroyCandidates();
918   SlabAllocator.Reset();
919   NumInlineBytesUsed = 0;
920   Candidates.clear();
921   Functions.clear();
922   Kind = CSK;
923 }
924 
925 namespace {
926   class UnbridgedCastsSet {
927     struct Entry {
928       Expr **Addr;
929       Expr *Saved;
930     };
931     SmallVector<Entry, 2> Entries;
932 
933   public:
934     void save(Sema &S, Expr *&E) {
935       assert(E->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast));
936       Entry entry = { &E, E };
937       Entries.push_back(entry);
938       E = S.stripARCUnbridgedCast(E);
939     }
940 
941     void restore() {
942       for (SmallVectorImpl<Entry>::iterator
943              i = Entries.begin(), e = Entries.end(); i != e; ++i)
944         *i->Addr = i->Saved;
945     }
946   };
947 }
948 
949 /// checkPlaceholderForOverload - Do any interesting placeholder-like
950 /// preprocessing on the given expression.
951 ///
952 /// \param unbridgedCasts a collection to which to add unbridged casts;
953 ///   without this, they will be immediately diagnosed as errors
954 ///
955 /// Return true on unrecoverable error.
956 static bool
957 checkPlaceholderForOverload(Sema &S, Expr *&E,
958                             UnbridgedCastsSet *unbridgedCasts = nullptr) {
959   if (const BuiltinType *placeholder =  E->getType()->getAsPlaceholderType()) {
960     // We can't handle overloaded expressions here because overload
961     // resolution might reasonably tweak them.
962     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) return false;
963 
964     // If the context potentially accepts unbridged ARC casts, strip
965     // the unbridged cast and add it to the collection for later restoration.
966     if (placeholder->getKind() == BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast &&
967         unbridgedCasts) {
968       unbridgedCasts->save(S, E);
969       return false;
970     }
971 
972     // Go ahead and check everything else.
973     ExprResult result = S.CheckPlaceholderExpr(E);
974     if (result.isInvalid())
975       return true;
976 
977     E = result.get();
978     return false;
979   }
980 
981   // Nothing to do.
982   return false;
983 }
984 
985 /// checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload - Check a set of call operands for
986 /// placeholders.
987 static bool checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(Sema &S,
988                                             MultiExprArg Args,
989                                             UnbridgedCastsSet &unbridged) {
990   for (unsigned i = 0, e = Args.size(); i != e; ++i)
991     if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, Args[i], &unbridged))
992       return true;
993 
994   return false;
995 }
996 
997 /// Determine whether the given New declaration is an overload of the
998 /// declarations in Old. This routine returns Ovl_Match or Ovl_NonFunction if
999 /// New and Old cannot be overloaded, e.g., if New has the same signature as
1000 /// some function in Old (C++ 1.3.10) or if the Old declarations aren't
1001 /// functions (or function templates) at all. When it does return Ovl_Match or
1002 /// Ovl_NonFunction, MatchedDecl will point to the decl that New cannot be
1003 /// overloaded with. This decl may be a UsingShadowDecl on top of the underlying
1004 /// declaration.
1005 ///
1006 /// Example: Given the following input:
1007 ///
1008 ///   void f(int, float); // #1
1009 ///   void f(int, int); // #2
1010 ///   int f(int, int); // #3
1011 ///
1012 /// When we process #1, there is no previous declaration of "f", so IsOverload
1013 /// will not be used.
1014 ///
1015 /// When we process #2, Old contains only the FunctionDecl for #1. By comparing
1016 /// the parameter types, we see that #1 and #2 are overloaded (since they have
1017 /// different signatures), so this routine returns Ovl_Overload; MatchedDecl is
1018 /// unchanged.
1019 ///
1020 /// When we process #3, Old is an overload set containing #1 and #2. We compare
1021 /// the signatures of #3 to #1 (they're overloaded, so we do nothing) and then
1022 /// #3 to #2. Since the signatures of #3 and #2 are identical (return types of
1023 /// functions are not part of the signature), IsOverload returns Ovl_Match and
1024 /// MatchedDecl will be set to point to the FunctionDecl for #2.
1025 ///
1026 /// 'NewIsUsingShadowDecl' indicates that 'New' is being introduced into a class
1027 /// by a using declaration. The rules for whether to hide shadow declarations
1028 /// ignore some properties which otherwise figure into a function template's
1029 /// signature.
1030 Sema::OverloadKind
1031 Sema::CheckOverload(Scope *S, FunctionDecl *New, const LookupResult &Old,
1032                     NamedDecl *&Match, bool NewIsUsingDecl) {
1033   for (LookupResult::iterator I = Old.begin(), E = Old.end();
1034          I != E; ++I) {
1035     NamedDecl *OldD = *I;
1036 
1037     bool OldIsUsingDecl = false;
1038     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)) {
1039       OldIsUsingDecl = true;
1040 
1041       // We can always introduce two using declarations into the same
1042       // context, even if they have identical signatures.
1043       if (NewIsUsingDecl) continue;
1044 
1045       OldD = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(OldD)->getTargetDecl();
1046     }
1047 
1048     // A using-declaration does not conflict with another declaration
1049     // if one of them is hidden.
1050     if ((OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && !isVisible(*I))
1051       continue;
1052 
1053     // If either declaration was introduced by a using declaration,
1054     // we'll need to use slightly different rules for matching.
1055     // Essentially, these rules are the normal rules, except that
1056     // function templates hide function templates with different
1057     // return types or template parameter lists.
1058     bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules =
1059       (OldIsUsingDecl || NewIsUsingDecl) && CurContext->isRecord() &&
1060       !New->getFriendObjectKind();
1061 
1062     if (FunctionDecl *OldF = OldD->getAsFunction()) {
1063       if (!IsOverload(New, OldF, UseMemberUsingDeclRules)) {
1064         if (UseMemberUsingDeclRules && OldIsUsingDecl) {
1065           HideUsingShadowDecl(S, cast<UsingShadowDecl>(*I));
1066           continue;
1067         }
1068 
1069         if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(OldD) &&
1070             !shouldLinkPossiblyHiddenDecl(*I, New))
1071           continue;
1072 
1073         Match = *I;
1074         return Ovl_Match;
1075       }
1076 
1077       // Builtins that have custom typechecking or have a reference should
1078       // not be overloadable or redeclarable.
1079       if (!getASTContext().canBuiltinBeRedeclared(OldF)) {
1080         Match = *I;
1081         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1082       }
1083     } else if (isa<UsingDecl>(OldD) || isa<UsingPackDecl>(OldD)) {
1084       // We can overload with these, which can show up when doing
1085       // redeclaration checks for UsingDecls.
1086       assert(Old.getLookupKind() == LookupUsingDeclName);
1087     } else if (isa<TagDecl>(OldD)) {
1088       // We can always overload with tags by hiding them.
1089     } else if (auto *UUD = dyn_cast<UnresolvedUsingValueDecl>(OldD)) {
1090       // Optimistically assume that an unresolved using decl will
1091       // overload; if it doesn't, we'll have to diagnose during
1092       // template instantiation.
1093       //
1094       // Exception: if the scope is dependent and this is not a class
1095       // member, the using declaration can only introduce an enumerator.
1096       if (UUD->getQualifier()->isDependent() && !UUD->isCXXClassMember()) {
1097         Match = *I;
1098         return Ovl_NonFunction;
1099       }
1100     } else {
1101       // (C++ 13p1):
1102       //   Only function declarations can be overloaded; object and type
1103       //   declarations cannot be overloaded.
1104       Match = *I;
1105       return Ovl_NonFunction;
1106     }
1107   }
1108 
1109   // C++ [temp.friend]p1:
1110   //   For a friend function declaration that is not a template declaration:
1111   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified or unqualified template-id,
1112   //       [...], otherwise
1113   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching
1114   //       non-template function is found in the specified class or namespace,
1115   //       the friend declaration refers to that function, otherwise,
1116   //    -- if the name of the friend is a qualified-id and a matching function
1117   //       template is found in the specified class or namespace, the friend
1118   //       declaration refers to the deduced specialization of that function
1119   //       template, otherwise
1120   //    -- the name shall be an unqualified-id [...]
1121   // If we get here for a qualified friend declaration, we've just reached the
1122   // third bullet. If the type of the friend is dependent, skip this lookup
1123   // until instantiation.
1124   if (New->getFriendObjectKind() && New->getQualifier() &&
1125       !New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
1126       !New->getDependentSpecializationInfo() &&
1127       !New->getType()->isDependentType()) {
1128     LookupResult TemplateSpecResult(LookupResult::Temporary, Old);
1129     TemplateSpecResult.addAllDecls(Old);
1130     if (CheckFunctionTemplateSpecialization(New, nullptr, TemplateSpecResult,
1131                                             /*QualifiedFriend*/true)) {
1132       New->setInvalidDecl();
1133       return Ovl_Overload;
1134     }
1135 
1136     Match = TemplateSpecResult.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>();
1137     return Ovl_Match;
1138   }
1139 
1140   return Ovl_Overload;
1141 }
1142 
1143 bool Sema::IsOverload(FunctionDecl *New, FunctionDecl *Old,
1144                       bool UseMemberUsingDeclRules, bool ConsiderCudaAttrs,
1145                       bool ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1146   // C++ [basic.start.main]p2: This function shall not be overloaded.
1147   if (New->isMain())
1148     return false;
1149 
1150   // MSVCRT user defined entry points cannot be overloaded.
1151   if (New->isMSVCRTEntryPoint())
1152     return false;
1153 
1154   FunctionTemplateDecl *OldTemplate = Old->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1155   FunctionTemplateDecl *NewTemplate = New->getDescribedFunctionTemplate();
1156 
1157   // C++ [temp.fct]p2:
1158   //   A function template can be overloaded with other function templates
1159   //   and with normal (non-template) functions.
1160   if ((OldTemplate == nullptr) != (NewTemplate == nullptr))
1161     return true;
1162 
1163   // Is the function New an overload of the function Old?
1164   QualType OldQType = Context.getCanonicalType(Old->getType());
1165   QualType NewQType = Context.getCanonicalType(New->getType());
1166 
1167   // Compare the signatures (C++ 1.3.10) of the two functions to
1168   // determine whether they are overloads. If we find any mismatch
1169   // in the signature, they are overloads.
1170 
1171   // If either of these functions is a K&R-style function (no
1172   // prototype), then we consider them to have matching signatures.
1173   if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(OldQType.getTypePtr()) ||
1174       isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(NewQType.getTypePtr()))
1175     return false;
1176 
1177   const FunctionProtoType *OldType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(OldQType);
1178   const FunctionProtoType *NewType = cast<FunctionProtoType>(NewQType);
1179 
1180   // The signature of a function includes the types of its
1181   // parameters (C++ 1.3.10), which includes the presence or absence
1182   // of the ellipsis; see C++ DR 357).
1183   if (OldQType != NewQType &&
1184       (OldType->getNumParams() != NewType->getNumParams() ||
1185        OldType->isVariadic() != NewType->isVariadic() ||
1186        !FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(OldType, NewType)))
1187     return true;
1188 
1189   // C++ [temp.over.link]p4:
1190   //   The signature of a function template consists of its function
1191   //   signature, its return type and its template parameter list. The names
1192   //   of the template parameters are significant only for establishing the
1193   //   relationship between the template parameters and the rest of the
1194   //   signature.
1195   //
1196   // We check the return type and template parameter lists for function
1197   // templates first; the remaining checks follow.
1198   //
1199   // However, we don't consider either of these when deciding whether
1200   // a member introduced by a shadow declaration is hidden.
1201   if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules && NewTemplate &&
1202       (!TemplateParameterListsAreEqual(NewTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1203                                        OldTemplate->getTemplateParameters(),
1204                                        false, TPL_TemplateMatch) ||
1205        !Context.hasSameType(Old->getDeclaredReturnType(),
1206                             New->getDeclaredReturnType())))
1207     return true;
1208 
1209   // If the function is a class member, its signature includes the
1210   // cv-qualifiers (if any) and ref-qualifier (if any) on the function itself.
1211   //
1212   // As part of this, also check whether one of the member functions
1213   // is static, in which case they are not overloads (C++
1214   // 13.1p2). While not part of the definition of the signature,
1215   // this check is important to determine whether these functions
1216   // can be overloaded.
1217   CXXMethodDecl *OldMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Old);
1218   CXXMethodDecl *NewMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(New);
1219   if (OldMethod && NewMethod &&
1220       !OldMethod->isStatic() && !NewMethod->isStatic()) {
1221     if (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() != NewMethod->getRefQualifier()) {
1222       if (!UseMemberUsingDeclRules &&
1223           (OldMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None ||
1224            NewMethod->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None)) {
1225         // C++0x [over.load]p2:
1226         //   - Member function declarations with the same name and the same
1227         //     parameter-type-list as well as member function template
1228         //     declarations with the same name, the same parameter-type-list, and
1229         //     the same template parameter lists cannot be overloaded if any of
1230         //     them, but not all, have a ref-qualifier (8.3.5).
1231         Diag(NewMethod->getLocation(), diag::err_ref_qualifier_overload)
1232           << NewMethod->getRefQualifier() << OldMethod->getRefQualifier();
1233         Diag(OldMethod->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_declaration);
1234       }
1235       return true;
1236     }
1237 
1238     // We may not have applied the implicit const for a constexpr member
1239     // function yet (because we haven't yet resolved whether this is a static
1240     // or non-static member function). Add it now, on the assumption that this
1241     // is a redeclaration of OldMethod.
1242     auto OldQuals = OldMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1243     auto NewQuals = NewMethod->getMethodQualifiers();
1244     if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && NewMethod->isConstexpr() &&
1245         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(NewMethod))
1246       NewQuals.addConst();
1247     // We do not allow overloading based off of '__restrict'.
1248     OldQuals.removeRestrict();
1249     NewQuals.removeRestrict();
1250     if (OldQuals != NewQuals)
1251       return true;
1252   }
1253 
1254   // Though pass_object_size is placed on parameters and takes an argument, we
1255   // consider it to be a function-level modifier for the sake of function
1256   // identity. Either the function has one or more parameters with
1257   // pass_object_size or it doesn't.
1258   if (functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(New) !=
1259       functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Old))
1260     return true;
1261 
1262   // enable_if attributes are an order-sensitive part of the signature.
1263   for (specific_attr_iterator<EnableIfAttr>
1264          NewI = New->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1265          NewE = New->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>(),
1266          OldI = Old->specific_attr_begin<EnableIfAttr>(),
1267          OldE = Old->specific_attr_end<EnableIfAttr>();
1268        NewI != NewE || OldI != OldE; ++NewI, ++OldI) {
1269     if (NewI == NewE || OldI == OldE)
1270       return true;
1271     llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1272     NewI->getCond()->Profile(NewID, Context, true);
1273     OldI->getCond()->Profile(OldID, Context, true);
1274     if (NewID != OldID)
1275       return true;
1276   }
1277 
1278   if (getLangOpts().CUDA && ConsiderCudaAttrs) {
1279     // Don't allow overloading of destructors.  (In theory we could, but it
1280     // would be a giant change to clang.)
1281     if (!isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(New)) {
1282       CUDAFunctionTarget NewTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(New),
1283                          OldTarget = IdentifyCUDATarget(Old);
1284       if (NewTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) {
1285         assert((OldTarget != CFT_InvalidTarget) &&
1286                "Unexpected invalid target.");
1287 
1288         // Allow overloading of functions with same signature and different CUDA
1289         // target attributes.
1290         if (NewTarget != OldTarget)
1291           return true;
1292       }
1293     }
1294   }
1295 
1296   if (ConsiderRequiresClauses) {
1297     Expr *NewRC = New->getTrailingRequiresClause(),
1298          *OldRC = Old->getTrailingRequiresClause();
1299     if ((NewRC != nullptr) != (OldRC != nullptr))
1300       // RC are most certainly different - these are overloads.
1301       return true;
1302 
1303     if (NewRC) {
1304       llvm::FoldingSetNodeID NewID, OldID;
1305       NewRC->Profile(NewID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1306       OldRC->Profile(OldID, Context, /*Canonical=*/true);
1307       if (NewID != OldID)
1308         // RCs are not equivalent - these are overloads.
1309         return true;
1310     }
1311   }
1312 
1313   // The signatures match; this is not an overload.
1314   return false;
1315 }
1316 
1317 /// Tries a user-defined conversion from From to ToType.
1318 ///
1319 /// Produces an implicit conversion sequence for when a standard conversion
1320 /// is not an option. See TryImplicitConversion for more information.
1321 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1322 TryUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1323                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
1324                          AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1325                          bool InOverloadResolution,
1326                          bool CStyle,
1327                          bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1328                          bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1329   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1330 
1331   if (SuppressUserConversions) {
1332     // We're not in the case above, so there is no conversion that
1333     // we can perform.
1334     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1335     return ICS;
1336   }
1337 
1338   // Attempt user-defined conversion.
1339   OverloadCandidateSet Conversions(From->getExprLoc(),
1340                                    OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
1341   switch (IsUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
1342                                   Conversions, AllowExplicit,
1343                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit)) {
1344   case OR_Success:
1345   case OR_Deleted:
1346     ICS.setUserDefined();
1347     // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1348     //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1349     //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1350     //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1351     //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy
1352     //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1353     //   called for those cases.
1354     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
1355           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)) {
1356       QualType FromCanon
1357         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
1358       QualType ToCanon
1359         = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
1360       if (Constructor->isCopyConstructor() &&
1361           (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
1362            S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromCanon, ToCanon))) {
1363         // Turn this into a "standard" conversion sequence, so that it
1364         // gets ranked with standard conversion sequences.
1365         DeclAccessPair Found = ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction;
1366         ICS.setStandard();
1367         ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1368         ICS.Standard.setFromType(From->getType());
1369         ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1370         ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = Constructor;
1371         ICS.Standard.FoundCopyConstructor = Found;
1372         if (ToCanon != FromCanon)
1373           ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1374       }
1375     }
1376     break;
1377 
1378   case OR_Ambiguous:
1379     ICS.setAmbiguous();
1380     ICS.Ambiguous.setFromType(From->getType());
1381     ICS.Ambiguous.setToType(ToType);
1382     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = Conversions.begin();
1383          Cand != Conversions.end(); ++Cand)
1384       if (Cand->Best)
1385         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
1386     break;
1387 
1388     // Fall through.
1389   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
1390     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1391     break;
1392   }
1393 
1394   return ICS;
1395 }
1396 
1397 /// TryImplicitConversion - Attempt to perform an implicit conversion
1398 /// from the given expression (Expr) to the given type (ToType). This
1399 /// function returns an implicit conversion sequence that can be used
1400 /// to perform the initialization. Given
1401 ///
1402 ///   void f(float f);
1403 ///   void g(int i) { f(i); }
1404 ///
1405 /// this routine would produce an implicit conversion sequence to
1406 /// describe the initialization of f from i, which will be a standard
1407 /// conversion sequence containing an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++
1408 /// 4.1) followed by a floating-integral conversion (C++ 4.9).
1409 //
1410 /// Note that this routine only determines how the conversion can be
1411 /// performed; it does not actually perform the conversion. As such,
1412 /// it will not produce any diagnostics if no conversion is available,
1413 /// but will instead return an implicit conversion sequence of kind
1414 /// "BadConversion".
1415 ///
1416 /// If @p SuppressUserConversions, then user-defined conversions are
1417 /// not permitted.
1418 /// If @p AllowExplicit, then explicit user-defined conversions are
1419 /// permitted.
1420 ///
1421 /// \param AllowObjCWritebackConversion Whether we allow the Objective-C
1422 /// writeback conversion, which allows __autoreleasing id* parameters to
1423 /// be initialized with __strong id* or __weak id* arguments.
1424 static ImplicitConversionSequence
1425 TryImplicitConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1426                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
1427                       AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1428                       bool InOverloadResolution,
1429                       bool CStyle,
1430                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1431                       bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
1432   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
1433   if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1434                            ICS.Standard, CStyle, AllowObjCWritebackConversion)){
1435     ICS.setStandard();
1436     return ICS;
1437   }
1438 
1439   if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
1440     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
1441     return ICS;
1442   }
1443 
1444   // C++ [over.ics.user]p4:
1445   //   A conversion of an expression of class type to the same class
1446   //   type is given Exact Match rank, and a conversion of an
1447   //   expression of class type to a base class of that type is
1448   //   given Conversion rank, in spite of the fact that a copy/move
1449   //   constructor (i.e., a user-defined conversion function) is
1450   //   called for those cases.
1451   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1452   if (ToType->getAs<RecordType>() && FromType->getAs<RecordType>() &&
1453       (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType) ||
1454        S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType, ToType))) {
1455     ICS.setStandard();
1456     ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
1457     ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
1458     ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
1459 
1460     // We don't actually check at this point whether there is a valid
1461     // copy/move constructor, since overloading just assumes that it
1462     // exists. When we actually perform initialization, we'll find the
1463     // appropriate constructor to copy the returned object, if needed.
1464     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1465 
1466     // Determine whether this is considered a derived-to-base conversion.
1467     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1468       ICS.Standard.Second = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
1469 
1470     return ICS;
1471   }
1472 
1473   return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1474                                   AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1475                                   AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1476                                   AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
1477 }
1478 
1479 ImplicitConversionSequence
1480 Sema::TryImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1481                             bool SuppressUserConversions,
1482                             AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
1483                             bool InOverloadResolution,
1484                             bool CStyle,
1485                             bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1486   return ::TryImplicitConversion(*this, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
1487                                  AllowExplicit, InOverloadResolution, CStyle,
1488                                  AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1489                                  /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1490 }
1491 
1492 /// PerformImplicitConversion - Perform an implicit conversion of the
1493 /// expression From to the type ToType. Returns the
1494 /// converted expression. Flavor is the kind of conversion we're
1495 /// performing, used in the error message. If @p AllowExplicit,
1496 /// explicit user-defined conversions are permitted.
1497 ExprResult Sema::PerformImplicitConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1498                                            AssignmentAction Action,
1499                                            bool AllowExplicit) {
1500   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
1501     return ExprError();
1502 
1503   // Objective-C ARC: Determine whether we will allow the writeback conversion.
1504   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion
1505     = getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount &&
1506       (Action == AA_Passing || Action == AA_Sending);
1507   if (getLangOpts().ObjC)
1508     CheckObjCBridgeRelatedConversions(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
1509                                       From->getType(), From);
1510   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = ::TryImplicitConversion(
1511       *this, From, ToType,
1512       /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
1513       AllowExplicit ? AllowedExplicit::All : AllowedExplicit::None,
1514       /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
1515       /*CStyle=*/false, AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
1516       /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
1517   return PerformImplicitConversion(From, ToType, ICS, Action);
1518 }
1519 
1520 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1521 /// conversion that strips "noexcept" or "noreturn" off the nested function
1522 /// type.
1523 bool Sema::IsFunctionConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
1524                                 QualType &ResultTy) {
1525   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1526     return false;
1527 
1528   // Permit the conversion F(t __attribute__((noreturn))) -> F(t)
1529   //                    or F(t noexcept) -> F(t)
1530   // where F adds one of the following at most once:
1531   //   - a pointer
1532   //   - a member pointer
1533   //   - a block pointer
1534   // Changes here need matching changes in FindCompositePointerType.
1535   CanQualType CanTo = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1536   CanQualType CanFrom = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1537   Type::TypeClass TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1538   if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1539   if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto) {
1540     if (TyClass == Type::Pointer) {
1541       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1542       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1543     } else if (TyClass == Type::BlockPointer) {
1544       CanTo = CanTo.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1545       CanFrom = CanFrom.castAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
1546     } else if (TyClass == Type::MemberPointer) {
1547       auto ToMPT = CanTo.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1548       auto FromMPT = CanFrom.castAs<MemberPointerType>();
1549       // A function pointer conversion cannot change the class of the function.
1550       if (ToMPT->getClass() != FromMPT->getClass())
1551         return false;
1552       CanTo = ToMPT->getPointeeType();
1553       CanFrom = FromMPT->getPointeeType();
1554     } else {
1555       return false;
1556     }
1557 
1558     TyClass = CanTo->getTypeClass();
1559     if (TyClass != CanFrom->getTypeClass()) return false;
1560     if (TyClass != Type::FunctionProto && TyClass != Type::FunctionNoProto)
1561       return false;
1562   }
1563 
1564   const auto *FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanFrom);
1565   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFn->getExtInfo();
1566 
1567   const auto *ToFn = cast<FunctionType>(CanTo);
1568   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFn->getExtInfo();
1569 
1570   bool Changed = false;
1571 
1572   // Drop 'noreturn' if not present in target type.
1573   if (FromEInfo.getNoReturn() && !ToEInfo.getNoReturn()) {
1574     FromFn = Context.adjustFunctionType(FromFn, FromEInfo.withNoReturn(false));
1575     Changed = true;
1576   }
1577 
1578   // Drop 'noexcept' if not present in target type.
1579   if (const auto *FromFPT = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFn)) {
1580     const auto *ToFPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFn);
1581     if (FromFPT->isNothrow() && !ToFPT->isNothrow()) {
1582       FromFn = cast<FunctionType>(
1583           Context.getFunctionTypeWithExceptionSpec(QualType(FromFPT, 0),
1584                                                    EST_None)
1585                  .getTypePtr());
1586       Changed = true;
1587     }
1588 
1589     // Convert FromFPT's ExtParameterInfo if necessary. The conversion is valid
1590     // only if the ExtParameterInfo lists of the two function prototypes can be
1591     // merged and the merged list is identical to ToFPT's ExtParameterInfo list.
1592     SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
1593     bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
1594     if (Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFPT, FromFPT, CanUseToFPT,
1595                                       CanUseFromFPT, NewParamInfos) &&
1596         CanUseToFPT && !CanUseFromFPT) {
1597       FunctionProtoType::ExtProtoInfo ExtInfo = FromFPT->getExtProtoInfo();
1598       ExtInfo.ExtParameterInfos =
1599           NewParamInfos.empty() ? nullptr : NewParamInfos.data();
1600       QualType QT = Context.getFunctionType(FromFPT->getReturnType(),
1601                                             FromFPT->getParamTypes(), ExtInfo);
1602       FromFn = QT->getAs<FunctionType>();
1603       Changed = true;
1604     }
1605   }
1606 
1607   if (!Changed)
1608     return false;
1609 
1610   assert(QualType(FromFn, 0).isCanonical());
1611   if (QualType(FromFn, 0) != CanTo) return false;
1612 
1613   ResultTy = ToType;
1614   return true;
1615 }
1616 
1617 /// Determine whether the conversion from FromType to ToType is a valid
1618 /// vector conversion.
1619 ///
1620 /// \param ICK Will be set to the vector conversion kind, if this is a vector
1621 /// conversion.
1622 static bool IsVectorConversion(Sema &S, QualType FromType,
1623                                QualType ToType, ImplicitConversionKind &ICK) {
1624   // We need at least one of these types to be a vector type to have a vector
1625   // conversion.
1626   if (!ToType->isVectorType() && !FromType->isVectorType())
1627     return false;
1628 
1629   // Identical types require no conversions.
1630   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
1631     return false;
1632 
1633   // There are no conversions between extended vector types, only identity.
1634   if (ToType->isExtVectorType()) {
1635     // There are no conversions between extended vector types other than the
1636     // identity conversion.
1637     if (FromType->isExtVectorType())
1638       return false;
1639 
1640     // Vector splat from any arithmetic type to a vector.
1641     if (FromType->isArithmeticType()) {
1642       ICK = ICK_Vector_Splat;
1643       return true;
1644     }
1645   }
1646 
1647   if ((ToType->isSizelessBuiltinType() || FromType->isSizelessBuiltinType()) &&
1648       S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
1649     ICK = ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion;
1650     return true;
1651   }
1652 
1653   // We can perform the conversion between vector types in the following cases:
1654   // 1)vector types are equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
1655   // 2)lax vector conversions are permitted and the vector types are of the
1656   //   same size
1657   // 3)the destination type does not have the ARM MVE strict-polymorphism
1658   //   attribute, which inhibits lax vector conversion for overload resolution
1659   //   only
1660   if (ToType->isVectorType() && FromType->isVectorType()) {
1661     if (S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromType, ToType) ||
1662         (S.isLaxVectorConversion(FromType, ToType) &&
1663          !ToType->hasAttr(attr::ArmMveStrictPolymorphism))) {
1664       ICK = ICK_Vector_Conversion;
1665       return true;
1666     }
1667   }
1668 
1669   return false;
1670 }
1671 
1672 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
1673                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
1674                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1675                                 bool CStyle);
1676 
1677 /// IsStandardConversion - Determines whether there is a standard
1678 /// conversion sequence (C++ [conv], C++ [over.ics.scs]) from the
1679 /// expression From to the type ToType. Standard conversion sequences
1680 /// only consider non-class types; for conversions that involve class
1681 /// types, use TryImplicitConversion. If a conversion exists, SCS will
1682 /// contain the standard conversion sequence required to perform this
1683 /// conversion and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this
1684 /// routine will return false and the value of SCS is unspecified.
1685 static bool IsStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From, QualType ToType,
1686                                  bool InOverloadResolution,
1687                                  StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
1688                                  bool CStyle,
1689                                  bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
1690   QualType FromType = From->getType();
1691 
1692   // Standard conversions (C++ [conv])
1693   SCS.setAsIdentityConversion();
1694   SCS.IncompatibleObjC = false;
1695   SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1696   SCS.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
1697 
1698   // There are no standard conversions for class types in C++, so
1699   // abort early. When overloading in C, however, we do permit them.
1700   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1701       (FromType->isRecordType() || ToType->isRecordType()))
1702     return false;
1703 
1704   // The first conversion can be an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion,
1705   // array-to-pointer conversion, or function-to-pointer conversion
1706   // (C++ 4p1).
1707 
1708   if (FromType == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1709     DeclAccessPair AccessPair;
1710     if (FunctionDecl *Fn
1711           = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(From, ToType, false,
1712                                                  AccessPair)) {
1713       // We were able to resolve the address of the overloaded function,
1714       // so we can convert to the type of that function.
1715       FromType = Fn->getType();
1716       SCS.setFromType(FromType);
1717 
1718       // we can sometimes resolve &foo<int> regardless of ToType, so check
1719       // if the type matches (identity) or we are converting to bool
1720       if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
1721                       S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), FromType)) {
1722         QualType resultTy;
1723         // if the function type matches except for [[noreturn]], it's ok
1724         if (!S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType,
1725               S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(ToType), resultTy))
1726           // otherwise, only a boolean conversion is standard
1727           if (!ToType->isBooleanType())
1728             return false;
1729       }
1730 
1731       // Check if the "from" expression is taking the address of an overloaded
1732       // function and recompute the FromType accordingly. Take advantage of the
1733       // fact that non-static member functions *must* have such an address-of
1734       // expression.
1735       CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn);
1736       if (Method && !Method->isStatic()) {
1737         assert(isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens()) &&
1738                "Non-unary operator on non-static member address");
1739         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode()
1740                == UO_AddrOf &&
1741                "Non-address-of operator on non-static member address");
1742         const Type *ClassType
1743           = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(Method->getParent()).getTypePtr();
1744         FromType = S.Context.getMemberPointerType(FromType, ClassType);
1745       } else if (isa<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())) {
1746         assert(cast<UnaryOperator>(From->IgnoreParens())->getOpcode() ==
1747                UO_AddrOf &&
1748                "Non-address-of operator for overloaded function expression");
1749         FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1750       }
1751 
1752       // Check that we've computed the proper type after overload resolution.
1753       // FIXME: FixOverloadedFunctionReference has side-effects; we shouldn't
1754       // be calling it from within an NDEBUG block.
1755       assert(S.Context.hasSameType(
1756         FromType,
1757         S.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(From, AccessPair, Fn)->getType()));
1758     } else {
1759       return false;
1760     }
1761   }
1762   // Lvalue-to-rvalue conversion (C++11 4.1):
1763   //   A glvalue (3.10) of a non-function, non-array type T can
1764   //   be converted to a prvalue.
1765   bool argIsLValue = From->isGLValue();
1766   if (argIsLValue &&
1767       !FromType->isFunctionType() && !FromType->isArrayType() &&
1768       S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType) != S.Context.OverloadTy) {
1769     SCS.First = ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue;
1770 
1771     // C11 6.3.2.1p2:
1772     //   ... if the lvalue has atomic type, the value has the non-atomic version
1773     //   of the type of the lvalue ...
1774     if (const AtomicType *Atomic = FromType->getAs<AtomicType>())
1775       FromType = Atomic->getValueType();
1776 
1777     // If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
1778     // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the rvalue
1779     // is T (C++ 4.1p1). C++ can't get here with class types; in C, we
1780     // just strip the qualifiers because they don't matter.
1781     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1782   } else if (FromType->isArrayType()) {
1783     // Array-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.2)
1784     SCS.First = ICK_Array_To_Pointer;
1785 
1786     // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown
1787     // bound of T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to
1788     // T" (C++ 4.2p1).
1789     FromType = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType);
1790 
1791     if (S.IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(From, ToType)) {
1792       // This conversion is deprecated in C++03 (D.4)
1793       SCS.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = true;
1794 
1795       // For the purpose of ranking in overload resolution
1796       // (13.3.3.1.1), this conversion is considered an
1797       // array-to-pointer conversion followed by a qualification
1798       // conversion (4.4). (C++ 4.2p2)
1799       SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1800       SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1801       SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = false;
1802       SCS.setAllToTypes(FromType);
1803       return true;
1804     }
1805   } else if (FromType->isFunctionType() && argIsLValue) {
1806     // Function-to-pointer conversion (C++ 4.3).
1807     SCS.First = ICK_Function_To_Pointer;
1808 
1809     if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(From->IgnoreParenCasts()))
1810       if (auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl()))
1811         if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
1812           return false;
1813 
1814     // An lvalue of function type T can be converted to an rvalue of
1815     // type "pointer to T." The result is a pointer to the
1816     // function. (C++ 4.3p1).
1817     FromType = S.Context.getPointerType(FromType);
1818   } else {
1819     // We don't require any conversions for the first step.
1820     SCS.First = ICK_Identity;
1821   }
1822   SCS.setToType(0, FromType);
1823 
1824   // The second conversion can be an integral promotion, floating
1825   // point promotion, integral conversion, floating point conversion,
1826   // floating-integral conversion, pointer conversion,
1827   // pointer-to-member conversion, or boolean conversion (C++ 4p1).
1828   // For overloading in C, this can also be a "compatible-type"
1829   // conversion.
1830   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
1831   ImplicitConversionKind SecondICK = ICK_Identity;
1832   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType)) {
1833     // The unqualified versions of the types are the same: there's no
1834     // conversion to do.
1835     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1836   } else if (S.IsIntegralPromotion(From, FromType, ToType)) {
1837     // Integral promotion (C++ 4.5).
1838     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Promotion;
1839     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1840   } else if (S.IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1841     // Floating point promotion (C++ 4.6).
1842     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Promotion;
1843     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1844   } else if (S.IsComplexPromotion(FromType, ToType)) {
1845     // Complex promotion (Clang extension)
1846     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Promotion;
1847     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1848   } else if (ToType->isBooleanType() &&
1849              (FromType->isArithmeticType() ||
1850               FromType->isAnyPointerType() ||
1851               FromType->isBlockPointerType() ||
1852               FromType->isMemberPointerType())) {
1853     // Boolean conversions (C++ 4.12).
1854     SCS.Second = ICK_Boolean_Conversion;
1855     FromType = S.Context.BoolTy;
1856   } else if (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1857              ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) {
1858     // Integral conversions (C++ 4.7).
1859     SCS.Second = ICK_Integral_Conversion;
1860     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1861   } else if (FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isAnyComplexType()) {
1862     // Complex conversions (C99 6.3.1.6)
1863     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Conversion;
1864     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1865   } else if ((FromType->isAnyComplexType() && ToType->isArithmeticType()) ||
1866              (ToType->isAnyComplexType() && FromType->isArithmeticType())) {
1867     // Complex-real conversions (C99 6.3.1.7)
1868     SCS.Second = ICK_Complex_Real;
1869     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1870   } else if (FromType->isRealFloatingType() && ToType->isRealFloatingType()) {
1871     // FIXME: disable conversions between long double and __float128 if
1872     // their representation is different until there is back end support
1873     // We of course allow this conversion if long double is really double.
1874 
1875     // Conversions between bfloat and other floats are not permitted.
1876     if (FromType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty || ToType == S.Context.BFloat16Ty)
1877       return false;
1878     if (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(FromType) !=
1879         &S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(ToType)) {
1880       bool Float128AndLongDouble = ((FromType == S.Context.Float128Ty &&
1881                                     ToType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ||
1882                                    (FromType == S.Context.LongDoubleTy &&
1883                                     ToType == S.Context.Float128Ty));
1884       if (Float128AndLongDouble &&
1885           (&S.Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(S.Context.LongDoubleTy) ==
1886            &llvm::APFloat::PPCDoubleDouble()))
1887         return false;
1888     }
1889     // Floating point conversions (C++ 4.8).
1890     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Conversion;
1891     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1892   } else if ((FromType->isRealFloatingType() &&
1893               ToType->isIntegralType(S.Context)) ||
1894              (FromType->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
1895               ToType->isRealFloatingType())) {
1896     // Conversions between bfloat and int are not permitted.
1897     if (FromType->isBFloat16Type() || ToType->isBFloat16Type())
1898       return false;
1899 
1900     // Floating-integral conversions (C++ 4.9).
1901     SCS.Second = ICK_Floating_Integral;
1902     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1903   } else if (S.IsBlockPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1904     SCS.Second = ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion;
1905   } else if (AllowObjCWritebackConversion &&
1906              S.isObjCWritebackConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1907     SCS.Second = ICK_Writeback_Conversion;
1908   } else if (S.IsPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType, InOverloadResolution,
1909                                    FromType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
1910     // Pointer conversions (C++ 4.10).
1911     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Conversion;
1912     SCS.IncompatibleObjC = IncompatibleObjC;
1913     FromType = FromType.getUnqualifiedType();
1914   } else if (S.IsMemberPointerConversion(From, FromType, ToType,
1915                                          InOverloadResolution, FromType)) {
1916     // Pointer to member conversions (4.11).
1917     SCS.Second = ICK_Pointer_Member;
1918   } else if (IsVectorConversion(S, FromType, ToType, SecondICK)) {
1919     SCS.Second = SecondICK;
1920     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1921   } else if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
1922              S.Context.typesAreCompatible(ToType, FromType)) {
1923     // Compatible conversions (Clang extension for C function overloading)
1924     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1925     FromType = ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
1926   } else if (IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(S, From, ToType,
1927                                              InOverloadResolution,
1928                                              SCS, CStyle)) {
1929     SCS.Second = ICK_TransparentUnionConversion;
1930     FromType = ToType;
1931   } else if (tryAtomicConversion(S, From, ToType, InOverloadResolution, SCS,
1932                                  CStyle)) {
1933     // tryAtomicConversion has updated the standard conversion sequence
1934     // appropriately.
1935     return true;
1936   } else if (ToType->isEventT() &&
1937              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1938              From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0) {
1939     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion;
1940     FromType = ToType;
1941   } else if (ToType->isQueueT() &&
1942              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext()) &&
1943              (From->EvaluateKnownConstInt(S.getASTContext()) == 0)) {
1944     SCS.Second = ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion;
1945     FromType = ToType;
1946   } else if (ToType->isSamplerT() &&
1947              From->isIntegerConstantExpr(S.getASTContext())) {
1948     SCS.Second = ICK_Compatible_Conversion;
1949     FromType = ToType;
1950   } else {
1951     // No second conversion required.
1952     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
1953   }
1954   SCS.setToType(1, FromType);
1955 
1956   // The third conversion can be a function pointer conversion or a
1957   // qualification conversion (C++ [conv.fctptr], [conv.qual]).
1958   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1959   if (S.IsFunctionConversion(FromType, ToType, FromType)) {
1960     // Function pointer conversions (removing 'noexcept') including removal of
1961     // 'noreturn' (Clang extension).
1962     SCS.Third = ICK_Function_Conversion;
1963   } else if (S.IsQualificationConversion(FromType, ToType, CStyle,
1964                                          ObjCLifetimeConversion)) {
1965     SCS.Third = ICK_Qualification;
1966     SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime = ObjCLifetimeConversion;
1967     FromType = ToType;
1968   } else {
1969     // No conversion required
1970     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
1971   }
1972 
1973   // C++ [over.best.ics]p6:
1974   //   [...] Any difference in top-level cv-qualification is
1975   //   subsumed by the initialization itself and does not constitute
1976   //   a conversion. [...]
1977   QualType CanonFrom = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
1978   QualType CanonTo = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
1979   if (CanonFrom.getLocalUnqualifiedType()
1980                                      == CanonTo.getLocalUnqualifiedType() &&
1981       CanonFrom.getLocalQualifiers() != CanonTo.getLocalQualifiers()) {
1982     FromType = ToType;
1983     CanonFrom = CanonTo;
1984   }
1985 
1986   SCS.setToType(2, FromType);
1987 
1988   if (CanonFrom == CanonTo)
1989     return true;
1990 
1991   // If we have not converted the argument type to the parameter type,
1992   // this is a bad conversion sequence, unless we're resolving an overload in C.
1993   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !InOverloadResolution)
1994     return false;
1995 
1996   ExprResult ER = ExprResult{From};
1997   Sema::AssignConvertType Conv =
1998       S.CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(ToType, ER,
1999                                          /*Diagnose=*/false,
2000                                          /*DiagnoseCFAudited=*/false,
2001                                          /*ConvertRHS=*/false);
2002   ImplicitConversionKind SecondConv;
2003   switch (Conv) {
2004   case Sema::Compatible:
2005     SecondConv = ICK_C_Only_Conversion;
2006     break;
2007   // For our purposes, discarding qualifiers is just as bad as using an
2008   // incompatible pointer. Note that an IncompatiblePointer conversion can drop
2009   // qualifiers, as well.
2010   case Sema::CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
2011   case Sema::IncompatiblePointer:
2012   case Sema::IncompatiblePointerSign:
2013     SecondConv = ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
2014     break;
2015   default:
2016     return false;
2017   }
2018 
2019   // First can only be an lvalue conversion, so we pretend that this was the
2020   // second conversion. First should already be valid from earlier in the
2021   // function.
2022   SCS.Second = SecondConv;
2023   SCS.setToType(1, ToType);
2024 
2025   // Third is Identity, because Second should rank us worse than any other
2026   // conversion. This could also be ICK_Qualification, but it's simpler to just
2027   // lump everything in with the second conversion, and we don't gain anything
2028   // from making this ICK_Qualification.
2029   SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
2030   SCS.setToType(2, ToType);
2031   return true;
2032 }
2033 
2034 static bool
2035 IsTransparentUnionStandardConversion(Sema &S, Expr* From,
2036                                      QualType &ToType,
2037                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
2038                                      StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
2039                                      bool CStyle) {
2040 
2041   const RecordType *UT = ToType->getAsUnionType();
2042   if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
2043     return false;
2044   // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
2045   RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
2046   // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
2047   for (const auto *it : UD->fields()) {
2048     if (IsStandardConversion(S, From, it->getType(), InOverloadResolution, SCS,
2049                              CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false)) {
2050       ToType = it->getType();
2051       return true;
2052     }
2053   }
2054   return false;
2055 }
2056 
2057 /// IsIntegralPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from the
2058 /// expression From (whose potentially-adjusted type is FromType) to
2059 /// ToType is an integral promotion (C++ 4.5). If so, returns true and
2060 /// sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2061 bool Sema::IsIntegralPromotion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2062   const BuiltinType *To = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>();
2063   // All integers are built-in.
2064   if (!To) {
2065     return false;
2066   }
2067 
2068   // An rvalue of type char, signed char, unsigned char, short int, or
2069   // unsigned short int can be converted to an rvalue of type int if
2070   // int can represent all the values of the source type; otherwise,
2071   // the source rvalue can be converted to an rvalue of type unsigned
2072   // int (C++ 4.5p1).
2073   if (FromType->isPromotableIntegerType() && !FromType->isBooleanType() &&
2074       !FromType->isEnumeralType()) {
2075     if (// We can promote any signed, promotable integer type to an int
2076         (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() ||
2077          // We can promote any unsigned integer type whose size is
2078          // less than int to an int.
2079          Context.getTypeSize(FromType) < Context.getTypeSize(ToType))) {
2080       return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2081     }
2082 
2083     return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2084   }
2085 
2086   // C++11 [conv.prom]p3:
2087   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is not
2088   //   fixed (7.2) can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the
2089   //   following types that can represent all the values of the enumeration
2090   //   (i.e., the values in the range bmin to bmax as described in 7.2): int,
2091   //   unsigned int, long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned
2092   //   long long int. If none of the types in that list can represent all the
2093   //   values of the enumeration, an rvalue a prvalue of an unscoped enumeration
2094   //   type can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of the extended integer type
2095   //   with lowest integer conversion rank (4.13) greater than the rank of long
2096   //   long in which all the values of the enumeration can be represented. If
2097   //   there are two such extended types, the signed one is chosen.
2098   // C++11 [conv.prom]p4:
2099   //   A prvalue of an unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed
2100   //   can be converted to a prvalue of its underlying type. Moreover, if
2101   //   integral promotion can be applied to its underlying type, a prvalue of an
2102   //   unscoped enumeration type whose underlying type is fixed can also be
2103   //   converted to a prvalue of the promoted underlying type.
2104   if (const EnumType *FromEnumType = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()) {
2105     // C++0x 7.2p9: Note that this implicit enum to int conversion is not
2106     // provided for a scoped enumeration.
2107     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isScoped())
2108       return false;
2109 
2110     // We can perform an integral promotion to the underlying type of the enum,
2111     // even if that's not the promoted type. Note that the check for promoting
2112     // the underlying type is based on the type alone, and does not consider
2113     // the bitfield-ness of the actual source expression.
2114     if (FromEnumType->getDecl()->isFixed()) {
2115       QualType Underlying = FromEnumType->getDecl()->getIntegerType();
2116       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Underlying, ToType) ||
2117              IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, Underlying, ToType);
2118     }
2119 
2120     // We have already pre-calculated the promotion type, so this is trivial.
2121     if (ToType->isIntegerType() &&
2122         isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), FromType))
2123       return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(
2124           ToType, FromEnumType->getDecl()->getPromotionType());
2125 
2126     // C++ [conv.prom]p5:
2127     //   If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any other
2128     //   value of that type for promotion purposes.
2129     //
2130     // ... so do not fall through into the bit-field checks below in C++.
2131     if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
2132       return false;
2133   }
2134 
2135   // C++0x [conv.prom]p2:
2136   //   A prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t, or wchar_t (3.9.1) can be converted
2137   //   to an rvalue a prvalue of the first of the following types that can
2138   //   represent all the values of its underlying type: int, unsigned int,
2139   //   long int, unsigned long int, long long int, or unsigned long long int.
2140   //   If none of the types in that list can represent all the values of its
2141   //   underlying type, an rvalue a prvalue of type char16_t, char32_t,
2142   //   or wchar_t can be converted to an rvalue a prvalue of its underlying
2143   //   type.
2144   if (FromType->isAnyCharacterType() && !FromType->isCharType() &&
2145       ToType->isIntegerType()) {
2146     // Determine whether the type we're converting from is signed or
2147     // unsigned.
2148     bool FromIsSigned = FromType->isSignedIntegerType();
2149     uint64_t FromSize = Context.getTypeSize(FromType);
2150 
2151     // The types we'll try to promote to, in the appropriate
2152     // order. Try each of these types.
2153     QualType PromoteTypes[6] = {
2154       Context.IntTy, Context.UnsignedIntTy,
2155       Context.LongTy, Context.UnsignedLongTy ,
2156       Context.LongLongTy, Context.UnsignedLongLongTy
2157     };
2158     for (int Idx = 0; Idx < 6; ++Idx) {
2159       uint64_t ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2160       if (FromSize < ToSize ||
2161           (FromSize == ToSize &&
2162            FromIsSigned == PromoteTypes[Idx]->isSignedIntegerType())) {
2163         // We found the type that we can promote to. If this is the
2164         // type we wanted, we have a promotion. Otherwise, no
2165         // promotion.
2166         return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, PromoteTypes[Idx]);
2167       }
2168     }
2169   }
2170 
2171   // An rvalue for an integral bit-field (9.6) can be converted to an
2172   // rvalue of type int if int can represent all the values of the
2173   // bit-field; otherwise, it can be converted to unsigned int if
2174   // unsigned int can represent all the values of the bit-field. If
2175   // the bit-field is larger yet, no integral promotion applies to
2176   // it. If the bit-field has an enumerated type, it is treated as any
2177   // other value of that type for promotion purposes (C++ 4.5p3).
2178   // FIXME: We should delay checking of bit-fields until we actually perform the
2179   // conversion.
2180   //
2181   // FIXME: In C, only bit-fields of types _Bool, int, or unsigned int may be
2182   // promoted, per C11 6.3.1.1/2. We promote all bit-fields (including enum
2183   // bit-fields and those whose underlying type is larger than int) for GCC
2184   // compatibility.
2185   if (From) {
2186     if (FieldDecl *MemberDecl = From->getSourceBitField()) {
2187       Optional<llvm::APSInt> BitWidth;
2188       if (FromType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
2189           (BitWidth =
2190                MemberDecl->getBitWidth()->getIntegerConstantExpr(Context))) {
2191         llvm::APSInt ToSize(BitWidth->getBitWidth(), BitWidth->isUnsigned());
2192         ToSize = Context.getTypeSize(ToType);
2193 
2194         // Are we promoting to an int from a bitfield that fits in an int?
2195         if (*BitWidth < ToSize ||
2196             (FromType->isSignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize)) {
2197           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int;
2198         }
2199 
2200         // Are we promoting to an unsigned int from an unsigned bitfield
2201         // that fits into an unsigned int?
2202         if (FromType->isUnsignedIntegerType() && *BitWidth <= ToSize) {
2203           return To->getKind() == BuiltinType::UInt;
2204         }
2205 
2206         return false;
2207       }
2208     }
2209   }
2210 
2211   // An rvalue of type bool can be converted to an rvalue of type int,
2212   // with false becoming zero and true becoming one (C++ 4.5p4).
2213   if (FromType->isBooleanType() && To->getKind() == BuiltinType::Int) {
2214     return true;
2215   }
2216 
2217   return false;
2218 }
2219 
2220 /// IsFloatingPointPromotion - Determines whether the conversion from
2221 /// FromType to ToType is a floating point promotion (C++ 4.6). If so,
2222 /// returns true and sets PromotedType to the promoted type.
2223 bool Sema::IsFloatingPointPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2224   if (const BuiltinType *FromBuiltin = FromType->getAs<BuiltinType>())
2225     if (const BuiltinType *ToBuiltin = ToType->getAs<BuiltinType>()) {
2226       /// An rvalue of type float can be converted to an rvalue of type
2227       /// double. (C++ 4.6p1).
2228       if (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float &&
2229           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double)
2230         return true;
2231 
2232       // C99 6.3.1.5p1:
2233       //   When a float is promoted to double or long double, or a
2234       //   double is promoted to long double [...].
2235       if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2236           (FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float ||
2237            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Double) &&
2238           (ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::LongDouble ||
2239            ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float128))
2240         return true;
2241 
2242       // Half can be promoted to float.
2243       if (!getLangOpts().NativeHalfType &&
2244            FromBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Half &&
2245           ToBuiltin->getKind() == BuiltinType::Float)
2246         return true;
2247     }
2248 
2249   return false;
2250 }
2251 
2252 /// Determine if a conversion is a complex promotion.
2253 ///
2254 /// A complex promotion is defined as a complex -> complex conversion
2255 /// where the conversion between the underlying real types is a
2256 /// floating-point or integral promotion.
2257 bool Sema::IsComplexPromotion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2258   const ComplexType *FromComplex = FromType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2259   if (!FromComplex)
2260     return false;
2261 
2262   const ComplexType *ToComplex = ToType->getAs<ComplexType>();
2263   if (!ToComplex)
2264     return false;
2265 
2266   return IsFloatingPointPromotion(FromComplex->getElementType(),
2267                                   ToComplex->getElementType()) ||
2268     IsIntegralPromotion(nullptr, FromComplex->getElementType(),
2269                         ToComplex->getElementType());
2270 }
2271 
2272 /// BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType - In a pointer conversion from
2273 /// the pointer type FromPtr to a pointer to type ToPointee, with the
2274 /// same type qualifiers as FromPtr has on its pointee type. ToType,
2275 /// if non-empty, will be a pointer to ToType that may or may not have
2276 /// the right set of qualifiers on its pointee.
2277 ///
2278 static QualType
2279 BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(const Type *FromPtr,
2280                                    QualType ToPointee, QualType ToType,
2281                                    ASTContext &Context,
2282                                    bool StripObjCLifetime = false) {
2283   assert((FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::Pointer ||
2284           FromPtr->getTypeClass() == Type::ObjCObjectPointer) &&
2285          "Invalid similarly-qualified pointer type");
2286 
2287   /// Conversions to 'id' subsume cv-qualifier conversions.
2288   if (ToType->isObjCIdType() || ToType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
2289     return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2290 
2291   QualType CanonFromPointee
2292     = Context.getCanonicalType(FromPtr->getPointeeType());
2293   QualType CanonToPointee = Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointee);
2294   Qualifiers Quals = CanonFromPointee.getQualifiers();
2295 
2296   if (StripObjCLifetime)
2297     Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
2298 
2299   // Exact qualifier match -> return the pointer type we're converting to.
2300   if (CanonToPointee.getLocalQualifiers() == Quals) {
2301     // ToType is exactly what we need. Return it.
2302     if (!ToType.isNull())
2303       return ToType.getUnqualifiedType();
2304 
2305     // Build a pointer to ToPointee. It has the right qualifiers
2306     // already.
2307     if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2308       return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(ToPointee);
2309     return Context.getPointerType(ToPointee);
2310   }
2311 
2312   // Just build a canonical type that has the right qualifiers.
2313   QualType QualifiedCanonToPointee
2314     = Context.getQualifiedType(CanonToPointee.getLocalUnqualifiedType(), Quals);
2315 
2316   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(ToType))
2317     return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2318   return Context.getPointerType(QualifiedCanonToPointee);
2319 }
2320 
2321 static bool isNullPointerConstantForConversion(Expr *Expr,
2322                                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2323                                                ASTContext &Context) {
2324   // Handle value-dependent integral null pointer constants correctly.
2325   // http://www.open-std.org/jtc1/sc22/wg21/docs/cwg_active.html#903
2326   if (Expr->isValueDependent() && !Expr->isTypeDependent() &&
2327       Expr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !Expr->getType()->isEnumeralType())
2328     return !InOverloadResolution;
2329 
2330   return Expr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
2331                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
2332                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
2333 }
2334 
2335 /// IsPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
2336 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType,
2337 /// can be converted to the type ToType via a pointer conversion (C++
2338 /// 4.10). If so, returns true and places the converted type (that
2339 /// might differ from ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into
2340 /// ConvertedType.
2341 ///
2342 /// This routine also supports conversions to and from block pointers
2343 /// and conversions with Objective-C's 'id', 'id<protocols...>', and
2344 /// pointers to interfaces. FIXME: Once we've determined the
2345 /// appropriate overloading rules for Objective-C, we may want to
2346 /// split the Objective-C checks into a different routine; however,
2347 /// GCC seems to consider all of these conversions to be pointer
2348 /// conversions, so for now they live here. IncompatibleObjC will be
2349 /// set if the conversion is an allowed Objective-C conversion that
2350 /// should result in a warning.
2351 bool Sema::IsPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2352                                bool InOverloadResolution,
2353                                QualType& ConvertedType,
2354                                bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2355   IncompatibleObjC = false;
2356   if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromType, ToType, ConvertedType,
2357                               IncompatibleObjC))
2358     return true;
2359 
2360   // Conversion from a null pointer constant to any Objective-C pointer type.
2361   if (ToType->isObjCObjectPointerType() &&
2362       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2363     ConvertedType = ToType;
2364     return true;
2365   }
2366 
2367   // Blocks: Block pointers can be converted to void*.
2368   if (FromType->isBlockPointerType() && ToType->isPointerType() &&
2369       ToType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
2370     ConvertedType = ToType;
2371     return true;
2372   }
2373   // Blocks: A null pointer constant can be converted to a block
2374   // pointer type.
2375   if (ToType->isBlockPointerType() &&
2376       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2377     ConvertedType = ToType;
2378     return true;
2379   }
2380 
2381   // If the left-hand-side is nullptr_t, the right side can be a null
2382   // pointer constant.
2383   if (ToType->isNullPtrType() &&
2384       isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2385     ConvertedType = ToType;
2386     return true;
2387   }
2388 
2389   const PointerType* ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>();
2390   if (!ToTypePtr)
2391     return false;
2392 
2393   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a pointer type (C++ 4.10p1).
2394   if (isNullPointerConstantForConversion(From, InOverloadResolution, Context)) {
2395     ConvertedType = ToType;
2396     return true;
2397   }
2398 
2399   // Beyond this point, both types need to be pointers
2400   // , including objective-c pointers.
2401   QualType ToPointeeType = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2402   if (FromType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType() &&
2403       !getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount) {
2404     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(
2405                                       FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>(),
2406                                                        ToPointeeType,
2407                                                        ToType, Context);
2408     return true;
2409   }
2410   const PointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>();
2411   if (!FromTypePtr)
2412     return false;
2413 
2414   QualType FromPointeeType = FromTypePtr->getPointeeType();
2415 
2416   // If the unqualified pointee types are the same, this can't be a
2417   // pointer conversion, so don't do all of the work below.
2418   if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2419     return false;
2420 
2421   // An rvalue of type "pointer to cv T," where T is an object type,
2422   // can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv void" (C++
2423   // 4.10p2).
2424   if (FromPointeeType->isIncompleteOrObjectType() &&
2425       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2426     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2427                                                        ToPointeeType,
2428                                                        ToType, Context,
2429                                                    /*StripObjCLifetime=*/true);
2430     return true;
2431   }
2432 
2433   // MSVC allows implicit function to void* type conversion.
2434   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() &&
2435       ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
2436     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2437                                                        ToPointeeType,
2438                                                        ToType, Context);
2439     return true;
2440   }
2441 
2442   // When we're overloading in C, we allow a special kind of pointer
2443   // conversion for compatible-but-not-identical pointee types.
2444   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus &&
2445       Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2446     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2447                                                        ToPointeeType,
2448                                                        ToType, Context);
2449     return true;
2450   }
2451 
2452   // C++ [conv.ptr]p3:
2453   //
2454   //   An rvalue of type "pointer to cv D," where D is a class type,
2455   //   can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to cv B," where
2456   //   B is a base class (clause 10) of D. If B is an inaccessible
2457   //   (clause 11) or ambiguous (10.2) base class of D, a program that
2458   //   necessitates this conversion is ill-formed. The result of the
2459   //   conversion is a pointer to the base class sub-object of the
2460   //   derived class object. The null pointer value is converted to
2461   //   the null pointer value of the destination type.
2462   //
2463   // Note that we do not check for ambiguity or inaccessibility
2464   // here. That is handled by CheckPointerConversion.
2465   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && FromPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2466       ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
2467       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType) &&
2468       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2469     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2470                                                        ToPointeeType,
2471                                                        ToType, Context);
2472     return true;
2473   }
2474 
2475   if (FromPointeeType->isVectorType() && ToPointeeType->isVectorType() &&
2476       Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
2477     ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromTypePtr,
2478                                                        ToPointeeType,
2479                                                        ToType, Context);
2480     return true;
2481   }
2482 
2483   return false;
2484 }
2485 
2486 /// Adopt the given qualifiers for the given type.
2487 static QualType AdoptQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, QualType T, Qualifiers Qs){
2488   Qualifiers TQs = T.getQualifiers();
2489 
2490   // Check whether qualifiers already match.
2491   if (TQs == Qs)
2492     return T;
2493 
2494   if (Qs.compatiblyIncludes(TQs))
2495     return Context.getQualifiedType(T, Qs);
2496 
2497   return Context.getQualifiedType(T.getUnqualifiedType(), Qs);
2498 }
2499 
2500 /// isObjCPointerConversion - Determines whether this is an
2501 /// Objective-C pointer conversion. Subroutine of IsPointerConversion,
2502 /// with the same arguments and return values.
2503 bool Sema::isObjCPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2504                                    QualType& ConvertedType,
2505                                    bool &IncompatibleObjC) {
2506   if (!getLangOpts().ObjC)
2507     return false;
2508 
2509   // The set of qualifiers on the type we're converting from.
2510   Qualifiers FromQualifiers = FromType.getQualifiers();
2511 
2512   // First, we handle all conversions on ObjC object pointer types.
2513   const ObjCObjectPointerType* ToObjCPtr =
2514     ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2515   const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromObjCPtr =
2516     FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
2517 
2518   if (ToObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr) {
2519     // If the pointee types are the same (ignoring qualifications),
2520     // then this is not a pointer conversion.
2521     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2522                                        FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2523       return false;
2524 
2525     // Conversion between Objective-C pointers.
2526     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToObjCPtr, FromObjCPtr)) {
2527       const ObjCInterfaceType* LHS = ToObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2528       const ObjCInterfaceType* RHS = FromObjCPtr->getInterfaceType();
2529       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && LHS && RHS &&
2530           !ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
2531                                                 FromObjCPtr->getPointeeType()))
2532         return false;
2533       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2534                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2535                                                          ToType, Context);
2536       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2537       return true;
2538     }
2539 
2540     if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr, ToObjCPtr)) {
2541       // Okay: this is some kind of implicit downcast of Objective-C
2542       // interfaces, which is permitted. However, we're going to
2543       // complain about it.
2544       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2545       ConvertedType = BuildSimilarlyQualifiedPointerType(FromObjCPtr,
2546                                                    ToObjCPtr->getPointeeType(),
2547                                                          ToType, Context);
2548       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2549       return true;
2550     }
2551   }
2552   // Beyond this point, both types need to be C pointers or block pointers.
2553   QualType ToPointeeType;
2554   if (const PointerType *ToCPtr = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2555     ToPointeeType = ToCPtr->getPointeeType();
2556   else if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2557             ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
2558     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a pointer to any object
2559     // to a block pointer type.
2560     if (FromObjCPtr && FromObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2561       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2562       return true;
2563     }
2564     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2565   }
2566   else if (FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>() &&
2567            ToObjCPtr && ToObjCPtr->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
2568     // Objective C++: We're able to convert from a block pointer type to a
2569     // pointer to any object.
2570     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2571     return true;
2572   }
2573   else
2574     return false;
2575 
2576   QualType FromPointeeType;
2577   if (const PointerType *FromCPtr = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2578     FromPointeeType = FromCPtr->getPointeeType();
2579   else if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2580            FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2581     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2582   else
2583     return false;
2584 
2585   // If we have pointers to pointers, recursively check whether this
2586   // is an Objective-C conversion.
2587   if (FromPointeeType->isPointerType() && ToPointeeType->isPointerType() &&
2588       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2589                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2590     // We always complain about this conversion.
2591     IncompatibleObjC = true;
2592     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2593     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2594     return true;
2595   }
2596   // Allow conversion of pointee being objective-c pointer to another one;
2597   // as in I* to id.
2598   if (FromPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2599       ToPointeeType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>() &&
2600       isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, ConvertedType,
2601                               IncompatibleObjC)) {
2602 
2603     ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(ConvertedType);
2604     ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ConvertedType, FromQualifiers);
2605     return true;
2606   }
2607 
2608   // If we have pointers to functions or blocks, check whether the only
2609   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2610   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion (but
2611   // complain about it).
2612   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2613     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2614   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2615     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2616   if (FromFunctionType && ToFunctionType) {
2617     // If the function types are exactly the same, this isn't an
2618     // Objective-C pointer conversion.
2619     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromPointeeType)
2620           == Context.getCanonicalType(ToPointeeType))
2621       return false;
2622 
2623     // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2624     // function types are obviously different.
2625     if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2626         FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic() ||
2627         FromFunctionType->getMethodQuals() != ToFunctionType->getMethodQuals())
2628       return false;
2629 
2630     bool HasObjCConversion = false;
2631     if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType()) ==
2632         Context.getCanonicalType(ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2633       // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2634     } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2635                                        ToFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2636                                        ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2637       // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2638       HasObjCConversion = true;
2639     } else {
2640       // Function types are too different. Abort.
2641       return false;
2642     }
2643 
2644     // Check argument types.
2645     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2646          ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2647       QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2648       QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2649       if (Context.getCanonicalType(FromArgType)
2650             == Context.getCanonicalType(ToArgType)) {
2651         // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2652       } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(FromArgType, ToArgType,
2653                                          ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2654         // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2655         HasObjCConversion = true;
2656       } else {
2657         // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2658         return false;
2659       }
2660     }
2661 
2662     if (HasObjCConversion) {
2663       // We had an Objective-C conversion. Allow this pointer
2664       // conversion, but complain about it.
2665       ConvertedType = AdoptQualifiers(Context, ToType, FromQualifiers);
2666       IncompatibleObjC = true;
2667       return true;
2668     }
2669   }
2670 
2671   return false;
2672 }
2673 
2674 /// Determine whether this is an Objective-C writeback conversion,
2675 /// used for parameter passing when performing automatic reference counting.
2676 ///
2677 /// \param FromType The type we're converting form.
2678 ///
2679 /// \param ToType The type we're converting to.
2680 ///
2681 /// \param ConvertedType The type that will be produced after applying
2682 /// this conversion.
2683 bool Sema::isObjCWritebackConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2684                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
2685   if (!getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount ||
2686       Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType, ToType))
2687     return false;
2688 
2689   // Parameter must be a pointer to __autoreleasing (with no other qualifiers).
2690   QualType ToPointee;
2691   if (const PointerType *ToPointer = ToType->getAs<PointerType>())
2692     ToPointee = ToPointer->getPointeeType();
2693   else
2694     return false;
2695 
2696   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToPointee.getQualifiers();
2697   if (!ToPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2698       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing ||
2699       !ToQuals.withoutObjCLifetime().empty())
2700     return false;
2701 
2702   // Argument must be a pointer to __strong to __weak.
2703   QualType FromPointee;
2704   if (const PointerType *FromPointer = FromType->getAs<PointerType>())
2705     FromPointee = FromPointer->getPointeeType();
2706   else
2707     return false;
2708 
2709   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromPointee.getQualifiers();
2710   if (!FromPointee->isObjCLifetimeType() ||
2711       (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Strong &&
2712        FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != Qualifiers::OCL_Weak))
2713     return false;
2714 
2715   // Make sure that we have compatible qualifiers.
2716   FromQuals.setObjCLifetime(Qualifiers::OCL_Autoreleasing);
2717   if (!ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
2718     return false;
2719 
2720   // Remove qualifiers from the pointee type we're converting from; they
2721   // aren't used in the compatibility check belong, and we'll be adding back
2722   // qualifiers (with __autoreleasing) if the compatibility check succeeds.
2723   FromPointee = FromPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2724 
2725   // The unqualified form of the pointee types must be compatible.
2726   ToPointee = ToPointee.getUnqualifiedType();
2727   bool IncompatibleObjC;
2728   if (Context.typesAreCompatible(FromPointee, ToPointee))
2729     FromPointee = ToPointee;
2730   else if (!isObjCPointerConversion(FromPointee, ToPointee, FromPointee,
2731                                     IncompatibleObjC))
2732     return false;
2733 
2734   /// Construct the type we're converting to, which is a pointer to
2735   /// __autoreleasing pointee.
2736   FromPointee = Context.getQualifiedType(FromPointee, FromQuals);
2737   ConvertedType = Context.getPointerType(FromPointee);
2738   return true;
2739 }
2740 
2741 bool Sema::IsBlockPointerConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
2742                                     QualType& ConvertedType) {
2743   QualType ToPointeeType;
2744   if (const BlockPointerType *ToBlockPtr =
2745         ToType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2746     ToPointeeType = ToBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2747   else
2748     return false;
2749 
2750   QualType FromPointeeType;
2751   if (const BlockPointerType *FromBlockPtr =
2752       FromType->getAs<BlockPointerType>())
2753     FromPointeeType = FromBlockPtr->getPointeeType();
2754   else
2755     return false;
2756   // We have pointer to blocks, check whether the only
2757   // differences in the argument and result types are in Objective-C
2758   // pointer conversions. If so, we permit the conversion.
2759 
2760   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunctionType
2761     = FromPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2762   const FunctionProtoType *ToFunctionType
2763     = ToPointeeType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2764 
2765   if (!FromFunctionType || !ToFunctionType)
2766     return false;
2767 
2768   if (Context.hasSameType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType))
2769     return true;
2770 
2771   // Perform the quick checks that will tell us whether these
2772   // function types are obviously different.
2773   if (FromFunctionType->getNumParams() != ToFunctionType->getNumParams() ||
2774       FromFunctionType->isVariadic() != ToFunctionType->isVariadic())
2775     return false;
2776 
2777   FunctionType::ExtInfo FromEInfo = FromFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2778   FunctionType::ExtInfo ToEInfo = ToFunctionType->getExtInfo();
2779   if (FromEInfo != ToEInfo)
2780     return false;
2781 
2782   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
2783   if (Context.hasSameType(FromFunctionType->getReturnType(),
2784                           ToFunctionType->getReturnType())) {
2785     // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2786   } else {
2787     QualType RHS = FromFunctionType->getReturnType();
2788     QualType LHS = ToFunctionType->getReturnType();
2789     if ((!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus || !RHS->isRecordType()) &&
2790         !RHS.hasQualifiers() && LHS.hasQualifiers())
2791        LHS = LHS.getUnqualifiedType();
2792 
2793      if (Context.hasSameType(RHS,LHS)) {
2794        // OK exact match.
2795      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(RHS, LHS,
2796                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2797      if (IncompatibleObjC)
2798        return false;
2799      // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2800      }
2801      else
2802        return false;
2803    }
2804 
2805    // Check argument types.
2806    for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, NumArgs = FromFunctionType->getNumParams();
2807         ArgIdx != NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
2808      IncompatibleObjC = false;
2809      QualType FromArgType = FromFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2810      QualType ToArgType = ToFunctionType->getParamType(ArgIdx);
2811      if (Context.hasSameType(FromArgType, ToArgType)) {
2812        // Okay, the types match exactly. Nothing to do.
2813      } else if (isObjCPointerConversion(ToArgType, FromArgType,
2814                                         ConvertedType, IncompatibleObjC)) {
2815        if (IncompatibleObjC)
2816          return false;
2817        // Okay, we have an Objective-C pointer conversion.
2818      } else
2819        // Argument types are too different. Abort.
2820        return false;
2821    }
2822 
2823    SmallVector<FunctionProtoType::ExtParameterInfo, 4> NewParamInfos;
2824    bool CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT;
2825    if (!Context.mergeExtParameterInfo(ToFunctionType, FromFunctionType,
2826                                       CanUseToFPT, CanUseFromFPT,
2827                                       NewParamInfos))
2828      return false;
2829 
2830    ConvertedType = ToType;
2831    return true;
2832 }
2833 
2834 enum {
2835   ft_default,
2836   ft_different_class,
2837   ft_parameter_arity,
2838   ft_parameter_mismatch,
2839   ft_return_type,
2840   ft_qualifer_mismatch,
2841   ft_noexcept
2842 };
2843 
2844 /// Attempts to get the FunctionProtoType from a Type. Handles
2845 /// MemberFunctionPointers properly.
2846 static const FunctionProtoType *tryGetFunctionProtoType(QualType FromType) {
2847   if (auto *FPT = FromType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
2848     return FPT;
2849 
2850   if (auto *MPT = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
2851     return MPT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
2852 
2853   return nullptr;
2854 }
2855 
2856 /// HandleFunctionTypeMismatch - Gives diagnostic information for differeing
2857 /// function types.  Catches different number of parameter, mismatch in
2858 /// parameter types, and different return types.
2859 void Sema::HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PartialDiagnostic &PDiag,
2860                                       QualType FromType, QualType ToType) {
2861   // If either type is not valid, include no extra info.
2862   if (FromType.isNull() || ToType.isNull()) {
2863     PDiag << ft_default;
2864     return;
2865   }
2866 
2867   // Get the function type from the pointers.
2868   if (FromType->isMemberPointerType() && ToType->isMemberPointerType()) {
2869     const auto *FromMember = FromType->castAs<MemberPointerType>(),
2870                *ToMember = ToType->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
2871     if (!Context.hasSameType(FromMember->getClass(), ToMember->getClass())) {
2872       PDiag << ft_different_class << QualType(ToMember->getClass(), 0)
2873             << QualType(FromMember->getClass(), 0);
2874       return;
2875     }
2876     FromType = FromMember->getPointeeType();
2877     ToType = ToMember->getPointeeType();
2878   }
2879 
2880   if (FromType->isPointerType())
2881     FromType = FromType->getPointeeType();
2882   if (ToType->isPointerType())
2883     ToType = ToType->getPointeeType();
2884 
2885   // Remove references.
2886   FromType = FromType.getNonReferenceType();
2887   ToType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
2888 
2889   // Don't print extra info for non-specialized template functions.
2890   if (FromType->isInstantiationDependentType() &&
2891       !FromType->getAs<TemplateSpecializationType>()) {
2892     PDiag << ft_default;
2893     return;
2894   }
2895 
2896   // No extra info for same types.
2897   if (Context.hasSameType(FromType, ToType)) {
2898     PDiag << ft_default;
2899     return;
2900   }
2901 
2902   const FunctionProtoType *FromFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(FromType),
2903                           *ToFunction = tryGetFunctionProtoType(ToType);
2904 
2905   // Both types need to be function types.
2906   if (!FromFunction || !ToFunction) {
2907     PDiag << ft_default;
2908     return;
2909   }
2910 
2911   if (FromFunction->getNumParams() != ToFunction->getNumParams()) {
2912     PDiag << ft_parameter_arity << ToFunction->getNumParams()
2913           << FromFunction->getNumParams();
2914     return;
2915   }
2916 
2917   // Handle different parameter types.
2918   unsigned ArgPos;
2919   if (!FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(FromFunction, ToFunction, &ArgPos)) {
2920     PDiag << ft_parameter_mismatch << ArgPos + 1
2921           << ToFunction->getParamType(ArgPos)
2922           << FromFunction->getParamType(ArgPos);
2923     return;
2924   }
2925 
2926   // Handle different return type.
2927   if (!Context.hasSameType(FromFunction->getReturnType(),
2928                            ToFunction->getReturnType())) {
2929     PDiag << ft_return_type << ToFunction->getReturnType()
2930           << FromFunction->getReturnType();
2931     return;
2932   }
2933 
2934   if (FromFunction->getMethodQuals() != ToFunction->getMethodQuals()) {
2935     PDiag << ft_qualifer_mismatch << ToFunction->getMethodQuals()
2936           << FromFunction->getMethodQuals();
2937     return;
2938   }
2939 
2940   // Handle exception specification differences on canonical type (in C++17
2941   // onwards).
2942   if (cast<FunctionProtoType>(FromFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2943           ->isNothrow() !=
2944       cast<FunctionProtoType>(ToFunction->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified())
2945           ->isNothrow()) {
2946     PDiag << ft_noexcept;
2947     return;
2948   }
2949 
2950   // Unable to find a difference, so add no extra info.
2951   PDiag << ft_default;
2952 }
2953 
2954 /// FunctionParamTypesAreEqual - This routine checks two function proto types
2955 /// for equality of their argument types. Caller has already checked that
2956 /// they have same number of arguments.  If the parameters are different,
2957 /// ArgPos will have the parameter index of the first different parameter.
2958 bool Sema::FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(const FunctionProtoType *OldType,
2959                                       const FunctionProtoType *NewType,
2960                                       unsigned *ArgPos) {
2961   for (FunctionProtoType::param_type_iterator O = OldType->param_type_begin(),
2962                                               N = NewType->param_type_begin(),
2963                                               E = OldType->param_type_end();
2964        O && (O != E); ++O, ++N) {
2965     // Ignore address spaces in pointee type. This is to disallow overloading
2966     // on __ptr32/__ptr64 address spaces.
2967     QualType Old = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(O->getUnqualifiedType());
2968     QualType New = Context.removePtrSizeAddrSpace(N->getUnqualifiedType());
2969 
2970     if (!Context.hasSameType(Old, New)) {
2971       if (ArgPos)
2972         *ArgPos = O - OldType->param_type_begin();
2973       return false;
2974     }
2975   }
2976   return true;
2977 }
2978 
2979 /// CheckPointerConversion - Check the pointer conversion from the
2980 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for
2981 /// ambiguous or inaccessible derived-to-base pointer
2982 /// conversions for which IsPointerConversion has already returned
2983 /// true. It returns true and produces a diagnostic if there was an
2984 /// error, or returns false otherwise.
2985 bool Sema::CheckPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
2986                                   CastKind &Kind,
2987                                   CXXCastPath& BasePath,
2988                                   bool IgnoreBaseAccess,
2989                                   bool Diagnose) {
2990   QualType FromType = From->getType();
2991   bool IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast = IgnoreBaseAccess;
2992 
2993   Kind = CK_BitCast;
2994 
2995   if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast && !FromType->isAnyPointerType() &&
2996       From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) ==
2997           Expr::NPCK_ZeroExpression) {
2998     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(From->getType(), Context.BoolTy))
2999       DiagRuntimeBehavior(From->getExprLoc(), From,
3000                           PDiag(diag::warn_impcast_bool_to_null_pointer)
3001                             << ToType << From->getSourceRange());
3002     else if (!isUnevaluatedContext())
3003       Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::warn_non_literal_null_pointer)
3004         << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3005   }
3006   if (const PointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3007     if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3008       QualType FromPointeeType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType(),
3009                ToPointeeType   = ToPtrType->getPointeeType();
3010 
3011       if (FromPointeeType->isRecordType() && ToPointeeType->isRecordType() &&
3012           !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType)) {
3013         // We must have a derived-to-base conversion. Check an
3014         // ambiguous or inaccessible conversion.
3015         unsigned InaccessibleID = 0;
3016         unsigned AmbiguousID = 0;
3017         if (Diagnose) {
3018           InaccessibleID = diag::err_upcast_to_inaccessible_base;
3019           AmbiguousID = diag::err_ambiguous_derived_to_base_conv;
3020         }
3021         if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(
3022                 FromPointeeType, ToPointeeType, InaccessibleID, AmbiguousID,
3023                 From->getExprLoc(), From->getSourceRange(), DeclarationName(),
3024                 &BasePath, IgnoreBaseAccess))
3025           return true;
3026 
3027         // The conversion was successful.
3028         Kind = CK_DerivedToBase;
3029       }
3030 
3031       if (Diagnose && !IsCStyleOrFunctionalCast &&
3032           FromPointeeType->isFunctionType() && ToPointeeType->isVoidType()) {
3033         assert(getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
3034                "this should only be possible with MSVCCompat!");
3035         Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_ms_impcast_fn_obj)
3036             << From->getSourceRange();
3037       }
3038     }
3039   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrType =
3040                ToType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3041     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrType =
3042           FromType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
3043       // Objective-C++ conversions are always okay.
3044       // FIXME: We should have a different class of conversions for the
3045       // Objective-C++ implicit conversions.
3046       if (FromPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType() || ToPtrType->isObjCBuiltinType())
3047         return false;
3048     } else if (FromType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3049       Kind = CK_BlockPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3050     } else {
3051       Kind = CK_CPointerToObjCPointerCast;
3052     }
3053   } else if (ToType->isBlockPointerType()) {
3054     if (!FromType->isBlockPointerType())
3055       Kind = CK_AnyPointerToBlockPointerCast;
3056   }
3057 
3058   // We shouldn't fall into this case unless it's valid for other
3059   // reasons.
3060   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
3061     Kind = CK_NullToPointer;
3062 
3063   return false;
3064 }
3065 
3066 /// IsMemberPointerConversion - Determines whether the conversion of the
3067 /// expression From, which has the (possibly adjusted) type FromType, can be
3068 /// converted to the type ToType via a member pointer conversion (C++ 4.11).
3069 /// If so, returns true and places the converted type (that might differ from
3070 /// ToType in its cv-qualifiers at some level) into ConvertedType.
3071 bool Sema::IsMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType FromType,
3072                                      QualType ToType,
3073                                      bool InOverloadResolution,
3074                                      QualType &ConvertedType) {
3075   const MemberPointerType *ToTypePtr = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3076   if (!ToTypePtr)
3077     return false;
3078 
3079   // A null pointer constant can be converted to a member pointer (C++ 4.11p1)
3080   if (From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3081                     InOverloadResolution? Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull
3082                                         : Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
3083     ConvertedType = ToType;
3084     return true;
3085   }
3086 
3087   // Otherwise, both types have to be member pointers.
3088   const MemberPointerType *FromTypePtr = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3089   if (!FromTypePtr)
3090     return false;
3091 
3092   // A pointer to member of B can be converted to a pointer to member of D,
3093   // where D is derived from B (C++ 4.11p2).
3094   QualType FromClass(FromTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3095   QualType ToClass(ToTypePtr->getClass(), 0);
3096 
3097   if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromClass, ToClass) &&
3098       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass)) {
3099     ConvertedType = Context.getMemberPointerType(FromTypePtr->getPointeeType(),
3100                                                  ToClass.getTypePtr());
3101     return true;
3102   }
3103 
3104   return false;
3105 }
3106 
3107 /// CheckMemberPointerConversion - Check the member pointer conversion from the
3108 /// expression From to the type ToType. This routine checks for ambiguous or
3109 /// virtual or inaccessible base-to-derived member pointer conversions
3110 /// for which IsMemberPointerConversion has already returned true. It returns
3111 /// true and produces a diagnostic if there was an error, or returns false
3112 /// otherwise.
3113 bool Sema::CheckMemberPointerConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3114                                         CastKind &Kind,
3115                                         CXXCastPath &BasePath,
3116                                         bool IgnoreBaseAccess) {
3117   QualType FromType = From->getType();
3118   const MemberPointerType *FromPtrType = FromType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3119   if (!FromPtrType) {
3120     // This must be a null pointer to member pointer conversion
3121     assert(From->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
3122                                        Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull) &&
3123            "Expr must be null pointer constant!");
3124     Kind = CK_NullToMemberPointer;
3125     return false;
3126   }
3127 
3128   const MemberPointerType *ToPtrType = ToType->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
3129   assert(ToPtrType && "No member pointer cast has a target type "
3130                       "that is not a member pointer.");
3131 
3132   QualType FromClass = QualType(FromPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3133   QualType ToClass   = QualType(ToPtrType->getClass(), 0);
3134 
3135   // FIXME: What about dependent types?
3136   assert(FromClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3137   assert(ToClass->isRecordType() && "Pointer into non-class.");
3138 
3139   CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
3140                      /*DetectVirtual=*/true);
3141   bool DerivationOkay =
3142       IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), ToClass, FromClass, Paths);
3143   assert(DerivationOkay &&
3144          "Should not have been called if derivation isn't OK.");
3145   (void)DerivationOkay;
3146 
3147   if (Paths.isAmbiguous(Context.getCanonicalType(FromClass).
3148                                   getUnqualifiedType())) {
3149     std::string PathDisplayStr = getAmbiguousPathsDisplayString(Paths);
3150     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_ambiguous_memptr_conv)
3151       << 0 << FromClass << ToClass << PathDisplayStr << From->getSourceRange();
3152     return true;
3153   }
3154 
3155   if (const RecordType *VBase = Paths.getDetectedVirtual()) {
3156     Diag(From->getExprLoc(), diag::err_memptr_conv_via_virtual)
3157       << FromClass << ToClass << QualType(VBase, 0)
3158       << From->getSourceRange();
3159     return true;
3160   }
3161 
3162   if (!IgnoreBaseAccess)
3163     CheckBaseClassAccess(From->getExprLoc(), FromClass, ToClass,
3164                          Paths.front(),
3165                          diag::err_downcast_from_inaccessible_base);
3166 
3167   // Must be a base to derived member conversion.
3168   BuildBasePathArray(Paths, BasePath);
3169   Kind = CK_BaseToDerivedMemberPointer;
3170   return false;
3171 }
3172 
3173 /// Determine whether the lifetime conversion between the two given
3174 /// qualifiers sets is nontrivial.
3175 static bool isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(Qualifiers FromQuals,
3176                                                Qualifiers ToQuals) {
3177   // Converting anything to const __unsafe_unretained is trivial.
3178   if (ToQuals.hasConst() &&
3179       ToQuals.getObjCLifetime() == Qualifiers::OCL_ExplicitNone)
3180     return false;
3181 
3182   return true;
3183 }
3184 
3185 /// Perform a single iteration of the loop for checking if a qualification
3186 /// conversion is valid.
3187 ///
3188 /// Specifically, check whether any change between the qualifiers of \p
3189 /// FromType and \p ToType is permissible, given knowledge about whether every
3190 /// outer layer is const-qualified.
3191 static bool isQualificationConversionStep(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3192                                           bool CStyle, bool IsTopLevel,
3193                                           bool &PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
3194                                           bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3195   Qualifiers FromQuals = FromType.getQualifiers();
3196   Qualifiers ToQuals = ToType.getQualifiers();
3197 
3198   // Ignore __unaligned qualifier if this type is void.
3199   if (ToType.getUnqualifiedType()->isVoidType())
3200     FromQuals.removeUnaligned();
3201 
3202   // Objective-C ARC:
3203   //   Check Objective-C lifetime conversions.
3204   if (FromQuals.getObjCLifetime() != ToQuals.getObjCLifetime()) {
3205     if (ToQuals.compatiblyIncludesObjCLifetime(FromQuals)) {
3206       if (isNonTrivialObjCLifetimeConversion(FromQuals, ToQuals))
3207         ObjCLifetimeConversion = true;
3208       FromQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3209       ToQuals.removeObjCLifetime();
3210     } else {
3211       // Qualification conversions cannot cast between different
3212       // Objective-C lifetime qualifiers.
3213       return false;
3214     }
3215   }
3216 
3217   // Allow addition/removal of GC attributes but not changing GC attributes.
3218   if (FromQuals.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQuals.getObjCGCAttr() &&
3219       (!FromQuals.hasObjCGCAttr() || !ToQuals.hasObjCGCAttr())) {
3220     FromQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3221     ToQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3222   }
3223 
3224   //   -- for every j > 0, if const is in cv 1,j then const is in cv
3225   //      2,j, and similarly for volatile.
3226   if (!CStyle && !ToQuals.compatiblyIncludes(FromQuals))
3227     return false;
3228 
3229   // If address spaces mismatch:
3230   //  - in top level it is only valid to convert to addr space that is a
3231   //    superset in all cases apart from C-style casts where we allow
3232   //    conversions between overlapping address spaces.
3233   //  - in non-top levels it is not a valid conversion.
3234   if (ToQuals.getAddressSpace() != FromQuals.getAddressSpace() &&
3235       (!IsTopLevel ||
3236        !(ToQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(FromQuals) ||
3237          (CStyle && FromQuals.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(ToQuals)))))
3238     return false;
3239 
3240   //   -- if the cv 1,j and cv 2,j are different, then const is in
3241   //      every cv for 0 < k < j.
3242   if (!CStyle && FromQuals.getCVRQualifiers() != ToQuals.getCVRQualifiers() &&
3243       !PreviousToQualsIncludeConst)
3244     return false;
3245 
3246   // Keep track of whether all prior cv-qualifiers in the "to" type
3247   // include const.
3248   PreviousToQualsIncludeConst =
3249       PreviousToQualsIncludeConst && ToQuals.hasConst();
3250   return true;
3251 }
3252 
3253 /// IsQualificationConversion - Determines whether the conversion from
3254 /// an rvalue of type FromType to ToType is a qualification conversion
3255 /// (C++ 4.4).
3256 ///
3257 /// \param ObjCLifetimeConversion Output parameter that will be set to indicate
3258 /// when the qualification conversion involves a change in the Objective-C
3259 /// object lifetime.
3260 bool
3261 Sema::IsQualificationConversion(QualType FromType, QualType ToType,
3262                                 bool CStyle, bool &ObjCLifetimeConversion) {
3263   FromType = Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
3264   ToType = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType);
3265   ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
3266 
3267   // If FromType and ToType are the same type, this is not a
3268   // qualification conversion.
3269   if (FromType.getUnqualifiedType() == ToType.getUnqualifiedType())
3270     return false;
3271 
3272   // (C++ 4.4p4):
3273   //   A conversion can add cv-qualifiers at levels other than the first
3274   //   in multi-level pointers, subject to the following rules: [...]
3275   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
3276   bool UnwrappedAnyPointer = false;
3277   while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(FromType, ToType)) {
3278     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(
3279             FromType, ToType, CStyle, !UnwrappedAnyPointer,
3280             PreviousToQualsIncludeConst, ObjCLifetimeConversion))
3281       return false;
3282     UnwrappedAnyPointer = true;
3283   }
3284 
3285   // We are left with FromType and ToType being the pointee types
3286   // after unwrapping the original FromType and ToType the same number
3287   // of times. If we unwrapped any pointers, and if FromType and
3288   // ToType have the same unqualified type (since we checked
3289   // qualifiers above), then this is a qualification conversion.
3290   return UnwrappedAnyPointer && Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType,ToType);
3291 }
3292 
3293 /// - Determine whether this is a conversion from a scalar type to an
3294 /// atomic type.
3295 ///
3296 /// If successful, updates \c SCS's second and third steps in the conversion
3297 /// sequence to finish the conversion.
3298 static bool tryAtomicConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3299                                 bool InOverloadResolution,
3300                                 StandardConversionSequence &SCS,
3301                                 bool CStyle) {
3302   const AtomicType *ToAtomic = ToType->getAs<AtomicType>();
3303   if (!ToAtomic)
3304     return false;
3305 
3306   StandardConversionSequence InnerSCS;
3307   if (!IsStandardConversion(S, From, ToAtomic->getValueType(),
3308                             InOverloadResolution, InnerSCS,
3309                             CStyle, /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false))
3310     return false;
3311 
3312   SCS.Second = InnerSCS.Second;
3313   SCS.setToType(1, InnerSCS.getToType(1));
3314   SCS.Third = InnerSCS.Third;
3315   SCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
3316     = InnerSCS.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime;
3317   SCS.setToType(2, InnerSCS.getToType(2));
3318   return true;
3319 }
3320 
3321 static bool isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(ASTContext &Context,
3322                                               CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor,
3323                                               QualType Type) {
3324   const auto *CtorType = Constructor->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3325   if (CtorType->getNumParams() > 0) {
3326     QualType FirstArg = CtorType->getParamType(0);
3327     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Type, FirstArg.getNonReferenceType()))
3328       return true;
3329   }
3330   return false;
3331 }
3332 
3333 static OverloadingResult
3334 IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3335                                        CXXRecordDecl *To,
3336                                        UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3337                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3338                                        bool AllowExplicit) {
3339   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3340   for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(To)) {
3341     auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3342     if (!Info)
3343       continue;
3344 
3345     bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl() &&
3346                   S.isInitListConstructor(Info.Constructor);
3347     if (Usable) {
3348       // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3349       // suppress conversions.
3350       bool SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3351           S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3352       if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3353         S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3354                                        /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, From,
3355                                        CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3356                                        /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3357                                        AllowExplicit);
3358       else
3359         S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl, From,
3360                                CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3361                                /*PartialOverloading*/ false, AllowExplicit);
3362     }
3363   }
3364 
3365   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3366 
3367   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3368   switch (auto Result =
3369               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3370   case OR_Deleted:
3371   case OR_Success: {
3372     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3373     CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function);
3374     QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3375     // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3376     User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3377     User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3378     User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3379     User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3380     User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3381     User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3382     User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3383     return Result;
3384   }
3385 
3386   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3387     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3388   case OR_Ambiguous:
3389     return OR_Ambiguous;
3390   }
3391 
3392   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3393 }
3394 
3395 /// Determines whether there is a user-defined conversion sequence
3396 /// (C++ [over.ics.user]) that converts expression From to the type
3397 /// ToType. If such a conversion exists, User will contain the
3398 /// user-defined conversion sequence that performs such a conversion
3399 /// and this routine will return true. Otherwise, this routine returns
3400 /// false and User is unspecified.
3401 ///
3402 /// \param AllowExplicit  true if the conversion should consider C++0x
3403 /// "explicit" conversion functions as well as non-explicit conversion
3404 /// functions (C++0x [class.conv.fct]p2).
3405 ///
3406 /// \param AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit true if the conversion should
3407 /// allow an extra Objective-C pointer conversion on uses of explicit
3408 /// constructors. Requires \c AllowExplicit to also be set.
3409 static OverloadingResult
3410 IsUserDefinedConversion(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
3411                         UserDefinedConversionSequence &User,
3412                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
3413                         AllowedExplicit AllowExplicit,
3414                         bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit) {
3415   assert(AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None ||
3416          !AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit);
3417   CandidateSet.clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3418 
3419   // Whether we will only visit constructors.
3420   bool ConstructorsOnly = false;
3421 
3422   // If the type we are conversion to is a class type, enumerate its
3423   // constructors.
3424   if (const RecordType *ToRecordType = ToType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3425     // C++ [over.match.ctor]p1:
3426     //   When objects of class type are direct-initialized (8.5), or
3427     //   copy-initialized from an expression of the same or a
3428     //   derived class type (8.5), overload resolution selects the
3429     //   constructor. [...] For copy-initialization, the candidate
3430     //   functions are all the converting constructors (12.3.1) of
3431     //   that class. The argument list is the expression-list within
3432     //   the parentheses of the initializer.
3433     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType, From->getType()) ||
3434         (From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>() &&
3435          S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), ToType)))
3436       ConstructorsOnly = true;
3437 
3438     if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getExprLoc(), ToType)) {
3439       // We're not going to find any constructors.
3440     } else if (CXXRecordDecl *ToRecordDecl
3441                  = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ToRecordType->getDecl())) {
3442 
3443       Expr **Args = &From;
3444       unsigned NumArgs = 1;
3445       bool ListInitializing = false;
3446       if (InitListExpr *InitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3447         // But first, see if there is an init-list-constructor that will work.
3448         OverloadingResult Result = IsInitializerListConstructorConversion(
3449             S, From, ToType, ToRecordDecl, User, CandidateSet,
3450             AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3451         if (Result != OR_No_Viable_Function)
3452           return Result;
3453         // Never mind.
3454         CandidateSet.clear(
3455             OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
3456 
3457         // If we're list-initializing, we pass the individual elements as
3458         // arguments, not the entire list.
3459         Args = InitList->getInits();
3460         NumArgs = InitList->getNumInits();
3461         ListInitializing = true;
3462       }
3463 
3464       for (auto *D : S.LookupConstructors(ToRecordDecl)) {
3465         auto Info = getConstructorInfo(D);
3466         if (!Info)
3467           continue;
3468 
3469         bool Usable = !Info.Constructor->isInvalidDecl();
3470         if (!ListInitializing)
3471           Usable = Usable && Info.Constructor->isConvertingConstructor(
3472                                  /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
3473         if (Usable) {
3474           bool SuppressUserConversions = !ConstructorsOnly;
3475           if (SuppressUserConversions && ListInitializing) {
3476             SuppressUserConversions = false;
3477             if (NumArgs == 1) {
3478               // If the first argument is (a reference to) the target type,
3479               // suppress conversions.
3480               SuppressUserConversions = isFirstArgumentCompatibleWithType(
3481                   S.Context, Info.Constructor, ToType);
3482             }
3483           }
3484           if (Info.ConstructorTmpl)
3485             S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
3486                 Info.ConstructorTmpl, Info.FoundDecl,
3487                 /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3488                 CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3489                 /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3490                 AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3491           else
3492             // Allow one user-defined conversion when user specifies a
3493             // From->ToType conversion via an static cast (c-style, etc).
3494             S.AddOverloadCandidate(Info.Constructor, Info.FoundDecl,
3495                                    llvm::makeArrayRef(Args, NumArgs),
3496                                    CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
3497                                    /*PartialOverloading*/ false,
3498                                    AllowExplicit == AllowedExplicit::All);
3499         }
3500       }
3501     }
3502   }
3503 
3504   // Enumerate conversion functions, if we're allowed to.
3505   if (ConstructorsOnly || isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3506   } else if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType())) {
3507     // No conversion functions from incomplete types.
3508   } else if (const RecordType *FromRecordType =
3509                  From->getType()->getAs<RecordType>()) {
3510     if (CXXRecordDecl *FromRecordDecl
3511          = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FromRecordType->getDecl())) {
3512       // Add all of the conversion functions as candidates.
3513       const auto &Conversions = FromRecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
3514       for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
3515         DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = I.getPair();
3516         NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
3517         CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
3518         if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
3519           D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
3520 
3521         CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
3522         FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
3523         if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
3524           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
3525         else
3526           Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
3527 
3528         if (ConvTemplate)
3529           S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
3530               ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3531               CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3532               AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3533         else
3534           S.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType,
3535                                    CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
3536                                    AllowExplicit != AllowedExplicit::None);
3537       }
3538     }
3539   }
3540 
3541   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
3542 
3543   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
3544   switch (auto Result =
3545               CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, From->getBeginLoc(), Best)) {
3546   case OR_Success:
3547   case OR_Deleted:
3548     // Record the standard conversion we used and the conversion function.
3549     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor
3550           = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3551       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3552       //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3553       //   constructor (12.3.1), the initial standard conversion
3554       //   sequence converts the source type to the type required by
3555       //   the argument of the constructor.
3556       //
3557       QualType ThisType = Constructor->getThisType();
3558       if (isa<InitListExpr>(From)) {
3559         // Initializer lists don't have conversions as such.
3560         User.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
3561       } else {
3562         if (Best->Conversions[0].isEllipsis())
3563           User.EllipsisConversion = true;
3564         else {
3565           User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3566           User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3567         }
3568       }
3569       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3570       User.ConversionFunction = Constructor;
3571       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3572       User.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
3573       User.After.setFromType(ThisType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
3574       User.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
3575       return Result;
3576     }
3577     if (CXXConversionDecl *Conversion
3578                  = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Best->Function)) {
3579       // C++ [over.ics.user]p1:
3580       //
3581       //   [...] If the user-defined conversion is specified by a
3582       //   conversion function (12.3.2), the initial standard
3583       //   conversion sequence converts the source type to the
3584       //   implicit object parameter of the conversion function.
3585       User.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
3586       User.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
3587       User.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
3588       User.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
3589       User.EllipsisConversion = false;
3590 
3591       // C++ [over.ics.user]p2:
3592       //   The second standard conversion sequence converts the
3593       //   result of the user-defined conversion to the target type
3594       //   for the sequence. Since an implicit conversion sequence
3595       //   is an initialization, the special rules for
3596       //   initialization by user-defined conversion apply when
3597       //   selecting the best user-defined conversion for a
3598       //   user-defined conversion sequence (see 13.3.3 and
3599       //   13.3.3.1).
3600       User.After = Best->FinalConversion;
3601       return Result;
3602     }
3603     llvm_unreachable("Not a constructor or conversion function?");
3604 
3605   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
3606     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
3607 
3608   case OR_Ambiguous:
3609     return OR_Ambiguous;
3610   }
3611 
3612   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
3613 }
3614 
3615 bool
3616 Sema::DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(Expr *From, QualType ToType) {
3617   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
3618   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(From->getExprLoc(),
3619                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
3620   OverloadingResult OvResult =
3621     IsUserDefinedConversion(*this, From, ToType, ICS.UserDefined,
3622                             CandidateSet, AllowedExplicit::None, false);
3623 
3624   if (!(OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ||
3625         (OvResult == OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty())))
3626     return false;
3627 
3628   auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(
3629       *this,
3630       OvResult == OR_Ambiguous ? OCD_AmbiguousCandidates : OCD_AllCandidates,
3631       From);
3632   if (OvResult == OR_Ambiguous)
3633     Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_ambiguous_condition)
3634         << From->getType() << ToType << From->getSourceRange();
3635   else { // OR_No_Viable_Function && !CandidateSet.empty()
3636     if (!RequireCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType,
3637                              diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition_incomplete,
3638                              From->getType(), From->getSourceRange()))
3639       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_nonviable_condition)
3640           << false << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << ToType;
3641   }
3642 
3643   CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
3644                               *this, From, Cands);
3645   return true;
3646 }
3647 
3648 // Helper for compareConversionFunctions that gets the FunctionType that the
3649 // conversion-operator return  value 'points' to, or nullptr.
3650 static const FunctionType *
3651 getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(CXXConversionDecl *Conv) {
3652   const FunctionType *ConvFuncTy = Conv->getType()->castAs<FunctionType>();
3653   const PointerType *RetPtrTy =
3654       ConvFuncTy->getReturnType()->getAs<PointerType>();
3655 
3656   if (!RetPtrTy)
3657     return nullptr;
3658 
3659   return RetPtrTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
3660 }
3661 
3662 /// Compare the user-defined conversion functions or constructors
3663 /// of two user-defined conversion sequences to determine whether any ordering
3664 /// is possible.
3665 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3666 compareConversionFunctions(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function1,
3667                            FunctionDecl *Function2) {
3668   CXXConversionDecl *Conv1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function1);
3669   CXXConversionDecl *Conv2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXConversionDecl>(Function2);
3670   if (!Conv1 || !Conv2)
3671     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3672 
3673   if (!Conv1->getParent()->isLambda() || !Conv2->getParent()->isLambda())
3674     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3675 
3676   // Objective-C++:
3677   //   If both conversion functions are implicitly-declared conversions from
3678   //   a lambda closure type to a function pointer and a block pointer,
3679   //   respectively, always prefer the conversion to a function pointer,
3680   //   because the function pointer is more lightweight and is more likely
3681   //   to keep code working.
3682   if (S.getLangOpts().ObjC && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
3683     bool Block1 = Conv1->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3684     bool Block2 = Conv2->getConversionType()->isBlockPointerType();
3685     if (Block1 != Block2)
3686       return Block1 ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3687                     : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3688   }
3689 
3690   // In order to support multiple calling conventions for the lambda conversion
3691   // operator (such as when the free and member function calling convention is
3692   // different), prefer the 'free' mechanism, followed by the calling-convention
3693   // of operator(). The latter is in place to support the MSVC-like solution of
3694   // defining ALL of the possible conversions in regards to calling-convention.
3695   const FunctionType *Conv1FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv1);
3696   const FunctionType *Conv2FuncRet = getConversionOpReturnTyAsFunction(Conv2);
3697 
3698   if (Conv1FuncRet && Conv2FuncRet &&
3699       Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv() != Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv()) {
3700     CallingConv Conv1CC = Conv1FuncRet->getCallConv();
3701     CallingConv Conv2CC = Conv2FuncRet->getCallConv();
3702 
3703     CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = Conv2->getParent()->getLambdaCallOperator();
3704     const FunctionProtoType *CallOpProto =
3705         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
3706 
3707     CallingConv CallOpCC =
3708         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
3709     CallingConv DefaultFree = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3710         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/false);
3711     CallingConv DefaultMember = S.Context.getDefaultCallingConvention(
3712         CallOpProto->isVariadic(), /*IsCXXMethod=*/true);
3713 
3714     CallingConv PrefOrder[] = {DefaultFree, DefaultMember, CallOpCC};
3715     for (CallingConv CC : PrefOrder) {
3716       if (Conv1CC == CC)
3717         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3718       if (Conv2CC == CC)
3719         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3720     }
3721   }
3722 
3723   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3724 }
3725 
3726 static bool hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(
3727     const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
3728   return (ICS.isStandard() && ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr) ||
3729          (ICS.isUserDefined() &&
3730           ICS.UserDefined.Before.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr);
3731 }
3732 
3733 /// CompareImplicitConversionSequences - Compare two implicit
3734 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3735 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2).
3736 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3737 CompareImplicitConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3738                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS1,
3739                                    const ImplicitConversionSequence& ICS2)
3740 {
3741   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p2): When comparing the basic forms of implicit
3742   // conversion sequences (as defined in 13.3.3.1)
3743   //   -- a standard conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.1) is a better
3744   //      conversion sequence than a user-defined conversion sequence or
3745   //      an ellipsis conversion sequence, and
3746   //   -- a user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2) is a better
3747   //      conversion sequence than an ellipsis conversion sequence
3748   //      (13.3.3.1.3).
3749   //
3750   // C++0x [over.best.ics]p10:
3751   //   For the purpose of ranking implicit conversion sequences as
3752   //   described in 13.3.3.2, the ambiguous conversion sequence is
3753   //   treated as a user-defined sequence that is indistinguishable
3754   //   from any other user-defined conversion sequence.
3755 
3756   // String literal to 'char *' conversion has been deprecated in C++03. It has
3757   // been removed from C++11. We still accept this conversion, if it happens at
3758   // the best viable function. Otherwise, this conversion is considered worse
3759   // than ellipsis conversion. Consider this as an extension; this is not in the
3760   // standard. For example:
3761   //
3762   // int &f(...);    // #1
3763   // void f(char*);  // #2
3764   // void g() { int &r = f("foo"); }
3765   //
3766   // In C++03, we pick #2 as the best viable function.
3767   // In C++11, we pick #1 as the best viable function, because ellipsis
3768   // conversion is better than string-literal to char* conversion (since there
3769   // is no such conversion in C++11). If there was no #1 at all or #1 couldn't
3770   // convert arguments, #2 would be the best viable function in C++11.
3771   // If the best viable function has this conversion, a warning will be issued
3772   // in C++03, or an ExtWarn (+SFINAE failure) will be issued in C++11.
3773 
3774   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
3775       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1) !=
3776       hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS2))
3777     return hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS1)
3778                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3779                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3780 
3781   if (ICS1.getKindRank() < ICS2.getKindRank())
3782     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3783   if (ICS2.getKindRank() < ICS1.getKindRank())
3784     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3785 
3786   // The following checks require both conversion sequences to be of
3787   // the same kind.
3788   if (ICS1.getKind() != ICS2.getKind())
3789     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3790 
3791   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
3792       ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3793 
3794   // Two implicit conversion sequences of the same form are
3795   // indistinguishable conversion sequences unless one of the
3796   // following rules apply: (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3797 
3798   // List-initialization sequence L1 is a better conversion sequence than
3799   // list-initialization sequence L2 if:
3800   // - L1 converts to std::initializer_list<X> for some X and L2 does not, or,
3801   //   if not that,
3802   // - L1 converts to type "array of N1 T", L2 converts to type "array of N2 T",
3803   //   and N1 is smaller than N2.,
3804   // even if one of the other rules in this paragraph would otherwise apply.
3805   if (!ICS1.isBad()) {
3806     if (ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3807         !ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3808       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3809     if (!ICS1.isStdInitializerListElement() &&
3810         ICS2.isStdInitializerListElement())
3811       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3812   }
3813 
3814   if (ICS1.isStandard())
3815     // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence than
3816     // standard conversion sequence S2 if [...]
3817     Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3818                                                 ICS1.Standard, ICS2.Standard);
3819   else if (ICS1.isUserDefined()) {
3820     // User-defined conversion sequence U1 is a better conversion
3821     // sequence than another user-defined conversion sequence U2 if
3822     // they contain the same user-defined conversion function or
3823     // constructor and if the second standard conversion sequence of
3824     // U1 is better than the second standard conversion sequence of
3825     // U2 (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3826     if (ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction ==
3827           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction)
3828       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
3829                                                   ICS1.UserDefined.After,
3830                                                   ICS2.UserDefined.After);
3831     else
3832       Result = compareConversionFunctions(S,
3833                                           ICS1.UserDefined.ConversionFunction,
3834                                           ICS2.UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
3835   }
3836 
3837   return Result;
3838 }
3839 
3840 // Per 13.3.3.2p3, compare the given standard conversion sequences to
3841 // determine if one is a proper subset of the other.
3842 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3843 compareStandardConversionSubsets(ASTContext &Context,
3844                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3845                                  const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
3846   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
3847     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3848 
3849   // the identity conversion sequence is considered to be a subsequence of
3850   // any non-identity conversion sequence
3851   if (SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && !SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3852     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3853   else if (!SCS1.isIdentityConversion() && SCS2.isIdentityConversion())
3854     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3855 
3856   if (SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second) {
3857     if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Identity)
3858       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3859     else if (SCS2.Second == ICK_Identity)
3860       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3861     else
3862       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3863   } else if (!Context.hasSimilarType(SCS1.getToType(1), SCS2.getToType(1)))
3864     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3865 
3866   if (SCS1.Third == SCS2.Third) {
3867     return Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getToType(2), SCS2.getToType(2))? Result
3868                              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3869   }
3870 
3871   if (SCS1.Third == ICK_Identity)
3872     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
3873              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3874              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3875 
3876   if (SCS2.Third == ICK_Identity)
3877     return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3878              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable
3879              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3880 
3881   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
3882 }
3883 
3884 /// Determine whether one of the given reference bindings is better
3885 /// than the other based on what kind of bindings they are.
3886 static bool
3887 isBetterReferenceBindingKind(const StandardConversionSequence &SCS1,
3888                              const StandardConversionSequence &SCS2) {
3889   // C++0x [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
3890   //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3) and neither refers to an
3891   //      implicit object parameter of a non-static member function declared
3892   //      without a ref-qualifier, and *either* S1 binds an rvalue reference
3893   //      to an rvalue and S2 binds an lvalue reference *or S1 binds an
3894   //      lvalue reference to a function lvalue and S2 binds an rvalue
3895   //      reference*.
3896   //
3897   // FIXME: Rvalue references. We're going rogue with the above edits,
3898   // because the semantics in the current C++0x working paper (N3225 at the
3899   // time of this writing) break the standard definition of std::forward
3900   // and std::reference_wrapper when dealing with references to functions.
3901   // Proposed wording changes submitted to CWG for consideration.
3902   if (SCS1.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier ||
3903       SCS2.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier)
3904     return false;
3905 
3906   return (!SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToRvalue &&
3907           SCS2.IsLvalueReference) ||
3908          (SCS1.IsLvalueReference && SCS1.BindsToFunctionLvalue &&
3909           !SCS2.IsLvalueReference && SCS2.BindsToFunctionLvalue);
3910 }
3911 
3912 enum class FixedEnumPromotion {
3913   None,
3914   ToUnderlyingType,
3915   ToPromotedUnderlyingType
3916 };
3917 
3918 /// Returns kind of fixed enum promotion the \a SCS uses.
3919 static FixedEnumPromotion
3920 getFixedEnumPromtion(Sema &S, const StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
3921 
3922   if (SCS.Second != ICK_Integral_Promotion)
3923     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3924 
3925   QualType FromType = SCS.getFromType();
3926   if (!FromType->isEnumeralType())
3927     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3928 
3929   EnumDecl *Enum = FromType->getAs<EnumType>()->getDecl();
3930   if (!Enum->isFixed())
3931     return FixedEnumPromotion::None;
3932 
3933   QualType UnderlyingType = Enum->getIntegerType();
3934   if (S.Context.hasSameType(SCS.getToType(1), UnderlyingType))
3935     return FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType;
3936 
3937   return FixedEnumPromotion::ToPromotedUnderlyingType;
3938 }
3939 
3940 /// CompareStandardConversionSequences - Compare two standard
3941 /// conversion sequences to determine whether one is better than the
3942 /// other or if they are indistinguishable (C++ 13.3.3.2p3).
3943 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
3944 CompareStandardConversionSequences(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
3945                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
3946                                    const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2)
3947 {
3948   // Standard conversion sequence S1 is a better conversion sequence
3949   // than standard conversion sequence S2 if (C++ 13.3.3.2p3):
3950 
3951   //  -- S1 is a proper subsequence of S2 (comparing the conversion
3952   //     sequences in the canonical form defined by 13.3.3.1.1,
3953   //     excluding any Lvalue Transformation; the identity conversion
3954   //     sequence is considered to be a subsequence of any
3955   //     non-identity conversion sequence) or, if not that,
3956   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind CK
3957         = compareStandardConversionSubsets(S.Context, SCS1, SCS2))
3958     return CK;
3959 
3960   //  -- the rank of S1 is better than the rank of S2 (by the rules
3961   //     defined below), or, if not that,
3962   ImplicitConversionRank Rank1 = SCS1.getRank();
3963   ImplicitConversionRank Rank2 = SCS2.getRank();
3964   if (Rank1 < Rank2)
3965     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
3966   else if (Rank2 < Rank1)
3967     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3968 
3969   // (C++ 13.3.3.2p4): Two conversion sequences with the same rank
3970   // are indistinguishable unless one of the following rules
3971   // applies:
3972 
3973   //   A conversion that is not a conversion of a pointer, or
3974   //   pointer to member, to bool is better than another conversion
3975   //   that is such a conversion.
3976   if (SCS1.isPointerConversionToBool() != SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool())
3977     return SCS2.isPointerConversionToBool()
3978              ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3979              : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3980 
3981   // C++14 [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3982   // This is retroactively applied to C++11 by CWG 1601.
3983   //
3984   //   A conversion that promotes an enumeration whose underlying type is fixed
3985   //   to its underlying type is better than one that promotes to the promoted
3986   //   underlying type, if the two are different.
3987   FixedEnumPromotion FEP1 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS1);
3988   FixedEnumPromotion FEP2 = getFixedEnumPromtion(S, SCS2);
3989   if (FEP1 != FixedEnumPromotion::None && FEP2 != FixedEnumPromotion::None &&
3990       FEP1 != FEP2)
3991     return FEP1 == FixedEnumPromotion::ToUnderlyingType
3992                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
3993                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
3994 
3995   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b2:
3996   //
3997   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A,
3998   //   conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of B* to
3999   //   void*, and conversion of A* to void* is better than conversion
4000   //   of B* to void*.
4001   bool SCS1ConvertsToVoid
4002     = SCS1.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4003   bool SCS2ConvertsToVoid
4004     = SCS2.isPointerConversionToVoidPointer(S.Context);
4005   if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid != SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4006     // Exactly one of the conversion sequences is a conversion to
4007     // a void pointer; it's the worse conversion.
4008     return SCS2ConvertsToVoid ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4009                               : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4010   } else if (!SCS1ConvertsToVoid && !SCS2ConvertsToVoid) {
4011     // Neither conversion sequence converts to a void pointer; compare
4012     // their derived-to-base conversions.
4013     if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind DerivedCK
4014           = CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(S, Loc, SCS1, SCS2))
4015       return DerivedCK;
4016   } else if (SCS1ConvertsToVoid && SCS2ConvertsToVoid &&
4017              !S.Context.hasSameType(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS2.getFromType())) {
4018     // Both conversion sequences are conversions to void
4019     // pointers. Compare the source types to determine if there's an
4020     // inheritance relationship in their sources.
4021     QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4022     QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4023 
4024     // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4025     // conversion, if we need to.
4026     if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4027       FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4028     if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4029       FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4030 
4031     QualType FromPointee1 = FromType1->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4032     QualType FromPointee2 = FromType2->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4033 
4034     if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4035       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4036     else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4037       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4038 
4039     // Objective-C++: If one interface is more specific than the
4040     // other, it is the better one.
4041     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr1
4042       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4043     const ObjCObjectPointerType* FromObjCPtr2
4044       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4045     if (FromObjCPtr1 && FromObjCPtr2) {
4046       bool AssignLeft = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr1,
4047                                                           FromObjCPtr2);
4048       bool AssignRight = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromObjCPtr2,
4049                                                            FromObjCPtr1);
4050       if (AssignLeft != AssignRight) {
4051         return AssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4052                          : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4053       }
4054     }
4055   }
4056 
4057   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4058     // Check for a better reference binding based on the kind of bindings.
4059     if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS1, SCS2))
4060       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4061     else if (isBetterReferenceBindingKind(SCS2, SCS1))
4062       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4063   }
4064 
4065   // Compare based on qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3,
4066   // bullet 3).
4067   if (ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind QualCK
4068         = CompareQualificationConversions(S, SCS1, SCS2))
4069     return QualCK;
4070 
4071   if (SCS1.ReferenceBinding && SCS2.ReferenceBinding) {
4072     // C++ [over.ics.rank]p3b4:
4073     //   -- S1 and S2 are reference bindings (8.5.3), and the types to
4074     //      which the references refer are the same type except for
4075     //      top-level cv-qualifiers, and the type to which the reference
4076     //      initialized by S2 refers is more cv-qualified than the type
4077     //      to which the reference initialized by S1 refers.
4078     QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4079     QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4080     T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4081     T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4082     Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4083     QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4084     QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4085     if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4086       // Objective-C++ ARC: If the references refer to objects with different
4087       // lifetimes, prefer bindings that don't change lifetime.
4088       if (SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding !=
4089                                           SCS2.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding) {
4090         return SCS1.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding
4091                                            ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4092                                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4093       }
4094 
4095       // If the type is an array type, promote the element qualifiers to the
4096       // type for comparison.
4097       if (isa<ArrayType>(T1) && T1Quals)
4098         T1 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT1, T1Quals);
4099       if (isa<ArrayType>(T2) && T2Quals)
4100         T2 = S.Context.getQualifiedType(UnqualT2, T2Quals);
4101       if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1))
4102         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4103       if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2))
4104         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4105     }
4106   }
4107 
4108   // In Microsoft mode, prefer an integral conversion to a
4109   // floating-to-integral conversion if the integral conversion
4110   // is between types of the same size.
4111   // For example:
4112   // void f(float);
4113   // void f(int);
4114   // int main {
4115   //    long a;
4116   //    f(a);
4117   // }
4118   // Here, MSVC will call f(int) instead of generating a compile error
4119   // as clang will do in standard mode.
4120   if (S.getLangOpts().MSVCCompat && SCS1.Second == ICK_Integral_Conversion &&
4121       SCS2.Second == ICK_Floating_Integral &&
4122       S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getFromType()) ==
4123           S.Context.getTypeSize(SCS1.getToType(2)))
4124     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4125 
4126   // Prefer a compatible vector conversion over a lax vector conversion
4127   // For example:
4128   //
4129   // typedef float __v4sf __attribute__((__vector_size__(16)));
4130   // void f(vector float);
4131   // void f(vector signed int);
4132   // int main() {
4133   //   __v4sf a;
4134   //   f(a);
4135   // }
4136   // Here, we'd like to choose f(vector float) and not
4137   // report an ambiguous call error
4138   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion &&
4139       SCS2.Second == ICK_Vector_Conversion) {
4140     bool SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4141         SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4142     bool SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion = S.Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(
4143         SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4144 
4145     if (SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion != SCS2IsCompatibleVectorConversion)
4146       return SCS1IsCompatibleVectorConversion
4147                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4148                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4149   }
4150 
4151   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion &&
4152       SCS2.Second == ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion) {
4153     bool SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4154         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS1.getFromType(), SCS1.getToType(2));
4155     bool SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion =
4156         S.Context.areCompatibleSveTypes(SCS2.getFromType(), SCS2.getToType(2));
4157 
4158     if (SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion !=
4159         SCS2IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion)
4160       return SCS1IsCompatibleSVEVectorConversion
4161                  ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4162                  : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4163   }
4164 
4165   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4166 }
4167 
4168 /// CompareQualificationConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4169 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4170 /// qualification conversions (C++ 13.3.3.2p3 bullet 3).
4171 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4172 CompareQualificationConversions(Sema &S,
4173                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4174                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4175   // C++ 13.3.3.2p3:
4176   //  -- S1 and S2 differ only in their qualification conversion and
4177   //     yield similar types T1 and T2 (C++ 4.4), respectively, and the
4178   //     cv-qualification signature of type T1 is a proper subset of
4179   //     the cv-qualification signature of type T2, and S1 is not the
4180   //     deprecated string literal array-to-pointer conversion (4.2).
4181   if (SCS1.First != SCS2.First || SCS1.Second != SCS2.Second ||
4182       SCS1.Third != SCS2.Third || SCS1.Third != ICK_Qualification)
4183     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4184 
4185   // FIXME: the example in the standard doesn't use a qualification
4186   // conversion (!)
4187   QualType T1 = SCS1.getToType(2);
4188   QualType T2 = SCS2.getToType(2);
4189   T1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T1);
4190   T2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2);
4191   assert(!T1->isReferenceType() && !T2->isReferenceType());
4192   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4193   QualType UnqualT1 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4194   QualType UnqualT2 = S.Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4195 
4196   // If the types are the same, we won't learn anything by unwrapping
4197   // them.
4198   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2)
4199     return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4200 
4201   ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result
4202     = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4203 
4204   // Objective-C++ ARC:
4205   //   Prefer qualification conversions not involving a change in lifetime
4206   //   to qualification conversions that do not change lifetime.
4207   if (SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime !=
4208                                       SCS2.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime) {
4209     Result = SCS1.QualificationIncludesObjCLifetime
4210                ? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4211                : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4212   }
4213 
4214   while (S.Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2)) {
4215     // Within each iteration of the loop, we check the qualifiers to
4216     // determine if this still looks like a qualification
4217     // conversion. Then, if all is well, we unwrap one more level of
4218     // pointers or pointers-to-members and do it all again
4219     // until there are no more pointers or pointers-to-members left
4220     // to unwrap. This essentially mimics what
4221     // IsQualificationConversion does, but here we're checking for a
4222     // strict subset of qualifiers.
4223     if (T1.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime() ==
4224         T2.getQualifiers().withoutObjCLifetime())
4225       // The qualifiers are the same, so this doesn't tell us anything
4226       // about how the sequences rank.
4227       // ObjC ownership quals are omitted above as they interfere with
4228       // the ARC overload rule.
4229       ;
4230     else if (T2.isMoreQualifiedThan(T1)) {
4231       // T1 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4232       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
4233         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4234         // qualifiers.
4235         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4236 
4237       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4238     } else if (T1.isMoreQualifiedThan(T2)) {
4239       // T2 has fewer qualifiers, so it could be the better sequence.
4240       if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better)
4241         // Neither has qualifiers that are a subset of the other's
4242         // qualifiers.
4243         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4244 
4245       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4246     } else {
4247       // Qualifiers are disjoint.
4248       return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4249     }
4250 
4251     // If the types after this point are equivalent, we're done.
4252     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4253       break;
4254   }
4255 
4256   // Check that the winning standard conversion sequence isn't using
4257   // the deprecated string literal array to pointer conversion.
4258   switch (Result) {
4259   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
4260     if (SCS1.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4261       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4262     break;
4263 
4264   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
4265     break;
4266 
4267   case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
4268     if (SCS2.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr)
4269       Result = ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4270     break;
4271   }
4272 
4273   return Result;
4274 }
4275 
4276 /// CompareDerivedToBaseConversions - Compares two standard conversion
4277 /// sequences to determine whether they can be ranked based on their
4278 /// various kinds of derived-to-base conversions (C++
4279 /// [over.ics.rank]p4b3).  As part of these checks, we also look at
4280 /// conversions between Objective-C interface types.
4281 static ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind
4282 CompareDerivedToBaseConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
4283                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS1,
4284                                 const StandardConversionSequence& SCS2) {
4285   QualType FromType1 = SCS1.getFromType();
4286   QualType ToType1 = SCS1.getToType(1);
4287   QualType FromType2 = SCS2.getFromType();
4288   QualType ToType2 = SCS2.getToType(1);
4289 
4290   // Adjust the types we're converting from via the array-to-pointer
4291   // conversion, if we need to.
4292   if (SCS1.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4293     FromType1 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType1);
4294   if (SCS2.First == ICK_Array_To_Pointer)
4295     FromType2 = S.Context.getArrayDecayedType(FromType2);
4296 
4297   // Canonicalize all of the types.
4298   FromType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType1);
4299   ToType1 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType1);
4300   FromType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType2);
4301   ToType2 = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToType2);
4302 
4303   // C++ [over.ics.rank]p4b3:
4304   //
4305   //   If class B is derived directly or indirectly from class A and
4306   //   class C is derived directly or indirectly from B,
4307   //
4308   // Compare based on pointer conversions.
4309   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4310       SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4311       /*FIXME: Remove if Objective-C id conversions get their own rank*/
4312       FromType1->isPointerType() && FromType2->isPointerType() &&
4313       ToType1->isPointerType() && ToType2->isPointerType()) {
4314     QualType FromPointee1 =
4315         FromType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4316     QualType ToPointee1 =
4317         ToType1->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4318     QualType FromPointee2 =
4319         FromType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4320     QualType ToPointee2 =
4321         ToType2->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType().getUnqualifiedType();
4322 
4323     //   -- conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4324     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4325       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4326         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4327       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4328         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4329     }
4330 
4331     //   -- conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,
4332     if (FromPointee1 != FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 == ToPointee2) {
4333       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4334         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4335       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4336         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4337     }
4338   } else if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion &&
4339              SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
4340     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr1
4341       = FromType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4342     const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtr2
4343       = FromType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4344     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr1
4345       = ToType1->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4346     const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtr2
4347       = ToType2->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4348 
4349     if (FromPtr1 && FromPtr2 && ToPtr1 && ToPtr2) {
4350       // Apply the same conversion ranking rules for Objective-C pointer types
4351       // that we do for C++ pointers to class types. However, we employ the
4352       // Objective-C pseudo-subtyping relationship used for assignment of
4353       // Objective-C pointer types.
4354       bool FromAssignLeft
4355         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr1, FromPtr2);
4356       bool FromAssignRight
4357         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(FromPtr2, FromPtr1);
4358       bool ToAssignLeft
4359         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr1, ToPtr2);
4360       bool ToAssignRight
4361         = S.Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(ToPtr2, ToPtr1);
4362 
4363       // A conversion to an a non-id object pointer type or qualified 'id'
4364       // type is better than a conversion to 'id'.
4365       if (ToPtr1->isObjCIdType() &&
4366           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4367         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4368       if (ToPtr2->isObjCIdType() &&
4369           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4370         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4371 
4372       // A conversion to a non-id object pointer type is better than a
4373       // conversion to a qualified 'id' type
4374       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4375         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4376       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedIdType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4377         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4378 
4379       // A conversion to an a non-Class object pointer type or qualified 'Class'
4380       // type is better than a conversion to 'Class'.
4381       if (ToPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4382           (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl()))
4383         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4384       if (ToPtr2->isObjCClassType() &&
4385           (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() || ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl()))
4386         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4387 
4388       // A conversion to a non-Class object pointer type is better than a
4389       // conversion to a qualified 'Class' type.
4390       if (ToPtr1->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl())
4391         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4392       if (ToPtr2->isObjCQualifiedClassType() && ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl())
4393         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4394 
4395       //   -- "conversion of C* to B* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4396       if (S.Context.hasSameType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4397           !FromPtr1->isObjCIdType() && !FromPtr1->isObjCClassType() &&
4398           (ToAssignLeft != ToAssignRight)) {
4399         if (FromPtr1->isSpecialized()) {
4400           // "conversion of B<A> * to B * is better than conversion of B * to
4401           // C *.
4402           bool IsFirstSame =
4403               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr1->getInterfaceDecl();
4404           bool IsSecondSame =
4405               FromPtr1->getInterfaceDecl() == ToPtr2->getInterfaceDecl();
4406           if (IsFirstSame) {
4407             if (!IsSecondSame)
4408               return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4409           } else if (IsSecondSame)
4410             return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4411         }
4412         return ToAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse
4413                            : ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4414       }
4415 
4416       //   -- "conversion of B* to A* is better than conversion of C* to A*,"
4417       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2) &&
4418           (FromAssignLeft != FromAssignRight))
4419         return FromAssignLeft? ImplicitConversionSequence::Better
4420         : ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4421     }
4422   }
4423 
4424   // Ranking of member-pointer types.
4425   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member && SCS2.Second == ICK_Pointer_Member &&
4426       FromType1->isMemberPointerType() && FromType2->isMemberPointerType() &&
4427       ToType1->isMemberPointerType() && ToType2->isMemberPointerType()) {
4428     const auto *FromMemPointer1 = FromType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4429     const auto *ToMemPointer1 = ToType1->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4430     const auto *FromMemPointer2 = FromType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4431     const auto *ToMemPointer2 = ToType2->castAs<MemberPointerType>();
4432     const Type *FromPointeeType1 = FromMemPointer1->getClass();
4433     const Type *ToPointeeType1 = ToMemPointer1->getClass();
4434     const Type *FromPointeeType2 = FromMemPointer2->getClass();
4435     const Type *ToPointeeType2 = ToMemPointer2->getClass();
4436     QualType FromPointee1 = QualType(FromPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4437     QualType ToPointee1 = QualType(ToPointeeType1, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4438     QualType FromPointee2 = QualType(FromPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4439     QualType ToPointee2 = QualType(ToPointeeType2, 0).getUnqualifiedType();
4440     // conversion of A::* to B::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*,
4441     if (FromPointee1 == FromPointee2 && ToPointee1 != ToPointee2) {
4442       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee1, ToPointee2))
4443         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4444       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToPointee2, ToPointee1))
4445         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4446     }
4447     // conversion of B::* to C::* is better than conversion of A::* to C::*
4448     if (ToPointee1 == ToPointee2 && FromPointee1 != FromPointee2) {
4449       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee1, FromPointee2))
4450         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4451       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromPointee2, FromPointee1))
4452         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4453     }
4454   }
4455 
4456   if (SCS1.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
4457     //   -- conversion of C to B is better than conversion of C to A,
4458     //   -- binding of an expression of type C to a reference of type
4459     //      B& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4460     //      reference of type A&,
4461     if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4462         !S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4463       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType1, ToType2))
4464         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4465       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, ToType2, ToType1))
4466         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4467     }
4468 
4469     //   -- conversion of B to A is better than conversion of C to A.
4470     //   -- binding of an expression of type B to a reference of type
4471     //      A& is better than binding an expression of type C to a
4472     //      reference of type A&,
4473     if (!S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromType1, FromType2) &&
4474         S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ToType1, ToType2)) {
4475       if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType2, FromType1))
4476         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
4477       else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType1, FromType2))
4478         return ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse;
4479     }
4480   }
4481 
4482   return ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable;
4483 }
4484 
4485 /// Determine whether the given type is valid, e.g., it is not an invalid
4486 /// C++ class.
4487 static bool isTypeValid(QualType T) {
4488   if (CXXRecordDecl *Record = T->getAsCXXRecordDecl())
4489     return !Record->isInvalidDecl();
4490 
4491   return true;
4492 }
4493 
4494 static QualType withoutUnaligned(ASTContext &Ctx, QualType T) {
4495   if (!T.getQualifiers().hasUnaligned())
4496     return T;
4497 
4498   Qualifiers Q;
4499   T = Ctx.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T, Q);
4500   Q.removeUnaligned();
4501   return Ctx.getQualifiedType(T, Q);
4502 }
4503 
4504 /// CompareReferenceRelationship - Compare the two types T1 and T2 to
4505 /// determine whether they are reference-compatible,
4506 /// reference-related, or incompatible, for use in C++ initialization by
4507 /// reference (C++ [dcl.ref.init]p4). Neither type can be a reference
4508 /// type, and the first type (T1) is the pointee type of the reference
4509 /// type being initialized.
4510 Sema::ReferenceCompareResult
4511 Sema::CompareReferenceRelationship(SourceLocation Loc,
4512                                    QualType OrigT1, QualType OrigT2,
4513                                    ReferenceConversions *ConvOut) {
4514   assert(!OrigT1->isReferenceType() &&
4515     "T1 must be the pointee type of the reference type");
4516   assert(!OrigT2->isReferenceType() && "T2 cannot be a reference type");
4517 
4518   QualType T1 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT1);
4519   QualType T2 = Context.getCanonicalType(OrigT2);
4520   Qualifiers T1Quals, T2Quals;
4521   QualType UnqualT1 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T1, T1Quals);
4522   QualType UnqualT2 = Context.getUnqualifiedArrayType(T2, T2Quals);
4523 
4524   ReferenceConversions ConvTmp;
4525   ReferenceConversions &Conv = ConvOut ? *ConvOut : ConvTmp;
4526   Conv = ReferenceConversions();
4527 
4528   // C++2a [dcl.init.ref]p4:
4529   //   Given types "cv1 T1" and "cv2 T2," "cv1 T1" is
4530   //   reference-related to "cv2 T2" if T1 is similar to T2, or
4531   //   T1 is a base class of T2.
4532   //   "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2" if
4533   //   a prvalue of type "pointer to cv2 T2" can be converted to the type
4534   //   "pointer to cv1 T1" via a standard conversion sequence.
4535 
4536   // Check for standard conversions we can apply to pointers: derived-to-base
4537   // conversions, ObjC pointer conversions, and function pointer conversions.
4538   // (Qualification conversions are checked last.)
4539   QualType ConvertedT2;
4540   if (UnqualT1 == UnqualT2) {
4541     // Nothing to do.
4542   } else if (isCompleteType(Loc, OrigT2) &&
4543              isTypeValid(UnqualT1) && isTypeValid(UnqualT2) &&
4544              IsDerivedFrom(Loc, UnqualT2, UnqualT1))
4545     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase;
4546   else if (UnqualT1->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4547            UnqualT2->isObjCObjectOrInterfaceType() &&
4548            Context.canBindObjCObjectType(UnqualT1, UnqualT2))
4549     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjC;
4550   else if (UnqualT2->isFunctionType() &&
4551            IsFunctionConversion(UnqualT2, UnqualT1, ConvertedT2)) {
4552     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Function;
4553     // No need to check qualifiers; function types don't have them.
4554     return Ref_Compatible;
4555   }
4556   bool ConvertedReferent = Conv != 0;
4557 
4558   // We can have a qualification conversion. Compute whether the types are
4559   // similar at the same time.
4560   bool PreviousToQualsIncludeConst = true;
4561   bool TopLevel = true;
4562   do {
4563     if (T1 == T2)
4564       break;
4565 
4566     // We will need a qualification conversion.
4567     Conv |= ReferenceConversions::Qualification;
4568 
4569     // Track whether we performed a qualification conversion anywhere other
4570     // than the top level. This matters for ranking reference bindings in
4571     // overload resolution.
4572     if (!TopLevel)
4573       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification;
4574 
4575     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4576     T1 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T1);
4577     T2 = withoutUnaligned(Context, T2);
4578 
4579     // If we find a qualifier mismatch, the types are not reference-compatible,
4580     // but are still be reference-related if they're similar.
4581     bool ObjCLifetimeConversion = false;
4582     if (!isQualificationConversionStep(T2, T1, /*CStyle=*/false, TopLevel,
4583                                        PreviousToQualsIncludeConst,
4584                                        ObjCLifetimeConversion))
4585       return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSimilarType(T1, T2))
4586                  ? Ref_Related
4587                  : Ref_Incompatible;
4588 
4589     // FIXME: Should we track this for any level other than the first?
4590     if (ObjCLifetimeConversion)
4591       Conv |= ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime;
4592 
4593     TopLevel = false;
4594   } while (Context.UnwrapSimilarTypes(T1, T2));
4595 
4596   // At this point, if the types are reference-related, we must either have the
4597   // same inner type (ignoring qualifiers), or must have already worked out how
4598   // to convert the referent.
4599   return (ConvertedReferent || Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
4600              ? Ref_Compatible
4601              : Ref_Incompatible;
4602 }
4603 
4604 /// Look for a user-defined conversion to a value reference-compatible
4605 ///        with DeclType. Return true if something definite is found.
4606 static bool
4607 FindConversionForRefInit(Sema &S, ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS,
4608                          QualType DeclType, SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4609                          Expr *Init, QualType T2, bool AllowRvalues,
4610                          bool AllowExplicit) {
4611   assert(T2->isRecordType() && "Can only find conversions of record types.");
4612   auto *T2RecordDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(T2->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
4613 
4614   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
4615       DeclLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion);
4616   const auto &Conversions = T2RecordDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
4617   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
4618     NamedDecl *D = *I;
4619     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
4620     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
4621       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
4622 
4623     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate
4624       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
4625     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
4626     if (ConvTemplate)
4627       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
4628     else
4629       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
4630 
4631     if (AllowRvalues) {
4632       // If we are initializing an rvalue reference, don't permit conversion
4633       // functions that return lvalues.
4634       if (!ConvTemplate && DeclType->isRValueReferenceType()) {
4635         const ReferenceType *RefType
4636           = Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4637         if (RefType && !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType())
4638           continue;
4639       }
4640 
4641       if (!ConvTemplate &&
4642           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(
4643               DeclLoc,
4644               Conv->getConversionType()
4645                   .getNonReferenceType()
4646                   .getUnqualifiedType(),
4647               DeclType.getNonReferenceType().getUnqualifiedType()) ==
4648               Sema::Ref_Incompatible)
4649         continue;
4650     } else {
4651       // If the conversion function doesn't return a reference type,
4652       // it can't be considered for this conversion. An rvalue reference
4653       // is only acceptable if its referencee is a function type.
4654 
4655       const ReferenceType *RefType =
4656         Conv->getConversionType()->getAs<ReferenceType>();
4657       if (!RefType ||
4658           (!RefType->isLValueReferenceType() &&
4659            !RefType->getPointeeType()->isFunctionType()))
4660         continue;
4661     }
4662 
4663     if (ConvTemplate)
4664       S.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
4665           ConvTemplate, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4666           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4667     else
4668       S.AddConversionCandidate(
4669           Conv, I.getPair(), ActingDC, Init, DeclType, CandidateSet,
4670           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, AllowExplicit);
4671   }
4672 
4673   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
4674 
4675   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
4676   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(S, DeclLoc, Best)) {
4677   case OR_Success:
4678     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4679     //
4680     //   [...] If the parameter binds directly to the result of
4681     //   applying a conversion function to the argument
4682     //   expression, the implicit conversion sequence is a
4683     //   user-defined conversion sequence (13.3.3.1.2), with the
4684     //   second standard conversion sequence either an identity
4685     //   conversion or, if the conversion function returns an
4686     //   entity of a type that is a derived class of the parameter
4687     //   type, a derived-to-base Conversion.
4688     if (!Best->FinalConversion.DirectBinding)
4689       return false;
4690 
4691     ICS.setUserDefined();
4692     ICS.UserDefined.Before = Best->Conversions[0].Standard;
4693     ICS.UserDefined.After = Best->FinalConversion;
4694     ICS.UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = HadMultipleCandidates;
4695     ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Best->Function;
4696     ICS.UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = Best->FoundDecl;
4697     ICS.UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
4698     assert(ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding &&
4699            ICS.UserDefined.After.DirectBinding &&
4700            "Expected a direct reference binding!");
4701     return true;
4702 
4703   case OR_Ambiguous:
4704     ICS.setAmbiguous();
4705     for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin();
4706          Cand != CandidateSet.end(); ++Cand)
4707       if (Cand->Best)
4708         ICS.Ambiguous.addConversion(Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function);
4709     return true;
4710 
4711   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
4712   case OR_Deleted:
4713     // There was no suitable conversion, or we found a deleted
4714     // conversion; continue with other checks.
4715     return false;
4716   }
4717 
4718   llvm_unreachable("Invalid OverloadResult!");
4719 }
4720 
4721 /// Compute an implicit conversion sequence for reference
4722 /// initialization.
4723 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4724 TryReferenceInit(Sema &S, Expr *Init, QualType DeclType,
4725                  SourceLocation DeclLoc,
4726                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
4727                  bool AllowExplicit) {
4728   assert(DeclType->isReferenceType() && "Reference init needs a reference");
4729 
4730   // Most paths end in a failed conversion.
4731   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
4732   ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4733 
4734   QualType T1 = DeclType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
4735   QualType T2 = Init->getType();
4736 
4737   // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
4738   // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
4739   // type of the resulting function.
4740   if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
4741     DeclAccessPair Found;
4742     if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Init, DeclType,
4743                                                                 false, Found))
4744       T2 = Fn->getType();
4745   }
4746 
4747   // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
4748   bool isRValRef = DeclType->isRValueReferenceType();
4749   Expr::Classification InitCategory = Init->Classify(S.Context);
4750 
4751   Sema::ReferenceConversions RefConv;
4752   Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
4753       S.CompareReferenceRelationship(DeclLoc, T1, T2, &RefConv);
4754 
4755   auto SetAsReferenceBinding = [&](bool BindsDirectly) {
4756     ICS.setStandard();
4757     ICS.Standard.First = ICK_Identity;
4758     // FIXME: A reference binding can be a function conversion too. We should
4759     // consider that when ordering reference-to-function bindings.
4760     ICS.Standard.Second = (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::DerivedToBase)
4761                               ? ICK_Derived_To_Base
4762                               : (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjC)
4763                                     ? ICK_Compatible_Conversion
4764                                     : ICK_Identity;
4765     // FIXME: As a speculative fix to a defect introduced by CWG2352, we rank
4766     // a reference binding that performs a non-top-level qualification
4767     // conversion as a qualification conversion, not as an identity conversion.
4768     ICS.Standard.Third = (RefConv &
4769                               Sema::ReferenceConversions::NestedQualification)
4770                              ? ICK_Qualification
4771                              : ICK_Identity;
4772     ICS.Standard.setFromType(T2);
4773     ICS.Standard.setToType(0, T2);
4774     ICS.Standard.setToType(1, T1);
4775     ICS.Standard.setToType(2, T1);
4776     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4777     ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = BindsDirectly;
4778     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4779     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = T2->isFunctionType();
4780     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = InitCategory.isRValue();
4781     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4782     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding =
4783         (RefConv & Sema::ReferenceConversions::ObjCLifetime) != 0;
4784     ICS.Standard.CopyConstructor = nullptr;
4785     ICS.Standard.DeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtr = false;
4786   };
4787 
4788   // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
4789   //   A reference to type "cv1 T1" is initialized by an expression
4790   //   of type "cv2 T2" as follows:
4791 
4792   //     -- If reference is an lvalue reference and the initializer expression
4793   if (!isRValRef) {
4794     //     -- is an lvalue (but is not a bit-field), and "cv1 T1" is
4795     //        reference-compatible with "cv2 T2," or
4796     //
4797     // Per C++ [over.ics.ref]p4, we don't check the bit-field property here.
4798     if (InitCategory.isLValue() && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible) {
4799       // C++ [over.ics.ref]p1:
4800       //   When a parameter of reference type binds directly (8.5.3)
4801       //   to an argument expression, the implicit conversion sequence
4802       //   is the identity conversion, unless the argument expression
4803       //   has a type that is a derived class of the parameter type,
4804       //   in which case the implicit conversion sequence is a
4805       //   derived-to-base Conversion (13.3.3.1).
4806       SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/true);
4807 
4808       // Nothing more to do: the inaccessibility/ambiguity check for
4809       // derived-to-base conversions is suppressed when we're
4810       // computing the implicit conversion sequence (C++
4811       // [over.best.ics]p2).
4812       return ICS;
4813     }
4814 
4815     //       -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is
4816     //          not reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly
4817     //          converted to an lvalue of type "cv3 T3," where "cv1 T1"
4818     //          is reference-compatible with "cv3 T3" 92) (this
4819     //          conversion is selected by enumerating the applicable
4820     //          conversion functions (13.3.1.6) and choosing the best
4821     //          one through overload resolution (13.3)),
4822     if (!SuppressUserConversions && T2->isRecordType() &&
4823         S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4824         RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible) {
4825       if (FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4826                                    Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/false,
4827                                    AllowExplicit))
4828         return ICS;
4829     }
4830   }
4831 
4832   //     -- Otherwise, the reference shall be an lvalue reference to a
4833   //        non-volatile const type (i.e., cv1 shall be const), or the reference
4834   //        shall be an rvalue reference.
4835   if (!isRValRef && (!T1.isConstQualified() || T1.isVolatileQualified()))
4836     return ICS;
4837 
4838   //       -- If the initializer expression
4839   //
4840   //            -- is an xvalue, class prvalue, array prvalue or function
4841   //               lvalue and "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with "cv2 T2", or
4842   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Compatible &&
4843       (InitCategory.isXValue() ||
4844        (InitCategory.isPRValue() &&
4845           (T2->isRecordType() || T2->isArrayType())) ||
4846        (InitCategory.isLValue() && T2->isFunctionType()))) {
4847     // In C++11, this is always a direct binding. In C++98/03, it's a direct
4848     // binding unless we're binding to a class prvalue.
4849     // Note: Although xvalues wouldn't normally show up in C++98/03 code, we
4850     // allow the use of rvalue references in C++98/03 for the benefit of
4851     // standard library implementors; therefore, we need the xvalue check here.
4852     SetAsReferenceBinding(/*BindsDirectly=*/S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 ||
4853                           !(InitCategory.isPRValue() || T2->isRecordType()));
4854     return ICS;
4855   }
4856 
4857   //            -- has a class type (i.e., T2 is a class type), where T1 is not
4858   //               reference-related to T2, and can be implicitly converted to
4859   //               an xvalue, class prvalue, or function lvalue of type
4860   //               "cv3 T3", where "cv1 T1" is reference-compatible with
4861   //               "cv3 T3",
4862   //
4863   //          then the reference is bound to the value of the initializer
4864   //          expression in the first case and to the result of the conversion
4865   //          in the second case (or, in either case, to an appropriate base
4866   //          class subobject).
4867   if (!SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4868       T2->isRecordType() && S.isCompleteType(DeclLoc, T2) &&
4869       FindConversionForRefInit(S, ICS, DeclType, DeclLoc,
4870                                Init, T2, /*AllowRvalues=*/true,
4871                                AllowExplicit)) {
4872     // In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference
4873     // and the second standard conversion sequence of the
4874     // user-defined conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue
4875     // conversion, the program is ill-formed.
4876     if (ICS.isUserDefined() && isRValRef &&
4877         ICS.UserDefined.After.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue)
4878       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, Init, DeclType);
4879 
4880     return ICS;
4881   }
4882 
4883   // A temporary of function type cannot be created; don't even try.
4884   if (T1->isFunctionType())
4885     return ICS;
4886 
4887   //       -- Otherwise, a temporary of type "cv1 T1" is created and
4888   //          initialized from the initializer expression using the
4889   //          rules for a non-reference copy initialization (8.5). The
4890   //          reference is then bound to the temporary. If T1 is
4891   //          reference-related to T2, cv1 must be the same
4892   //          cv-qualification as, or greater cv-qualification than,
4893   //          cv2; otherwise, the program is ill-formed.
4894   if (RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Related) {
4895     // If cv1 == cv2 or cv1 is a greater cv-qualified than cv2, then
4896     // we would be reference-compatible or reference-compatible with
4897     // added qualification. But that wasn't the case, so the reference
4898     // initialization fails.
4899     //
4900     // Note that we only want to check address spaces and cvr-qualifiers here.
4901     // ObjC GC, lifetime and unaligned qualifiers aren't important.
4902     Qualifiers T1Quals = T1.getQualifiers();
4903     Qualifiers T2Quals = T2.getQualifiers();
4904     T1Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4905     T1Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4906     T2Quals.removeObjCGCAttr();
4907     T2Quals.removeObjCLifetime();
4908     // MS compiler ignores __unaligned qualifier for references; do the same.
4909     T1Quals.removeUnaligned();
4910     T2Quals.removeUnaligned();
4911     if (!T1Quals.compatiblyIncludes(T2Quals))
4912       return ICS;
4913   }
4914 
4915   // If at least one of the types is a class type, the types are not
4916   // related, and we aren't allowed any user conversions, the
4917   // reference binding fails. This case is important for breaking
4918   // recursion, since TryImplicitConversion below will attempt to
4919   // create a temporary through the use of a copy constructor.
4920   if (SuppressUserConversions && RefRelationship == Sema::Ref_Incompatible &&
4921       (T1->isRecordType() || T2->isRecordType()))
4922     return ICS;
4923 
4924   // If T1 is reference-related to T2 and the reference is an rvalue
4925   // reference, the initializer expression shall not be an lvalue.
4926   if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related &&
4927       isRValRef && Init->Classify(S.Context).isLValue())
4928     return ICS;
4929 
4930   // C++ [over.ics.ref]p2:
4931   //   When a parameter of reference type is not bound directly to
4932   //   an argument expression, the conversion sequence is the one
4933   //   required to convert the argument expression to the
4934   //   underlying type of the reference according to
4935   //   13.3.3.1. Conceptually, this conversion sequence corresponds
4936   //   to copy-initializing a temporary of the underlying type with
4937   //   the argument expression. Any difference in top-level
4938   //   cv-qualification is subsumed by the initialization itself
4939   //   and does not constitute a conversion.
4940   ICS = TryImplicitConversion(S, Init, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
4941                               AllowedExplicit::None,
4942                               /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
4943                               /*CStyle=*/false,
4944                               /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
4945                               /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
4946 
4947   // Of course, that's still a reference binding.
4948   if (ICS.isStandard()) {
4949     ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
4950     ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4951     ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4952     ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = true;
4953     ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4954     ICS.Standard.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4955   } else if (ICS.isUserDefined()) {
4956     const ReferenceType *LValRefType =
4957         ICS.UserDefined.ConversionFunction->getReturnType()
4958             ->getAs<LValueReferenceType>();
4959 
4960     // C++ [over.ics.ref]p3:
4961     //   Except for an implicit object parameter, for which see 13.3.1, a
4962     //   standard conversion sequence cannot be formed if it requires [...]
4963     //   binding an rvalue reference to an lvalue other than a function
4964     //   lvalue.
4965     // Note that the function case is not possible here.
4966     if (DeclType->isRValueReferenceType() && LValRefType) {
4967       // FIXME: This is the wrong BadConversionSequence. The problem is binding
4968       // an rvalue reference to a (non-function) lvalue, not binding an lvalue
4969       // reference to an rvalue!
4970       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, Init, DeclType);
4971       return ICS;
4972     }
4973 
4974     ICS.UserDefined.After.ReferenceBinding = true;
4975     ICS.UserDefined.After.IsLvalueReference = !isRValRef;
4976     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
4977     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsToRvalue = !LValRefType;
4978     ICS.UserDefined.After.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
4979     ICS.UserDefined.After.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
4980   }
4981 
4982   return ICS;
4983 }
4984 
4985 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4986 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
4987                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
4988                       bool InOverloadResolution,
4989                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
4990                       bool AllowExplicit = false);
4991 
4992 /// TryListConversion - Try to copy-initialize a value of type ToType from the
4993 /// initializer list From.
4994 static ImplicitConversionSequence
4995 TryListConversion(Sema &S, InitListExpr *From, QualType ToType,
4996                   bool SuppressUserConversions,
4997                   bool InOverloadResolution,
4998                   bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion) {
4999   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p1:
5000   //   When an argument is an initializer list, it is not an expression and
5001   //   special rules apply for converting it to a parameter type.
5002 
5003   ImplicitConversionSequence Result;
5004   Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::no_conversion, From, ToType);
5005 
5006   // We need a complete type for what follows. Incomplete types can never be
5007   // initialized from init lists.
5008   if (!S.isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ToType))
5009     return Result;
5010 
5011   // Per DR1467:
5012   //   If the parameter type is a class X and the initializer list has a single
5013   //   element of type cv U, where U is X or a class derived from X, the
5014   //   implicit conversion sequence is the one required to convert the element
5015   //   to the parameter type.
5016   //
5017   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is a character array [... ]
5018   //   and the initializer list has a single element that is an
5019   //   appropriately-typed string literal (8.5.2 [dcl.init.string]), the
5020   //   implicit conversion sequence is the identity conversion.
5021   if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5022     if (ToType->isRecordType()) {
5023       QualType InitType = From->getInit(0)->getType();
5024       if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(InitType, ToType) ||
5025           S.IsDerivedFrom(From->getBeginLoc(), InitType, ToType))
5026         return TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5027                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5028                                      InOverloadResolution,
5029                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5030     }
5031 
5032     if (const auto *AT = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)) {
5033       if (S.IsStringInit(From->getInit(0), AT)) {
5034         InitializedEntity Entity =
5035           InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5036                                                  /*Consumed=*/false);
5037         if (S.CanPerformCopyInitialization(Entity, From)) {
5038           Result.setStandard();
5039           Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5040           Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5041           Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5042           return Result;
5043         }
5044       }
5045     }
5046   }
5047 
5048   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p2: Otherwise, if the parameter type [...] (below).
5049   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p2:
5050   //   If the parameter type is std::initializer_list<X> or "array of X" and
5051   //   all the elements can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit
5052   //   conversion sequence is the worst conversion necessary to convert an
5053   //   element of the list to X.
5054   //
5055   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p3:
5056   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is "array of N X", if the initializer
5057   //   list has exactly N elements or if it has fewer than N elements and X is
5058   //   default-constructible, and if all the elements of the initializer list
5059   //   can be implicitly converted to X, the implicit conversion sequence is
5060   //   the worst conversion necessary to convert an element of the list to X.
5061   //
5062   // FIXME: We're missing a lot of these checks.
5063   bool toStdInitializerList = false;
5064   QualType X;
5065   if (ToType->isArrayType())
5066     X = S.Context.getAsArrayType(ToType)->getElementType();
5067   else
5068     toStdInitializerList = S.isStdInitializerList(ToType, &X);
5069   if (!X.isNull()) {
5070     for (unsigned i = 0, e = From->getNumInits(); i < e; ++i) {
5071       Expr *Init = From->getInit(i);
5072       ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5073           TryCopyInitialization(S, Init, X, SuppressUserConversions,
5074                                 InOverloadResolution,
5075                                 AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5076       // If a single element isn't convertible, fail.
5077       if (ICS.isBad()) {
5078         Result = ICS;
5079         break;
5080       }
5081       // Otherwise, look for the worst conversion.
5082       if (Result.isBad() || CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
5083                                 S, From->getBeginLoc(), ICS, Result) ==
5084                                 ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse)
5085         Result = ICS;
5086     }
5087 
5088     // For an empty list, we won't have computed any conversion sequence.
5089     // Introduce the identity conversion sequence.
5090     if (From->getNumInits() == 0) {
5091       Result.setStandard();
5092       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5093       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5094       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5095     }
5096 
5097     Result.setStdInitializerListElement(toStdInitializerList);
5098     return Result;
5099   }
5100 
5101   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p4:
5102   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p3:
5103   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a non-aggregate class X and overload
5104   //   resolution chooses a single best constructor [...] the implicit
5105   //   conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence. If multiple
5106   //   constructors are viable but none is better than the others, the
5107   //   implicit conversion sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5108   if (ToType->isRecordType() && !ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5109     // This function can deal with initializer lists.
5110     return TryUserDefinedConversion(S, From, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5111                                     AllowedExplicit::None,
5112                                     InOverloadResolution, /*CStyle=*/false,
5113                                     AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5114                                     /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5115   }
5116 
5117   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p5:
5118   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p4:
5119   //   Otherwise, if the parameter has an aggregate type which can be
5120   //   initialized from the initializer list [...] the implicit conversion
5121   //   sequence is a user-defined conversion sequence.
5122   if (ToType->isAggregateType()) {
5123     // Type is an aggregate, argument is an init list. At this point it comes
5124     // down to checking whether the initialization works.
5125     // FIXME: Find out whether this parameter is consumed or not.
5126     InitializedEntity Entity =
5127         InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(S.Context, ToType,
5128                                                /*Consumed=*/false);
5129     if (S.CanPerformAggregateInitializationForOverloadResolution(Entity,
5130                                                                  From)) {
5131       Result.setUserDefined();
5132       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAsIdentityConversion();
5133       // Initializer lists don't have a type.
5134       Result.UserDefined.Before.setFromType(QualType());
5135       Result.UserDefined.Before.setAllToTypes(QualType());
5136 
5137       Result.UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
5138       Result.UserDefined.After.setFromType(ToType);
5139       Result.UserDefined.After.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5140       Result.UserDefined.ConversionFunction = nullptr;
5141     }
5142     return Result;
5143   }
5144 
5145   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p6:
5146   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p5:
5147   //   Otherwise, if the parameter is a reference, see 13.3.3.1.4.
5148   if (ToType->isReferenceType()) {
5149     // The standard is notoriously unclear here, since 13.3.3.1.4 doesn't
5150     // mention initializer lists in any way. So we go by what list-
5151     // initialization would do and try to extrapolate from that.
5152 
5153     QualType T1 = ToType->castAs<ReferenceType>()->getPointeeType();
5154 
5155     // If the initializer list has a single element that is reference-related
5156     // to the parameter type, we initialize the reference from that.
5157     if (From->getNumInits() == 1) {
5158       Expr *Init = From->getInit(0);
5159 
5160       QualType T2 = Init->getType();
5161 
5162       // If the initializer is the address of an overloaded function, try
5163       // to resolve the overloaded function. If all goes well, T2 is the
5164       // type of the resulting function.
5165       if (S.Context.getCanonicalType(T2) == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
5166         DeclAccessPair Found;
5167         if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(
5168                                    Init, ToType, false, Found))
5169           T2 = Fn->getType();
5170       }
5171 
5172       // Compute some basic properties of the types and the initializer.
5173       Sema::ReferenceCompareResult RefRelationship =
5174           S.CompareReferenceRelationship(From->getBeginLoc(), T1, T2);
5175 
5176       if (RefRelationship >= Sema::Ref_Related) {
5177         return TryReferenceInit(S, Init, ToType, /*FIXME*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5178                                 SuppressUserConversions,
5179                                 /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5180       }
5181     }
5182 
5183     // Otherwise, we bind the reference to a temporary created from the
5184     // initializer list.
5185     Result = TryListConversion(S, From, T1, SuppressUserConversions,
5186                                InOverloadResolution,
5187                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5188     if (Result.isFailure())
5189       return Result;
5190     assert(!Result.isEllipsis() &&
5191            "Sub-initialization cannot result in ellipsis conversion.");
5192 
5193     // Can we even bind to a temporary?
5194     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() ||
5195         (T1.isConstQualified() && !T1.isVolatileQualified())) {
5196       StandardConversionSequence &SCS = Result.isStandard() ? Result.Standard :
5197                                             Result.UserDefined.After;
5198       SCS.ReferenceBinding = true;
5199       SCS.IsLvalueReference = ToType->isLValueReferenceType();
5200       SCS.BindsToRvalue = true;
5201       SCS.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5202       SCS.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier = false;
5203       SCS.ObjCLifetimeConversionBinding = false;
5204     } else
5205       Result.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue,
5206                     From, ToType);
5207     return Result;
5208   }
5209 
5210   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p7:
5211   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p6:
5212   //   Otherwise, if the parameter type is not a class:
5213   if (!ToType->isRecordType()) {
5214     //    - if the initializer list has one element that is not itself an
5215     //      initializer list, the implicit conversion sequence is the one
5216     //      required to convert the element to the parameter type.
5217     unsigned NumInits = From->getNumInits();
5218     if (NumInits == 1 && !isa<InitListExpr>(From->getInit(0)))
5219       Result = TryCopyInitialization(S, From->getInit(0), ToType,
5220                                      SuppressUserConversions,
5221                                      InOverloadResolution,
5222                                      AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5223     //    - if the initializer list has no elements, the implicit conversion
5224     //      sequence is the identity conversion.
5225     else if (NumInits == 0) {
5226       Result.setStandard();
5227       Result.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5228       Result.Standard.setFromType(ToType);
5229       Result.Standard.setAllToTypes(ToType);
5230     }
5231     return Result;
5232   }
5233 
5234   // C++14 [over.ics.list]p8:
5235   // C++11 [over.ics.list]p7:
5236   //   In all cases other than those enumerated above, no conversion is possible
5237   return Result;
5238 }
5239 
5240 /// TryCopyInitialization - Try to copy-initialize a value of type
5241 /// ToType from the expression From. Return the implicit conversion
5242 /// sequence required to pass this argument, which may be a bad
5243 /// conversion sequence (meaning that the argument cannot be passed to
5244 /// a parameter of this type). If @p SuppressUserConversions, then we
5245 /// do not permit any user-defined conversion sequences.
5246 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5247 TryCopyInitialization(Sema &S, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5248                       bool SuppressUserConversions,
5249                       bool InOverloadResolution,
5250                       bool AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5251                       bool AllowExplicit) {
5252   if (InitListExpr *FromInitList = dyn_cast<InitListExpr>(From))
5253     return TryListConversion(S, FromInitList, ToType, SuppressUserConversions,
5254                              InOverloadResolution,AllowObjCWritebackConversion);
5255 
5256   if (ToType->isReferenceType())
5257     return TryReferenceInit(S, From, ToType,
5258                             /*FIXME:*/ From->getBeginLoc(),
5259                             SuppressUserConversions, AllowExplicit);
5260 
5261   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, ToType,
5262                                SuppressUserConversions,
5263                                AllowedExplicit::None,
5264                                InOverloadResolution,
5265                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5266                                AllowObjCWritebackConversion,
5267                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5268 }
5269 
5270 static bool TryCopyInitialization(const CanQualType FromQTy,
5271                                   const CanQualType ToQTy,
5272                                   Sema &S,
5273                                   SourceLocation Loc,
5274                                   ExprValueKind FromVK) {
5275   OpaqueValueExpr TmpExpr(Loc, FromQTy, FromVK);
5276   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5277     TryCopyInitialization(S, &TmpExpr, ToQTy, true, true, false);
5278 
5279   return !ICS.isBad();
5280 }
5281 
5282 /// TryObjectArgumentInitialization - Try to initialize the object
5283 /// parameter of the given member function (@c Method) from the
5284 /// expression @p From.
5285 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5286 TryObjectArgumentInitialization(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType FromType,
5287                                 Expr::Classification FromClassification,
5288                                 CXXMethodDecl *Method,
5289                                 CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext) {
5290   QualType ClassType = S.Context.getTypeDeclType(ActingContext);
5291   // [class.dtor]p2: A destructor can be invoked for a const, volatile or
5292   //                 const volatile object.
5293   Qualifiers Quals = Method->getMethodQualifiers();
5294   if (isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(Method)) {
5295     Quals.addConst();
5296     Quals.addVolatile();
5297   }
5298 
5299   QualType ImplicitParamType = S.Context.getQualifiedType(ClassType, Quals);
5300 
5301   // Set up the conversion sequence as a "bad" conversion, to allow us
5302   // to exit early.
5303   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS;
5304 
5305   // We need to have an object of class type.
5306   if (const PointerType *PT = FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5307     FromType = PT->getPointeeType();
5308 
5309     // When we had a pointer, it's implicitly dereferenced, so we
5310     // better have an lvalue.
5311     assert(FromClassification.isLValue());
5312   }
5313 
5314   assert(FromType->isRecordType());
5315 
5316   // C++0x [over.match.funcs]p4:
5317   //   For non-static member functions, the type of the implicit object
5318   //   parameter is
5319   //
5320   //     - "lvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared without a
5321   //        ref-qualifier or with the & ref-qualifier
5322   //     - "rvalue reference to cv X" for functions declared with the &&
5323   //        ref-qualifier
5324   //
5325   // where X is the class of which the function is a member and cv is the
5326   // cv-qualification on the member function declaration.
5327   //
5328   // However, when finding an implicit conversion sequence for the argument, we
5329   // are not allowed to perform user-defined conversions
5330   // (C++ [over.match.funcs]p5). We perform a simplified version of
5331   // reference binding here, that allows class rvalues to bind to
5332   // non-constant references.
5333 
5334   // First check the qualifiers.
5335   QualType FromTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromType);
5336   if (ImplicitParamType.getCVRQualifiers()
5337                                     != FromTypeCanon.getLocalCVRQualifiers() &&
5338       !ImplicitParamType.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTypeCanon)) {
5339     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5340                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5341     return ICS;
5342   }
5343 
5344   if (FromTypeCanon.hasAddressSpace()) {
5345     Qualifiers QualsImplicitParamType = ImplicitParamType.getQualifiers();
5346     Qualifiers QualsFromType = FromTypeCanon.getQualifiers();
5347     if (!QualsImplicitParamType.isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(QualsFromType)) {
5348       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers,
5349                  FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5350       return ICS;
5351     }
5352   }
5353 
5354   // Check that we have either the same type or a derived type. It
5355   // affects the conversion rank.
5356   QualType ClassTypeCanon = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ClassType);
5357   ImplicitConversionKind SecondKind;
5358   if (ClassTypeCanon == FromTypeCanon.getLocalUnqualifiedType()) {
5359     SecondKind = ICK_Identity;
5360   } else if (S.IsDerivedFrom(Loc, FromType, ClassType))
5361     SecondKind = ICK_Derived_To_Base;
5362   else {
5363     ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class,
5364                FromType, ImplicitParamType);
5365     return ICS;
5366   }
5367 
5368   // Check the ref-qualifier.
5369   switch (Method->getRefQualifier()) {
5370   case RQ_None:
5371     // Do nothing; we don't care about lvalueness or rvalueness.
5372     break;
5373 
5374   case RQ_LValue:
5375     if (!FromClassification.isLValue() && !Quals.hasOnlyConst()) {
5376       // non-const lvalue reference cannot bind to an rvalue
5377       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue, FromType,
5378                  ImplicitParamType);
5379       return ICS;
5380     }
5381     break;
5382 
5383   case RQ_RValue:
5384     if (!FromClassification.isRValue()) {
5385       // rvalue reference cannot bind to an lvalue
5386       ICS.setBad(BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue, FromType,
5387                  ImplicitParamType);
5388       return ICS;
5389     }
5390     break;
5391   }
5392 
5393   // Success. Mark this as a reference binding.
5394   ICS.setStandard();
5395   ICS.Standard.setAsIdentityConversion();
5396   ICS.Standard.Second = SecondKind;
5397   ICS.Standard.setFromType(FromType);
5398   ICS.Standard.setAllToTypes(ImplicitParamType);
5399   ICS.Standard.ReferenceBinding = true;
5400   ICS.Standard.DirectBinding = true;
5401   ICS.Standard.IsLvalueReference = Method->getRefQualifier() != RQ_RValue;
5402   ICS.Standard.BindsToFunctionLvalue = false;
5403   ICS.Standard.BindsToRvalue = FromClassification.isRValue();
5404   ICS.Standard.BindsImplicitObjectArgumentWithoutRefQualifier
5405     = (Method->getRefQualifier() == RQ_None);
5406   return ICS;
5407 }
5408 
5409 /// PerformObjectArgumentInitialization - Perform initialization of
5410 /// the implicit object parameter for the given Method with the given
5411 /// expression.
5412 ExprResult
5413 Sema::PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Expr *From,
5414                                           NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
5415                                           NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
5416                                           CXXMethodDecl *Method) {
5417   QualType FromRecordType, DestType;
5418   QualType ImplicitParamRecordType  =
5419     Method->getThisType()->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5420 
5421   Expr::Classification FromClassification;
5422   if (const PointerType *PT = From->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
5423     FromRecordType = PT->getPointeeType();
5424     DestType = Method->getThisType();
5425     FromClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
5426   } else {
5427     FromRecordType = From->getType();
5428     DestType = ImplicitParamRecordType;
5429     FromClassification = From->Classify(Context);
5430 
5431     // When performing member access on an rvalue, materialize a temporary.
5432     if (From->isRValue()) {
5433       From = CreateMaterializeTemporaryExpr(FromRecordType, From,
5434                                             Method->getRefQualifier() !=
5435                                                 RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue);
5436     }
5437   }
5438 
5439   // Note that we always use the true parent context when performing
5440   // the actual argument initialization.
5441   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
5442       *this, From->getBeginLoc(), From->getType(), FromClassification, Method,
5443       Method->getParent());
5444   if (ICS.isBad()) {
5445     switch (ICS.Bad.Kind) {
5446     case BadConversionSequence::bad_qualifiers: {
5447       Qualifiers FromQs = FromRecordType.getQualifiers();
5448       Qualifiers ToQs = DestType.getQualifiers();
5449       unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
5450       if (CVR) {
5451         Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_cvr)
5452             << Method->getDeclName() << FromRecordType << (CVR - 1)
5453             << From->getSourceRange();
5454         Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5455           << Method->getDeclName();
5456         return ExprError();
5457       }
5458       break;
5459     }
5460 
5461     case BadConversionSequence::lvalue_ref_to_rvalue:
5462     case BadConversionSequence::rvalue_ref_to_lvalue: {
5463       bool IsRValueQualified =
5464         Method->getRefQualifier() == RefQualifierKind::RQ_RValue;
5465       Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_ref)
5466           << Method->getDeclName() << FromClassification.isRValue()
5467           << IsRValueQualified;
5468       Diag(Method->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
5469         << Method->getDeclName();
5470       return ExprError();
5471     }
5472 
5473     case BadConversionSequence::no_conversion:
5474     case BadConversionSequence::unrelated_class:
5475       break;
5476     }
5477 
5478     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_member_function_call_bad_type)
5479            << ImplicitParamRecordType << FromRecordType
5480            << From->getSourceRange();
5481   }
5482 
5483   if (ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Derived_To_Base) {
5484     ExprResult FromRes =
5485       PerformObjectMemberConversion(From, Qualifier, FoundDecl, Method);
5486     if (FromRes.isInvalid())
5487       return ExprError();
5488     From = FromRes.get();
5489   }
5490 
5491   if (!Context.hasSameType(From->getType(), DestType)) {
5492     CastKind CK;
5493     QualType PteeTy = DestType->getPointeeType();
5494     LangAS DestAS =
5495         PteeTy.isNull() ? DestType.getAddressSpace() : PteeTy.getAddressSpace();
5496     if (FromRecordType.getAddressSpace() != DestAS)
5497       CK = CK_AddressSpaceConversion;
5498     else
5499       CK = CK_NoOp;
5500     From = ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK, From->getValueKind()).get();
5501   }
5502   return From;
5503 }
5504 
5505 /// TryContextuallyConvertToBool - Attempt to contextually convert the
5506 /// expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5507 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5508 TryContextuallyConvertToBool(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5509   // C++ [dcl.init]/17.8:
5510   //   - Otherwise, if the initialization is direct-initialization, the source
5511   //     type is std::nullptr_t, and the destination type is bool, the initial
5512   //     value of the object being initialized is false.
5513   if (From->getType()->isNullPtrType())
5514     return ImplicitConversionSequence::getNullptrToBool(From->getType(),
5515                                                         S.Context.BoolTy,
5516                                                         From->isGLValue());
5517 
5518   // All other direct-initialization of bool is equivalent to an implicit
5519   // conversion to bool in which explicit conversions are permitted.
5520   return TryImplicitConversion(S, From, S.Context.BoolTy,
5521                                /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5522                                AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5523                                /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5524                                /*CStyle=*/false,
5525                                /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5526                                /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false);
5527 }
5528 
5529 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToBool - Perform a contextual conversion
5530 /// of the expression From to bool (C++0x [conv]p3).
5531 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(Expr *From) {
5532   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5533     return ExprError();
5534 
5535   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, From);
5536   if (!ICS.isBad())
5537     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Context.BoolTy, ICS, AA_Converting);
5538 
5539   if (!DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, Context.BoolTy))
5540     return Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_bool_condition)
5541            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange();
5542   return ExprError();
5543 }
5544 
5545 /// Check that the specified conversion is permitted in a converted constant
5546 /// expression, according to C++11 [expr.const]p3. Return true if the conversion
5547 /// is acceptable.
5548 static bool CheckConvertedConstantConversions(Sema &S,
5549                                               StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5550   // Since we know that the target type is an integral or unscoped enumeration
5551   // type, most conversion kinds are impossible. All possible First and Third
5552   // conversions are fine.
5553   switch (SCS.Second) {
5554   case ICK_Identity:
5555   case ICK_Integral_Promotion:
5556   case ICK_Integral_Conversion: // Narrowing conversions are checked elsewhere.
5557   case ICK_Zero_Queue_Conversion:
5558     return true;
5559 
5560   case ICK_Boolean_Conversion:
5561     // Conversion from an integral or unscoped enumeration type to bool is
5562     // classified as ICK_Boolean_Conversion, but it's also arguably an integral
5563     // conversion, so we allow it in a converted constant expression.
5564     //
5565     // FIXME: Per core issue 1407, we should not allow this, but that breaks
5566     // a lot of popular code. We should at least add a warning for this
5567     // (non-conforming) extension.
5568     return SCS.getFromType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
5569            SCS.getToType(2)->isBooleanType();
5570 
5571   case ICK_Pointer_Conversion:
5572   case ICK_Pointer_Member:
5573     // C++1z: null pointer conversions and null member pointer conversions are
5574     // only permitted if the source type is std::nullptr_t.
5575     return SCS.getFromType()->isNullPtrType();
5576 
5577   case ICK_Floating_Promotion:
5578   case ICK_Complex_Promotion:
5579   case ICK_Floating_Conversion:
5580   case ICK_Complex_Conversion:
5581   case ICK_Floating_Integral:
5582   case ICK_Compatible_Conversion:
5583   case ICK_Derived_To_Base:
5584   case ICK_Vector_Conversion:
5585   case ICK_SVE_Vector_Conversion:
5586   case ICK_Vector_Splat:
5587   case ICK_Complex_Real:
5588   case ICK_Block_Pointer_Conversion:
5589   case ICK_TransparentUnionConversion:
5590   case ICK_Writeback_Conversion:
5591   case ICK_Zero_Event_Conversion:
5592   case ICK_C_Only_Conversion:
5593   case ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion:
5594     return false;
5595 
5596   case ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue:
5597   case ICK_Array_To_Pointer:
5598   case ICK_Function_To_Pointer:
5599     llvm_unreachable("found a first conversion kind in Second");
5600 
5601   case ICK_Function_Conversion:
5602   case ICK_Qualification:
5603     llvm_unreachable("found a third conversion kind in Second");
5604 
5605   case ICK_Num_Conversion_Kinds:
5606     break;
5607   }
5608 
5609   llvm_unreachable("unknown conversion kind");
5610 }
5611 
5612 /// CheckConvertedConstantExpression - Check that the expression From is a
5613 /// converted constant expression of type T, perform the conversion and produce
5614 /// the converted expression, per C++11 [expr.const]p3.
5615 static ExprResult CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Sema &S, Expr *From,
5616                                                    QualType T, APValue &Value,
5617                                                    Sema::CCEKind CCE,
5618                                                    bool RequireInt,
5619                                                    NamedDecl *Dest) {
5620   assert(S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 &&
5621          "converted constant expression outside C++11");
5622 
5623   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(S, From))
5624     return ExprError();
5625 
5626   // C++1z [expr.const]p3:
5627   //  A converted constant expression of type T is an expression,
5628   //  implicitly converted to type T, where the converted
5629   //  expression is a constant expression and the implicit conversion
5630   //  sequence contains only [... list of conversions ...].
5631   // C++1z [stmt.if]p2:
5632   //  If the if statement is of the form if constexpr, the value of the
5633   //  condition shall be a contextually converted constant expression of type
5634   //  bool.
5635   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5636       CCE == Sema::CCEK_ConstexprIf || CCE == Sema::CCEK_ExplicitBool
5637           ? TryContextuallyConvertToBool(S, From)
5638           : TryCopyInitialization(S, From, T,
5639                                   /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5640                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5641                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5642                                   /*AllowExplicit=*/false);
5643   StandardConversionSequence *SCS = nullptr;
5644   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5645   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5646     SCS = &ICS.Standard;
5647     break;
5648   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5649     if (T->isRecordType())
5650       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.Before;
5651     else
5652       SCS = &ICS.UserDefined.After;
5653     break;
5654   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5655   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5656     if (!S.DiagnoseMultipleUserDefinedConversion(From, T))
5657       return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5658                     diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression)
5659              << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5660     return ExprError();
5661 
5662   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5663     llvm_unreachable("ellipsis conversion in converted constant expression");
5664   }
5665 
5666   // Check that we would only use permitted conversions.
5667   if (!CheckConvertedConstantConversions(S, *SCS)) {
5668     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5669                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_disallowed)
5670            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5671   }
5672   // [...] and where the reference binding (if any) binds directly.
5673   if (SCS->ReferenceBinding && !SCS->DirectBinding) {
5674     return S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(),
5675                   diag::err_typecheck_converted_constant_expression_indirect)
5676            << From->getType() << From->getSourceRange() << T;
5677   }
5678 
5679   // Usually we can simply apply the ImplicitConversionSequence we formed
5680   // earlier, but that's not guaranteed to work when initializing an object of
5681   // class type.
5682   ExprResult Result;
5683   if (T->isRecordType()) {
5684     assert(CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg &&
5685            "unexpected class type converted constant expr");
5686     Result = S.PerformCopyInitialization(
5687         InitializedEntity::InitializeTemplateParameter(
5688             T, cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(Dest)),
5689         SourceLocation(), From);
5690   } else {
5691     Result = S.PerformImplicitConversion(From, T, ICS, Sema::AA_Converting);
5692   }
5693   if (Result.isInvalid())
5694     return Result;
5695 
5696   // C++2a [intro.execution]p5:
5697   //   A full-expression is [...] a constant-expression [...]
5698   Result =
5699       S.ActOnFinishFullExpr(Result.get(), From->getExprLoc(),
5700                             /*DiscardedValue=*/false, /*IsConstexpr=*/true);
5701   if (Result.isInvalid())
5702     return Result;
5703 
5704   // Check for a narrowing implicit conversion.
5705   bool ReturnPreNarrowingValue = false;
5706   APValue PreNarrowingValue;
5707   QualType PreNarrowingType;
5708   switch (SCS->getNarrowingKind(S.Context, Result.get(), PreNarrowingValue,
5709                                 PreNarrowingType)) {
5710   case NK_Dependent_Narrowing:
5711     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, but the expression is
5712     // value-dependent so we can't tell whether it's actually narrowing.
5713   case NK_Variable_Narrowing:
5714     // Implicit conversion to a narrower type, and the value is not a constant
5715     // expression. We'll diagnose this in a moment.
5716   case NK_Not_Narrowing:
5717     break;
5718 
5719   case NK_Constant_Narrowing:
5720     if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_ArrayBound &&
5721         PreNarrowingType->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() &&
5722         PreNarrowingValue.isInt()) {
5723       // Don't diagnose array bound narrowing here; we produce more precise
5724       // errors by allowing the un-narrowed value through.
5725       ReturnPreNarrowingValue = true;
5726       break;
5727     }
5728     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5729         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 1
5730         << PreNarrowingValue.getAsString(S.Context, PreNarrowingType) << T;
5731     break;
5732 
5733   case NK_Type_Narrowing:
5734     // FIXME: It would be better to diagnose that the expression is not a
5735     // constant expression.
5736     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::ext_cce_narrowing)
5737         << CCE << /*Constant*/ 0 << From->getType() << T;
5738     break;
5739   }
5740 
5741   if (Result.get()->isValueDependent()) {
5742     Value = APValue();
5743     return Result;
5744   }
5745 
5746   // Check the expression is a constant expression.
5747   SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 8> Notes;
5748   Expr::EvalResult Eval;
5749   Eval.Diag = &Notes;
5750 
5751   ConstantExprKind Kind;
5752   if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg && T->isRecordType())
5753     Kind = ConstantExprKind::ClassTemplateArgument;
5754   else if (CCE == Sema::CCEK_TemplateArg)
5755     Kind = ConstantExprKind::NonClassTemplateArgument;
5756   else
5757     Kind = ConstantExprKind::Normal;
5758 
5759   if (!Result.get()->EvaluateAsConstantExpr(Eval, S.Context, Kind) ||
5760       (RequireInt && !Eval.Val.isInt())) {
5761     // The expression can't be folded, so we can't keep it at this position in
5762     // the AST.
5763     Result = ExprError();
5764   } else {
5765     Value = Eval.Val;
5766 
5767     if (Notes.empty()) {
5768       // It's a constant expression.
5769       Expr *E = ConstantExpr::Create(S.Context, Result.get(), Value);
5770       if (ReturnPreNarrowingValue)
5771         Value = std::move(PreNarrowingValue);
5772       return E;
5773     }
5774   }
5775 
5776   // It's not a constant expression. Produce an appropriate diagnostic.
5777   if (Notes.size() == 1 &&
5778       Notes[0].second.getDiagID() == diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_const_expr) {
5779     S.Diag(Notes[0].first, diag::err_expr_not_cce) << CCE;
5780   } else if (!Notes.empty() && Notes[0].second.getDiagID() ==
5781                                    diag::note_constexpr_invalid_template_arg) {
5782     Notes[0].second.setDiagID(diag::err_constexpr_invalid_template_arg);
5783     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5784       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5785   } else {
5786     S.Diag(From->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_cce)
5787         << CCE << From->getSourceRange();
5788     for (unsigned I = 0; I < Notes.size(); ++I)
5789       S.Diag(Notes[I].first, Notes[I].second);
5790   }
5791   return ExprError();
5792 }
5793 
5794 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5795                                                   APValue &Value, CCEKind CCE,
5796                                                   NamedDecl *Dest) {
5797   return ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, Value, CCE, false,
5798                                             Dest);
5799 }
5800 
5801 ExprResult Sema::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(Expr *From, QualType T,
5802                                                   llvm::APSInt &Value,
5803                                                   CCEKind CCE) {
5804   assert(T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType() && "unexpected converted const type");
5805 
5806   APValue V;
5807   auto R = ::CheckConvertedConstantExpression(*this, From, T, V, CCE, true,
5808                                               /*Dest=*/nullptr);
5809   if (!R.isInvalid() && !R.get()->isValueDependent())
5810     Value = V.getInt();
5811   return R;
5812 }
5813 
5814 
5815 /// dropPointerConversions - If the given standard conversion sequence
5816 /// involves any pointer conversions, remove them.  This may change
5817 /// the result type of the conversion sequence.
5818 static void dropPointerConversion(StandardConversionSequence &SCS) {
5819   if (SCS.Second == ICK_Pointer_Conversion) {
5820     SCS.Second = ICK_Identity;
5821     SCS.Third = ICK_Identity;
5822     SCS.ToTypePtrs[2] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[1] = SCS.ToTypePtrs[0];
5823   }
5824 }
5825 
5826 /// TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Attempt to contextually
5827 /// convert the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5828 static ImplicitConversionSequence
5829 TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Sema &S, Expr *From) {
5830   // Do an implicit conversion to 'id'.
5831   QualType Ty = S.Context.getObjCIdType();
5832   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS
5833     = TryImplicitConversion(S, From, Ty,
5834                             // FIXME: Are these flags correct?
5835                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
5836                             AllowedExplicit::Conversions,
5837                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
5838                             /*CStyle=*/false,
5839                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false,
5840                             /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/true);
5841 
5842   // Strip off any final conversions to 'id'.
5843   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
5844   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
5845   case ImplicitConversionSequence::AmbiguousConversion:
5846   case ImplicitConversionSequence::EllipsisConversion:
5847     break;
5848 
5849   case ImplicitConversionSequence::UserDefinedConversion:
5850     dropPointerConversion(ICS.UserDefined.After);
5851     break;
5852 
5853   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
5854     dropPointerConversion(ICS.Standard);
5855     break;
5856   }
5857 
5858   return ICS;
5859 }
5860 
5861 /// PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer - Perform a contextual
5862 /// conversion of the expression From to an Objective-C pointer type.
5863 /// Returns a valid but null ExprResult if no conversion sequence exists.
5864 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(Expr *From) {
5865   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, From))
5866     return ExprError();
5867 
5868   QualType Ty = Context.getObjCIdType();
5869   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
5870     TryContextuallyConvertToObjCPointer(*this, From);
5871   if (!ICS.isBad())
5872     return PerformImplicitConversion(From, Ty, ICS, AA_Converting);
5873   return ExprResult();
5874 }
5875 
5876 /// Determine whether the provided type is an integral type, or an enumeration
5877 /// type of a permitted flavor.
5878 bool Sema::ICEConvertDiagnoser::match(QualType T) {
5879   return AllowScopedEnumerations ? T->isIntegralOrEnumerationType()
5880                                  : T->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
5881 }
5882 
5883 static ExprResult
5884 diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5885                             Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5886                             QualType T, UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions) {
5887 
5888   if (Converter.Suppress)
5889     return ExprError();
5890 
5891   Converter.diagnoseAmbiguous(SemaRef, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
5892   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5893     CXXConversionDecl *Conv =
5894         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ViableConversions[I]->getUnderlyingDecl());
5895     QualType ConvTy = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5896     Converter.noteAmbiguous(SemaRef, Conv, ConvTy);
5897   }
5898   return From;
5899 }
5900 
5901 static bool
5902 diagnoseNoViableConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5903                            Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5904                            QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5905                            UnresolvedSetImpl &ExplicitConversions) {
5906   if (ExplicitConversions.size() == 1 && !Converter.Suppress) {
5907     DeclAccessPair Found = ExplicitConversions[0];
5908     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5909         cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5910 
5911     // The user probably meant to invoke the given explicit
5912     // conversion; use it.
5913     QualType ConvTy = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5914     std::string TypeStr;
5915     ConvTy.getAsStringInternal(TypeStr, SemaRef.getPrintingPolicy());
5916 
5917     Converter.diagnoseExplicitConv(SemaRef, Loc, T, ConvTy)
5918         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(From->getBeginLoc(),
5919                                       "static_cast<" + TypeStr + ">(")
5920         << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(
5921                SemaRef.getLocForEndOfToken(From->getEndLoc()), ")");
5922     Converter.noteExplicitConv(SemaRef, Conversion, ConvTy);
5923 
5924     // If we aren't in a SFINAE context, build a call to the
5925     // explicit conversion function.
5926     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5927       return true;
5928 
5929     SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5930     ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5931                                                        HadMultipleCandidates);
5932     if (Result.isInvalid())
5933       return true;
5934     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5935     From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5936                                     CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5937                                     nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5938                                     SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5939   }
5940   return false;
5941 }
5942 
5943 static bool recordConversion(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&From,
5944                              Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter,
5945                              QualType T, bool HadMultipleCandidates,
5946                              DeclAccessPair &Found) {
5947   CXXConversionDecl *Conversion =
5948       cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Found->getUnderlyingDecl());
5949   SemaRef.CheckMemberOperatorAccess(From->getExprLoc(), From, nullptr, Found);
5950 
5951   QualType ToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
5952   if (!Converter.SuppressConversion) {
5953     if (SemaRef.isSFINAEContext())
5954       return true;
5955 
5956     Converter.diagnoseConversion(SemaRef, Loc, T, ToType)
5957         << From->getSourceRange();
5958   }
5959 
5960   ExprResult Result = SemaRef.BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(From, Found, Conversion,
5961                                                      HadMultipleCandidates);
5962   if (Result.isInvalid())
5963     return true;
5964   // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
5965   From = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(SemaRef.Context, Result.get()->getType(),
5966                                   CK_UserDefinedConversion, Result.get(),
5967                                   nullptr, Result.get()->getValueKind(),
5968                                   SemaRef.CurFPFeatureOverrides());
5969   return false;
5970 }
5971 
5972 static ExprResult finishContextualImplicitConversion(
5973     Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From,
5974     Sema::ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
5975   if (!Converter.match(From->getType()) && !Converter.Suppress)
5976     Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(SemaRef, Loc, From->getType())
5977         << From->getSourceRange();
5978 
5979   return SemaRef.DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
5980 }
5981 
5982 static void
5983 collectViableConversionCandidates(Sema &SemaRef, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
5984                                   UnresolvedSetImpl &ViableConversions,
5985                                   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
5986   for (unsigned I = 0, N = ViableConversions.size(); I != N; ++I) {
5987     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = ViableConversions[I];
5988     NamedDecl *D = FoundDecl.getDecl();
5989     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
5990     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
5991       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
5992 
5993     CXXConversionDecl *Conv;
5994     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate;
5995     if ((ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D)))
5996       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
5997     else
5998       Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
5999 
6000     if (ConvTemplate)
6001       SemaRef.AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
6002           ConvTemplate, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From, ToType, CandidateSet,
6003           /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false, /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6004     else
6005       SemaRef.AddConversionCandidate(Conv, FoundDecl, ActingContext, From,
6006                                      ToType, CandidateSet,
6007                                      /*AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit=*/false,
6008                                      /*AllowExplicit*/ true);
6009   }
6010 }
6011 
6012 /// Attempt to convert the given expression to a type which is accepted
6013 /// by the given converter.
6014 ///
6015 /// This routine will attempt to convert an expression of class type to a
6016 /// type accepted by the specified converter. In C++11 and before, the class
6017 /// must have a single non-explicit conversion function converting to a matching
6018 /// type. In C++1y, there can be multiple such conversion functions, but only
6019 /// one target type.
6020 ///
6021 /// \param Loc The source location of the construct that requires the
6022 /// conversion.
6023 ///
6024 /// \param From The expression we're converting from.
6025 ///
6026 /// \param Converter Used to control and diagnose the conversion process.
6027 ///
6028 /// \returns The expression, converted to an integral or enumeration type if
6029 /// successful.
6030 ExprResult Sema::PerformContextualImplicitConversion(
6031     SourceLocation Loc, Expr *From, ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter) {
6032   // We can't perform any more checking for type-dependent expressions.
6033   if (From->isTypeDependent())
6034     return From;
6035 
6036   // Process placeholders immediately.
6037   if (From->hasPlaceholderType()) {
6038     ExprResult result = CheckPlaceholderExpr(From);
6039     if (result.isInvalid())
6040       return result;
6041     From = result.get();
6042   }
6043 
6044   // If the expression already has a matching type, we're golden.
6045   QualType T = From->getType();
6046   if (Converter.match(T))
6047     return DefaultLvalueConversion(From);
6048 
6049   // FIXME: Check for missing '()' if T is a function type?
6050 
6051   // We can only perform contextual implicit conversions on objects of class
6052   // type.
6053   const RecordType *RecordTy = T->getAs<RecordType>();
6054   if (!RecordTy || !getLangOpts().CPlusPlus) {
6055     if (!Converter.Suppress)
6056       Converter.diagnoseNoMatch(*this, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6057     return From;
6058   }
6059 
6060   // We must have a complete class type.
6061   struct TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag : TypeDiagnoser {
6062     ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter;
6063     Expr *From;
6064 
6065     TypeDiagnoserPartialDiag(ContextualImplicitConverter &Converter, Expr *From)
6066         : Converter(Converter), From(From) {}
6067 
6068     void diagnose(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) override {
6069       Converter.diagnoseIncomplete(S, Loc, T) << From->getSourceRange();
6070     }
6071   } IncompleteDiagnoser(Converter, From);
6072 
6073   if (Converter.Suppress ? !isCompleteType(Loc, T)
6074                          : RequireCompleteType(Loc, T, IncompleteDiagnoser))
6075     return From;
6076 
6077   // Look for a conversion to an integral or enumeration type.
6078   UnresolvedSet<4>
6079       ViableConversions; // These are *potentially* viable in C++1y.
6080   UnresolvedSet<4> ExplicitConversions;
6081   const auto &Conversions =
6082       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RecordTy->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
6083 
6084   bool HadMultipleCandidates =
6085       (std::distance(Conversions.begin(), Conversions.end()) > 1);
6086 
6087   // To check that there is only one target type, in C++1y:
6088   QualType ToType;
6089   bool HasUniqueTargetType = true;
6090 
6091   // Collect explicit or viable (potentially in C++1y) conversions.
6092   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
6093     NamedDecl *D = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
6094     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion;
6095     FunctionTemplateDecl *ConvTemplate = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6096     if (ConvTemplate) {
6097       if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14)
6098         Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(ConvTemplate->getTemplatedDecl());
6099       else
6100         continue; // C++11 does not consider conversion operator templates(?).
6101     } else
6102       Conversion = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
6103 
6104     assert((!ConvTemplate || getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) &&
6105            "Conversion operator templates are considered potentially "
6106            "viable in C++1y");
6107 
6108     QualType CurToType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
6109     if (Converter.match(CurToType) || ConvTemplate) {
6110 
6111       if (Conversion->isExplicit()) {
6112         // FIXME: For C++1y, do we need this restriction?
6113         // cf. diagnoseNoViableConversion()
6114         if (!ConvTemplate)
6115           ExplicitConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6116       } else {
6117         if (!ConvTemplate && getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6118           if (ToType.isNull())
6119             ToType = CurToType.getUnqualifiedType();
6120           else if (HasUniqueTargetType &&
6121                    (CurToType.getUnqualifiedType() != ToType))
6122             HasUniqueTargetType = false;
6123         }
6124         ViableConversions.addDecl(I.getDecl(), I.getAccess());
6125       }
6126     }
6127   }
6128 
6129   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14) {
6130     // C++1y [conv]p6:
6131     // ... An expression e of class type E appearing in such a context
6132     // is said to be contextually implicitly converted to a specified
6133     // type T and is well-formed if and only if e can be implicitly
6134     // converted to a type T that is determined as follows: E is searched
6135     // for conversion functions whose return type is cv T or reference to
6136     // cv T such that T is allowed by the context. There shall be
6137     // exactly one such T.
6138 
6139     // If no unique T is found:
6140     if (ToType.isNull()) {
6141       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6142                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6143                                      ExplicitConversions))
6144         return ExprError();
6145       return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6146     }
6147 
6148     // If more than one unique Ts are found:
6149     if (!HasUniqueTargetType)
6150       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6151                                          ViableConversions);
6152 
6153     // If one unique T is found:
6154     // First, build a candidate set from the previously recorded
6155     // potentially viable conversions.
6156     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
6157     collectViableConversionCandidates(*this, From, ToType, ViableConversions,
6158                                       CandidateSet);
6159 
6160     // Then, perform overload resolution over the candidate set.
6161     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
6162     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Loc, Best)) {
6163     case OR_Success: {
6164       // Apply this conversion.
6165       DeclAccessPair Found =
6166           DeclAccessPair::make(Best->Function, Best->FoundDecl.getAccess());
6167       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6168                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6169         return ExprError();
6170       break;
6171     }
6172     case OR_Ambiguous:
6173       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6174                                          ViableConversions);
6175     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
6176       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6177                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6178                                      ExplicitConversions))
6179         return ExprError();
6180       LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
6181     case OR_Deleted:
6182       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6183       break;
6184     }
6185   } else {
6186     switch (ViableConversions.size()) {
6187     case 0: {
6188       if (diagnoseNoViableConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6189                                      HadMultipleCandidates,
6190                                      ExplicitConversions))
6191         return ExprError();
6192 
6193       // We'll complain below about a non-integral condition type.
6194       break;
6195     }
6196     case 1: {
6197       // Apply this conversion.
6198       DeclAccessPair Found = ViableConversions[0];
6199       if (recordConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6200                            HadMultipleCandidates, Found))
6201         return ExprError();
6202       break;
6203     }
6204     default:
6205       return diagnoseAmbiguousConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter, T,
6206                                          ViableConversions);
6207     }
6208   }
6209 
6210   return finishContextualImplicitConversion(*this, Loc, From, Converter);
6211 }
6212 
6213 /// IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate - Determine whether Fn is
6214 /// an acceptable non-member overloaded operator for a call whose
6215 /// arguments have types T1 (and, if non-empty, T2). This routine
6216 /// implements the check in C++ [over.match.oper]p3b2 concerning
6217 /// enumeration types.
6218 static bool IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(ASTContext &Context,
6219                                                    FunctionDecl *Fn,
6220                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
6221   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
6222   QualType T2 = Args.size() > 1 ? Args[1]->getType() : QualType();
6223 
6224   if (T1->isDependentType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isDependentType()))
6225     return true;
6226 
6227   if (T1->isRecordType() || (!T2.isNull() && T2->isRecordType()))
6228     return true;
6229 
6230   const auto *Proto = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
6231   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 1)
6232     return false;
6233 
6234   if (T1->isEnumeralType()) {
6235     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(0).getNonReferenceType();
6236     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, ArgType))
6237       return true;
6238   }
6239 
6240   if (Proto->getNumParams() < 2)
6241     return false;
6242 
6243   if (!T2.isNull() && T2->isEnumeralType()) {
6244     QualType ArgType = Proto->getParamType(1).getNonReferenceType();
6245     if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T2, ArgType))
6246       return true;
6247   }
6248 
6249   return false;
6250 }
6251 
6252 /// AddOverloadCandidate - Adds the given function to the set of
6253 /// candidate functions, using the given function call arguments.  If
6254 /// @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't allow user-defined
6255 /// conversions via constructors or conversion operators.
6256 ///
6257 /// \param PartialOverloading true if we are performing "partial" overloading
6258 /// based on an incomplete set of function arguments. This feature is used by
6259 /// code completion.
6260 void Sema::AddOverloadCandidate(
6261     FunctionDecl *Function, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6262     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
6263     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowExplicitConversions,
6264     ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate, ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6265     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6266   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6267     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Function->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6268   assert(Proto && "Functions without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6269   assert(!Function->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
6270          "Use AddTemplateOverloadCandidate for function templates");
6271 
6272   if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6273     if (!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method)) {
6274       // If we get here, it's because we're calling a member function
6275       // that is named without a member access expression (e.g.,
6276       // "this->f") that was either written explicitly or created
6277       // implicitly. This can happen with a qualified call to a member
6278       // function, e.g., X::f(). We use an empty type for the implied
6279       // object argument (C++ [over.call.func]p3), and the acting context
6280       // is irrelevant.
6281       AddMethodCandidate(Method, FoundDecl, Method->getParent(), QualType(),
6282                          Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue(), Args,
6283                          CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6284                          PartialOverloading, EarlyConversions, PO);
6285       return;
6286     }
6287     // We treat a constructor like a non-member function, since its object
6288     // argument doesn't participate in overload resolution.
6289   }
6290 
6291   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Function, PO))
6292     return;
6293 
6294   // C++11 [class.copy]p11: [DR1402]
6295   //   A defaulted move constructor that is defined as deleted is ignored by
6296   //   overload resolution.
6297   CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Function);
6298   if (Constructor && Constructor->isDefaulted() && Constructor->isDeleted() &&
6299       Constructor->isMoveConstructor())
6300     return;
6301 
6302   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6303   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6304       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6305 
6306   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
6307   //   if no operand has a class type, only those non-member functions in the
6308   //   lookup set that have a first parameter of type T1 or "reference to
6309   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T1", when T1 is an enumeration type, or (if there
6310   //   is a right operand) a second parameter of type T2 or "reference to
6311   //   (possibly cv-qualified) T2", when T2 is an enumeration type, are
6312   //   candidate functions.
6313   if (CandidateSet.getKind() == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
6314       !IsAcceptableNonMemberOperatorCandidate(Context, Function, Args))
6315     return;
6316 
6317   // Add this candidate
6318   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6319       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size(), EarlyConversions);
6320   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6321   Candidate.Function = Function;
6322   Candidate.Viable = true;
6323   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6324       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Function, PO);
6325   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6326   Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
6327   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6328   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6329 
6330   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
6331   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
6332   // to them in diagnostics.
6333   if (!AllowExplicit && ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Function).isExplicit()) {
6334     Candidate.Viable = false;
6335     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
6336     return;
6337   }
6338 
6339   if (Function->isMultiVersion() && Function->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
6340       !Function->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6341     Candidate.Viable = false;
6342     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
6343     return;
6344   }
6345 
6346   if (Constructor) {
6347     // C++ [class.copy]p3:
6348     //   A member function template is never instantiated to perform the copy
6349     //   of a class object to an object of its class type.
6350     QualType ClassType = Context.getTypeDeclType(Constructor->getParent());
6351     if (Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->isSpecializationCopyingObject() &&
6352         (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ClassType, Args[0]->getType()) ||
6353          IsDerivedFrom(Args[0]->getBeginLoc(), Args[0]->getType(),
6354                        ClassType))) {
6355       Candidate.Viable = false;
6356       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_illegal_constructor;
6357       return;
6358     }
6359 
6360     // C++ [over.match.funcs]p8: (proposed DR resolution)
6361     //   A constructor inherited from class type C that has a first parameter
6362     //   of type "reference to P" (including such a constructor instantiated
6363     //   from a template) is excluded from the set of candidate functions when
6364     //   constructing an object of type cv D if the argument list has exactly
6365     //   one argument and D is reference-related to P and P is reference-related
6366     //   to C.
6367     auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl.getDecl());
6368     if (Shadow && Args.size() == 1 && Constructor->getNumParams() >= 1 &&
6369         Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
6370       QualType P = Constructor->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getPointeeType();
6371       QualType C = Context.getRecordType(Constructor->getParent());
6372       QualType D = Context.getRecordType(Shadow->getParent());
6373       SourceLocation Loc = Args.front()->getExprLoc();
6374       if ((Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(P, C) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, P, C)) &&
6375           (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(D, P) || IsDerivedFrom(Loc, D, P))) {
6376         Candidate.Viable = false;
6377         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_inhctor_slice;
6378         return;
6379       }
6380     }
6381 
6382     // Check that the constructor is capable of constructing an object in the
6383     // destination address space.
6384     if (!Qualifiers::isAddressSpaceSupersetOf(
6385             Constructor->getMethodQualifiers().getAddressSpace(),
6386             CandidateSet.getDestAS())) {
6387       Candidate.Viable = false;
6388       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch;
6389     }
6390   }
6391 
6392   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6393 
6394   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6395   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6396   // list (8.3.5).
6397   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6398       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6399     Candidate.Viable = false;
6400     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6401     return;
6402   }
6403 
6404   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6405   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6406   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6407   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6408   // exactly m parameters.
6409   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Function->getMinRequiredArguments();
6410   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6411     // Not enough arguments.
6412     Candidate.Viable = false;
6413     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6414     return;
6415   }
6416 
6417   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6418   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6419     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6420       // Skip the check for callers that are implicit members, because in this
6421       // case we may not yet know what the member's target is; the target is
6422       // inferred for the member automatically, based on the bases and fields of
6423       // the class.
6424       if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Function)) {
6425         Candidate.Viable = false;
6426         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6427         return;
6428       }
6429 
6430   if (Function->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6431     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6432     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Function, Satisfaction) ||
6433         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6434       Candidate.Viable = false;
6435       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6436       return;
6437     }
6438   }
6439 
6440   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6441   // arguments.
6442   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6443     unsigned ConvIdx =
6444         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 - ArgIdx : ArgIdx;
6445     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6446       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6447       // template argument deduction.
6448     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6449       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6450       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6451       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6452       // parameter of F.
6453       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6454       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryCopyInitialization(
6455           *this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType, SuppressUserConversions,
6456           /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6457           /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6458           getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount, AllowExplicitConversions);
6459       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6460         Candidate.Viable = false;
6461         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6462         return;
6463       }
6464     } else {
6465       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6466       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6467       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6468       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6469     }
6470   }
6471 
6472   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6473           CheckEnableIf(Function, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args)) {
6474     Candidate.Viable = false;
6475     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6476     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6477     return;
6478   }
6479 
6480   if (LangOpts.OpenCL && isOpenCLDisabledDecl(Function)) {
6481     Candidate.Viable = false;
6482     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_ext_disabled;
6483     return;
6484   }
6485 }
6486 
6487 ObjCMethodDecl *
6488 Sema::SelectBestMethod(Selector Sel, MultiExprArg Args, bool IsInstance,
6489                        SmallVectorImpl<ObjCMethodDecl *> &Methods) {
6490   if (Methods.size() <= 1)
6491     return nullptr;
6492 
6493   for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6494     bool Match = true;
6495     ObjCMethodDecl *Method = Methods[b];
6496     unsigned NumNamedArgs = Sel.getNumArgs();
6497     // Method might have more arguments than selector indicates. This is due
6498     // to addition of c-style arguments in method.
6499     if (Method->param_size() > NumNamedArgs)
6500       NumNamedArgs = Method->param_size();
6501     if (Args.size() < NumNamedArgs)
6502       continue;
6503 
6504     for (unsigned i = 0; i < NumNamedArgs; i++) {
6505       // We can't do any type-checking on a type-dependent argument.
6506       if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6507         Match = false;
6508         break;
6509       }
6510 
6511       ParmVarDecl *param = Method->parameters()[i];
6512       Expr *argExpr = Args[i];
6513       assert(argExpr && "SelectBestMethod(): missing expression");
6514 
6515       // Strip the unbridged-cast placeholder expression off unless it's
6516       // a consumed argument.
6517       if (argExpr->hasPlaceholderType(BuiltinType::ARCUnbridgedCast) &&
6518           !param->hasAttr<CFConsumedAttr>())
6519         argExpr = stripARCUnbridgedCast(argExpr);
6520 
6521       // If the parameter is __unknown_anytype, move on to the next method.
6522       if (param->getType() == Context.UnknownAnyTy) {
6523         Match = false;
6524         break;
6525       }
6526 
6527       ImplicitConversionSequence ConversionState
6528         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, argExpr, param->getType(),
6529                                 /*SuppressUserConversions*/false,
6530                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6531                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6532                                 getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
6533                                 /*AllowExplicit*/false);
6534       // This function looks for a reasonably-exact match, so we consider
6535       // incompatible pointer conversions to be a failure here.
6536       if (ConversionState.isBad() ||
6537           (ConversionState.isStandard() &&
6538            ConversionState.Standard.Second ==
6539                ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion)) {
6540         Match = false;
6541         break;
6542       }
6543     }
6544     // Promote additional arguments to variadic methods.
6545     if (Match && Method->isVariadic()) {
6546       for (unsigned i = NumNamedArgs, e = Args.size(); i < e; ++i) {
6547         if (Args[i]->isTypeDependent()) {
6548           Match = false;
6549           break;
6550         }
6551         ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
6552                                                           nullptr);
6553         if (Arg.isInvalid()) {
6554           Match = false;
6555           break;
6556         }
6557       }
6558     } else {
6559       // Check for extra arguments to non-variadic methods.
6560       if (Args.size() != NumNamedArgs)
6561         Match = false;
6562       else if (Match && NumNamedArgs == 0 && Methods.size() > 1) {
6563         // Special case when selectors have no argument. In this case, select
6564         // one with the most general result type of 'id'.
6565         for (unsigned b = 0, e = Methods.size(); b < e; b++) {
6566           QualType ReturnT = Methods[b]->getReturnType();
6567           if (ReturnT->isObjCIdType())
6568             return Methods[b];
6569         }
6570       }
6571     }
6572 
6573     if (Match)
6574       return Method;
6575   }
6576   return nullptr;
6577 }
6578 
6579 static bool convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6580     Sema &S, FunctionDecl *Function, Expr *ThisArg, SourceLocation CallLoc,
6581     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, Sema::SFINAETrap &Trap, bool MissingImplicitThis,
6582     Expr *&ConvertedThis, SmallVectorImpl<Expr *> &ConvertedArgs) {
6583   if (ThisArg) {
6584     CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function);
6585     assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6586            "Shouldn't have `this` for ctors!");
6587     assert(!Method->isStatic() && "Shouldn't have `this` for static methods!");
6588     ExprResult R = S.PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(
6589         ThisArg, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr, Method, Method);
6590     if (R.isInvalid())
6591       return false;
6592     ConvertedThis = R.get();
6593   } else {
6594     if (auto *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Function)) {
6595       (void)MD;
6596       assert((MissingImplicitThis || MD->isStatic() ||
6597               isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(MD)) &&
6598              "Expected `this` for non-ctor instance methods");
6599     }
6600     ConvertedThis = nullptr;
6601   }
6602 
6603   // Ignore any variadic arguments. Converting them is pointless, since the
6604   // user can't refer to them in the function condition.
6605   unsigned ArgSizeNoVarargs = std::min(Function->param_size(), Args.size());
6606 
6607   // Convert the arguments.
6608   for (unsigned I = 0; I != ArgSizeNoVarargs; ++I) {
6609     ExprResult R;
6610     R = S.PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
6611                                         S.Context, Function->getParamDecl(I)),
6612                                     SourceLocation(), Args[I]);
6613 
6614     if (R.isInvalid())
6615       return false;
6616 
6617     ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6618   }
6619 
6620   if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6621     return false;
6622 
6623   // Push default arguments if needed.
6624   if (!Function->isVariadic() && Args.size() < Function->getNumParams()) {
6625     for (unsigned i = Args.size(), e = Function->getNumParams(); i != e; ++i) {
6626       ParmVarDecl *P = Function->getParamDecl(i);
6627       if (!P->hasDefaultArg())
6628         return false;
6629       ExprResult R = S.BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, Function, P);
6630       if (R.isInvalid())
6631         return false;
6632       ConvertedArgs.push_back(R.get());
6633     }
6634 
6635     if (Trap.hasErrorOccurred())
6636       return false;
6637   }
6638   return true;
6639 }
6640 
6641 EnableIfAttr *Sema::CheckEnableIf(FunctionDecl *Function,
6642                                   SourceLocation CallLoc,
6643                                   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6644                                   bool MissingImplicitThis) {
6645   auto EnableIfAttrs = Function->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
6646   if (EnableIfAttrs.begin() == EnableIfAttrs.end())
6647     return nullptr;
6648 
6649   SFINAETrap Trap(*this);
6650   SmallVector<Expr *, 16> ConvertedArgs;
6651   // FIXME: We should look into making enable_if late-parsed.
6652   Expr *DiscardedThis;
6653   if (!convertArgsForAvailabilityChecks(
6654           *this, Function, /*ThisArg=*/nullptr, CallLoc, Args, Trap,
6655           /*MissingImplicitThis=*/true, DiscardedThis, ConvertedArgs))
6656     return *EnableIfAttrs.begin();
6657 
6658   for (auto *EIA : EnableIfAttrs) {
6659     APValue Result;
6660     // FIXME: This doesn't consider value-dependent cases, because doing so is
6661     // very difficult. Ideally, we should handle them more gracefully.
6662     if (EIA->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
6663         !EIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6664             Result, Context, Function, llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvertedArgs)))
6665       return EIA;
6666 
6667     if (!Result.isInt() || !Result.getInt().getBoolValue())
6668       return EIA;
6669   }
6670   return nullptr;
6671 }
6672 
6673 template <typename CheckFn>
6674 static bool diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(Sema &S, const NamedDecl *ND,
6675                                         bool ArgDependent, SourceLocation Loc,
6676                                         CheckFn &&IsSuccessful) {
6677   SmallVector<const DiagnoseIfAttr *, 8> Attrs;
6678   for (const auto *DIA : ND->specific_attrs<DiagnoseIfAttr>()) {
6679     if (ArgDependent == DIA->getArgDependent())
6680       Attrs.push_back(DIA);
6681   }
6682 
6683   // Common case: No diagnose_if attributes, so we can quit early.
6684   if (Attrs.empty())
6685     return false;
6686 
6687   auto WarningBegin = std::stable_partition(
6688       Attrs.begin(), Attrs.end(),
6689       [](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) { return DIA->isError(); });
6690 
6691   // Note that diagnose_if attributes are late-parsed, so they appear in the
6692   // correct order (unlike enable_if attributes).
6693   auto ErrAttr = llvm::find_if(llvm::make_range(Attrs.begin(), WarningBegin),
6694                                IsSuccessful);
6695   if (ErrAttr != WarningBegin) {
6696     const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA = *ErrAttr;
6697     S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6698     S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6699         << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6700     return true;
6701   }
6702 
6703   for (const auto *DIA : llvm::make_range(WarningBegin, Attrs.end()))
6704     if (IsSuccessful(DIA)) {
6705       S.Diag(Loc, diag::warn_diagnose_if_succeeded) << DIA->getMessage();
6706       S.Diag(DIA->getLocation(), diag::note_from_diagnose_if)
6707           << DIA->getParent() << DIA->getCond()->getSourceRange();
6708     }
6709 
6710   return false;
6711 }
6712 
6713 bool Sema::diagnoseArgDependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const FunctionDecl *Function,
6714                                                const Expr *ThisArg,
6715                                                ArrayRef<const Expr *> Args,
6716                                                SourceLocation Loc) {
6717   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6718       *this, Function, /*ArgDependent=*/true, Loc,
6719       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6720         APValue Result;
6721         // It's sane to use the same Args for any redecl of this function, since
6722         // EvaluateWithSubstitution only cares about the position of each
6723         // argument in the arg list, not the ParmVarDecl* it maps to.
6724         if (!DIA->getCond()->EvaluateWithSubstitution(
6725                 Result, Context, cast<FunctionDecl>(DIA->getParent()), Args, ThisArg))
6726           return false;
6727         return Result.isInt() && Result.getInt().getBoolValue();
6728       });
6729 }
6730 
6731 bool Sema::diagnoseArgIndependentDiagnoseIfAttrs(const NamedDecl *ND,
6732                                                  SourceLocation Loc) {
6733   return diagnoseDiagnoseIfAttrsWith(
6734       *this, ND, /*ArgDependent=*/false, Loc,
6735       [&](const DiagnoseIfAttr *DIA) {
6736         bool Result;
6737         return DIA->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(Result, Context) &&
6738                Result;
6739       });
6740 }
6741 
6742 /// Add all of the function declarations in the given function set to
6743 /// the overload candidate set.
6744 void Sema::AddFunctionCandidates(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
6745                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6746                                  OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6747                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
6748                                  bool SuppressUserConversions,
6749                                  bool PartialOverloading,
6750                                  bool FirstArgumentIsBase) {
6751   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
6752     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
6753     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
6754 
6755     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
6756     FunctionDecl *FD =
6757         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
6758 
6759     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic()) {
6760       QualType ObjectType;
6761       Expr::Classification ObjectClassification;
6762       if (Args.size() > 0) {
6763         if (Expr *E = Args[0]) {
6764           // Use the explicit base to restrict the lookup:
6765           ObjectType = E->getType();
6766           // Pointers in the object arguments are implicitly dereferenced, so we
6767           // always classify them as l-values.
6768           if (!ObjectType.isNull() && ObjectType->isPointerType())
6769             ObjectClassification = Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue();
6770           else
6771             ObjectClassification = E->Classify(Context);
6772         } // .. else there is an implicit base.
6773         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6774       }
6775       if (FunTmpl) {
6776         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
6777             FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6778             cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FunTmpl->getDeclContext()),
6779             ExplicitTemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6780             FunctionArgs, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6781             PartialOverloading);
6782       } else {
6783         AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD), F.getPair(),
6784                            cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->getParent(), ObjectType,
6785                            ObjectClassification, FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6786                            SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6787       }
6788     } else {
6789       // This branch handles both standalone functions and static methods.
6790 
6791       // Slice the first argument (which is the base) when we access
6792       // static method as non-static.
6793       if (Args.size() > 0 &&
6794           (!Args[0] || (FirstArgumentIsBase && isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
6795                         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(FD)))) {
6796         assert(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic());
6797         FunctionArgs = Args.slice(1);
6798       }
6799       if (FunTmpl) {
6800         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(),
6801                                      ExplicitTemplateArgs, FunctionArgs,
6802                                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
6803                                      PartialOverloading);
6804       } else {
6805         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet,
6806                              SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading);
6807       }
6808     }
6809   }
6810 }
6811 
6812 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds a named decl (which is some kind of
6813 /// method) as a method candidate to the given overload set.
6814 void Sema::AddMethodCandidate(DeclAccessPair FoundDecl, QualType ObjectType,
6815                               Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6816                               ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6817                               OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6818                               bool SuppressUserConversions,
6819                               OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6820   NamedDecl *Decl = FoundDecl.getDecl();
6821   CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Decl->getDeclContext());
6822 
6823   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl))
6824     Decl = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Decl)->getTargetDecl();
6825 
6826   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *TD = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Decl)) {
6827     assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(TD->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
6828            "Expected a member function template");
6829     AddMethodTemplateCandidate(TD, FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6830                                /*ExplicitArgs*/ nullptr, ObjectType,
6831                                ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6832                                SuppressUserConversions, false, PO);
6833   } else {
6834     AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Decl), FoundDecl, ActingContext,
6835                        ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
6836                        SuppressUserConversions, false, None, PO);
6837   }
6838 }
6839 
6840 /// AddMethodCandidate - Adds the given C++ member function to the set
6841 /// of candidate functions, using the given function call arguments
6842 /// and the object argument (@c Object). For example, in a call
6843 /// @c o.f(a1,a2), @c Object will contain @c o and @c Args will contain
6844 /// both @c a1 and @c a2. If @p SuppressUserConversions, then don't
6845 /// allow user-defined conversions via constructors or conversion
6846 /// operators.
6847 void
6848 Sema::AddMethodCandidate(CXXMethodDecl *Method, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
6849                          CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
6850                          Expr::Classification ObjectClassification,
6851                          ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
6852                          OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
6853                          bool SuppressUserConversions,
6854                          bool PartialOverloading,
6855                          ConversionSequenceList EarlyConversions,
6856                          OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
6857   const FunctionProtoType *Proto
6858     = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Method->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>());
6859   assert(Proto && "Methods without a prototype cannot be overloaded");
6860   assert(!isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method) &&
6861          "Use AddOverloadCandidate for constructors");
6862 
6863   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Method, PO))
6864     return;
6865 
6866   // C++11 [class.copy]p23: [DR1402]
6867   //   A defaulted move assignment operator that is defined as deleted is
6868   //   ignored by overload resolution.
6869   if (Method->isDefaulted() && Method->isDeleted() &&
6870       Method->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
6871     return;
6872 
6873   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
6874   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
6875       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
6876 
6877   // Add this candidate
6878   OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
6879       CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1, EarlyConversions);
6880   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
6881   Candidate.Function = Method;
6882   Candidate.RewriteKind =
6883       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Method, PO);
6884   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
6885   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
6886   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
6887 
6888   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
6889 
6890   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
6891   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
6892   // list (8.3.5).
6893   if (TooManyArguments(NumParams, Args.size(), PartialOverloading) &&
6894       !Proto->isVariadic()) {
6895     Candidate.Viable = false;
6896     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
6897     return;
6898   }
6899 
6900   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having more than m parameters
6901   // is viable only if the (m+1)st parameter has a default argument
6902   // (8.3.6). For the purposes of overload resolution, the
6903   // parameter list is truncated on the right, so that there are
6904   // exactly m parameters.
6905   unsigned MinRequiredArgs = Method->getMinRequiredArguments();
6906   if (Args.size() < MinRequiredArgs && !PartialOverloading) {
6907     // Not enough arguments.
6908     Candidate.Viable = false;
6909     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
6910     return;
6911   }
6912 
6913   Candidate.Viable = true;
6914 
6915   if (Method->isStatic() || ObjectType.isNull())
6916     // The implicit object argument is ignored.
6917     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = true;
6918   else {
6919     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
6920     // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the object
6921     // parameter.
6922     Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
6923         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
6924         Method, ActingContext);
6925     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6926       Candidate.Viable = false;
6927       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6928       return;
6929     }
6930   }
6931 
6932   // (CUDA B.1): Check for invalid calls between targets.
6933   if (getLangOpts().CUDA)
6934     if (const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(CurContext))
6935       if (!IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, Method)) {
6936         Candidate.Viable = false;
6937         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_target;
6938         return;
6939       }
6940 
6941   if (Method->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
6942     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
6943     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Method, Satisfaction) ||
6944         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
6945       Candidate.Viable = false;
6946       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
6947       return;
6948     }
6949   }
6950 
6951   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
6952   // arguments.
6953   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < Args.size(); ++ArgIdx) {
6954     unsigned ConvIdx =
6955         PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 0 : (ArgIdx + 1);
6956     if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
6957       // We already formed a conversion sequence for this parameter during
6958       // template argument deduction.
6959     } else if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
6960       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
6961       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
6962       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
6963       // parameter of F.
6964       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
6965       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx]
6966         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
6967                                 SuppressUserConversions,
6968                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
6969                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
6970                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
6971       if (Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
6972         Candidate.Viable = false;
6973         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
6974         return;
6975       }
6976     } else {
6977       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
6978       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
6979       // considered to "match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
6980       Candidate.Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
6981     }
6982   }
6983 
6984   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
6985           CheckEnableIf(Method, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Args, true)) {
6986     Candidate.Viable = false;
6987     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
6988     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
6989     return;
6990   }
6991 
6992   if (Method->isMultiVersion() && Method->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
6993       !Method->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
6994     Candidate.Viable = false;
6995     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
6996   }
6997 }
6998 
6999 /// Add a C++ member function template as a candidate to the candidate
7000 /// set, using template argument deduction to produce an appropriate member
7001 /// function template specialization.
7002 void Sema::AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
7003     FunctionTemplateDecl *MethodTmpl, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7004     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7005     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, QualType ObjectType,
7006     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7007     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7008     bool PartialOverloading, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7009   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(MethodTmpl, PO))
7010     return;
7011 
7012   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7013   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7014   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7015   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7016   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7017   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7018   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7019   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7020   //   functions.
7021   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7022   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7023   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7024   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7025           MethodTmpl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7026           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7027             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7028                 MethodTmpl, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7029                 SuppressUserConversions, ActingContext, ObjectType,
7030                 ObjectClassification, PO);
7031           })) {
7032     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7033         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7034     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7035     Candidate.Function = MethodTmpl->getTemplatedDecl();
7036     Candidate.Viable = false;
7037     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7038       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7039     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7040     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7041         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function)->isStatic() ||
7042         ObjectType.isNull();
7043     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7044     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7045       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7046     else {
7047       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7048       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7049                                                             Info);
7050     }
7051     return;
7052   }
7053 
7054   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7055   // deduction as a candidate.
7056   assert(Specialization && "Missing member function template specialization?");
7057   assert(isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization) &&
7058          "Specialization is not a member function?");
7059   AddMethodCandidate(cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Specialization), FoundDecl,
7060                      ActingContext, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args,
7061                      CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions, PartialOverloading,
7062                      Conversions, PO);
7063 }
7064 
7065 /// Determine whether a given function template has a simple explicit specifier
7066 /// or a non-value-dependent explicit-specification that evaluates to true.
7067 static bool isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplateDecl *FTD) {
7068   return ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(FTD->getTemplatedDecl()).isExplicit();
7069 }
7070 
7071 /// Add a C++ function template specialization as a candidate
7072 /// in the candidate set, using template argument deduction to produce
7073 /// an appropriate function template specialization.
7074 void Sema::AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7075     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7076     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7077     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7078     bool PartialOverloading, bool AllowExplicit, ADLCallKind IsADLCandidate,
7079     OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7080   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate, PO))
7081     return;
7082 
7083   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7084   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7085   // and substitution in this case.
7086   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7087     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7088     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7089     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7090     Candidate.Viable = false;
7091     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7092     return;
7093   }
7094 
7095   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p7:
7096   //   In each case where a candidate is a function template, candidate
7097   //   function template specializations are generated using template argument
7098   //   deduction (14.8.3, 14.8.2). Those candidates are then handled as
7099   //   candidate functions in the usual way.113) A given name can refer to one
7100   //   or more function templates and also to a set of overloaded non-template
7101   //   functions. In such a case, the candidate functions generated from each
7102   //   function template are combined with the set of non-template candidate
7103   //   functions.
7104   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7105   FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7106   ConversionSequenceList Conversions;
7107   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result = DeduceTemplateArguments(
7108           FunctionTemplate, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, Specialization, Info,
7109           PartialOverloading, [&](ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes) {
7110             return CheckNonDependentConversions(
7111                 FunctionTemplate, ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet, Conversions,
7112                 SuppressUserConversions, nullptr, QualType(), {}, PO);
7113           })) {
7114     OverloadCandidate &Candidate =
7115         CandidateSet.addCandidate(Conversions.size(), Conversions);
7116     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7117     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7118     Candidate.Viable = false;
7119     Candidate.RewriteKind =
7120       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().getRewriteKind(Candidate.Function, PO);
7121     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7122     Candidate.IsADLCandidate = IsADLCandidate;
7123     // Ignore the object argument if there is one, since we don't have an object
7124     // type.
7125     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument =
7126         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Candidate.Function) &&
7127         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Candidate.Function);
7128     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7129     if (Result == TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure)
7130       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7131     else {
7132       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7133       Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7134                                                             Info);
7135     }
7136     return;
7137   }
7138 
7139   // Add the function template specialization produced by template argument
7140   // deduction as a candidate.
7141   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7142   AddOverloadCandidate(
7143       Specialization, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, SuppressUserConversions,
7144       PartialOverloading, AllowExplicit,
7145       /*AllowExplicitConversions*/ false, IsADLCandidate, Conversions, PO);
7146 }
7147 
7148 /// Check that implicit conversion sequences can be formed for each argument
7149 /// whose corresponding parameter has a non-dependent type, per DR1391's
7150 /// [temp.deduct.call]p10.
7151 bool Sema::CheckNonDependentConversions(
7152     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes,
7153     ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7154     ConversionSequenceList &Conversions, bool SuppressUserConversions,
7155     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, QualType ObjectType,
7156     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification, OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7157   // FIXME: The cases in which we allow explicit conversions for constructor
7158   // arguments never consider calling a constructor template. It's not clear
7159   // that is correct.
7160   const bool AllowExplicit = false;
7161 
7162   auto *FD = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7163   auto *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD);
7164   bool HasThisConversion = Method && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Method);
7165   unsigned ThisConversions = HasThisConversion ? 1 : 0;
7166 
7167   Conversions =
7168       CandidateSet.allocateConversionSequences(ThisConversions + Args.size());
7169 
7170   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7171   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7172       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7173 
7174   // For a method call, check the 'this' conversion here too. DR1391 doesn't
7175   // require that, but this check should never result in a hard error, and
7176   // overload resolution is permitted to sidestep instantiations.
7177   if (HasThisConversion && !cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FD)->isStatic() &&
7178       !ObjectType.isNull()) {
7179     unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed ? 1 : 0;
7180     Conversions[ConvIdx] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7181         *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), ObjectType, ObjectClassification,
7182         Method, ActingContext);
7183     if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7184       return true;
7185   }
7186 
7187   for (unsigned I = 0, N = std::min(ParamTypes.size(), Args.size()); I != N;
7188        ++I) {
7189     QualType ParamType = ParamTypes[I];
7190     if (!ParamType->isDependentType()) {
7191       unsigned ConvIdx = PO == OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed
7192                              ? 0
7193                              : (ThisConversions + I);
7194       Conversions[ConvIdx]
7195         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[I], ParamType,
7196                                 SuppressUserConversions,
7197                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
7198                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7199                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount,
7200                                 AllowExplicit);
7201       if (Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
7202         return true;
7203     }
7204   }
7205 
7206   return false;
7207 }
7208 
7209 /// Determine whether this is an allowable conversion from the result
7210 /// of an explicit conversion operator to the expected type, per C++
7211 /// [over.match.conv]p1 and [over.match.ref]p1.
7212 ///
7213 /// \param ConvType The return type of the conversion function.
7214 ///
7215 /// \param ToType The type we are converting to.
7216 ///
7217 /// \param AllowObjCPointerConversion Allow a conversion from one
7218 /// Objective-C pointer to another.
7219 ///
7220 /// \returns true if the conversion is allowable, false otherwise.
7221 static bool isAllowableExplicitConversion(Sema &S,
7222                                           QualType ConvType, QualType ToType,
7223                                           bool AllowObjCPointerConversion) {
7224   QualType ToNonRefType = ToType.getNonReferenceType();
7225 
7226   // Easy case: the types are the same.
7227   if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(ConvType, ToNonRefType))
7228     return true;
7229 
7230   // Allow qualification conversions.
7231   bool ObjCLifetimeConversion;
7232   if (S.IsQualificationConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, /*CStyle*/false,
7233                                   ObjCLifetimeConversion))
7234     return true;
7235 
7236   // If we're not allowed to consider Objective-C pointer conversions,
7237   // we're done.
7238   if (!AllowObjCPointerConversion)
7239     return false;
7240 
7241   // Is this an Objective-C pointer conversion?
7242   bool IncompatibleObjC = false;
7243   QualType ConvertedType;
7244   return S.isObjCPointerConversion(ConvType, ToNonRefType, ConvertedType,
7245                                    IncompatibleObjC);
7246 }
7247 
7248 /// AddConversionCandidate - Add a C++ conversion function as a
7249 /// candidate in the candidate set (C++ [over.match.conv],
7250 /// C++ [over.match.copy]). From is the expression we're converting from,
7251 /// and ToType is the type that we're eventually trying to convert to
7252 /// (which may or may not be the same type as the type that the
7253 /// conversion function produces).
7254 void Sema::AddConversionCandidate(
7255     CXXConversionDecl *Conversion, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7256     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7257     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7258     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7259   assert(!Conversion->getDescribedFunctionTemplate() &&
7260          "Conversion function templates use AddTemplateConversionCandidate");
7261   QualType ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7262   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7263     return;
7264 
7265   // If the conversion function has an undeduced return type, trigger its
7266   // deduction now.
7267   if (getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && ConvType->isUndeducedType()) {
7268     if (DeduceReturnType(Conversion, From->getExprLoc()))
7269       return;
7270     ConvType = Conversion->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
7271   }
7272 
7273   // If we don't allow any conversion of the result type, ignore conversion
7274   // functions that don't convert to exactly (possibly cv-qualified) T.
7275   if (!AllowResultConversion &&
7276       !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Conversion->getConversionType(), ToType))
7277     return;
7278 
7279   // Per C++ [over.match.conv]p1, [over.match.ref]p1, an explicit conversion
7280   // operator is only a candidate if its return type is the target type or
7281   // can be converted to the target type with a qualification conversion.
7282   //
7283   // FIXME: Include such functions in the candidate list and explain why we
7284   // can't select them.
7285   if (Conversion->isExplicit() &&
7286       !isAllowableExplicitConversion(*this, ConvType, ToType,
7287                                      AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit))
7288     return;
7289 
7290   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7291   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7292       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7293 
7294   // Add this candidate
7295   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(1);
7296   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7297   Candidate.Function = Conversion;
7298   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7299   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7300   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAsIdentityConversion();
7301   Candidate.FinalConversion.setFromType(ConvType);
7302   Candidate.FinalConversion.setAllToTypes(ToType);
7303   Candidate.Viable = true;
7304   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7305 
7306   // Explicit functions are not actually candidates at all if we're not
7307   // allowing them in this context, but keep them around so we can point
7308   // to them in diagnostics.
7309   if (!AllowExplicit && Conversion->isExplicit()) {
7310     Candidate.Viable = false;
7311     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7312     return;
7313   }
7314 
7315   // C++ [over.match.funcs]p4:
7316   //   For conversion functions, the function is considered to be a member of
7317   //   the class of the implicit implied object argument for the purpose of
7318   //   defining the type of the implicit object parameter.
7319   //
7320   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7321   // object parameter.
7322   QualType ImplicitParamType = From->getType();
7323   if (const PointerType *FromPtrType = ImplicitParamType->getAs<PointerType>())
7324     ImplicitParamType = FromPtrType->getPointeeType();
7325   CXXRecordDecl *ConversionContext
7326     = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(ImplicitParamType->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
7327 
7328   Candidate.Conversions[0] = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7329       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), From->getType(),
7330       From->Classify(Context), Conversion, ConversionContext);
7331 
7332   if (Candidate.Conversions[0].isBad()) {
7333     Candidate.Viable = false;
7334     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7335     return;
7336   }
7337 
7338   if (Conversion->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
7339     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
7340     if (CheckFunctionConstraints(Conversion, Satisfaction) ||
7341         !Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
7342       Candidate.Viable = false;
7343       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied;
7344       return;
7345     }
7346   }
7347 
7348   // We won't go through a user-defined type conversion function to convert a
7349   // derived to base as such conversions are given Conversion Rank. They only
7350   // go through a copy constructor. 13.3.3.1.2-p4 [over.ics.user]
7351   QualType FromCanon
7352     = Context.getCanonicalType(From->getType().getUnqualifiedType());
7353   QualType ToCanon = Context.getCanonicalType(ToType).getUnqualifiedType();
7354   if (FromCanon == ToCanon ||
7355       IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), FromCanon, ToCanon)) {
7356     Candidate.Viable = false;
7357     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_trivial_conversion;
7358     return;
7359   }
7360 
7361   // To determine what the conversion from the result of calling the
7362   // conversion function to the type we're eventually trying to
7363   // convert to (ToType), we need to synthesize a call to the
7364   // conversion function and attempt copy initialization from it. This
7365   // makes sure that we get the right semantics with respect to
7366   // lvalues/rvalues and the type. Fortunately, we can allocate this
7367   // call on the stack and we don't need its arguments to be
7368   // well-formed.
7369   DeclRefExpr ConversionRef(Context, Conversion, false, Conversion->getType(),
7370                             VK_LValue, From->getBeginLoc());
7371   ImplicitCastExpr ConversionFn(ImplicitCastExpr::OnStack,
7372                                 Context.getPointerType(Conversion->getType()),
7373                                 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay, &ConversionRef,
7374                                 VK_RValue, FPOptionsOverride());
7375 
7376   QualType ConversionType = Conversion->getConversionType();
7377   if (!isCompleteType(From->getBeginLoc(), ConversionType)) {
7378     Candidate.Viable = false;
7379     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7380     return;
7381   }
7382 
7383   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ConversionType);
7384 
7385   // Note that it is safe to allocate CallExpr on the stack here because
7386   // there are 0 arguments (i.e., nothing is allocated using ASTContext's
7387   // allocator).
7388   QualType CallResultType = ConversionType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
7389 
7390   alignas(CallExpr) char Buffer[sizeof(CallExpr) + sizeof(Stmt *)];
7391   CallExpr *TheTemporaryCall = CallExpr::CreateTemporary(
7392       Buffer, &ConversionFn, CallResultType, VK, From->getBeginLoc());
7393 
7394   ImplicitConversionSequence ICS =
7395       TryCopyInitialization(*this, TheTemporaryCall, ToType,
7396                             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/true,
7397                             /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7398                             /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/false);
7399 
7400   switch (ICS.getKind()) {
7401   case ImplicitConversionSequence::StandardConversion:
7402     Candidate.FinalConversion = ICS.Standard;
7403 
7404     // C++ [over.ics.user]p3:
7405     //   If the user-defined conversion is specified by a specialization of a
7406     //   conversion function template, the second standard conversion sequence
7407     //   shall have exact match rank.
7408     if (Conversion->getPrimaryTemplate() &&
7409         GetConversionRank(ICS.Standard.Second) != ICR_Exact_Match) {
7410       Candidate.Viable = false;
7411       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact;
7412       return;
7413     }
7414 
7415     // C++0x [dcl.init.ref]p5:
7416     //    In the second case, if the reference is an rvalue reference and
7417     //    the second standard conversion sequence of the user-defined
7418     //    conversion sequence includes an lvalue-to-rvalue conversion, the
7419     //    program is ill-formed.
7420     if (ToType->isRValueReferenceType() &&
7421         ICS.Standard.First == ICK_Lvalue_To_Rvalue) {
7422       Candidate.Viable = false;
7423       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7424       return;
7425     }
7426     break;
7427 
7428   case ImplicitConversionSequence::BadConversion:
7429     Candidate.Viable = false;
7430     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion;
7431     return;
7432 
7433   default:
7434     llvm_unreachable(
7435            "Can only end up with a standard conversion sequence or failure");
7436   }
7437 
7438   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7439           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7440     Candidate.Viable = false;
7441     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7442     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7443     return;
7444   }
7445 
7446   if (Conversion->isMultiVersion() && Conversion->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
7447       !Conversion->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion()) {
7448     Candidate.Viable = false;
7449     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_non_default_multiversion_function;
7450   }
7451 }
7452 
7453 /// Adds a conversion function template specialization
7454 /// candidate to the overload set, using template argument deduction
7455 /// to deduce the template arguments of the conversion function
7456 /// template from the type that we are converting to (C++
7457 /// [temp.deduct.conv]).
7458 void Sema::AddTemplateConversionCandidate(
7459     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate, DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7460     CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC, Expr *From, QualType ToType,
7461     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet, bool AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7462     bool AllowExplicit, bool AllowResultConversion) {
7463   assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl()) &&
7464          "Only conversion function templates permitted here");
7465 
7466   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(FunctionTemplate))
7467     return;
7468 
7469   // If the function template has a non-dependent explicit specification,
7470   // exclude it now if appropriate; we are not permitted to perform deduction
7471   // and substitution in this case.
7472   if (!AllowExplicit && isNonDependentlyExplicit(FunctionTemplate)) {
7473     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7474     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7475     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7476     Candidate.Viable = false;
7477     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_explicit;
7478     return;
7479   }
7480 
7481   TemplateDeductionInfo Info(CandidateSet.getLocation());
7482   CXXConversionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
7483   if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
7484         = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, ToType,
7485                                   Specialization, Info)) {
7486     OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate();
7487     Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7488     Candidate.Function = FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl();
7489     Candidate.Viable = false;
7490     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_deduction;
7491     Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7492     Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7493     Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = 1;
7494     Candidate.DeductionFailure = MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result,
7495                                                           Info);
7496     return;
7497   }
7498 
7499   // Add the conversion function template specialization produced by
7500   // template argument deduction as a candidate.
7501   assert(Specialization && "Missing function template specialization?");
7502   AddConversionCandidate(Specialization, FoundDecl, ActingDC, From, ToType,
7503                          CandidateSet, AllowObjCConversionOnExplicit,
7504                          AllowExplicit, AllowResultConversion);
7505 }
7506 
7507 /// AddSurrogateCandidate - Adds a "surrogate" candidate function that
7508 /// converts the given @c Object to a function pointer via the
7509 /// conversion function @c Conversion, and then attempts to call it
7510 /// with the given arguments (C++ [over.call.object]p2-4). Proto is
7511 /// the type of function that we'll eventually be calling.
7512 void Sema::AddSurrogateCandidate(CXXConversionDecl *Conversion,
7513                                  DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
7514                                  CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext,
7515                                  const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
7516                                  Expr *Object,
7517                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7518                                  OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet) {
7519   if (!CandidateSet.isNewCandidate(Conversion))
7520     return;
7521 
7522   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7523   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7524       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7525 
7526   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size() + 1);
7527   Candidate.FoundDecl = FoundDecl;
7528   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7529   Candidate.Surrogate = Conversion;
7530   Candidate.Viable = true;
7531   Candidate.IsSurrogate = true;
7532   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7533   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7534 
7535   // Determine the implicit conversion sequence for the implicit
7536   // object parameter.
7537   ImplicitConversionSequence ObjectInit = TryObjectArgumentInitialization(
7538       *this, CandidateSet.getLocation(), Object->getType(),
7539       Object->Classify(Context), Conversion, ActingContext);
7540   if (ObjectInit.isBad()) {
7541     Candidate.Viable = false;
7542     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7543     Candidate.Conversions[0] = ObjectInit;
7544     return;
7545   }
7546 
7547   // The first conversion is actually a user-defined conversion whose
7548   // first conversion is ObjectInit's standard conversion (which is
7549   // effectively a reference binding). Record it as such.
7550   Candidate.Conversions[0].setUserDefined();
7551   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before = ObjectInit.Standard;
7552   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.EllipsisConversion = false;
7553   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.HadMultipleCandidates = false;
7554   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction = Conversion;
7555   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.FoundConversionFunction = FoundDecl;
7556   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After
7557     = Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.Before;
7558   Candidate.Conversions[0].UserDefined.After.setAsIdentityConversion();
7559 
7560   // Find the
7561   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
7562 
7563   // (C++ 13.3.2p2): A candidate function having fewer than m
7564   // parameters is viable only if it has an ellipsis in its parameter
7565   // list (8.3.5).
7566   if (Args.size() > NumParams && !Proto->isVariadic()) {
7567     Candidate.Viable = false;
7568     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
7569     return;
7570   }
7571 
7572   // Function types don't have any default arguments, so just check if
7573   // we have enough arguments.
7574   if (Args.size() < NumParams) {
7575     // Not enough arguments.
7576     Candidate.Viable = false;
7577     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
7578     return;
7579   }
7580 
7581   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7582   // arguments.
7583   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7584     if (ArgIdx < NumParams) {
7585       // (C++ 13.3.2p3): for F to be a viable function, there shall
7586       // exist for each argument an implicit conversion sequence
7587       // (13.3.3.1) that converts that argument to the corresponding
7588       // parameter of F.
7589       QualType ParamType = Proto->getParamType(ArgIdx);
7590       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1]
7591         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamType,
7592                                 /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
7593                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7594                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7595                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7596       if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].isBad()) {
7597         Candidate.Viable = false;
7598         Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7599         return;
7600       }
7601     } else {
7602       // (C++ 13.3.2p2): For the purposes of overload resolution, any
7603       // argument for which there is no corresponding parameter is
7604       // considered to ""match the ellipsis" (C+ 13.3.3.1.3).
7605       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx + 1].setEllipsis();
7606     }
7607   }
7608 
7609   if (EnableIfAttr *FailedAttr =
7610           CheckEnableIf(Conversion, CandidateSet.getLocation(), None)) {
7611     Candidate.Viable = false;
7612     Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_enable_if;
7613     Candidate.DeductionFailure.Data = FailedAttr;
7614     return;
7615   }
7616 }
7617 
7618 /// Add all of the non-member operator function declarations in the given
7619 /// function set to the overload candidate set.
7620 void Sema::AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(
7621     const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7622     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7623     TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
7624   for (UnresolvedSetIterator F = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); F != E; ++F) {
7625     NamedDecl *D = F.getDecl()->getUnderlyingDecl();
7626     ArrayRef<Expr *> FunctionArgs = Args;
7627 
7628     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D);
7629     FunctionDecl *FD =
7630         FunTmpl ? FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl() : cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
7631 
7632     // Don't consider rewritten functions if we're not rewriting.
7633     if (!CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isAcceptableCandidate(FD))
7634       continue;
7635 
7636     assert(!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FD) &&
7637            "unqualified operator lookup found a member function");
7638 
7639     if (FunTmpl) {
7640       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7641                                    FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7642       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7643         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
7644             FunTmpl, F.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs,
7645             {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet, false, false,
7646             true, ADLCallKind::NotADL, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7647     } else {
7648       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
7649         continue;
7650       AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(), FunctionArgs, CandidateSet);
7651       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD))
7652         AddOverloadCandidate(FD, F.getPair(),
7653                              {FunctionArgs[1], FunctionArgs[0]}, CandidateSet,
7654                              false, false, true, false, ADLCallKind::NotADL,
7655                              None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
7656     }
7657   }
7658 }
7659 
7660 /// Add overload candidates for overloaded operators that are
7661 /// member functions.
7662 ///
7663 /// Add the overloaded operator candidates that are member functions
7664 /// for the operator Op that was used in an operator expression such
7665 /// as "x Op y". , Args/NumArgs provides the operator arguments, and
7666 /// CandidateSet will store the added overload candidates. (C++
7667 /// [over.match.oper]).
7668 void Sema::AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
7669                                        SourceLocation OpLoc,
7670                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7671                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
7672                                        OverloadCandidateParamOrder PO) {
7673   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
7674 
7675   // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
7676   //   For a unary operator @ with an operand of a type whose
7677   //   cv-unqualified version is T1, and for a binary operator @ with
7678   //   a left operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T1 and
7679   //   a right operand of a type whose cv-unqualified version is T2,
7680   //   three sets of candidate functions, designated member
7681   //   candidates, non-member candidates and built-in candidates, are
7682   //   constructed as follows:
7683   QualType T1 = Args[0]->getType();
7684 
7685   //     -- If T1 is a complete class type or a class currently being
7686   //        defined, the set of member candidates is the result of the
7687   //        qualified lookup of T1::operator@ (13.3.1.1.1); otherwise,
7688   //        the set of member candidates is empty.
7689   if (const RecordType *T1Rec = T1->getAs<RecordType>()) {
7690     // Complete the type if it can be completed.
7691     if (!isCompleteType(OpLoc, T1) && !T1Rec->isBeingDefined())
7692       return;
7693     // If the type is neither complete nor being defined, bail out now.
7694     if (!T1Rec->getDecl()->getDefinition())
7695       return;
7696 
7697     LookupResult Operators(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
7698     LookupQualifiedName(Operators, T1Rec->getDecl());
7699     Operators.suppressDiagnostics();
7700 
7701     for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = Operators.begin(),
7702                              OperEnd = Operators.end();
7703          Oper != OperEnd;
7704          ++Oper)
7705       AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Args[0]->getType(),
7706                          Args[0]->Classify(Context), Args.slice(1),
7707                          CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false, PO);
7708   }
7709 }
7710 
7711 /// AddBuiltinCandidate - Add a candidate for a built-in
7712 /// operator. ResultTy and ParamTys are the result and parameter types
7713 /// of the built-in candidate, respectively. Args and NumArgs are the
7714 /// arguments being passed to the candidate. IsAssignmentOperator
7715 /// should be true when this built-in candidate is an assignment
7716 /// operator. NumContextualBoolArguments is the number of arguments
7717 /// (at the beginning of the argument list) that will be contextually
7718 /// converted to bool.
7719 void Sema::AddBuiltinCandidate(QualType *ParamTys, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
7720                                OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
7721                                bool IsAssignmentOperator,
7722                                unsigned NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7723   // Overload resolution is always an unevaluated context.
7724   EnterExpressionEvaluationContext Unevaluated(
7725       *this, Sema::ExpressionEvaluationContext::Unevaluated);
7726 
7727   // Add this candidate
7728   OverloadCandidate &Candidate = CandidateSet.addCandidate(Args.size());
7729   Candidate.FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_none);
7730   Candidate.Function = nullptr;
7731   Candidate.IsSurrogate = false;
7732   Candidate.IgnoreObjectArgument = false;
7733   std::copy(ParamTys, ParamTys + Args.size(), Candidate.BuiltinParamTypes);
7734 
7735   // Determine the implicit conversion sequences for each of the
7736   // arguments.
7737   Candidate.Viable = true;
7738   Candidate.ExplicitCallArguments = Args.size();
7739   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
7740     // C++ [over.match.oper]p4:
7741     //   For the built-in assignment operators, conversions of the
7742     //   left operand are restricted as follows:
7743     //     -- no temporaries are introduced to hold the left operand, and
7744     //     -- no user-defined conversions are applied to the left
7745     //        operand to achieve a type match with the left-most
7746     //        parameter of a built-in candidate.
7747     //
7748     // We block these conversions by turning off user-defined
7749     // conversions, since that is the only way that initialization of
7750     // a reference to a non-class type can occur from something that
7751     // is not of the same type.
7752     if (ArgIdx < NumContextualBoolArguments) {
7753       assert(ParamTys[ArgIdx] == Context.BoolTy &&
7754              "Contextual conversion to bool requires bool type");
7755       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7756         = TryContextuallyConvertToBool(*this, Args[ArgIdx]);
7757     } else {
7758       Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx]
7759         = TryCopyInitialization(*this, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTys[ArgIdx],
7760                                 ArgIdx == 0 && IsAssignmentOperator,
7761                                 /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
7762                                 /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
7763                                   getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
7764     }
7765     if (Candidate.Conversions[ArgIdx].isBad()) {
7766       Candidate.Viable = false;
7767       Candidate.FailureKind = ovl_fail_bad_conversion;
7768       break;
7769     }
7770   }
7771 }
7772 
7773 namespace {
7774 
7775 /// BuiltinCandidateTypeSet - A set of types that will be used for the
7776 /// candidate operator functions for built-in operators (C++
7777 /// [over.built]). The types are separated into pointer types and
7778 /// enumeration types.
7779 class BuiltinCandidateTypeSet  {
7780   /// TypeSet - A set of types.
7781   typedef llvm::SetVector<QualType, SmallVector<QualType, 8>,
7782                           llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8>> TypeSet;
7783 
7784   /// PointerTypes - The set of pointer types that will be used in the
7785   /// built-in candidates.
7786   TypeSet PointerTypes;
7787 
7788   /// MemberPointerTypes - The set of member pointer types that will be
7789   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7790   TypeSet MemberPointerTypes;
7791 
7792   /// EnumerationTypes - The set of enumeration types that will be
7793   /// used in the built-in candidates.
7794   TypeSet EnumerationTypes;
7795 
7796   /// The set of vector types that will be used in the built-in
7797   /// candidates.
7798   TypeSet VectorTypes;
7799 
7800   /// The set of matrix types that will be used in the built-in
7801   /// candidates.
7802   TypeSet MatrixTypes;
7803 
7804   /// A flag indicating non-record types are viable candidates
7805   bool HasNonRecordTypes;
7806 
7807   /// A flag indicating whether either arithmetic or enumeration types
7808   /// were present in the candidate set.
7809   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes;
7810 
7811   /// A flag indicating whether the nullptr type was present in the
7812   /// candidate set.
7813   bool HasNullPtrType;
7814 
7815   /// Sema - The semantic analysis instance where we are building the
7816   /// candidate type set.
7817   Sema &SemaRef;
7818 
7819   /// Context - The AST context in which we will build the type sets.
7820   ASTContext &Context;
7821 
7822   bool AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7823                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals);
7824   bool AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty);
7825 
7826 public:
7827   /// iterator - Iterates through the types that are part of the set.
7828   typedef TypeSet::iterator iterator;
7829 
7830   BuiltinCandidateTypeSet(Sema &SemaRef)
7831     : HasNonRecordTypes(false),
7832       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes(false),
7833       HasNullPtrType(false),
7834       SemaRef(SemaRef),
7835       Context(SemaRef.Context) { }
7836 
7837   void AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7838                              SourceLocation Loc,
7839                              bool AllowUserConversions,
7840                              bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7841                              const Qualifiers &VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
7842 
7843   /// pointer_begin - First pointer type found;
7844   iterator pointer_begin() { return PointerTypes.begin(); }
7845 
7846   /// pointer_end - Past the last pointer type found;
7847   iterator pointer_end() { return PointerTypes.end(); }
7848 
7849   /// member_pointer_begin - First member pointer type found;
7850   iterator member_pointer_begin() { return MemberPointerTypes.begin(); }
7851 
7852   /// member_pointer_end - Past the last member pointer type found;
7853   iterator member_pointer_end() { return MemberPointerTypes.end(); }
7854 
7855   /// enumeration_begin - First enumeration type found;
7856   iterator enumeration_begin() { return EnumerationTypes.begin(); }
7857 
7858   /// enumeration_end - Past the last enumeration type found;
7859   iterator enumeration_end() { return EnumerationTypes.end(); }
7860 
7861   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> vector_types() { return VectorTypes; }
7862 
7863   llvm::iterator_range<iterator> matrix_types() { return MatrixTypes; }
7864 
7865   bool containsMatrixType(QualType Ty) const { return MatrixTypes.count(Ty); }
7866   bool hasNonRecordTypes() { return HasNonRecordTypes; }
7867   bool hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes() { return HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes; }
7868   bool hasNullPtrType() const { return HasNullPtrType; }
7869 };
7870 
7871 } // end anonymous namespace
7872 
7873 /// AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty to
7874 /// the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7875 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7876 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7877 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7878 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7879 /// false otherwise.
7880 ///
7881 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7882 bool
7883 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(QualType Ty,
7884                                              const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7885 
7886   // Insert this type.
7887   if (!PointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7888     return false;
7889 
7890   QualType PointeeTy;
7891   const PointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<PointerType>();
7892   bool buildObjCPtr = false;
7893   if (!PointerTy) {
7894     const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy = Ty->castAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
7895     PointeeTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
7896     buildObjCPtr = true;
7897   } else {
7898     PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7899   }
7900 
7901   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7902   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7903   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7904   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7905   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7906     return true;
7907 
7908   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7909   bool hasVolatile = VisibleQuals.hasVolatile();
7910   bool hasRestrict = VisibleQuals.hasRestrict();
7911 
7912   // Iterate through all strict supersets of BaseCVR.
7913   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7914     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7915     // Skip over volatile if no volatile found anywhere in the types.
7916     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Volatile) && !hasVolatile) continue;
7917 
7918     // Skip over restrict if no restrict found anywhere in the types, or if
7919     // the type cannot be restrict-qualified.
7920     if ((CVR & Qualifiers::Restrict) &&
7921         (!hasRestrict ||
7922          (!(PointeeTy->isAnyPointerType() || PointeeTy->isReferenceType()))))
7923       continue;
7924 
7925     // Build qualified pointee type.
7926     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7927 
7928     // Build qualified pointer type.
7929     QualType QPointerTy;
7930     if (!buildObjCPtr)
7931       QPointerTy = Context.getPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7932     else
7933       QPointerTy = Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(QPointeeTy);
7934 
7935     // Insert qualified pointer type.
7936     PointerTypes.insert(QPointerTy);
7937   }
7938 
7939   return true;
7940 }
7941 
7942 /// AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants - Add the pointer type @p Ty
7943 /// to the set of pointer types along with any more-qualified variants of
7944 /// that type. For example, if @p Ty is "int const *", this routine
7945 /// will add "int const *", "int const volatile *", "int const
7946 /// restrict *", and "int const volatile restrict *" to the set of
7947 /// pointer types. Returns true if the add of @p Ty itself succeeded,
7948 /// false otherwise.
7949 ///
7950 /// FIXME: what to do about extended qualifiers?
7951 bool
7952 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(
7953     QualType Ty) {
7954   // Insert this type.
7955   if (!MemberPointerTypes.insert(Ty))
7956     return false;
7957 
7958   const MemberPointerType *PointerTy = Ty->getAs<MemberPointerType>();
7959   assert(PointerTy && "type was not a member pointer type!");
7960 
7961   QualType PointeeTy = PointerTy->getPointeeType();
7962   // Don't add qualified variants of arrays. For one, they're not allowed
7963   // (the qualifier would sink to the element type), and for another, the
7964   // only overload situation where it matters is subscript or pointer +- int,
7965   // and those shouldn't have qualifier variants anyway.
7966   if (PointeeTy->isArrayType())
7967     return true;
7968   const Type *ClassTy = PointerTy->getClass();
7969 
7970   // Iterate through all strict supersets of the pointee type's CVR
7971   // qualifiers.
7972   unsigned BaseCVR = PointeeTy.getCVRQualifiers();
7973   for (unsigned CVR = BaseCVR+1; CVR <= Qualifiers::CVRMask; ++CVR) {
7974     if ((CVR | BaseCVR) != CVR) continue;
7975 
7976     QualType QPointeeTy = Context.getCVRQualifiedType(PointeeTy, CVR);
7977     MemberPointerTypes.insert(
7978       Context.getMemberPointerType(QPointeeTy, ClassTy));
7979   }
7980 
7981   return true;
7982 }
7983 
7984 /// AddTypesConvertedFrom - Add each of the types to which the type @p
7985 /// Ty can be implicit converted to the given set of @p Types. We're
7986 /// primarily interested in pointer types and enumeration types. We also
7987 /// take member pointer types, for the conditional operator.
7988 /// AllowUserConversions is true if we should look at the conversion
7989 /// functions of a class type, and AllowExplicitConversions if we
7990 /// should also include the explicit conversion functions of a class
7991 /// type.
7992 void
7993 BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::AddTypesConvertedFrom(QualType Ty,
7994                                                SourceLocation Loc,
7995                                                bool AllowUserConversions,
7996                                                bool AllowExplicitConversions,
7997                                                const Qualifiers &VisibleQuals) {
7998   // Only deal with canonical types.
7999   Ty = Context.getCanonicalType(Ty);
8000 
8001   // Look through reference types; they aren't part of the type of an
8002   // expression for the purposes of conversions.
8003   if (const ReferenceType *RefTy = Ty->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8004     Ty = RefTy->getPointeeType();
8005 
8006   // If we're dealing with an array type, decay to the pointer.
8007   if (Ty->isArrayType())
8008     Ty = SemaRef.Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty);
8009 
8010   // Otherwise, we don't care about qualifiers on the type.
8011   Ty = Ty.getLocalUnqualifiedType();
8012 
8013   // Flag if we ever add a non-record type.
8014   const RecordType *TyRec = Ty->getAs<RecordType>();
8015   HasNonRecordTypes = HasNonRecordTypes || !TyRec;
8016 
8017   // Flag if we encounter an arithmetic type.
8018   HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes =
8019     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes || Ty->isArithmeticType();
8020 
8021   if (Ty->isObjCIdType() || Ty->isObjCClassType())
8022     PointerTypes.insert(Ty);
8023   else if (Ty->getAs<PointerType>() || Ty->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
8024     // Insert our type, and its more-qualified variants, into the set
8025     // of types.
8026     if (!AddPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty, VisibleQuals))
8027       return;
8028   } else if (Ty->isMemberPointerType()) {
8029     // Member pointers are far easier, since the pointee can't be converted.
8030     if (!AddMemberPointerWithMoreQualifiedTypeVariants(Ty))
8031       return;
8032   } else if (Ty->isEnumeralType()) {
8033     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8034     EnumerationTypes.insert(Ty);
8035   } else if (Ty->isVectorType()) {
8036     // We treat vector types as arithmetic types in many contexts as an
8037     // extension.
8038     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8039     VectorTypes.insert(Ty);
8040   } else if (Ty->isMatrixType()) {
8041     // Similar to vector types, we treat vector types as arithmetic types in
8042     // many contexts as an extension.
8043     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes = true;
8044     MatrixTypes.insert(Ty);
8045   } else if (Ty->isNullPtrType()) {
8046     HasNullPtrType = true;
8047   } else if (AllowUserConversions && TyRec) {
8048     // No conversion functions in incomplete types.
8049     if (!SemaRef.isCompleteType(Loc, Ty))
8050       return;
8051 
8052     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8053     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8054       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8055         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8056 
8057       // Skip conversion function templates; they don't tell us anything
8058       // about which builtin types we can convert to.
8059       if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
8060         continue;
8061 
8062       CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
8063       if (AllowExplicitConversions || !Conv->isExplicit()) {
8064         AddTypesConvertedFrom(Conv->getConversionType(), Loc, false, false,
8065                               VisibleQuals);
8066       }
8067     }
8068   }
8069 }
8070 /// Helper function for adjusting address spaces for the pointer or reference
8071 /// operands of builtin operators depending on the argument.
8072 static QualType AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(Sema &S, QualType T,
8073                                                         Expr *Arg) {
8074   return S.Context.getAddrSpaceQualType(T, Arg->getType().getAddressSpace());
8075 }
8076 
8077 /// Helper function for AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates() that adds
8078 /// the volatile- and non-volatile-qualified assignment operators for the
8079 /// given type to the candidate set.
8080 static void AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(Sema &S,
8081                                                    QualType T,
8082                                                    ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8083                                     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
8084   QualType ParamTypes[2];
8085 
8086   // T& operator=(T&, T)
8087   ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8088       AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, T, Args[0]));
8089   ParamTypes[1] = T;
8090   S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8091                         /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8092 
8093   if (!S.Context.getCanonicalType(T).isVolatileQualified()) {
8094     // volatile T& operator=(volatile T&, T)
8095     ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8096         AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(S, S.Context.getVolatileType(T),
8097                                                 Args[0]));
8098     ParamTypes[1] = T;
8099     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8100                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8101   }
8102 }
8103 
8104 /// CollectVRQualifiers - This routine returns Volatile/Restrict qualifiers,
8105 /// if any, found in visible type conversion functions found in ArgExpr's type.
8106 static  Qualifiers CollectVRQualifiers(ASTContext &Context, Expr* ArgExpr) {
8107     Qualifiers VRQuals;
8108     const RecordType *TyRec;
8109     if (const MemberPointerType *RHSMPType =
8110         ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8111       TyRec = RHSMPType->getClass()->getAs<RecordType>();
8112     else
8113       TyRec = ArgExpr->getType()->getAs<RecordType>();
8114     if (!TyRec) {
8115       // Just to be safe, assume the worst case.
8116       VRQuals.addVolatile();
8117       VRQuals.addRestrict();
8118       return VRQuals;
8119     }
8120 
8121     CXXRecordDecl *ClassDecl = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(TyRec->getDecl());
8122     if (!ClassDecl->hasDefinition())
8123       return VRQuals;
8124 
8125     for (NamedDecl *D : ClassDecl->getVisibleConversionFunctions()) {
8126       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
8127         D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
8128       if (CXXConversionDecl *Conv = dyn_cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D)) {
8129         QualType CanTy = Context.getCanonicalType(Conv->getConversionType());
8130         if (const ReferenceType *ResTypeRef = CanTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
8131           CanTy = ResTypeRef->getPointeeType();
8132         // Need to go down the pointer/mempointer chain and add qualifiers
8133         // as see them.
8134         bool done = false;
8135         while (!done) {
8136           if (CanTy.isRestrictQualified())
8137             VRQuals.addRestrict();
8138           if (const PointerType *ResTypePtr = CanTy->getAs<PointerType>())
8139             CanTy = ResTypePtr->getPointeeType();
8140           else if (const MemberPointerType *ResTypeMPtr =
8141                 CanTy->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
8142             CanTy = ResTypeMPtr->getPointeeType();
8143           else
8144             done = true;
8145           if (CanTy.isVolatileQualified())
8146             VRQuals.addVolatile();
8147           if (VRQuals.hasRestrict() && VRQuals.hasVolatile())
8148             return VRQuals;
8149         }
8150       }
8151     }
8152     return VRQuals;
8153 }
8154 
8155 namespace {
8156 
8157 /// Helper class to manage the addition of builtin operator overload
8158 /// candidates. It provides shared state and utility methods used throughout
8159 /// the process, as well as a helper method to add each group of builtin
8160 /// operator overloads from the standard to a candidate set.
8161 class BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder {
8162   // Common instance state available to all overload candidate addition methods.
8163   Sema &S;
8164   ArrayRef<Expr *> Args;
8165   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
8166   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType;
8167   SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes;
8168   OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet;
8169 
8170   static constexpr int ArithmeticTypesCap = 24;
8171   SmallVector<CanQualType, ArithmeticTypesCap> ArithmeticTypes;
8172 
8173   // Define some indices used to iterate over the arithmetic types in
8174   // ArithmeticTypes.  The "promoted arithmetic types" are the arithmetic
8175   // types are that preserved by promotion (C++ [over.built]p2).
8176   unsigned FirstIntegralType,
8177            LastIntegralType;
8178   unsigned FirstPromotedIntegralType,
8179            LastPromotedIntegralType;
8180   unsigned FirstPromotedArithmeticType,
8181            LastPromotedArithmeticType;
8182   unsigned NumArithmeticTypes;
8183 
8184   void InitArithmeticTypes() {
8185     // Start of promoted types.
8186     FirstPromotedArithmeticType = 0;
8187     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.FloatTy);
8188     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.DoubleTy);
8189     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongDoubleTy);
8190     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasFloat128Type())
8191       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Float128Ty);
8192 
8193     // Start of integral types.
8194     FirstIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8195     FirstPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8196     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.IntTy);
8197     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongTy);
8198     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.LongLongTy);
8199     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
8200       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Int128Ty);
8201     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedIntTy);
8202     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongTy);
8203     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedLongLongTy);
8204     if (S.Context.getTargetInfo().hasInt128Type())
8205       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedInt128Ty);
8206     LastPromotedIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8207     LastPromotedArithmeticType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8208     // End of promoted types.
8209 
8210     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.BoolTy);
8211     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.CharTy);
8212     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.WCharTy);
8213     if (S.Context.getLangOpts().Char8)
8214       ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char8Ty);
8215     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char16Ty);
8216     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.Char32Ty);
8217     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.SignedCharTy);
8218     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.ShortTy);
8219     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedCharTy);
8220     ArithmeticTypes.push_back(S.Context.UnsignedShortTy);
8221     LastIntegralType = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8222     NumArithmeticTypes = ArithmeticTypes.size();
8223     // End of integral types.
8224     // FIXME: What about complex? What about half?
8225 
8226     assert(ArithmeticTypes.size() <= ArithmeticTypesCap &&
8227            "Enough inline storage for all arithmetic types.");
8228   }
8229 
8230   /// Helper method to factor out the common pattern of adding overloads
8231   /// for '++' and '--' builtin operators.
8232   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(QualType CandidateTy,
8233                                            bool HasVolatile,
8234                                            bool HasRestrict) {
8235     QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8236       S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(CandidateTy),
8237       S.Context.IntTy
8238     };
8239 
8240     // Non-volatile version.
8241     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8242 
8243     // Use a heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set:
8244     // add volatile version only if there are conversions to a volatile type.
8245     if (HasVolatile) {
8246       ParamTypes[0] =
8247         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8248           S.Context.getVolatileType(CandidateTy));
8249       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8250     }
8251 
8252     // Add restrict version only if there are conversions to a restrict type
8253     // and our candidate type is a non-restrict-qualified pointer.
8254     if (HasRestrict && CandidateTy->isAnyPointerType() &&
8255         !CandidateTy.isRestrictQualified()) {
8256       ParamTypes[0]
8257         = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8258             S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy, Qualifiers::Restrict));
8259       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8260 
8261       if (HasVolatile) {
8262         ParamTypes[0]
8263           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8264               S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(CandidateTy,
8265                                             (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8266                                              Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8267         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8268       }
8269     }
8270 
8271   }
8272 
8273   /// Helper to add an overload candidate for a binary builtin with types \p L
8274   /// and \p R.
8275   void AddCandidate(QualType L, QualType R) {
8276     QualType LandR[2] = {L, R};
8277     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8278   }
8279 
8280 public:
8281   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder(
8282     Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
8283     Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
8284     bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
8285     SmallVectorImpl<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet> &CandidateTypes,
8286     OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet)
8287     : S(S), Args(Args),
8288       VisibleTypeConversionsQuals(VisibleTypeConversionsQuals),
8289       HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType(
8290         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType),
8291       CandidateTypes(CandidateTypes),
8292       CandidateSet(CandidateSet) {
8293 
8294     InitArithmeticTypes();
8295   }
8296 
8297   // Increment is deprecated for bool since C++17.
8298   //
8299   // C++ [over.built]p3:
8300   //
8301   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8302   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8303   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8304   //
8305   //       VQ T&      operator++(VQ T&);
8306   //       T          operator++(VQ T&, int);
8307   //
8308   // C++ [over.built]p4:
8309   //
8310   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an arithmetic type other
8311   //   than bool, and VQ is either volatile or empty, there exist
8312   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8313   //
8314   //       VQ T&      operator--(VQ T&);
8315   //       T          operator--(VQ T&, int);
8316   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8317     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8318       return;
8319 
8320     for (unsigned Arith = 0; Arith < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Arith) {
8321       const auto TypeOfT = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8322       if (TypeOfT == S.Context.BoolTy) {
8323         if (Op == OO_MinusMinus)
8324           continue;
8325         if (Op == OO_PlusPlus && S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17)
8326           continue;
8327       }
8328       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(
8329         TypeOfT,
8330         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile(),
8331         VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict());
8332     }
8333   }
8334 
8335   // C++ [over.built]p5:
8336   //
8337   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8338   //   cv-unqualified object type, and VQ is either volatile or
8339   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8340   //
8341   //       T*VQ&      operator++(T*VQ&);
8342   //       T*VQ&      operator--(T*VQ&);
8343   //       T*         operator++(T*VQ&, int);
8344   //       T*         operator--(T*VQ&, int);
8345   void addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads() {
8346     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8347               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8348            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8349          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8350       // Skip pointer types that aren't pointers to object types.
8351       if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8352         continue;
8353 
8354       addPlusPlusMinusMinusStyleOverloads(*Ptr,
8355         (!(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
8356          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()),
8357         (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
8358          VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()));
8359     }
8360   }
8361 
8362   // C++ [over.built]p6:
8363   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T, there
8364   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8365   //
8366   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8367   //
8368   // C++ [over.built]p7:
8369   //   For every function type T that does not have cv-qualifiers or a
8370   //   ref-qualifier, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8371   //       T&         operator*(T*);
8372   void addUnaryStarPointerOverloads() {
8373     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8374               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8375            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8376          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8377       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
8378       QualType PointeeTy = ParamTy->getPointeeType();
8379       if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType() && !PointeeTy->isFunctionType())
8380         continue;
8381 
8382       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto =PointeeTy->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
8383         if (Proto->getMethodQuals() || Proto->getRefQualifier())
8384           continue;
8385 
8386       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8387     }
8388   }
8389 
8390   // C++ [over.built]p9:
8391   //  For every promoted arithmetic type T, there exist candidate
8392   //  operator functions of the form
8393   //
8394   //       T         operator+(T);
8395   //       T         operator-(T);
8396   void addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads() {
8397     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8398       return;
8399 
8400     for (unsigned Arith = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8401          Arith < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Arith) {
8402       QualType ArithTy = ArithmeticTypes[Arith];
8403       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ArithTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8404     }
8405 
8406     // Extension: We also add these operators for vector types.
8407     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8408       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8409   }
8410 
8411   // C++ [over.built]p8:
8412   //   For every type T, there exist candidate operator functions of
8413   //   the form
8414   //
8415   //       T*         operator+(T*);
8416   void addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads() {
8417     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8418               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8419            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8420          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8421       QualType ParamTy = *Ptr;
8422       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8423     }
8424   }
8425 
8426   // C++ [over.built]p10:
8427   //   For every promoted integral type T, there exist candidate
8428   //   operator functions of the form
8429   //
8430   //        T         operator~(T);
8431   void addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads() {
8432     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8433       return;
8434 
8435     for (unsigned Int = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8436          Int < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Int) {
8437       QualType IntTy = ArithmeticTypes[Int];
8438       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&IntTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8439     }
8440 
8441     // Extension: We also add this operator for vector types.
8442     for (QualType VecTy : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8443       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&VecTy, Args, CandidateSet);
8444   }
8445 
8446   // C++ [over.match.oper]p16:
8447   //   For every pointer to member type T or type std::nullptr_t, there
8448   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8449   //
8450   //        bool operator==(T,T);
8451   //        bool operator!=(T,T);
8452   void addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads() {
8453     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8454     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8455 
8456     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8457       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8458                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
8459              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
8460            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd;
8461            ++MemPtr) {
8462         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8463         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
8464           continue;
8465 
8466         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
8467         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8468       }
8469 
8470       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNullPtrType()) {
8471         CanQualType NullPtrTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(S.Context.NullPtrTy);
8472         if (AddedTypes.insert(NullPtrTy).second) {
8473           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { NullPtrTy, NullPtrTy };
8474           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8475         }
8476       }
8477     }
8478   }
8479 
8480   // C++ [over.built]p15:
8481   //
8482   //   For every T, where T is an enumeration type or a pointer type,
8483   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8484   //
8485   //        bool       operator<(T, T);
8486   //        bool       operator>(T, T);
8487   //        bool       operator<=(T, T);
8488   //        bool       operator>=(T, T);
8489   //        bool       operator==(T, T);
8490   //        bool       operator!=(T, T);
8491   //           R       operator<=>(T, T)
8492   void addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8493     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
8494     //   [...]the built-in candidates include all of the candidate operator
8495     //   functions defined in 13.6 that, compared to the given operator, [...]
8496     //   do not have the same parameter-type-list as any non-template non-member
8497     //   candidate.
8498     //
8499     // Note that in practice, this only affects enumeration types because there
8500     // aren't any built-in candidates of record type, and a user-defined operator
8501     // must have an operand of record or enumeration type. Also, the only other
8502     // overloaded operator with enumeration arguments, operator=,
8503     // cannot be overloaded for enumeration types, so this is the only place
8504     // where we must suppress candidates like this.
8505     llvm::DenseSet<std::pair<CanQualType, CanQualType> >
8506       UserDefinedBinaryOperators;
8507 
8508     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8509       if (CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin() !=
8510           CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end()) {
8511         for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator C = CandidateSet.begin(),
8512                                          CEnd = CandidateSet.end();
8513              C != CEnd; ++C) {
8514           if (!C->Viable || !C->Function || C->Function->getNumParams() != 2)
8515             continue;
8516 
8517           if (C->Function->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization())
8518             continue;
8519 
8520           // We interpret "same parameter-type-list" as applying to the
8521           // "synthesized candidate, with the order of the two parameters
8522           // reversed", not to the original function.
8523           bool Reversed = C->isReversed();
8524           QualType FirstParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 1 : 0)
8525                                         ->getType()
8526                                         .getUnqualifiedType();
8527           QualType SecondParamType = C->Function->getParamDecl(Reversed ? 0 : 1)
8528                                          ->getType()
8529                                          .getUnqualifiedType();
8530 
8531           // Skip if either parameter isn't of enumeral type.
8532           if (!FirstParamType->isEnumeralType() ||
8533               !SecondParamType->isEnumeralType())
8534             continue;
8535 
8536           // Add this operator to the set of known user-defined operators.
8537           UserDefinedBinaryOperators.insert(
8538             std::make_pair(S.Context.getCanonicalType(FirstParamType),
8539                            S.Context.getCanonicalType(SecondParamType)));
8540         }
8541       }
8542     }
8543 
8544     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8545     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8546 
8547     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
8548       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8549                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
8550              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
8551            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8552         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice.
8553         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8554           continue;
8555 
8556         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
8557         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8558       }
8559       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8560                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8561              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8562            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8563         CanQualType CanonType = S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum);
8564 
8565         // Don't add the same builtin candidate twice, or if a user defined
8566         // candidate exists.
8567         if (!AddedTypes.insert(CanonType).second ||
8568             UserDefinedBinaryOperators.count(std::make_pair(CanonType,
8569                                                             CanonType)))
8570           continue;
8571         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
8572         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8573       }
8574     }
8575   }
8576 
8577   // C++ [over.built]p13:
8578   //
8579   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T
8580   //   there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8581   //
8582   //      T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8583   //      T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);    [BELOW]
8584   //      T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);
8585   //      T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8586   //      T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);    [BELOW]
8587   //
8588   // C++ [over.built]p14:
8589   //
8590   //   For every T, where T is a pointer to object type, there
8591   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8592   //
8593   //      ptrdiff_t  operator-(T, T);
8594   void addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8595     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8596     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8597 
8598     for (int Arg = 0; Arg < 2; ++Arg) {
8599       QualType AsymmetricParamTypes[2] = {
8600         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8601         S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8602       };
8603       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8604                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_begin(),
8605              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[Arg].pointer_end();
8606            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8607         QualType PointeeTy = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
8608         if (!PointeeTy->isObjectType())
8609           continue;
8610 
8611         AsymmetricParamTypes[Arg] = *Ptr;
8612         if (Arg == 0 || Op == OO_Plus) {
8613           // operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t) or operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t)
8614           // T* operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);
8615           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(AsymmetricParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8616         }
8617         if (Op == OO_Minus) {
8618           // ptrdiff_t operator-(T, T);
8619           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8620             continue;
8621 
8622           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
8623           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
8624         }
8625       }
8626     }
8627   }
8628 
8629   // C++ [over.built]p12:
8630   //
8631   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there
8632   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8633   //
8634   //        LR         operator*(L, R);
8635   //        LR         operator/(L, R);
8636   //        LR         operator+(L, R);
8637   //        LR         operator-(L, R);
8638   //        bool       operator<(L, R);
8639   //        bool       operator>(L, R);
8640   //        bool       operator<=(L, R);
8641   //        bool       operator>=(L, R);
8642   //        bool       operator==(L, R);
8643   //        bool       operator!=(L, R);
8644   //
8645   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8646   //   between types L and R.
8647   //
8648   // C++ [over.built]p24:
8649   //
8650   //   For every pair of promoted arithmetic types L and R, there exist
8651   //   candidate operator functions of the form
8652   //
8653   //        LR       operator?(bool, L, R);
8654   //
8655   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8656   //   between types L and R.
8657   // Our candidates ignore the first parameter.
8658   void addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8659     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8660       return;
8661 
8662     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8663          Left < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Left) {
8664       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8665            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8666         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8667                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8668         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8669       }
8670     }
8671 
8672     // Extension: Add the binary operators ==, !=, <, <=, >=, >, *, /, and the
8673     // conditional operator for vector types.
8674     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8675       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[1].vector_types()) {
8676         QualType LandR[2] = {Vec1Ty, Vec2Ty};
8677         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8678       }
8679   }
8680 
8681   /// Add binary operator overloads for each candidate matrix type M1, M2:
8682   ///  * (M1, M1) -> M1
8683   ///  * (M1, M1.getElementType()) -> M1
8684   ///  * (M2.getElementType(), M2) -> M2
8685   ///  * (M2, M2) -> M2 // Only if M2 is not part of CandidateTypes[0].
8686   void addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads() {
8687     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8688       return;
8689 
8690     for (QualType M1 : CandidateTypes[0].matrix_types()) {
8691       AddCandidate(M1, cast<MatrixType>(M1)->getElementType());
8692       AddCandidate(M1, M1);
8693     }
8694 
8695     for (QualType M2 : CandidateTypes[1].matrix_types()) {
8696       AddCandidate(cast<MatrixType>(M2)->getElementType(), M2);
8697       if (!CandidateTypes[0].containsMatrixType(M2))
8698         AddCandidate(M2, M2);
8699     }
8700   }
8701 
8702   // C++2a [over.built]p14:
8703   //
8704   //   For every integral type T there exists a candidate operator function
8705   //   of the form
8706   //
8707   //        std::strong_ordering operator<=>(T, T)
8708   //
8709   // C++2a [over.built]p15:
8710   //
8711   //   For every pair of floating-point types L and R, there exists a candidate
8712   //   operator function of the form
8713   //
8714   //       std::partial_ordering operator<=>(L, R);
8715   //
8716   // FIXME: The current specification for integral types doesn't play nice with
8717   // the direction of p0946r0, which allows mixed integral and unscoped-enum
8718   // comparisons. Under the current spec this can lead to ambiguity during
8719   // overload resolution. For example:
8720   //
8721   //   enum A : int {a};
8722   //   auto x = (a <=> (long)42);
8723   //
8724   //   error: call is ambiguous for arguments 'A' and 'long'.
8725   //   note: candidate operator<=>(int, int)
8726   //   note: candidate operator<=>(long, long)
8727   //
8728   // To avoid this error, this function deviates from the specification and adds
8729   // the mixed overloads `operator<=>(L, R)` where L and R are promoted
8730   // arithmetic types (the same as the generic relational overloads).
8731   //
8732   // For now this function acts as a placeholder.
8733   void addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads() {
8734     addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
8735   }
8736 
8737   // C++ [over.built]p17:
8738   //
8739   //   For every pair of promoted integral types L and R, there
8740   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
8741   //
8742   //      LR         operator%(L, R);
8743   //      LR         operator&(L, R);
8744   //      LR         operator^(L, R);
8745   //      LR         operator|(L, R);
8746   //      L          operator<<(L, R);
8747   //      L          operator>>(L, R);
8748   //
8749   //   where LR is the result of the usual arithmetic conversions
8750   //   between types L and R.
8751   void addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(OverloadedOperatorKind Op) {
8752     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8753       return;
8754 
8755     for (unsigned Left = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8756          Left < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Left) {
8757       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8758            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8759         QualType LandR[2] = { ArithmeticTypes[Left],
8760                               ArithmeticTypes[Right] };
8761         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(LandR, Args, CandidateSet);
8762       }
8763     }
8764   }
8765 
8766   // C++ [over.built]p20:
8767   //
8768   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is an enumeration or
8769   //   pointer to member type and VQ is either volatile or
8770   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8771   //
8772   //        VQ T&      operator=(VQ T&, T);
8773   void addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads() {
8774     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8775     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8776 
8777     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
8778       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8779                 Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
8780              EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
8781            Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
8782         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second)
8783           continue;
8784 
8785         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *Enum, Args, CandidateSet);
8786       }
8787 
8788       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8789                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
8790              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
8791            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
8792         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
8793           continue;
8794 
8795         AddBuiltinAssignmentOperatorCandidates(S, *MemPtr, Args, CandidateSet);
8796       }
8797     }
8798   }
8799 
8800   // C++ [over.built]p19:
8801   //
8802   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is any type and VQ is either
8803   //   volatile or empty, there exist candidate operator functions
8804   //   of the form
8805   //
8806   //        T*VQ&      operator=(T*VQ&, T*);
8807   //
8808   // C++ [over.built]p21:
8809   //
8810   //   For every pair (T, VQ), where T is a cv-qualified or
8811   //   cv-unqualified object type and VQ is either volatile or
8812   //   empty, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8813   //
8814   //        T*VQ&      operator+=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8815   //        T*VQ&      operator-=(T*VQ&, ptrdiff_t);
8816   void addAssignmentPointerOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8817     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
8818     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
8819 
8820     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8821               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
8822            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
8823          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8824       // If this is operator=, keep track of the builtin candidates we added.
8825       if (isEqualOp)
8826         AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr));
8827       else if (!(*Ptr)->getPointeeType()->isObjectType())
8828         continue;
8829 
8830       // non-volatile version
8831       QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8832         S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
8833         isEqualOp ? *Ptr : S.Context.getPointerDiffType(),
8834       };
8835       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8836                             /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/ isEqualOp);
8837 
8838       bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
8839                           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8840       if (NeedVolatile) {
8841         // volatile version
8842         ParamTypes[0] =
8843           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
8844         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8845                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8846       }
8847 
8848       if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
8849           VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8850         // restrict version
8851         ParamTypes[0]
8852           = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
8853         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8854                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8855 
8856         if (NeedVolatile) {
8857           // volatile restrict version
8858           ParamTypes[0]
8859             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8860                 S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
8861                                               (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8862                                                Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8863           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8864                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8865         }
8866       }
8867     }
8868 
8869     if (isEqualOp) {
8870       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
8871                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
8872              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
8873            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
8874         // Make sure we don't add the same candidate twice.
8875         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
8876           continue;
8877 
8878         QualType ParamTypes[2] = {
8879           S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(*Ptr),
8880           *Ptr,
8881         };
8882 
8883         // non-volatile version
8884         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8885                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8886 
8887         bool NeedVolatile = !(*Ptr).isVolatileQualified() &&
8888                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile();
8889         if (NeedVolatile) {
8890           // volatile version
8891           ParamTypes[0] =
8892             S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getVolatileType(*Ptr));
8893           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8894                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8895         }
8896 
8897         if (!(*Ptr).isRestrictQualified() &&
8898             VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict()) {
8899           // restrict version
8900           ParamTypes[0]
8901             = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(S.Context.getRestrictType(*Ptr));
8902           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8903                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8904 
8905           if (NeedVolatile) {
8906             // volatile restrict version
8907             ParamTypes[0]
8908               = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(
8909                   S.Context.getCVRQualifiedType(*Ptr,
8910                                                 (Qualifiers::Volatile |
8911                                                  Qualifiers::Restrict)));
8912             S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8913                                   /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/true);
8914           }
8915         }
8916       }
8917     }
8918   }
8919 
8920   // C++ [over.built]p18:
8921   //
8922   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an arithmetic type,
8923   //   VQ is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted
8924   //   arithmetic type, there exist candidate operator functions of
8925   //   the form
8926   //
8927   //        VQ L&      operator=(VQ L&, R);
8928   //        VQ L&      operator*=(VQ L&, R);
8929   //        VQ L&      operator/=(VQ L&, R);
8930   //        VQ L&      operator+=(VQ L&, R);
8931   //        VQ L&      operator-=(VQ L&, R);
8932   void addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(bool isEqualOp) {
8933     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8934       return;
8935 
8936     for (unsigned Left = 0; Left < NumArithmeticTypes; ++Left) {
8937       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedArithmeticType;
8938            Right < LastPromotedArithmeticType; ++Right) {
8939         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8940         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8941         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
8942             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
8943         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8944         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
8945         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8946                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8947 
8948         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8949         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8950           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(LeftBaseTy);
8951           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8952           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8953                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8954         }
8955       }
8956     }
8957 
8958     // Extension: Add the binary operators =, +=, -=, *=, /= for vector types.
8959     for (QualType Vec1Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types())
8960       for (QualType Vec2Ty : CandidateTypes[0].vector_types()) {
8961         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8962         ParamTypes[1] = Vec2Ty;
8963         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
8964         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(Vec1Ty);
8965         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8966                               /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8967 
8968         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
8969         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
8970           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(Vec1Ty);
8971           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
8972           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
8973                                 /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/isEqualOp);
8974         }
8975       }
8976   }
8977 
8978   // C++ [over.built]p22:
8979   //
8980   //   For every triple (L, VQ, R), where L is an integral type, VQ
8981   //   is either volatile or empty, and R is a promoted integral
8982   //   type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
8983   //
8984   //        VQ L&       operator%=(VQ L&, R);
8985   //        VQ L&       operator<<=(VQ L&, R);
8986   //        VQ L&       operator>>=(VQ L&, R);
8987   //        VQ L&       operator&=(VQ L&, R);
8988   //        VQ L&       operator^=(VQ L&, R);
8989   //        VQ L&       operator|=(VQ L&, R);
8990   void addAssignmentIntegralOverloads() {
8991     if (!HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType)
8992       return;
8993 
8994     for (unsigned Left = FirstIntegralType; Left < LastIntegralType; ++Left) {
8995       for (unsigned Right = FirstPromotedIntegralType;
8996            Right < LastPromotedIntegralType; ++Right) {
8997         QualType ParamTypes[2];
8998         ParamTypes[1] = ArithmeticTypes[Right];
8999         auto LeftBaseTy = AdjustAddressSpaceForBuiltinOperandType(
9000             S, ArithmeticTypes[Left], Args[0]);
9001         // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is empty).
9002         ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(LeftBaseTy);
9003         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9004         if (VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile()) {
9005           // Add this built-in operator as a candidate (VQ is 'volatile').
9006           ParamTypes[0] = LeftBaseTy;
9007           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getVolatileType(ParamTypes[0]);
9008           ParamTypes[0] = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(ParamTypes[0]);
9009           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9010         }
9011       }
9012     }
9013   }
9014 
9015   // C++ [over.operator]p23:
9016   //
9017   //   There also exist candidate operator functions of the form
9018   //
9019   //        bool        operator!(bool);
9020   //        bool        operator&&(bool, bool);
9021   //        bool        operator||(bool, bool);
9022   void addExclaimOverload() {
9023     QualType ParamTy = S.Context.BoolTy;
9024     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(&ParamTy, Args, CandidateSet,
9025                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
9026                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/1);
9027   }
9028   void addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload() {
9029     QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.BoolTy, S.Context.BoolTy };
9030     S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet,
9031                           /*IsAssignmentOperator=*/false,
9032                           /*NumContextualBoolArguments=*/2);
9033   }
9034 
9035   // C++ [over.built]p13:
9036   //
9037   //   For every cv-qualified or cv-unqualified object type T there
9038   //   exist candidate operator functions of the form
9039   //
9040   //        T*         operator+(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
9041   //        T&         operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t);
9042   //        T*         operator-(T*, ptrdiff_t);     [ABOVE]
9043   //        T*         operator+(ptrdiff_t, T*);     [ABOVE]
9044   //        T&         operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*);
9045   void addSubscriptOverloads() {
9046     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
9047               Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
9048            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
9049          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
9050       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, S.Context.getPointerDiffType() };
9051       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
9052       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9053         continue;
9054 
9055       // T& operator[](T*, ptrdiff_t)
9056       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9057     }
9058 
9059     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
9060               Ptr = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_begin(),
9061            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].pointer_end();
9062          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
9063       QualType ParamTypes[2] = { S.Context.getPointerDiffType(), *Ptr };
9064       QualType PointeeType = (*Ptr)->getPointeeType();
9065       if (!PointeeType->isObjectType())
9066         continue;
9067 
9068       // T& operator[](ptrdiff_t, T*)
9069       S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9070     }
9071   }
9072 
9073   // C++ [over.built]p11:
9074   //    For every quintuple (C1, C2, T, CV1, CV2), where C2 is a class type,
9075   //    C1 is the same type as C2 or is a derived class of C2, T is an object
9076   //    type or a function type, and CV1 and CV2 are cv-qualifier-seqs,
9077   //    there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9078   //
9079   //      CV12 T& operator->*(CV1 C1*, CV2 T C2::*);
9080   //
9081   //    where CV12 is the union of CV1 and CV2.
9082   void addArrowStarOverloads() {
9083     for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
9084              Ptr = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_begin(),
9085            PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[0].pointer_end();
9086          Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
9087       QualType C1Ty = (*Ptr);
9088       QualType C1;
9089       QualifierCollector Q1;
9090       C1 = QualType(Q1.strip(C1Ty->getPointeeType()), 0);
9091       if (!isa<RecordType>(C1))
9092         continue;
9093       // heuristic to reduce number of builtin candidates in the set.
9094       // Add volatile/restrict version only if there are conversions to a
9095       // volatile/restrict type.
9096       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() && Q1.hasVolatile())
9097         continue;
9098       if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() && Q1.hasRestrict())
9099         continue;
9100       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
9101                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_begin(),
9102              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[1].member_pointer_end();
9103            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
9104         const MemberPointerType *mptr = cast<MemberPointerType>(*MemPtr);
9105         QualType C2 = QualType(mptr->getClass(), 0);
9106         C2 = C2.getUnqualifiedType();
9107         if (C1 != C2 && !S.IsDerivedFrom(CandidateSet.getLocation(), C1, C2))
9108           break;
9109         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *MemPtr };
9110         // build CV12 T&
9111         QualType T = mptr->getPointeeType();
9112         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasVolatile() &&
9113             T.isVolatileQualified())
9114           continue;
9115         if (!VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.hasRestrict() &&
9116             T.isRestrictQualified())
9117           continue;
9118         T = Q1.apply(S.Context, T);
9119         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9120       }
9121     }
9122   }
9123 
9124   // Note that we don't consider the first argument, since it has been
9125   // contextually converted to bool long ago. The candidates below are
9126   // therefore added as binary.
9127   //
9128   // C++ [over.built]p25:
9129   //   For every type T, where T is a pointer, pointer-to-member, or scoped
9130   //   enumeration type, there exist candidate operator functions of the form
9131   //
9132   //        T        operator?(bool, T, T);
9133   //
9134   void addConditionalOperatorOverloads() {
9135     /// Set of (canonical) types that we've already handled.
9136     llvm::SmallPtrSet<QualType, 8> AddedTypes;
9137 
9138     for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
9139       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
9140                 Ptr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_begin(),
9141              PtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].pointer_end();
9142            Ptr != PtrEnd; ++Ptr) {
9143         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Ptr)).second)
9144           continue;
9145 
9146         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Ptr, *Ptr };
9147         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9148       }
9149 
9150       for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
9151                 MemPtr = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_begin(),
9152              MemPtrEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].member_pointer_end();
9153            MemPtr != MemPtrEnd; ++MemPtr) {
9154         if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*MemPtr)).second)
9155           continue;
9156 
9157         QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *MemPtr, *MemPtr };
9158         S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9159       }
9160 
9161       if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11) {
9162         for (BuiltinCandidateTypeSet::iterator
9163                   Enum = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_begin(),
9164                EnumEnd = CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].enumeration_end();
9165              Enum != EnumEnd; ++Enum) {
9166           if (!(*Enum)->castAs<EnumType>()->getDecl()->isScoped())
9167             continue;
9168 
9169           if (!AddedTypes.insert(S.Context.getCanonicalType(*Enum)).second)
9170             continue;
9171 
9172           QualType ParamTypes[2] = { *Enum, *Enum };
9173           S.AddBuiltinCandidate(ParamTypes, Args, CandidateSet);
9174         }
9175       }
9176     }
9177   }
9178 };
9179 
9180 } // end anonymous namespace
9181 
9182 /// AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates - Add the appropriate built-in
9183 /// operator overloads to the candidate set (C++ [over.built]), based
9184 /// on the operator @p Op and the arguments given. For example, if the
9185 /// operator is a binary '+', this routine might add "int
9186 /// operator+(int, int)" to cover integer addition.
9187 void Sema::AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
9188                                         SourceLocation OpLoc,
9189                                         ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9190                                         OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet) {
9191   // Find all of the types that the arguments can convert to, but only
9192   // if the operator we're looking at has built-in operator candidates
9193   // that make use of these types. Also record whether we encounter non-record
9194   // candidate types or either arithmetic or enumeral candidate types.
9195   Qualifiers VisibleTypeConversionsQuals;
9196   VisibleTypeConversionsQuals.addConst();
9197   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx)
9198     VisibleTypeConversionsQuals += CollectVRQualifiers(Context, Args[ArgIdx]);
9199 
9200   bool HasNonRecordCandidateType = false;
9201   bool HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType = false;
9202   SmallVector<BuiltinCandidateTypeSet, 2> CandidateTypes;
9203   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
9204     CandidateTypes.emplace_back(*this);
9205     CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].AddTypesConvertedFrom(Args[ArgIdx]->getType(),
9206                                                  OpLoc,
9207                                                  true,
9208                                                  (Op == OO_Exclaim ||
9209                                                   Op == OO_AmpAmp ||
9210                                                   Op == OO_PipePipe),
9211                                                  VisibleTypeConversionsQuals);
9212     HasNonRecordCandidateType = HasNonRecordCandidateType ||
9213         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasNonRecordTypes();
9214     HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType =
9215         HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType ||
9216         CandidateTypes[ArgIdx].hasArithmeticOrEnumeralTypes();
9217   }
9218 
9219   // Exit early when no non-record types have been added to the candidate set
9220   // for any of the arguments to the operator.
9221   //
9222   // We can't exit early for !, ||, or &&, since there we have always have
9223   // 'bool' overloads.
9224   if (!HasNonRecordCandidateType &&
9225       !(Op == OO_Exclaim || Op == OO_AmpAmp || Op == OO_PipePipe))
9226     return;
9227 
9228   // Setup an object to manage the common state for building overloads.
9229   BuiltinOperatorOverloadBuilder OpBuilder(*this, Args,
9230                                            VisibleTypeConversionsQuals,
9231                                            HasArithmeticOrEnumeralCandidateType,
9232                                            CandidateTypes, CandidateSet);
9233 
9234   // Dispatch over the operation to add in only those overloads which apply.
9235   switch (Op) {
9236   case OO_None:
9237   case NUM_OVERLOADED_OPERATORS:
9238     llvm_unreachable("Expected an overloaded operator");
9239 
9240   case OO_New:
9241   case OO_Delete:
9242   case OO_Array_New:
9243   case OO_Array_Delete:
9244   case OO_Call:
9245     llvm_unreachable(
9246                     "Special operators don't use AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates");
9247 
9248   case OO_Comma:
9249   case OO_Arrow:
9250   case OO_Coawait:
9251     // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9252     //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', the
9253     //      operator '->', or the operator 'co_await', the
9254     //      built-in candidates set is empty.
9255     break;
9256 
9257   case OO_Plus: // '+' is either unary or binary
9258     if (Args.size() == 1)
9259       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusPointerOverloads();
9260     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9261 
9262   case OO_Minus: // '-' is either unary or binary
9263     if (Args.size() == 1) {
9264       OpBuilder.addUnaryPlusOrMinusArithmeticOverloads();
9265     } else {
9266       OpBuilder.addBinaryPlusOrMinusPointerOverloads(Op);
9267       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9268       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9269     }
9270     break;
9271 
9272   case OO_Star: // '*' is either unary or binary
9273     if (Args.size() == 1)
9274       OpBuilder.addUnaryStarPointerOverloads();
9275     else {
9276       OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9277       OpBuilder.addMatrixBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9278     }
9279     break;
9280 
9281   case OO_Slash:
9282     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9283     break;
9284 
9285   case OO_PlusPlus:
9286   case OO_MinusMinus:
9287     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9288     OpBuilder.addPlusPlusMinusMinusPointerOverloads();
9289     break;
9290 
9291   case OO_EqualEqual:
9292   case OO_ExclaimEqual:
9293     OpBuilder.addEqualEqualOrNotEqualMemberPointerOrNullptrOverloads();
9294     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9295 
9296   case OO_Less:
9297   case OO_Greater:
9298   case OO_LessEqual:
9299   case OO_GreaterEqual:
9300     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9301     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9302     break;
9303 
9304   case OO_Spaceship:
9305     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9306     OpBuilder.addThreeWayArithmeticOverloads();
9307     break;
9308 
9309   case OO_Percent:
9310   case OO_Caret:
9311   case OO_Pipe:
9312   case OO_LessLess:
9313   case OO_GreaterGreater:
9314     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9315     break;
9316 
9317   case OO_Amp: // '&' is either unary or binary
9318     if (Args.size() == 1)
9319       // C++ [over.match.oper]p3:
9320       //   -- For the operator ',', the unary operator '&', or the
9321       //      operator '->', the built-in candidates set is empty.
9322       break;
9323 
9324     OpBuilder.addBinaryBitwiseArithmeticOverloads(Op);
9325     break;
9326 
9327   case OO_Tilde:
9328     OpBuilder.addUnaryTildePromotedIntegralOverloads();
9329     break;
9330 
9331   case OO_Equal:
9332     OpBuilder.addAssignmentMemberPointerOrEnumeralOverloads();
9333     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9334 
9335   case OO_PlusEqual:
9336   case OO_MinusEqual:
9337     OpBuilder.addAssignmentPointerOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9338     LLVM_FALLTHROUGH;
9339 
9340   case OO_StarEqual:
9341   case OO_SlashEqual:
9342     OpBuilder.addAssignmentArithmeticOverloads(Op == OO_Equal);
9343     break;
9344 
9345   case OO_PercentEqual:
9346   case OO_LessLessEqual:
9347   case OO_GreaterGreaterEqual:
9348   case OO_AmpEqual:
9349   case OO_CaretEqual:
9350   case OO_PipeEqual:
9351     OpBuilder.addAssignmentIntegralOverloads();
9352     break;
9353 
9354   case OO_Exclaim:
9355     OpBuilder.addExclaimOverload();
9356     break;
9357 
9358   case OO_AmpAmp:
9359   case OO_PipePipe:
9360     OpBuilder.addAmpAmpOrPipePipeOverload();
9361     break;
9362 
9363   case OO_Subscript:
9364     OpBuilder.addSubscriptOverloads();
9365     break;
9366 
9367   case OO_ArrowStar:
9368     OpBuilder.addArrowStarOverloads();
9369     break;
9370 
9371   case OO_Conditional:
9372     OpBuilder.addConditionalOperatorOverloads();
9373     OpBuilder.addGenericBinaryArithmeticOverloads();
9374     break;
9375   }
9376 }
9377 
9378 /// Add function candidates found via argument-dependent lookup
9379 /// to the set of overloading candidates.
9380 ///
9381 /// This routine performs argument-dependent name lookup based on the
9382 /// given function name (which may also be an operator name) and adds
9383 /// all of the overload candidates found by ADL to the overload
9384 /// candidate set (C++ [basic.lookup.argdep]).
9385 void
9386 Sema::AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(DeclarationName Name,
9387                                            SourceLocation Loc,
9388                                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
9389                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
9390                                            OverloadCandidateSet& CandidateSet,
9391                                            bool PartialOverloading) {
9392   ADLResult Fns;
9393 
9394   // FIXME: This approach for uniquing ADL results (and removing
9395   // redundant candidates from the set) relies on pointer-equality,
9396   // which means we need to key off the canonical decl.  However,
9397   // always going back to the canonical decl might not get us the
9398   // right set of default arguments.  What default arguments are
9399   // we supposed to consider on ADL candidates, anyway?
9400 
9401   // FIXME: Pass in the explicit template arguments?
9402   ArgumentDependentLookup(Name, Loc, Args, Fns);
9403 
9404   // Erase all of the candidates we already knew about.
9405   for (OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Cand = CandidateSet.begin(),
9406                                    CandEnd = CandidateSet.end();
9407        Cand != CandEnd; ++Cand)
9408     if (Cand->Function) {
9409       Fns.erase(Cand->Function);
9410       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Cand->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
9411         Fns.erase(FunTmpl);
9412     }
9413 
9414   // For each of the ADL candidates we found, add it to the overload
9415   // set.
9416   for (ADLResult::iterator I = Fns.begin(), E = Fns.end(); I != E; ++I) {
9417     DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(*I, AS_none);
9418 
9419     if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*I)) {
9420       if (ExplicitTemplateArgs)
9421         continue;
9422 
9423       AddOverloadCandidate(
9424           FD, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
9425           PartialOverloading, /*AllowExplicit=*/true,
9426           /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9427       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Context, FD)) {
9428         AddOverloadCandidate(
9429             FD, FoundDecl, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
9430             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9431             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, /*AllowExplicitConversions=*/false,
9432             ADLCallKind::UsesADL, None, OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9433       }
9434     } else {
9435       auto *FTD = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*I);
9436       AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9437           FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
9438           /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9439           /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL);
9440       if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(
9441               Context, FTD->getTemplatedDecl())) {
9442         AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(
9443             FTD, FoundDecl, ExplicitTemplateArgs, {Args[1], Args[0]},
9444             CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false, PartialOverloading,
9445             /*AllowExplicit=*/true, ADLCallKind::UsesADL,
9446             OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
9447       }
9448     }
9449   }
9450 }
9451 
9452 namespace {
9453 enum class Comparison { Equal, Better, Worse };
9454 }
9455 
9456 /// Compares the enable_if attributes of two FunctionDecls, for the purposes of
9457 /// overload resolution.
9458 ///
9459 /// Cand1's set of enable_if attributes are said to be "better" than Cand2's iff
9460 /// Cand1's first N enable_if attributes have precisely the same conditions as
9461 /// Cand2's first N enable_if attributes (where N = the number of enable_if
9462 /// attributes on Cand2), and Cand1 has more than N enable_if attributes.
9463 ///
9464 /// Note that you can have a pair of candidates such that Cand1's enable_if
9465 /// attributes are worse than Cand2's, and Cand2's enable_if attributes are
9466 /// worse than Cand1's.
9467 static Comparison compareEnableIfAttrs(const Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *Cand1,
9468                                        const FunctionDecl *Cand2) {
9469   // Common case: One (or both) decls don't have enable_if attrs.
9470   bool Cand1Attr = Cand1->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9471   bool Cand2Attr = Cand2->hasAttr<EnableIfAttr>();
9472   if (!Cand1Attr || !Cand2Attr) {
9473     if (Cand1Attr == Cand2Attr)
9474       return Comparison::Equal;
9475     return Cand1Attr ? Comparison::Better : Comparison::Worse;
9476   }
9477 
9478   auto Cand1Attrs = Cand1->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9479   auto Cand2Attrs = Cand2->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>();
9480 
9481   llvm::FoldingSetNodeID Cand1ID, Cand2ID;
9482   for (auto Pair : zip_longest(Cand1Attrs, Cand2Attrs)) {
9483     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand1A = std::get<0>(Pair);
9484     Optional<EnableIfAttr *> Cand2A = std::get<1>(Pair);
9485 
9486     // It's impossible for Cand1 to be better than (or equal to) Cand2 if Cand1
9487     // has fewer enable_if attributes than Cand2, and vice versa.
9488     if (!Cand1A)
9489       return Comparison::Worse;
9490     if (!Cand2A)
9491       return Comparison::Better;
9492 
9493     Cand1ID.clear();
9494     Cand2ID.clear();
9495 
9496     (*Cand1A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand1ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9497     (*Cand2A)->getCond()->Profile(Cand2ID, S.getASTContext(), true);
9498     if (Cand1ID != Cand2ID)
9499       return Comparison::Worse;
9500   }
9501 
9502   return Comparison::Equal;
9503 }
9504 
9505 static Comparison
9506 isBetterMultiversionCandidate(const OverloadCandidate &Cand1,
9507                               const OverloadCandidate &Cand2) {
9508   if (!Cand1.Function || !Cand1.Function->isMultiVersion() || !Cand2.Function ||
9509       !Cand2.Function->isMultiVersion())
9510     return Comparison::Equal;
9511 
9512   // If both are invalid, they are equal. If one of them is invalid, the other
9513   // is better.
9514   if (Cand1.Function->isInvalidDecl()) {
9515     if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9516       return Comparison::Equal;
9517     return Comparison::Worse;
9518   }
9519   if (Cand2.Function->isInvalidDecl())
9520     return Comparison::Better;
9521 
9522   // If this is a cpu_dispatch/cpu_specific multiversion situation, prefer
9523   // cpu_dispatch, else arbitrarily based on the identifiers.
9524   bool Cand1CPUDisp = Cand1.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9525   bool Cand2CPUDisp = Cand2.Function->hasAttr<CPUDispatchAttr>();
9526   const auto *Cand1CPUSpec = Cand1.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9527   const auto *Cand2CPUSpec = Cand2.Function->getAttr<CPUSpecificAttr>();
9528 
9529   if (!Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUSpec && !Cand2CPUSpec)
9530     return Comparison::Equal;
9531 
9532   if (Cand1CPUDisp && !Cand2CPUDisp)
9533     return Comparison::Better;
9534   if (Cand2CPUDisp && !Cand1CPUDisp)
9535     return Comparison::Worse;
9536 
9537   if (Cand1CPUSpec && Cand2CPUSpec) {
9538     if (Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() != Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size())
9539       return Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_size() < Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_size()
9540                  ? Comparison::Better
9541                  : Comparison::Worse;
9542 
9543     std::pair<CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator, CPUSpecificAttr::cpus_iterator>
9544         FirstDiff = std::mismatch(
9545             Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_begin(), Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end(),
9546             Cand2CPUSpec->cpus_begin(),
9547             [](const IdentifierInfo *LHS, const IdentifierInfo *RHS) {
9548               return LHS->getName() == RHS->getName();
9549             });
9550 
9551     assert(FirstDiff.first != Cand1CPUSpec->cpus_end() &&
9552            "Two different cpu-specific versions should not have the same "
9553            "identifier list, otherwise they'd be the same decl!");
9554     return (*FirstDiff.first)->getName() < (*FirstDiff.second)->getName()
9555                ? Comparison::Better
9556                : Comparison::Worse;
9557   }
9558   llvm_unreachable("No way to get here unless both had cpu_dispatch");
9559 }
9560 
9561 /// Compute the type of the implicit object parameter for the given function,
9562 /// if any. Returns None if there is no implicit object parameter, and a null
9563 /// QualType if there is a 'matches anything' implicit object parameter.
9564 static Optional<QualType> getImplicitObjectParamType(ASTContext &Context,
9565                                                      const FunctionDecl *F) {
9566   if (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(F) || isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(F))
9567     return llvm::None;
9568 
9569   auto *M = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(F);
9570   // Static member functions' object parameters match all types.
9571   if (M->isStatic())
9572     return QualType();
9573 
9574   QualType T = M->getThisObjectType();
9575   if (M->getRefQualifier() == RQ_RValue)
9576     return Context.getRValueReferenceType(T);
9577   return Context.getLValueReferenceType(T);
9578 }
9579 
9580 static bool haveSameParameterTypes(ASTContext &Context, const FunctionDecl *F1,
9581                                    const FunctionDecl *F2, unsigned NumParams) {
9582   if (declaresSameEntity(F1, F2))
9583     return true;
9584 
9585   auto NextParam = [&](const FunctionDecl *F, unsigned &I, bool First) {
9586     if (First) {
9587       if (Optional<QualType> T = getImplicitObjectParamType(Context, F))
9588         return *T;
9589     }
9590     assert(I < F->getNumParams());
9591     return F->getParamDecl(I++)->getType();
9592   };
9593 
9594   unsigned I1 = 0, I2 = 0;
9595   for (unsigned I = 0; I != NumParams; ++I) {
9596     QualType T1 = NextParam(F1, I1, I == 0);
9597     QualType T2 = NextParam(F2, I2, I == 0);
9598     if (!T1.isNull() && !T1.isNull() && !Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(T1, T2))
9599       return false;
9600   }
9601   return true;
9602 }
9603 
9604 /// isBetterOverloadCandidate - Determines whether the first overload
9605 /// candidate is a better candidate than the second (C++ 13.3.3p1).
9606 bool clang::isBetterOverloadCandidate(
9607     Sema &S, const OverloadCandidate &Cand1, const OverloadCandidate &Cand2,
9608     SourceLocation Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind Kind) {
9609   // Define viable functions to be better candidates than non-viable
9610   // functions.
9611   if (!Cand2.Viable)
9612     return Cand1.Viable;
9613   else if (!Cand1.Viable)
9614     return false;
9615 
9616   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9617   //
9618   //   -- if F is a static member function, ICS1(F) is defined such
9619   //      that ICS1(F) is neither better nor worse than ICS1(G) for
9620   //      any function G, and, symmetrically, ICS1(G) is neither
9621   //      better nor worse than ICS1(F).
9622   unsigned StartArg = 0;
9623   if (Cand1.IgnoreObjectArgument || Cand2.IgnoreObjectArgument)
9624     StartArg = 1;
9625 
9626   auto IsIllFormedConversion = [&](const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS) {
9627     // We don't allow incompatible pointer conversions in C++.
9628     if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus)
9629       return ICS.isStandard() &&
9630              ICS.Standard.Second == ICK_Incompatible_Pointer_Conversion;
9631 
9632     // The only ill-formed conversion we allow in C++ is the string literal to
9633     // char* conversion, which is only considered ill-formed after C++11.
9634     return S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus11 && !S.getLangOpts().WritableStrings &&
9635            hasDeprecatedStringLiteralToCharPtrConversion(ICS);
9636   };
9637 
9638   // Define functions that don't require ill-formed conversions for a given
9639   // argument to be better candidates than functions that do.
9640   unsigned NumArgs = Cand1.Conversions.size();
9641   assert(Cand2.Conversions.size() == NumArgs && "Overload candidate mismatch");
9642   bool HasBetterConversion = false;
9643   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9644     bool Cand1Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9645     bool Cand2Bad = IsIllFormedConversion(Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx]);
9646     if (Cand1Bad != Cand2Bad) {
9647       if (Cand1Bad)
9648         return false;
9649       HasBetterConversion = true;
9650     }
9651   }
9652 
9653   if (HasBetterConversion)
9654     return true;
9655 
9656   // C++ [over.match.best]p1:
9657   //   A viable function F1 is defined to be a better function than another
9658   //   viable function F2 if for all arguments i, ICSi(F1) is not a worse
9659   //   conversion sequence than ICSi(F2), and then...
9660   bool HasWorseConversion = false;
9661   for (unsigned ArgIdx = StartArg; ArgIdx < NumArgs; ++ArgIdx) {
9662     switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9663                                                Cand1.Conversions[ArgIdx],
9664                                                Cand2.Conversions[ArgIdx])) {
9665     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
9666       // Cand1 has a better conversion sequence.
9667       HasBetterConversion = true;
9668       break;
9669 
9670     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
9671       if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9672           Cand1.isReversed() != Cand2.isReversed() &&
9673           haveSameParameterTypes(S.Context, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function,
9674                                  NumArgs)) {
9675         // Work around large-scale breakage caused by considering reversed
9676         // forms of operator== in C++20:
9677         //
9678         // When comparing a function against a reversed function with the same
9679         // parameter types, if we have a better conversion for one argument and
9680         // a worse conversion for the other, the implicit conversion sequences
9681         // are treated as being equally good.
9682         //
9683         // This prevents a comparison function from being considered ambiguous
9684         // with a reversed form that is written in the same way.
9685         //
9686         // We diagnose this as an extension from CreateOverloadedBinOp.
9687         HasWorseConversion = true;
9688         break;
9689       }
9690 
9691       // Cand1 can't be better than Cand2.
9692       return false;
9693 
9694     case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
9695       // Do nothing.
9696       break;
9697     }
9698   }
9699 
9700   //    -- for some argument j, ICSj(F1) is a better conversion sequence than
9701   //       ICSj(F2), or, if not that,
9702   if (HasBetterConversion && !HasWorseConversion)
9703     return true;
9704 
9705   //   -- the context is an initialization by user-defined conversion
9706   //      (see 8.5, 13.3.1.5) and the standard conversion sequence
9707   //      from the return type of F1 to the destination type (i.e.,
9708   //      the type of the entity being initialized) is a better
9709   //      conversion sequence than the standard conversion sequence
9710   //      from the return type of F2 to the destination type.
9711   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByUserDefinedConversion &&
9712       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9713       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) &&
9714       isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand2.Function)) {
9715     // First check whether we prefer one of the conversion functions over the
9716     // other. This only distinguishes the results in non-standard, extension
9717     // cases such as the conversion from a lambda closure type to a function
9718     // pointer or block.
9719     ImplicitConversionSequence::CompareKind Result =
9720         compareConversionFunctions(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9721     if (Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9722       Result = CompareStandardConversionSequences(S, Loc,
9723                                                   Cand1.FinalConversion,
9724                                                   Cand2.FinalConversion);
9725 
9726     if (Result != ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable)
9727       return Result == ImplicitConversionSequence::Better;
9728 
9729     // FIXME: Compare kind of reference binding if conversion functions
9730     // convert to a reference type used in direct reference binding, per
9731     // C++14 [over.match.best]p1 section 2 bullet 3.
9732   }
9733 
9734   // FIXME: Work around a defect in the C++17 guaranteed copy elision wording,
9735   // as combined with the resolution to CWG issue 243.
9736   //
9737   // When the context is initialization by constructor ([over.match.ctor] or
9738   // either phase of [over.match.list]), a constructor is preferred over
9739   // a conversion function.
9740   if (Kind == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_InitByConstructor && NumArgs == 1 &&
9741       Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function &&
9742       isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function) !=
9743           isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand2.Function))
9744     return isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9745 
9746   //    -- F1 is a non-template function and F2 is a function template
9747   //       specialization, or, if not that,
9748   bool Cand1IsSpecialization = Cand1.Function &&
9749                                Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9750   bool Cand2IsSpecialization = Cand2.Function &&
9751                                Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9752   if (Cand1IsSpecialization != Cand2IsSpecialization)
9753     return Cand2IsSpecialization;
9754 
9755   //   -- F1 and F2 are function template specializations, and the function
9756   //      template for F1 is more specialized than the template for F2
9757   //      according to the partial ordering rules described in 14.5.5.2, or,
9758   //      if not that,
9759   if (Cand1IsSpecialization && Cand2IsSpecialization) {
9760     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *BetterTemplate = S.getMoreSpecializedTemplate(
9761             Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(),
9762             Cand2.Function->getPrimaryTemplate(), Loc,
9763             isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Cand1.Function) ? TPOC_Conversion
9764                                                    : TPOC_Call,
9765             Cand1.ExplicitCallArguments, Cand2.ExplicitCallArguments,
9766             Cand1.isReversed() ^ Cand2.isReversed()))
9767       return BetterTemplate == Cand1.Function->getPrimaryTemplate();
9768   }
9769 
9770   //   -— F1 and F2 are non-template functions with the same
9771   //      parameter-type-lists, and F1 is more constrained than F2 [...],
9772   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function && !Cand1IsSpecialization &&
9773       !Cand2IsSpecialization && Cand1.Function->hasPrototype() &&
9774       Cand2.Function->hasPrototype()) {
9775     auto *PT1 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand1.Function->getFunctionType());
9776     auto *PT2 = cast<FunctionProtoType>(Cand2.Function->getFunctionType());
9777     if (PT1->getNumParams() == PT2->getNumParams() &&
9778         PT1->isVariadic() == PT2->isVariadic() &&
9779         S.FunctionParamTypesAreEqual(PT1, PT2)) {
9780       Expr *RC1 = Cand1.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9781       Expr *RC2 = Cand2.Function->getTrailingRequiresClause();
9782       if (RC1 && RC2) {
9783         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
9784         if (S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand1.Function, {RC1}, Cand2.Function,
9785                                      {RC2}, AtLeastAsConstrained1) ||
9786             S.IsAtLeastAsConstrained(Cand2.Function, {RC2}, Cand1.Function,
9787                                      {RC1}, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
9788           return false;
9789         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 != AtLeastAsConstrained2)
9790           return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
9791       } else if (RC1 || RC2) {
9792         return RC1 != nullptr;
9793       }
9794     }
9795   }
9796 
9797   //   -- F1 is a constructor for a class D, F2 is a constructor for a base
9798   //      class B of D, and for all arguments the corresponding parameters of
9799   //      F1 and F2 have the same type.
9800   // FIXME: Implement the "all parameters have the same type" check.
9801   bool Cand1IsInherited =
9802       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand1.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9803   bool Cand2IsInherited =
9804       dyn_cast_or_null<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Cand2.FoundDecl.getDecl());
9805   if (Cand1IsInherited != Cand2IsInherited)
9806     return Cand2IsInherited;
9807   else if (Cand1IsInherited) {
9808     assert(Cand2IsInherited);
9809     auto *Cand1Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand1.Function->getDeclContext());
9810     auto *Cand2Class = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Cand2.Function->getDeclContext());
9811     if (Cand1Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand2Class))
9812       return true;
9813     if (Cand2Class->isDerivedFrom(Cand1Class))
9814       return false;
9815     // Inherited from sibling base classes: still ambiguous.
9816   }
9817 
9818   //   -- F2 is a rewritten candidate (12.4.1.2) and F1 is not
9819   //   -- F1 and F2 are rewritten candidates, and F2 is a synthesized candidate
9820   //      with reversed order of parameters and F1 is not
9821   //
9822   // We rank reversed + different operator as worse than just reversed, but
9823   // that comparison can never happen, because we only consider reversing for
9824   // the maximally-rewritten operator (== or <=>).
9825   if (Cand1.RewriteKind != Cand2.RewriteKind)
9826     return Cand1.RewriteKind < Cand2.RewriteKind;
9827 
9828   // Check C++17 tie-breakers for deduction guides.
9829   {
9830     auto *Guide1 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand1.Function);
9831     auto *Guide2 = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXDeductionGuideDecl>(Cand2.Function);
9832     if (Guide1 && Guide2) {
9833       //  -- F1 is generated from a deduction-guide and F2 is not
9834       if (Guide1->isImplicit() != Guide2->isImplicit())
9835         return Guide2->isImplicit();
9836 
9837       //  -- F1 is the copy deduction candidate(16.3.1.8) and F2 is not
9838       if (Guide1->isCopyDeductionCandidate())
9839         return true;
9840     }
9841   }
9842 
9843   // Check for enable_if value-based overload resolution.
9844   if (Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9845     Comparison Cmp = compareEnableIfAttrs(S, Cand1.Function, Cand2.Function);
9846     if (Cmp != Comparison::Equal)
9847       return Cmp == Comparison::Better;
9848   }
9849 
9850   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Cand1.Function && Cand2.Function) {
9851     FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9852     return S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand1.Function) >
9853            S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand2.Function);
9854   }
9855 
9856   bool HasPS1 = Cand1.Function != nullptr &&
9857                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand1.Function);
9858   bool HasPS2 = Cand2.Function != nullptr &&
9859                 functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Cand2.Function);
9860   if (HasPS1 != HasPS2 && HasPS1)
9861     return true;
9862 
9863   Comparison MV = isBetterMultiversionCandidate(Cand1, Cand2);
9864   return MV == Comparison::Better;
9865 }
9866 
9867 /// Determine whether two declarations are "equivalent" for the purposes of
9868 /// name lookup and overload resolution. This applies when the same internal/no
9869 /// linkage entity is defined by two modules (probably by textually including
9870 /// the same header). In such a case, we don't consider the declarations to
9871 /// declare the same entity, but we also don't want lookups with both
9872 /// declarations visible to be ambiguous in some cases (this happens when using
9873 /// a modularized libstdc++).
9874 bool Sema::isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(const NamedDecl *A,
9875                                                   const NamedDecl *B) {
9876   auto *VA = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(A);
9877   auto *VB = dyn_cast_or_null<ValueDecl>(B);
9878   if (!VA || !VB)
9879     return false;
9880 
9881   // The declarations must be declaring the same name as an internal linkage
9882   // entity in different modules.
9883   if (!VA->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()->Equals(
9884           VB->getDeclContext()->getRedeclContext()) ||
9885       getOwningModule(VA) == getOwningModule(VB) ||
9886       VA->isExternallyVisible() || VB->isExternallyVisible())
9887     return false;
9888 
9889   // Check that the declarations appear to be equivalent.
9890   //
9891   // FIXME: Checking the type isn't really enough to resolve the ambiguity.
9892   // For constants and functions, we should check the initializer or body is
9893   // the same. For non-constant variables, we shouldn't allow it at all.
9894   if (Context.hasSameType(VA->getType(), VB->getType()))
9895     return true;
9896 
9897   // Enum constants within unnamed enumerations will have different types, but
9898   // may still be similar enough to be interchangeable for our purposes.
9899   if (auto *EA = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VA)) {
9900     if (auto *EB = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(VB)) {
9901       // Only handle anonymous enums. If the enumerations were named and
9902       // equivalent, they would have been merged to the same type.
9903       auto *EnumA = cast<EnumDecl>(EA->getDeclContext());
9904       auto *EnumB = cast<EnumDecl>(EB->getDeclContext());
9905       if (EnumA->hasNameForLinkage() || EnumB->hasNameForLinkage() ||
9906           !Context.hasSameType(EnumA->getIntegerType(),
9907                                EnumB->getIntegerType()))
9908         return false;
9909       // Allow this only if the value is the same for both enumerators.
9910       return llvm::APSInt::isSameValue(EA->getInitVal(), EB->getInitVal());
9911     }
9912   }
9913 
9914   // Nothing else is sufficiently similar.
9915   return false;
9916 }
9917 
9918 void Sema::diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(
9919     SourceLocation Loc, const NamedDecl *D, ArrayRef<const NamedDecl *> Equiv) {
9920   Diag(Loc, diag::ext_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl_in_modules) << D;
9921 
9922   Module *M = getOwningModule(D);
9923   Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9924       << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9925 
9926   for (auto *E : Equiv) {
9927     Module *M = getOwningModule(E);
9928     Diag(E->getLocation(), diag::note_equivalent_internal_linkage_decl)
9929         << !M << (M ? M->getFullModuleName() : "");
9930   }
9931 }
9932 
9933 /// Computes the best viable function (C++ 13.3.3)
9934 /// within an overload candidate set.
9935 ///
9936 /// \param Loc The location of the function name (or operator symbol) for
9937 /// which overload resolution occurs.
9938 ///
9939 /// \param Best If overload resolution was successful or found a deleted
9940 /// function, \p Best points to the candidate function found.
9941 ///
9942 /// \returns The result of overload resolution.
9943 OverloadingResult
9944 OverloadCandidateSet::BestViableFunction(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc,
9945                                          iterator &Best) {
9946   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 16> Candidates;
9947   std::transform(begin(), end(), std::back_inserter(Candidates),
9948                  [](OverloadCandidate &Cand) { return &Cand; });
9949 
9950   // [CUDA] HD->H or HD->D calls are technically not allowed by CUDA but
9951   // are accepted by both clang and NVCC. However, during a particular
9952   // compilation mode only one call variant is viable. We need to
9953   // exclude non-viable overload candidates from consideration based
9954   // only on their host/device attributes. Specifically, if one
9955   // candidate call is WrongSide and the other is SameSide, we ignore
9956   // the WrongSide candidate.
9957   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA) {
9958     const FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
9959     bool ContainsSameSideCandidate =
9960         llvm::any_of(Candidates, [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9961           // Check viable function only.
9962           return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9963                  S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9964                      Sema::CFP_SameSide;
9965         });
9966     if (ContainsSameSideCandidate) {
9967       auto IsWrongSideCandidate = [&](OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
9968         // Check viable function only to avoid unnecessary data copying/moving.
9969         return Cand->Viable && Cand->Function &&
9970                S.IdentifyCUDAPreference(Caller, Cand->Function) ==
9971                    Sema::CFP_WrongSide;
9972       };
9973       llvm::erase_if(Candidates, IsWrongSideCandidate);
9974     }
9975   }
9976 
9977   // Find the best viable function.
9978   Best = end();
9979   for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
9980     Cand->Best = false;
9981     if (Cand->Viable)
9982       if (Best == end() ||
9983           isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Cand, *Best, Loc, Kind))
9984         Best = Cand;
9985   }
9986 
9987   // If we didn't find any viable functions, abort.
9988   if (Best == end())
9989     return OR_No_Viable_Function;
9990 
9991   llvm::SmallVector<const NamedDecl *, 4> EquivalentCands;
9992 
9993   llvm::SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 4> PendingBest;
9994   PendingBest.push_back(&*Best);
9995   Best->Best = true;
9996 
9997   // Make sure that this function is better than every other viable
9998   // function. If not, we have an ambiguity.
9999   while (!PendingBest.empty()) {
10000     auto *Curr = PendingBest.pop_back_val();
10001     for (auto *Cand : Candidates) {
10002       if (Cand->Viable && !Cand->Best &&
10003           !isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *Curr, *Cand, Loc, Kind)) {
10004         PendingBest.push_back(Cand);
10005         Cand->Best = true;
10006 
10007         if (S.isEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclaration(Cand->Function,
10008                                                      Curr->Function))
10009           EquivalentCands.push_back(Cand->Function);
10010         else
10011           Best = end();
10012       }
10013     }
10014   }
10015 
10016   // If we found more than one best candidate, this is ambiguous.
10017   if (Best == end())
10018     return OR_Ambiguous;
10019 
10020   // Best is the best viable function.
10021   if (Best->Function && Best->Function->isDeleted())
10022     return OR_Deleted;
10023 
10024   if (!EquivalentCands.empty())
10025     S.diagnoseEquivalentInternalLinkageDeclarations(Loc, Best->Function,
10026                                                     EquivalentCands);
10027 
10028   return OR_Success;
10029 }
10030 
10031 namespace {
10032 
10033 enum OverloadCandidateKind {
10034   oc_function,
10035   oc_method,
10036   oc_reversed_binary_operator,
10037   oc_constructor,
10038   oc_implicit_default_constructor,
10039   oc_implicit_copy_constructor,
10040   oc_implicit_move_constructor,
10041   oc_implicit_copy_assignment,
10042   oc_implicit_move_assignment,
10043   oc_implicit_equality_comparison,
10044   oc_inherited_constructor
10045 };
10046 
10047 enum OverloadCandidateSelect {
10048   ocs_non_template,
10049   ocs_template,
10050   ocs_described_template,
10051 };
10052 
10053 static std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect>
10054 ClassifyOverloadCandidate(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10055                           OverloadCandidateRewriteKind CRK,
10056                           std::string &Description) {
10057 
10058   bool isTemplate = Fn->isTemplateDecl() || Found->isTemplateDecl();
10059   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl = Fn->getPrimaryTemplate()) {
10060     isTemplate = true;
10061     Description = S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10062         FunTmpl->getTemplateParameters(), *Fn->getTemplateSpecializationArgs());
10063   }
10064 
10065   OverloadCandidateSelect Select = [&]() {
10066     if (!Description.empty())
10067       return ocs_described_template;
10068     return isTemplate ? ocs_template : ocs_non_template;
10069   }();
10070 
10071   OverloadCandidateKind Kind = [&]() {
10072     if (Fn->isImplicit() && Fn->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_EqualEqual)
10073       return oc_implicit_equality_comparison;
10074 
10075     if (CRK & CRK_Reversed)
10076       return oc_reversed_binary_operator;
10077 
10078     if (CXXConstructorDecl *Ctor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10079       if (!Ctor->isImplicit()) {
10080         if (isa<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(Found))
10081           return oc_inherited_constructor;
10082         else
10083           return oc_constructor;
10084       }
10085 
10086       if (Ctor->isDefaultConstructor())
10087         return oc_implicit_default_constructor;
10088 
10089       if (Ctor->isMoveConstructor())
10090         return oc_implicit_move_constructor;
10091 
10092       assert(Ctor->isCopyConstructor() &&
10093              "unexpected sort of implicit constructor");
10094       return oc_implicit_copy_constructor;
10095     }
10096 
10097     if (CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
10098       // This actually gets spelled 'candidate function' for now, but
10099       // it doesn't hurt to split it out.
10100       if (!Meth->isImplicit())
10101         return oc_method;
10102 
10103       if (Meth->isMoveAssignmentOperator())
10104         return oc_implicit_move_assignment;
10105 
10106       if (Meth->isCopyAssignmentOperator())
10107         return oc_implicit_copy_assignment;
10108 
10109       assert(isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Meth) && "expected conversion");
10110       return oc_method;
10111     }
10112 
10113     return oc_function;
10114   }();
10115 
10116   return std::make_pair(Kind, Select);
10117 }
10118 
10119 void MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(Sema &S, Decl *FoundDecl) {
10120   // FIXME: It'd be nice to only emit a note once per using-decl per overload
10121   // set.
10122   if (auto *Shadow = dyn_cast<ConstructorUsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl))
10123     S.Diag(FoundDecl->getLocation(),
10124            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor)
10125       << Shadow->getNominatedBaseClass();
10126 }
10127 
10128 } // end anonymous namespace
10129 
10130 static bool isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(const ASTContext &Ctx,
10131                                     const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10132   for (auto *EnableIf : FD->specific_attrs<EnableIfAttr>()) {
10133     bool AlwaysTrue;
10134     if (EnableIf->getCond()->isValueDependent() ||
10135         !EnableIf->getCond()->EvaluateAsBooleanCondition(AlwaysTrue, Ctx))
10136       return false;
10137     if (!AlwaysTrue)
10138       return false;
10139   }
10140   return true;
10141 }
10142 
10143 /// Returns true if we can take the address of the function.
10144 ///
10145 /// \param Complain - If true, we'll emit a diagnostic
10146 /// \param InOverloadResolution - For the purposes of emitting a diagnostic, are
10147 ///   we in overload resolution?
10148 /// \param Loc - The location of the statement we're complaining about. Ignored
10149 ///   if we're not complaining, or if we're in overload resolution.
10150 static bool checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Sema &S, const FunctionDecl *FD,
10151                                               bool Complain,
10152                                               bool InOverloadResolution,
10153                                               SourceLocation Loc) {
10154   if (!isFunctionAlwaysEnabled(S.Context, FD)) {
10155     if (Complain) {
10156       if (InOverloadResolution)
10157         S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10158                diag::note_addrof_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if_attr);
10159       else
10160         S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_disabled_by_enable_if_attr) << FD;
10161     }
10162     return false;
10163   }
10164 
10165   if (FD->getTrailingRequiresClause()) {
10166     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
10167     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(FD, Satisfaction, Loc))
10168       return false;
10169     if (!Satisfaction.IsSatisfied) {
10170       if (Complain) {
10171         if (InOverloadResolution)
10172           S.Diag(FD->getBeginLoc(),
10173                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints);
10174         else
10175           S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_addrof_function_constraints_not_satisfied)
10176               << FD;
10177         S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
10178       }
10179       return false;
10180     }
10181   }
10182 
10183   auto I = llvm::find_if(FD->parameters(), [](const ParmVarDecl *P) {
10184     return P->hasAttr<PassObjectSizeAttr>();
10185   });
10186   if (I == FD->param_end())
10187     return true;
10188 
10189   if (Complain) {
10190     // Add one to ParamNo because it's user-facing
10191     unsigned ParamNo = std::distance(FD->param_begin(), I) + 1;
10192     if (InOverloadResolution)
10193       S.Diag(FD->getLocation(),
10194              diag::note_ovl_candidate_has_pass_object_size_params)
10195           << ParamNo;
10196     else
10197       S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_address_of_function_with_pass_object_size_params)
10198           << FD << ParamNo;
10199   }
10200   return false;
10201 }
10202 
10203 static bool checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(Sema &S,
10204                                                const FunctionDecl *FD) {
10205   return checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(S, FD, /*Complain=*/true,
10206                                            /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
10207                                            /*Loc=*/SourceLocation());
10208 }
10209 
10210 bool Sema::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(const FunctionDecl *Function,
10211                                              bool Complain,
10212                                              SourceLocation Loc) {
10213   return ::checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(*this, Function, Complain,
10214                                              /*InOverloadResolution=*/false,
10215                                              Loc);
10216 }
10217 
10218 // Notes the location of an overload candidate.
10219 void Sema::NoteOverloadCandidate(NamedDecl *Found, FunctionDecl *Fn,
10220                                  OverloadCandidateRewriteKind RewriteKind,
10221                                  QualType DestType, bool TakingAddress) {
10222   if (TakingAddress && !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(*this, Fn))
10223     return;
10224   if (Fn->isMultiVersion() && Fn->hasAttr<TargetAttr>() &&
10225       !Fn->getAttr<TargetAttr>()->isDefaultVersion())
10226     return;
10227   if (isa<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn) &&
10228       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent())->isLambda()) {
10229     // Don't print candidates other than the one that matches the calling
10230     // convention of the call operator, since that is guaranteed to exist.
10231     const auto *RD = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Fn->getParent());
10232     CXXMethodDecl *CallOp = RD->getLambdaCallOperator();
10233     CallingConv CallOpCC =
10234         CallOp->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10235     CXXConversionDecl *ConvD = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(Fn);
10236     QualType ConvRTy = ConvD->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getReturnType();
10237     CallingConv ConvToCC =
10238         ConvRTy->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()->getCallConv();
10239 
10240     if (ConvToCC != CallOpCC)
10241       return;
10242   }
10243 
10244   std::string FnDesc;
10245   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> KSPair =
10246       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(*this, Found, Fn, RewriteKind, FnDesc);
10247   PartialDiagnostic PD = PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
10248                          << (unsigned)KSPair.first << (unsigned)KSPair.second
10249                          << Fn << FnDesc;
10250 
10251   HandleFunctionTypeMismatch(PD, Fn->getType(), DestType);
10252   Diag(Fn->getLocation(), PD);
10253   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(*this, Found);
10254 }
10255 
10256 static void
10257 MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(Sema &S, ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate> Cands) {
10258   // Perhaps the ambiguity was caused by two atomic constraints that are
10259   // 'identical' but not equivalent:
10260   //
10261   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) { } // #1
10262   // void foo() requires (sizeof(T) > 4) && T::value { } // #2
10263   //
10264   // The 'sizeof(T) > 4' constraints are seemingly equivalent and should cause
10265   // #2 to subsume #1, but these constraint are not considered equivalent
10266   // according to the subsumption rules because they are not the same
10267   // source-level construct. This behavior is quite confusing and we should try
10268   // to help the user figure out what happened.
10269 
10270   SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> FirstAC, SecondAC;
10271   FunctionDecl *FirstCand = nullptr, *SecondCand = nullptr;
10272   for (auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10273     if (!I->Function)
10274       continue;
10275     SmallVector<const Expr *, 3> AC;
10276     if (auto *Template = I->Function->getPrimaryTemplate())
10277       Template->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10278     else
10279       I->Function->getAssociatedConstraints(AC);
10280     if (AC.empty())
10281       continue;
10282     if (FirstCand == nullptr) {
10283       FirstCand = I->Function;
10284       FirstAC = AC;
10285     } else if (SecondCand == nullptr) {
10286       SecondCand = I->Function;
10287       SecondAC = AC;
10288     } else {
10289       // We have more than one pair of constrained functions - this check is
10290       // expensive and we'd rather not try to diagnose it.
10291       return;
10292     }
10293   }
10294   if (!SecondCand)
10295     return;
10296   // The diagnostic can only happen if there are associated constraints on
10297   // both sides (there needs to be some identical atomic constraint).
10298   if (S.MaybeEmitAmbiguousAtomicConstraintsDiagnostic(FirstCand, FirstAC,
10299                                                       SecondCand, SecondAC))
10300     // Just show the user one diagnostic, they'll probably figure it out
10301     // from here.
10302     return;
10303 }
10304 
10305 // Notes the location of all overload candidates designated through
10306 // OverloadedExpr
10307 void Sema::NoteAllOverloadCandidates(Expr *OverloadedExpr, QualType DestType,
10308                                      bool TakingAddress) {
10309   assert(OverloadedExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
10310 
10311   OverloadExpr::FindResult Ovl = OverloadExpr::find(OverloadedExpr);
10312   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr = Ovl.Expression;
10313 
10314   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
10315                             IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
10316        I != IEnd; ++I) {
10317     if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunTmpl =
10318                 dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10319       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, FunTmpl->getTemplatedDecl(), CRK_None, DestType,
10320                             TakingAddress);
10321     } else if (FunctionDecl *Fun
10322                       = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()) ) {
10323       NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, DestType, TakingAddress);
10324     }
10325   }
10326 }
10327 
10328 /// Diagnoses an ambiguous conversion.  The partial diagnostic is the
10329 /// "lead" diagnostic; it will be given two arguments, the source and
10330 /// target types of the conversion.
10331 void ImplicitConversionSequence::DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
10332                                  Sema &S,
10333                                  SourceLocation CaretLoc,
10334                                  const PartialDiagnostic &PDiag) const {
10335   S.Diag(CaretLoc, PDiag)
10336     << Ambiguous.getFromType() << Ambiguous.getToType();
10337   // FIXME: The note limiting machinery is borrowed from
10338   // OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates; there's an opportunity for
10339   // refactoring here.
10340   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
10341   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
10342   AmbiguousConversionSequence::const_iterator I, E;
10343   for (I = Ambiguous.begin(), E = Ambiguous.end(); I != E; ++I) {
10344     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
10345       break;
10346     ++CandsShown;
10347     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(I->first, I->second);
10348   }
10349   if (I != E)
10350     S.Diag(SourceLocation(), diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
10351 }
10352 
10353 static void DiagnoseBadConversion(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10354                                   unsigned I, bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10355   const ImplicitConversionSequence &Conv = Cand->Conversions[I];
10356   assert(Conv.isBad());
10357   assert(Cand->Function && "for now, candidate must be a function");
10358   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10359 
10360   // There's a conversion slot for the object argument if this is a
10361   // non-constructor method.  Note that 'I' corresponds the
10362   // conversion-slot index.
10363   bool isObjectArgument = false;
10364   if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn) && !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)) {
10365     if (I == 0)
10366       isObjectArgument = true;
10367     else
10368       I--;
10369   }
10370 
10371   std::string FnDesc;
10372   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10373       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind(),
10374                                 FnDesc);
10375 
10376   Expr *FromExpr = Conv.Bad.FromExpr;
10377   QualType FromTy = Conv.Bad.getFromType();
10378   QualType ToTy = Conv.Bad.getToType();
10379 
10380   if (FromTy == S.Context.OverloadTy) {
10381     assert(FromExpr && "overload set argument came from implicit argument?");
10382     Expr *E = FromExpr->IgnoreParens();
10383     if (isa<UnaryOperator>(E))
10384       E = cast<UnaryOperator>(E)->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
10385     DeclarationName Name = cast<OverloadExpr>(E)->getName();
10386 
10387     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_overload)
10388         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10389         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << ToTy
10390         << Name << I + 1;
10391     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10392     return;
10393   }
10394 
10395   // Do some hand-waving analysis to see if the non-viability is due
10396   // to a qualifier mismatch.
10397   CanQualType CFromTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(FromTy);
10398   CanQualType CToTy = S.Context.getCanonicalType(ToTy);
10399   if (CanQual<ReferenceType> RT = CToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>())
10400     CToTy = RT->getPointeeType();
10401   else {
10402     // TODO: detect and diagnose the full richness of const mismatches.
10403     if (CanQual<PointerType> FromPT = CFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10404       if (CanQual<PointerType> ToPT = CToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10405         CFromTy = FromPT->getPointeeType();
10406         CToTy = ToPT->getPointeeType();
10407       }
10408   }
10409 
10410   if (CToTy.getUnqualifiedType() == CFromTy.getUnqualifiedType() &&
10411       !CToTy.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(CFromTy)) {
10412     Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10413     Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10414 
10415     if (FromQs.getAddressSpace() != ToQs.getAddressSpace()) {
10416       if (isObjectArgument)
10417         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace_this)
10418             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10419             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10420             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace();
10421       else
10422         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_addrspace)
10423             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10424             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10425             << FromQs.getAddressSpace() << ToQs.getAddressSpace()
10426             << ToTy->isReferenceType() << I + 1;
10427       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10428       return;
10429     }
10430 
10431     if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10432       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_ownership)
10433           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10434           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10435           << FromQs.getObjCLifetime() << ToQs.getObjCLifetime()
10436           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10437       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10438       return;
10439     }
10440 
10441     if (FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() != ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()) {
10442       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_gc)
10443           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10444           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10445           << FromQs.getObjCGCAttr() << ToQs.getObjCGCAttr()
10446           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10447       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10448       return;
10449     }
10450 
10451     if (FromQs.hasUnaligned() != ToQs.hasUnaligned()) {
10452       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_unaligned)
10453           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10454           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10455           << FromQs.hasUnaligned() << I + 1;
10456       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10457       return;
10458     }
10459 
10460     unsigned CVR = FromQs.getCVRQualifiers() & ~ToQs.getCVRQualifiers();
10461     assert(CVR && "unexpected qualifiers mismatch");
10462 
10463     if (isObjectArgument) {
10464       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr_this)
10465           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10466           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10467           << (CVR - 1);
10468     } else {
10469       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_cvr)
10470           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10471           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10472           << (CVR - 1) << I + 1;
10473     }
10474     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10475     return;
10476   }
10477 
10478   // Special diagnostic for failure to convert an initializer list, since
10479   // telling the user that it has type void is not useful.
10480   if (FromExpr && isa<InitListExpr>(FromExpr)) {
10481     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_list_argument)
10482         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10483         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10484         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10485     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10486     return;
10487   }
10488 
10489   // Diagnose references or pointers to incomplete types differently,
10490   // since it's far from impossible that the incompleteness triggered
10491   // the failure.
10492   QualType TempFromTy = FromTy.getNonReferenceType();
10493   if (const PointerType *PTy = TempFromTy->getAs<PointerType>())
10494     TempFromTy = PTy->getPointeeType();
10495   if (TempFromTy->isIncompleteType()) {
10496     // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10497     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv_incomplete)
10498         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10499         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10500         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10501         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10502 
10503     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10504     return;
10505   }
10506 
10507   // Diagnose base -> derived pointer conversions.
10508   unsigned BaseToDerivedConversion = 0;
10509   if (const PointerType *FromPtrTy = FromTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10510     if (const PointerType *ToPtrTy = ToTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
10511       if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10512                                                FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10513           !FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10514           !ToPtrTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10515           S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToPtrTy->getPointeeType(),
10516                           FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()))
10517         BaseToDerivedConversion = 1;
10518     }
10519   } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *FromPtrTy
10520                                     = FromTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
10521     if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *ToPtrTy
10522                                         = ToTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
10523       if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *FromIface = FromPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10524         if (const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ToIface = ToPtrTy->getInterfaceDecl())
10525           if (ToPtrTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(
10526                                                 FromPtrTy->getPointeeType()) &&
10527               FromIface->isSuperClassOf(ToIface))
10528             BaseToDerivedConversion = 2;
10529   } else if (const ReferenceType *ToRefTy = ToTy->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
10530     if (ToRefTy->getPointeeType().isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(FromTy) &&
10531         !FromTy->isIncompleteType() &&
10532         !ToRefTy->getPointeeType()->isIncompleteType() &&
10533         S.IsDerivedFrom(SourceLocation(), ToRefTy->getPointeeType(), FromTy)) {
10534       BaseToDerivedConversion = 3;
10535     } else if (ToTy->isLValueReferenceType() && !FromExpr->isLValue() &&
10536                ToTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType() ==
10537                FromTy.getNonReferenceType().getCanonicalType()) {
10538       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_lvalue)
10539           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10540           << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10541           << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
10542       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10543       return;
10544     }
10545   }
10546 
10547   if (BaseToDerivedConversion) {
10548     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_base_to_derived_conv)
10549         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10550         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10551         << (BaseToDerivedConversion - 1) << FromTy << ToTy << I + 1;
10552     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10553     return;
10554   }
10555 
10556   if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(CFromTy) &&
10557       isa<PointerType>(CToTy)) {
10558       Qualifiers FromQs = CFromTy.getQualifiers();
10559       Qualifiers ToQs = CToTy.getQualifiers();
10560       if (FromQs.getObjCLifetime() != ToQs.getObjCLifetime()) {
10561         S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_arc_conv)
10562             << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10563             << FnDesc << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange())
10564             << FromTy << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1;
10565         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10566         return;
10567       }
10568   }
10569 
10570   if (TakingCandidateAddress &&
10571       !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function))
10572     return;
10573 
10574   // Emit the generic diagnostic and, optionally, add the hints to it.
10575   PartialDiagnostic FDiag = S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_conv);
10576   FDiag << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
10577         << (FromExpr ? FromExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange()) << FromTy
10578         << ToTy << (unsigned)isObjectArgument << I + 1
10579         << (unsigned)(Cand->Fix.Kind);
10580 
10581   // If we can fix the conversion, suggest the FixIts.
10582   for (std::vector<FixItHint>::iterator HI = Cand->Fix.Hints.begin(),
10583        HE = Cand->Fix.Hints.end(); HI != HE; ++HI)
10584     FDiag << *HI;
10585   S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), FDiag);
10586 
10587   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
10588 }
10589 
10590 /// Additional arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload
10591 /// candidates. This is not covered by the more general DiagnoseArityMismatch()
10592 /// over a candidate in any candidate set.
10593 static bool CheckArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10594                                unsigned NumArgs) {
10595   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
10596   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10597 
10598   // With invalid overloaded operators, it's possible that we think we
10599   // have an arity mismatch when in fact it looks like we have the
10600   // right number of arguments, because only overloaded operators have
10601   // the weird behavior of overloading member and non-member functions.
10602   // Just don't report anything.
10603   if (Fn->isInvalidDecl() &&
10604       Fn->getDeclName().getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName)
10605     return true;
10606 
10607   if (NumArgs < MinParams) {
10608     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) ||
10609            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10610             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments));
10611   } else {
10612     assert((Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments) ||
10613            (Cand->FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction &&
10614             Cand->DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments));
10615   }
10616 
10617   return false;
10618 }
10619 
10620 /// General arity mismatch diagnosis over a candidate in a candidate set.
10621 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *D,
10622                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10623   assert(isa<FunctionDecl>(D) &&
10624       "The templated declaration should at least be a function"
10625       " when diagnosing bad template argument deduction due to too many"
10626       " or too few arguments");
10627 
10628   FunctionDecl *Fn = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
10629 
10630   // TODO: treat calls to a missing default constructor as a special case
10631   const auto *FnTy = Fn->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
10632   unsigned MinParams = Fn->getMinRequiredArguments();
10633 
10634   // at least / at most / exactly
10635   unsigned mode, modeCount;
10636   if (NumFormalArgs < MinParams) {
10637     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams() || FnTy->isVariadic() ||
10638         FnTy->isTemplateVariadic())
10639       mode = 0; // "at least"
10640     else
10641       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10642     modeCount = MinParams;
10643   } else {
10644     if (MinParams != FnTy->getNumParams())
10645       mode = 1; // "at most"
10646     else
10647       mode = 2; // "exactly"
10648     modeCount = FnTy->getNumParams();
10649   }
10650 
10651   std::string Description;
10652   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10653       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Found, Fn, CRK_None, Description);
10654 
10655   if (modeCount == 1 && Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getDeclName())
10656     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity_one)
10657         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10658         << Description << mode << Fn->getParamDecl(0) << NumFormalArgs;
10659   else
10660     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_arity)
10661         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second
10662         << Description << mode << modeCount << NumFormalArgs;
10663 
10664   MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10665 }
10666 
10667 /// Arity mismatch diagnosis specific to a function overload candidate.
10668 static void DiagnoseArityMismatch(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10669                                   unsigned NumFormalArgs) {
10670   if (!CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumFormalArgs))
10671     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, NumFormalArgs);
10672 }
10673 
10674 static TemplateDecl *getDescribedTemplate(Decl *Templated) {
10675   if (TemplateDecl *TD = Templated->getDescribedTemplate())
10676     return TD;
10677   llvm_unreachable("Unsupported: Getting the described template declaration"
10678                    " for bad deduction diagnosis");
10679 }
10680 
10681 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction.
10682 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, NamedDecl *Found, Decl *Templated,
10683                                  DeductionFailureInfo &DeductionFailure,
10684                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10685                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10686   TemplateParameter Param = DeductionFailure.getTemplateParameter();
10687   NamedDecl *ParamD;
10688   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl*>()) ||
10689   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl*>()) ||
10690   (ParamD = Param.dyn_cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl*>());
10691   switch (DeductionFailure.Result) {
10692   case Sema::TDK_Success:
10693     llvm_unreachable("TDK_success while diagnosing bad deduction");
10694 
10695   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete: {
10696     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10697     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10698            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction)
10699         << ParamD->getDeclName();
10700     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10701     return;
10702   }
10703 
10704   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack: {
10705     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for incomplete deduction result");
10706     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10707            diag::note_ovl_candidate_incomplete_deduction_pack)
10708         << ParamD->getDeclName()
10709         << (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() + 1)
10710         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10711     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10712     return;
10713   }
10714 
10715   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified: {
10716     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for bad qualifiers deduction result");
10717     TemplateTypeParmDecl *TParam = cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD);
10718 
10719     QualType Param = DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getAsType();
10720 
10721     // Param will have been canonicalized, but it should just be a
10722     // qualified version of ParamD, so move the qualifiers to that.
10723     QualifierCollector Qs;
10724     Qs.strip(Param);
10725     QualType NonCanonParam = Qs.apply(S.Context, TParam->getTypeForDecl());
10726     assert(S.Context.hasSameType(Param, NonCanonParam));
10727 
10728     // Arg has also been canonicalized, but there's nothing we can do
10729     // about that.  It also doesn't matter as much, because it won't
10730     // have any template parameters in it (because deduction isn't
10731     // done on dependent types).
10732     QualType Arg = DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getAsType();
10733 
10734     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_underqualified)
10735         << ParamD->getDeclName() << Arg << NonCanonParam;
10736     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10737     return;
10738   }
10739 
10740   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent: {
10741     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for inconsistent deduction result");
10742     int which = 0;
10743     if (isa<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10744       which = 0;
10745     else if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)) {
10746       // Deduction might have failed because we deduced arguments of two
10747       // different types for a non-type template parameter.
10748       // FIXME: Use a different TDK value for this.
10749       QualType T1 =
10750           DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10751       QualType T2 =
10752           DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getNonTypeTemplateArgumentType();
10753       if (!T1.isNull() && !T2.isNull() && !S.Context.hasSameType(T1, T2)) {
10754         S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10755                diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction_types)
10756           << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << T1
10757           << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg() << T2;
10758         MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10759         return;
10760       }
10761 
10762       which = 1;
10763     } else {
10764       which = 2;
10765     }
10766 
10767     // Tweak the diagnostic if the problem is that we deduced packs of
10768     // different arities. We'll print the actual packs anyway in case that
10769     // includes additional useful information.
10770     if (DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10771         DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->getKind() == TemplateArgument::Pack &&
10772         DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()->pack_size() !=
10773             DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()->pack_size()) {
10774       which = 3;
10775     }
10776 
10777     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10778            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inconsistent_deduction)
10779         << which << ParamD->getDeclName() << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg()
10780         << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10781     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10782     return;
10783   }
10784 
10785   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
10786     assert(ParamD && "no parameter found for invalid explicit arguments");
10787     if (ParamD->getDeclName())
10788       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10789              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_named)
10790           << ParamD->getDeclName();
10791     else {
10792       int index = 0;
10793       if (TemplateTypeParmDecl *TTP = dyn_cast<TemplateTypeParmDecl>(ParamD))
10794         index = TTP->getIndex();
10795       else if (NonTypeTemplateParmDecl *NTTP
10796                                   = dyn_cast<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD))
10797         index = NTTP->getIndex();
10798       else
10799         index = cast<TemplateTemplateParmDecl>(ParamD)->getIndex();
10800       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10801              diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit_arg_mismatch_unnamed)
10802           << (index + 1);
10803     }
10804     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10805     return;
10806 
10807   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied: {
10808     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10809     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10810     TemplateArgumentList *Args = DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList();
10811     TemplateArgString = " ";
10812     TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10813         getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10814     if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10815       TemplateArgString.clear();
10816     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10817            diag::note_ovl_candidate_unsatisfied_constraints)
10818         << TemplateArgString;
10819 
10820     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(
10821         static_cast<CNSInfo*>(DeductionFailure.Data)->Satisfaction);
10822     return;
10823   }
10824   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
10825   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
10826     DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Found, Templated, NumArgs);
10827     return;
10828 
10829   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
10830     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10831            diag::note_ovl_candidate_instantiation_depth);
10832     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10833     return;
10834 
10835   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure: {
10836     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10837     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10838     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10839             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10840       TemplateArgString = " ";
10841       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10842           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10843       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10844         TemplateArgString.clear();
10845     }
10846 
10847     // If this candidate was disabled by enable_if, say so.
10848     PartialDiagnosticAt *PDiag = DeductionFailure.getSFINAEDiagnostic();
10849     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10850           diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_enable_if) {
10851       // FIXME: Use the source range of the condition, and the fully-qualified
10852       //        name of the enable_if template. These are both present in PDiag.
10853       S.Diag(PDiag->first, diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_enable_if)
10854         << "'enable_if'" << TemplateArgString;
10855       return;
10856     }
10857 
10858     // We found a specific requirement that disabled the enable_if.
10859     if (PDiag && PDiag->second.getDiagID() ==
10860         diag::err_typename_nested_not_found_requirement) {
10861       S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10862              diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_requirement)
10863         << PDiag->second.getStringArg(0) << TemplateArgString;
10864       return;
10865     }
10866 
10867     // Format the SFINAE diagnostic into the argument string.
10868     // FIXME: Add a general mechanism to include a PartialDiagnostic *'s
10869     //        formatted message in another diagnostic.
10870     SmallString<128> SFINAEArgString;
10871     SourceRange R;
10872     if (PDiag) {
10873       SFINAEArgString = ": ";
10874       R = SourceRange(PDiag->first, PDiag->first);
10875       PDiag->second.EmitToString(S.getDiagnostics(), SFINAEArgString);
10876     }
10877 
10878     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10879            diag::note_ovl_candidate_substitution_failure)
10880         << TemplateArgString << SFINAEArgString << R;
10881     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10882     return;
10883   }
10884 
10885   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
10886   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested: {
10887     // Format the template argument list into the argument string.
10888     SmallString<128> TemplateArgString;
10889     if (TemplateArgumentList *Args =
10890             DeductionFailure.getTemplateArgumentList()) {
10891       TemplateArgString = " ";
10892       TemplateArgString += S.getTemplateArgumentBindingsText(
10893           getDescribedTemplate(Templated)->getTemplateParameters(), *Args);
10894       if (TemplateArgString.size() == 1)
10895         TemplateArgString.clear();
10896     }
10897 
10898     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deduced_mismatch)
10899         << (*DeductionFailure.getCallArgIndex() + 1)
10900         << *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg() << *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg()
10901         << TemplateArgString
10902         << (DeductionFailure.Result == Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested);
10903     break;
10904   }
10905 
10906   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch: {
10907     // FIXME: Provide a source location to indicate what we couldn't match.
10908     TemplateArgument FirstTA = *DeductionFailure.getFirstArg();
10909     TemplateArgument SecondTA = *DeductionFailure.getSecondArg();
10910     if (FirstTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template &&
10911         SecondTA.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Template) {
10912       TemplateName FirstTN = FirstTA.getAsTemplate();
10913       TemplateName SecondTN = SecondTA.getAsTemplate();
10914       if (FirstTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template &&
10915           SecondTN.getKind() == TemplateName::Template) {
10916         if (FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName() ==
10917             SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl()->getName()) {
10918           // FIXME: This fixes a bad diagnostic where both templates are named
10919           // the same.  This particular case is a bit difficult since:
10920           // 1) It is passed as a string to the diagnostic printer.
10921           // 2) The diagnostic printer only attempts to find a better
10922           //    name for types, not decls.
10923           // Ideally, this should folded into the diagnostic printer.
10924           S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10925                  diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch_qualified)
10926               << FirstTN.getAsTemplateDecl() << SecondTN.getAsTemplateDecl();
10927           return;
10928         }
10929       }
10930     }
10931 
10932     if (TakingCandidateAddress && isa<FunctionDecl>(Templated) &&
10933         !checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, cast<FunctionDecl>(Templated)))
10934       return;
10935 
10936     // FIXME: For generic lambda parameters, check if the function is a lambda
10937     // call operator, and if so, emit a prettier and more informative
10938     // diagnostic that mentions 'auto' and lambda in addition to
10939     // (or instead of?) the canonical template type parameters.
10940     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10941            diag::note_ovl_candidate_non_deduced_mismatch)
10942         << FirstTA << SecondTA;
10943     return;
10944   }
10945   // TODO: diagnose these individually, then kill off
10946   // note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction, which is uselessly vague.
10947   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
10948     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_deduction);
10949     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Found);
10950     return;
10951   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
10952     S.Diag(Templated->getLocation(),
10953            diag::note_cuda_ovl_candidate_target_mismatch);
10954     return;
10955   }
10956 }
10957 
10958 /// Diagnose a failed template-argument deduction, for function calls.
10959 static void DiagnoseBadDeduction(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
10960                                  unsigned NumArgs,
10961                                  bool TakingCandidateAddress) {
10962   unsigned TDK = Cand->DeductionFailure.Result;
10963   if (TDK == Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments || TDK == Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments) {
10964     if (CheckArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs))
10965       return;
10966   }
10967   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Cand->Function, // pattern
10968                        Cand->DeductionFailure, NumArgs, TakingCandidateAddress);
10969 }
10970 
10971 /// CUDA: diagnose an invalid call across targets.
10972 static void DiagnoseBadTarget(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
10973   FunctionDecl *Caller = cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext);
10974   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
10975 
10976   Sema::CUDAFunctionTarget CallerTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Caller),
10977                            CalleeTarget = S.IdentifyCUDATarget(Callee);
10978 
10979   std::string FnDesc;
10980   std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
10981       ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Callee,
10982                                 Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
10983 
10984   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_bad_target)
10985       << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
10986       << FnDesc /* Ignored */
10987       << CalleeTarget << CallerTarget;
10988 
10989   // This could be an implicit constructor for which we could not infer the
10990   // target due to a collsion. Diagnose that case.
10991   CXXMethodDecl *Meth = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Callee);
10992   if (Meth != nullptr && Meth->isImplicit()) {
10993     CXXRecordDecl *ParentClass = Meth->getParent();
10994     Sema::CXXSpecialMember CSM;
10995 
10996     switch (FnKindPair.first) {
10997     default:
10998       return;
10999     case oc_implicit_default_constructor:
11000       CSM = Sema::CXXDefaultConstructor;
11001       break;
11002     case oc_implicit_copy_constructor:
11003       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyConstructor;
11004       break;
11005     case oc_implicit_move_constructor:
11006       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveConstructor;
11007       break;
11008     case oc_implicit_copy_assignment:
11009       CSM = Sema::CXXCopyAssignment;
11010       break;
11011     case oc_implicit_move_assignment:
11012       CSM = Sema::CXXMoveAssignment;
11013       break;
11014     };
11015 
11016     bool ConstRHS = false;
11017     if (Meth->getNumParams()) {
11018       if (const ReferenceType *RT =
11019               Meth->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
11020         ConstRHS = RT->getPointeeType().isConstQualified();
11021       }
11022     }
11023 
11024     S.inferCUDATargetForImplicitSpecialMember(ParentClass, CSM, Meth,
11025                                               /* ConstRHS */ ConstRHS,
11026                                               /* Diagnose */ true);
11027   }
11028 }
11029 
11030 static void DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11031   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11032   EnableIfAttr *Attr = static_cast<EnableIfAttr*>(Cand->DeductionFailure.Data);
11033 
11034   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11035          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
11036       << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
11037 }
11038 
11039 static void DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11040   ExplicitSpecifier ES = ExplicitSpecifier::getFromDecl(Cand->Function);
11041   assert(ES.isExplicit() && "not an explicit candidate");
11042 
11043   unsigned Kind;
11044   switch (Cand->Function->getDeclKind()) {
11045   case Decl::Kind::CXXConstructor:
11046     Kind = 0;
11047     break;
11048   case Decl::Kind::CXXConversion:
11049     Kind = 1;
11050     break;
11051   case Decl::Kind::CXXDeductionGuide:
11052     Kind = Cand->Function->isImplicit() ? 0 : 2;
11053     break;
11054   default:
11055     llvm_unreachable("invalid Decl");
11056   }
11057 
11058   // Note the location of the first (in-class) declaration; a redeclaration
11059   // (particularly an out-of-class definition) will typically lack the
11060   // 'explicit' specifier.
11061   // FIXME: This is probably a good thing to do for all 'candidate' notes.
11062   FunctionDecl *First = Cand->Function->getFirstDecl();
11063   if (FunctionDecl *Pattern = First->getTemplateInstantiationPattern())
11064     First = Pattern->getFirstDecl();
11065 
11066   S.Diag(First->getLocation(),
11067          diag::note_ovl_candidate_explicit)
11068       << Kind << (ES.getExpr() ? 1 : 0)
11069       << (ES.getExpr() ? ES.getExpr()->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
11070 }
11071 
11072 static void DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11073   FunctionDecl *Callee = Cand->Function;
11074 
11075   S.Diag(Callee->getLocation(),
11076          diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_extension)
11077     << S.getOpenCLExtensionsFromDeclExtMap(Callee);
11078 }
11079 
11080 /// Generates a 'note' diagnostic for an overload candidate.  We've
11081 /// already generated a primary error at the call site.
11082 ///
11083 /// It really does need to be a single diagnostic with its caret
11084 /// pointed at the candidate declaration.  Yes, this creates some
11085 /// major challenges of technical writing.  Yes, this makes pointing
11086 /// out problems with specific arguments quite awkward.  It's still
11087 /// better than generating twenty screens of text for every failed
11088 /// overload.
11089 ///
11090 /// It would be great to be able to express per-candidate problems
11091 /// more richly for those diagnostic clients that cared, but we'd
11092 /// still have to be just as careful with the default diagnostics.
11093 /// \param CtorDestAS Addr space of object being constructed (for ctor
11094 /// candidates only).
11095 static void NoteFunctionCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11096                                   unsigned NumArgs,
11097                                   bool TakingCandidateAddress,
11098                                   LangAS CtorDestAS = LangAS::Default) {
11099   FunctionDecl *Fn = Cand->Function;
11100 
11101   // Note deleted candidates, but only if they're viable.
11102   if (Cand->Viable) {
11103     if (Fn->isDeleted()) {
11104       std::string FnDesc;
11105       std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11106           ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11107                                     Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11108 
11109       S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_deleted)
11110           << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)FnKindPair.second << FnDesc
11111           << (Fn->isDeleted() ? (Fn->isDeletedAsWritten() ? 1 : 2) : 0);
11112       MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11113       return;
11114     }
11115 
11116     // We don't really have anything else to say about viable candidates.
11117     S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11118     return;
11119   }
11120 
11121   switch (Cand->FailureKind) {
11122   case ovl_fail_too_many_arguments:
11123   case ovl_fail_too_few_arguments:
11124     return DiagnoseArityMismatch(S, Cand, NumArgs);
11125 
11126   case ovl_fail_bad_deduction:
11127     return DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, Cand, NumArgs,
11128                                 TakingCandidateAddress);
11129 
11130   case ovl_fail_illegal_constructor: {
11131     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor)
11132       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0);
11133     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11134     return;
11135   }
11136 
11137   case ovl_fail_object_addrspace_mismatch: {
11138     Qualifiers QualsForPrinting;
11139     QualsForPrinting.setAddressSpace(CtorDestAS);
11140     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11141            diag::note_ovl_candidate_illegal_constructor_adrspace_mismatch)
11142         << QualsForPrinting;
11143     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11144     return;
11145   }
11146 
11147   case ovl_fail_trivial_conversion:
11148   case ovl_fail_bad_final_conversion:
11149   case ovl_fail_final_conversion_not_exact:
11150     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11151 
11152   case ovl_fail_bad_conversion: {
11153     unsigned I = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0);
11154     for (unsigned N = Cand->Conversions.size(); I != N; ++I)
11155       if (Cand->Conversions[I].isBad())
11156         return DiagnoseBadConversion(S, Cand, I, TakingCandidateAddress);
11157 
11158     // FIXME: this currently happens when we're called from SemaInit
11159     // when user-conversion overload fails.  Figure out how to handle
11160     // those conditions and diagnose them well.
11161     return S.NoteOverloadCandidate(Cand->FoundDecl, Fn, Cand->getRewriteKind());
11162   }
11163 
11164   case ovl_fail_bad_target:
11165     return DiagnoseBadTarget(S, Cand);
11166 
11167   case ovl_fail_enable_if:
11168     return DiagnoseFailedEnableIfAttr(S, Cand);
11169 
11170   case ovl_fail_explicit:
11171     return DiagnoseFailedExplicitSpec(S, Cand);
11172 
11173   case ovl_fail_ext_disabled:
11174     return DiagnoseOpenCLExtensionDisabled(S, Cand);
11175 
11176   case ovl_fail_inhctor_slice:
11177     // It's generally not interesting to note copy/move constructors here.
11178     if (cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Fn)->isCopyOrMoveConstructor())
11179       return;
11180     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11181            diag::note_ovl_candidate_inherited_constructor_slice)
11182       << (Fn->getPrimaryTemplate() ? 1 : 0)
11183       << Fn->getParamDecl(0)->getType()->isRValueReferenceType();
11184     MaybeEmitInheritedConstructorNote(S, Cand->FoundDecl);
11185     return;
11186 
11187   case ovl_fail_addr_not_available: {
11188     bool Available = checkAddressOfCandidateIsAvailable(S, Cand->Function);
11189     (void)Available;
11190     assert(!Available);
11191     break;
11192   }
11193   case ovl_non_default_multiversion_function:
11194     // Do nothing, these should simply be ignored.
11195     break;
11196 
11197   case ovl_fail_constraints_not_satisfied: {
11198     std::string FnDesc;
11199     std::pair<OverloadCandidateKind, OverloadCandidateSelect> FnKindPair =
11200         ClassifyOverloadCandidate(S, Cand->FoundDecl, Fn,
11201                                   Cand->getRewriteKind(), FnDesc);
11202 
11203     S.Diag(Fn->getLocation(),
11204            diag::note_ovl_candidate_constraints_not_satisfied)
11205         << (unsigned)FnKindPair.first << (unsigned)ocs_non_template
11206         << FnDesc /* Ignored */;
11207     ConstraintSatisfaction Satisfaction;
11208     if (S.CheckFunctionConstraints(Fn, Satisfaction))
11209       break;
11210     S.DiagnoseUnsatisfiedConstraint(Satisfaction);
11211   }
11212   }
11213 }
11214 
11215 static void NoteSurrogateCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11216   // Desugar the type of the surrogate down to a function type,
11217   // retaining as many typedefs as possible while still showing
11218   // the function type (and, therefore, its parameter types).
11219   QualType FnType = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType();
11220   bool isLValueReference = false;
11221   bool isRValueReference = false;
11222   bool isPointer = false;
11223   if (const LValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11224         FnType->getAs<LValueReferenceType>()) {
11225     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11226     isLValueReference = true;
11227   } else if (const RValueReferenceType *FnTypeRef =
11228                FnType->getAs<RValueReferenceType>()) {
11229     FnType = FnTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11230     isRValueReference = true;
11231   }
11232   if (const PointerType *FnTypePtr = FnType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
11233     FnType = FnTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11234     isPointer = true;
11235   }
11236   // Desugar down to a function type.
11237   FnType = QualType(FnType->getAs<FunctionType>(), 0);
11238   // Reconstruct the pointer/reference as appropriate.
11239   if (isPointer) FnType = S.Context.getPointerType(FnType);
11240   if (isRValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getRValueReferenceType(FnType);
11241   if (isLValueReference) FnType = S.Context.getLValueReferenceType(FnType);
11242 
11243   S.Diag(Cand->Surrogate->getLocation(), diag::note_ovl_surrogate_cand)
11244     << FnType;
11245 }
11246 
11247 static void NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(Sema &S, StringRef Opc,
11248                                          SourceLocation OpLoc,
11249                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11250   assert(Cand->Conversions.size() <= 2 && "builtin operator is not binary");
11251   std::string TypeStr("operator");
11252   TypeStr += Opc;
11253   TypeStr += "(";
11254   TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[0].getAsString();
11255   if (Cand->Conversions.size() == 1) {
11256     TypeStr += ")";
11257     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11258   } else {
11259     TypeStr += ", ";
11260     TypeStr += Cand->BuiltinParamTypes[1].getAsString();
11261     TypeStr += ")";
11262     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_builtin_candidate) << TypeStr;
11263   }
11264 }
11265 
11266 static void NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(Sema &S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11267                                          OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11268   for (const ImplicitConversionSequence &ICS : Cand->Conversions) {
11269     if (ICS.isBad()) break; // all meaningless after first invalid
11270     if (!ICS.isAmbiguous()) continue;
11271 
11272     ICS.DiagnoseAmbiguousConversion(
11273         S, OpLoc, S.PDiag(diag::note_ambiguous_type_conversion));
11274   }
11275 }
11276 
11277 static SourceLocation GetLocationForCandidate(const OverloadCandidate *Cand) {
11278   if (Cand->Function)
11279     return Cand->Function->getLocation();
11280   if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11281     return Cand->Surrogate->getLocation();
11282   return SourceLocation();
11283 }
11284 
11285 static unsigned RankDeductionFailure(const DeductionFailureInfo &DFI) {
11286   switch ((Sema::TemplateDeductionResult)DFI.Result) {
11287   case Sema::TDK_Success:
11288   case Sema::TDK_NonDependentConversionFailure:
11289     llvm_unreachable("non-deduction failure while diagnosing bad deduction");
11290 
11291   case Sema::TDK_Invalid:
11292   case Sema::TDK_Incomplete:
11293   case Sema::TDK_IncompletePack:
11294     return 1;
11295 
11296   case Sema::TDK_Underqualified:
11297   case Sema::TDK_Inconsistent:
11298     return 2;
11299 
11300   case Sema::TDK_SubstitutionFailure:
11301   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatch:
11302   case Sema::TDK_ConstraintsNotSatisfied:
11303   case Sema::TDK_DeducedMismatchNested:
11304   case Sema::TDK_NonDeducedMismatch:
11305   case Sema::TDK_MiscellaneousDeductionFailure:
11306   case Sema::TDK_CUDATargetMismatch:
11307     return 3;
11308 
11309   case Sema::TDK_InstantiationDepth:
11310     return 4;
11311 
11312   case Sema::TDK_InvalidExplicitArguments:
11313     return 5;
11314 
11315   case Sema::TDK_TooManyArguments:
11316   case Sema::TDK_TooFewArguments:
11317     return 6;
11318   }
11319   llvm_unreachable("Unhandled deduction result");
11320 }
11321 
11322 namespace {
11323 struct CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay {
11324   Sema &S;
11325   SourceLocation Loc;
11326   size_t NumArgs;
11327   OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK;
11328 
11329   CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(
11330       Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, size_t NArgs,
11331       OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK)
11332       : S(S), NumArgs(NArgs), CSK(CSK) {}
11333 
11334   OverloadFailureKind EffectiveFailureKind(const OverloadCandidate *C) const {
11335     // If there are too many or too few arguments, that's the high-order bit we
11336     // want to sort by, even if the immediate failure kind was something else.
11337     if (C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11338         C->FailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11339       return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11340 
11341     if (C->Function) {
11342       if (NumArgs > C->Function->getNumParams() && !C->Function->isVariadic())
11343         return ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11344       if (NumArgs < C->Function->getMinRequiredArguments())
11345         return ovl_fail_too_few_arguments;
11346     }
11347 
11348     return static_cast<OverloadFailureKind>(C->FailureKind);
11349   }
11350 
11351   bool operator()(const OverloadCandidate *L,
11352                   const OverloadCandidate *R) {
11353     // Fast-path this check.
11354     if (L == R) return false;
11355 
11356     // Order first by viability.
11357     if (L->Viable) {
11358       if (!R->Viable) return true;
11359 
11360       // TODO: introduce a tri-valued comparison for overload
11361       // candidates.  Would be more worthwhile if we had a sort
11362       // that could exploit it.
11363       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *L, *R, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11364         return true;
11365       if (isBetterOverloadCandidate(S, *R, *L, SourceLocation(), CSK))
11366         return false;
11367     } else if (R->Viable)
11368       return false;
11369 
11370     assert(L->Viable == R->Viable);
11371 
11372     // Criteria by which we can sort non-viable candidates:
11373     if (!L->Viable) {
11374       OverloadFailureKind LFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(L);
11375       OverloadFailureKind RFailureKind = EffectiveFailureKind(R);
11376 
11377       // 1. Arity mismatches come after other candidates.
11378       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11379           LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11380         if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11381             RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments) {
11382           int LDist = std::abs((int)L->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11383           int RDist = std::abs((int)R->getNumParams() - (int)NumArgs);
11384           if (LDist == RDist) {
11385             if (LFailureKind == RFailureKind)
11386               // Sort non-surrogates before surrogates.
11387               return !L->IsSurrogate && R->IsSurrogate;
11388             // Sort candidates requiring fewer parameters than there were
11389             // arguments given after candidates requiring more parameters
11390             // than there were arguments given.
11391             return LFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments;
11392           }
11393           return LDist < RDist;
11394         }
11395         return false;
11396       }
11397       if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_many_arguments ||
11398           RFailureKind == ovl_fail_too_few_arguments)
11399         return true;
11400 
11401       // 2. Bad conversions come first and are ordered by the number
11402       // of bad conversions and quality of good conversions.
11403       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion) {
11404         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11405           return true;
11406 
11407         // The conversion that can be fixed with a smaller number of changes,
11408         // comes first.
11409         unsigned numLFixes = L->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11410         unsigned numRFixes = R->Fix.NumConversionsFixed;
11411         numLFixes = (numLFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numLFixes;
11412         numRFixes = (numRFixes == 0) ? UINT_MAX : numRFixes;
11413         if (numLFixes != numRFixes) {
11414           return numLFixes < numRFixes;
11415         }
11416 
11417         // If there's any ordering between the defined conversions...
11418         // FIXME: this might not be transitive.
11419         assert(L->Conversions.size() == R->Conversions.size());
11420 
11421         int leftBetter = 0;
11422         unsigned I = (L->IgnoreObjectArgument || R->IgnoreObjectArgument);
11423         for (unsigned E = L->Conversions.size(); I != E; ++I) {
11424           switch (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(S, Loc,
11425                                                      L->Conversions[I],
11426                                                      R->Conversions[I])) {
11427           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Better:
11428             leftBetter++;
11429             break;
11430 
11431           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Worse:
11432             leftBetter--;
11433             break;
11434 
11435           case ImplicitConversionSequence::Indistinguishable:
11436             break;
11437           }
11438         }
11439         if (leftBetter > 0) return true;
11440         if (leftBetter < 0) return false;
11441 
11442       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11443         return false;
11444 
11445       if (LFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction) {
11446         if (RFailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11447           return true;
11448 
11449         if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11450           return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure)
11451                < RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11452       } else if (RFailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_deduction)
11453         return false;
11454 
11455       // TODO: others?
11456     }
11457 
11458     // Sort everything else by location.
11459     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11460     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11461 
11462     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11463     if (LLoc.isInvalid()) return false;
11464     if (RLoc.isInvalid()) return true;
11465 
11466     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11467   }
11468 };
11469 }
11470 
11471 /// CompleteNonViableCandidate - Normally, overload resolution only
11472 /// computes up to the first bad conversion. Produces the FixIt set if
11473 /// possible.
11474 static void
11475 CompleteNonViableCandidate(Sema &S, OverloadCandidate *Cand,
11476                            ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11477                            OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK) {
11478   assert(!Cand->Viable);
11479 
11480   // Don't do anything on failures other than bad conversion.
11481   if (Cand->FailureKind != ovl_fail_bad_conversion)
11482     return;
11483 
11484   // We only want the FixIts if all the arguments can be corrected.
11485   bool Unfixable = false;
11486   // Use a implicit copy initialization to check conversion fixes.
11487   Cand->Fix.setConversionChecker(TryCopyInitialization);
11488 
11489   // Attempt to fix the bad conversion.
11490   unsigned ConvCount = Cand->Conversions.size();
11491   for (unsigned ConvIdx = (Cand->IgnoreObjectArgument ? 1 : 0); /**/;
11492        ++ConvIdx) {
11493     assert(ConvIdx != ConvCount && "no bad conversion in candidate");
11494     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized() &&
11495         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad()) {
11496       Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11497       break;
11498     }
11499   }
11500 
11501   // FIXME: this should probably be preserved from the overload
11502   // operation somehow.
11503   bool SuppressUserConversions = false;
11504 
11505   unsigned ConvIdx = 0;
11506   unsigned ArgIdx = 0;
11507   ArrayRef<QualType> ParamTypes;
11508   bool Reversed = Cand->isReversed();
11509 
11510   if (Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11511     QualType ConvType
11512       = Cand->Surrogate->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
11513     if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
11514       ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
11515     ParamTypes = ConvType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11516     // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11517     ConvIdx = 1;
11518   } else if (Cand->Function) {
11519     ParamTypes =
11520         Cand->Function->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()->getParamTypes();
11521     if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(Cand->Function) &&
11522         !isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Cand->Function) && !Reversed) {
11523       // Conversion 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11524       ConvIdx = 1;
11525       if (CSK == OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator &&
11526           Cand->Function->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator() != OO_Call)
11527         // Argument 0 is 'this', which doesn't have a corresponding parameter.
11528         ArgIdx = 1;
11529     }
11530   } else {
11531     // Builtin operator.
11532     assert(ConvCount <= 3);
11533     ParamTypes = Cand->BuiltinParamTypes;
11534   }
11535 
11536   // Fill in the rest of the conversions.
11537   for (unsigned ParamIdx = Reversed ? ParamTypes.size() - 1 : 0;
11538        ConvIdx != ConvCount;
11539        ++ConvIdx, ++ArgIdx, ParamIdx += (Reversed ? -1 : 1)) {
11540     assert(ArgIdx < Args.size() && "no argument for this arg conversion");
11541     if (Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isInitialized()) {
11542       // We've already checked this conversion.
11543     } else if (ParamIdx < ParamTypes.size()) {
11544       if (ParamTypes[ParamIdx]->isDependentType())
11545         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setAsIdentityConversion(
11546             Args[ArgIdx]->getType());
11547       else {
11548         Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx] =
11549             TryCopyInitialization(S, Args[ArgIdx], ParamTypes[ParamIdx],
11550                                   SuppressUserConversions,
11551                                   /*InOverloadResolution=*/true,
11552                                   /*AllowObjCWritebackConversion=*/
11553                                   S.getLangOpts().ObjCAutoRefCount);
11554         // Store the FixIt in the candidate if it exists.
11555         if (!Unfixable && Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].isBad())
11556           Unfixable = !Cand->TryToFixBadConversion(ConvIdx, S);
11557       }
11558     } else
11559       Cand->Conversions[ConvIdx].setEllipsis();
11560   }
11561 }
11562 
11563 SmallVector<OverloadCandidate *, 32> OverloadCandidateSet::CompleteCandidates(
11564     Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11565     SourceLocation OpLoc,
11566     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11567   // Sort the candidates by viability and position.  Sorting directly would
11568   // be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers and sort those.
11569   SmallVector<OverloadCandidate*, 32> Cands;
11570   if (OCD == OCD_AllCandidates) Cands.reserve(size());
11571   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11572     if (!Filter(*Cand))
11573       continue;
11574     switch (OCD) {
11575     case OCD_AllCandidates:
11576       if (!Cand->Viable) {
11577         if (!Cand->Function && !Cand->IsSurrogate) {
11578           // This a non-viable builtin candidate.  We do not, in general,
11579           // want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11580           continue;
11581         }
11582         CompleteNonViableCandidate(S, Cand, Args, Kind);
11583       }
11584       break;
11585 
11586     case OCD_ViableCandidates:
11587       if (!Cand->Viable)
11588         continue;
11589       break;
11590 
11591     case OCD_AmbiguousCandidates:
11592       if (!Cand->Best)
11593         continue;
11594       break;
11595     }
11596 
11597     Cands.push_back(Cand);
11598   }
11599 
11600   llvm::stable_sort(
11601       Cands, CompareOverloadCandidatesForDisplay(S, OpLoc, Args.size(), Kind));
11602 
11603   return Cands;
11604 }
11605 
11606 /// When overload resolution fails, prints diagnostic messages containing the
11607 /// candidates in the candidate set.
11608 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt PD,
11609     Sema &S, OverloadCandidateDisplayKind OCD, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11610     StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc,
11611     llvm::function_ref<bool(OverloadCandidate &)> Filter) {
11612 
11613   bool DeferHint = false;
11614   if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && S.getLangOpts().GPUDeferDiag) {
11615     // Defer diagnostic for CUDA/HIP if there are wrong-sided candidates.
11616     auto WrongSidedCands =
11617         CompleteCandidates(S, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, OpLoc, [](auto &Cand) {
11618           return Cand.Viable == false &&
11619                  Cand.FailureKind == ovl_fail_bad_target;
11620         });
11621     DeferHint = WrongSidedCands.size();
11622   }
11623   auto Cands = CompleteCandidates(S, OCD, Args, OpLoc, Filter);
11624 
11625   S.Diag(PD.first, PD.second, DeferHint);
11626 
11627   NoteCandidates(S, Args, Cands, Opc, OpLoc);
11628 
11629   if (OCD == OCD_AmbiguousCandidates)
11630     MaybeDiagnoseAmbiguousConstraints(S, {begin(), end()});
11631 }
11632 
11633 void OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
11634                                           ArrayRef<OverloadCandidate *> Cands,
11635                                           StringRef Opc, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
11636   bool ReportedAmbiguousConversions = false;
11637 
11638   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11639   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11640   auto I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end();
11641   for (; I != E; ++I) {
11642     OverloadCandidate *Cand = *I;
11643 
11644     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidate functions we'll spam
11645     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
11646     // candidate list.
11647     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best) {
11648       break;
11649     }
11650     ++CandsShown;
11651 
11652     if (Cand->Function)
11653       NoteFunctionCandidate(S, Cand, Args.size(),
11654                             /*TakingCandidateAddress=*/false, DestAS);
11655     else if (Cand->IsSurrogate)
11656       NoteSurrogateCandidate(S, Cand);
11657     else {
11658       assert(Cand->Viable &&
11659              "Non-viable built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11660       // Generally we only see ambiguities including viable builtin
11661       // operators if overload resolution got screwed up by an
11662       // ambiguous user-defined conversion.
11663       //
11664       // FIXME: It's quite possible for different conversions to see
11665       // different ambiguities, though.
11666       if (!ReportedAmbiguousConversions) {
11667         NoteAmbiguousUserConversions(S, OpLoc, Cand);
11668         ReportedAmbiguousConversions = true;
11669       }
11670 
11671       // If this is a viable builtin, print it.
11672       NoteBuiltinOperatorCandidate(S, Opc, OpLoc, Cand);
11673     }
11674   }
11675 
11676   if (I != E)
11677     S.Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
11678 }
11679 
11680 static SourceLocation
11681 GetLocationForCandidate(const TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand) {
11682   return Cand->Specialization ? Cand->Specialization->getLocation()
11683                               : SourceLocation();
11684 }
11685 
11686 namespace {
11687 struct CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay {
11688   Sema &S;
11689   CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(Sema &S) : S(S) {}
11690 
11691   bool operator()(const TemplateSpecCandidate *L,
11692                   const TemplateSpecCandidate *R) {
11693     // Fast-path this check.
11694     if (L == R)
11695       return false;
11696 
11697     // Assuming that both candidates are not matches...
11698 
11699     // Sort by the ranking of deduction failures.
11700     if (L->DeductionFailure.Result != R->DeductionFailure.Result)
11701       return RankDeductionFailure(L->DeductionFailure) <
11702              RankDeductionFailure(R->DeductionFailure);
11703 
11704     // Sort everything else by location.
11705     SourceLocation LLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(L);
11706     SourceLocation RLoc = GetLocationForCandidate(R);
11707 
11708     // Put candidates without locations (e.g. builtins) at the end.
11709     if (LLoc.isInvalid())
11710       return false;
11711     if (RLoc.isInvalid())
11712       return true;
11713 
11714     return S.SourceMgr.isBeforeInTranslationUnit(LLoc, RLoc);
11715   }
11716 };
11717 }
11718 
11719 /// Diagnose a template argument deduction failure.
11720 /// We are treating these failures as overload failures due to bad
11721 /// deductions.
11722 void TemplateSpecCandidate::NoteDeductionFailure(Sema &S,
11723                                                  bool ForTakingAddress) {
11724   DiagnoseBadDeduction(S, FoundDecl, Specialization, // pattern
11725                        DeductionFailure, /*NumArgs=*/0, ForTakingAddress);
11726 }
11727 
11728 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::destroyCandidates() {
11729   for (iterator i = begin(), e = end(); i != e; ++i) {
11730     i->DeductionFailure.Destroy();
11731   }
11732 }
11733 
11734 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::clear() {
11735   destroyCandidates();
11736   Candidates.clear();
11737 }
11738 
11739 /// NoteCandidates - When no template specialization match is found, prints
11740 /// diagnostic messages containing the non-matching specializations that form
11741 /// the candidate set.
11742 /// This is analoguous to OverloadCandidateSet::NoteCandidates() with
11743 /// OCD == OCD_AllCandidates and Cand->Viable == false.
11744 void TemplateSpecCandidateSet::NoteCandidates(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) {
11745   // Sort the candidates by position (assuming no candidate is a match).
11746   // Sorting directly would be prohibitive, so we make a set of pointers
11747   // and sort those.
11748   SmallVector<TemplateSpecCandidate *, 32> Cands;
11749   Cands.reserve(size());
11750   for (iterator Cand = begin(), LastCand = end(); Cand != LastCand; ++Cand) {
11751     if (Cand->Specialization)
11752       Cands.push_back(Cand);
11753     // Otherwise, this is a non-matching builtin candidate.  We do not,
11754     // in general, want to list every possible builtin candidate.
11755   }
11756 
11757   llvm::sort(Cands, CompareTemplateSpecCandidatesForDisplay(S));
11758 
11759   // FIXME: Perhaps rename OverloadsShown and getShowOverloads()
11760   // for generalization purposes (?).
11761   const OverloadsShown ShowOverloads = S.Diags.getShowOverloads();
11762 
11763   SmallVectorImpl<TemplateSpecCandidate *>::iterator I, E;
11764   unsigned CandsShown = 0;
11765   for (I = Cands.begin(), E = Cands.end(); I != E; ++I) {
11766     TemplateSpecCandidate *Cand = *I;
11767 
11768     // Set an arbitrary limit on the number of candidates we'll spam
11769     // the user with.  FIXME: This limit should depend on details of the
11770     // candidate list.
11771     if (CandsShown >= 4 && ShowOverloads == Ovl_Best)
11772       break;
11773     ++CandsShown;
11774 
11775     assert(Cand->Specialization &&
11776            "Non-matching built-in candidates are not added to Cands.");
11777     Cand->NoteDeductionFailure(S, ForTakingAddress);
11778   }
11779 
11780   if (I != E)
11781     S.Diag(Loc, diag::note_ovl_too_many_candidates) << int(E - I);
11782 }
11783 
11784 // [PossiblyAFunctionType]  -->   [Return]
11785 // NonFunctionType --> NonFunctionType
11786 // R (A) --> R(A)
11787 // R (*)(A) --> R (A)
11788 // R (&)(A) --> R (A)
11789 // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A)
11790 QualType Sema::ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(QualType PossiblyAFunctionType) {
11791   QualType Ret = PossiblyAFunctionType;
11792   if (const PointerType *ToTypePtr =
11793     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<PointerType>())
11794     Ret = ToTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11795   else if (const ReferenceType *ToTypeRef =
11796     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
11797     Ret = ToTypeRef->getPointeeType();
11798   else if (const MemberPointerType *MemTypePtr =
11799     PossiblyAFunctionType->getAs<MemberPointerType>())
11800     Ret = MemTypePtr->getPointeeType();
11801   Ret =
11802     Context.getCanonicalType(Ret).getUnqualifiedType();
11803   return Ret;
11804 }
11805 
11806 static bool completeFunctionType(Sema &S, FunctionDecl *FD, SourceLocation Loc,
11807                                  bool Complain = true) {
11808   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus14 && FD->getReturnType()->isUndeducedType() &&
11809       S.DeduceReturnType(FD, Loc, Complain))
11810     return true;
11811 
11812   auto *FPT = FD->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
11813   if (S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus17 &&
11814       isUnresolvedExceptionSpec(FPT->getExceptionSpecType()) &&
11815       !S.ResolveExceptionSpec(Loc, FPT))
11816     return true;
11817 
11818   return false;
11819 }
11820 
11821 namespace {
11822 // A helper class to help with address of function resolution
11823 // - allows us to avoid passing around all those ugly parameters
11824 class AddressOfFunctionResolver {
11825   Sema& S;
11826   Expr* SourceExpr;
11827   const QualType& TargetType;
11828   QualType TargetFunctionType; // Extracted function type from target type
11829 
11830   bool Complain;
11831   //DeclAccessPair& ResultFunctionAccessPair;
11832   ASTContext& Context;
11833 
11834   bool TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction;
11835   bool FoundNonTemplateFunction;
11836   bool StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
11837   bool HasComplained;
11838 
11839   OverloadExpr::FindResult OvlExprInfo;
11840   OverloadExpr *OvlExpr;
11841   TemplateArgumentListInfo OvlExplicitTemplateArgs;
11842   SmallVector<std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl*>, 4> Matches;
11843   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates;
11844 
11845 public:
11846   AddressOfFunctionResolver(Sema &S, Expr *SourceExpr,
11847                             const QualType &TargetType, bool Complain)
11848       : S(S), SourceExpr(SourceExpr), TargetType(TargetType),
11849         Complain(Complain), Context(S.getASTContext()),
11850         TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction(
11851             !!TargetType->getAs<MemberPointerType>()),
11852         FoundNonTemplateFunction(false),
11853         StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer(false),
11854         HasComplained(false),
11855         OvlExprInfo(OverloadExpr::find(SourceExpr)),
11856         OvlExpr(OvlExprInfo.Expression),
11857         FailedCandidates(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), /*ForTakingAddress=*/true) {
11858     ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType();
11859 
11860     if (TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType()) {
11861       if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *UME = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(OvlExpr))
11862         if (!UME->isImplicitAccess() &&
11863             !S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(UME))
11864           StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer = true;
11865     } else if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
11866       DeclAccessPair dap;
11867       if (FunctionDecl *Fn = S.ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
11868               OvlExpr, false, &dap)) {
11869         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn))
11870           if (!Method->isStatic()) {
11871             // If the target type is a non-function type and the function found
11872             // is a non-static member function, pretend as if that was the
11873             // target, it's the only possible type to end up with.
11874             TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction = true;
11875 
11876             // And skip adding the function if its not in the proper form.
11877             // We'll diagnose this due to an empty set of functions.
11878             if (!OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer)
11879               return;
11880           }
11881 
11882         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(dap, Fn));
11883       }
11884       return;
11885     }
11886 
11887     if (OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
11888       OvlExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(OvlExplicitTemplateArgs);
11889 
11890     if (FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly()) {
11891       // C++ [over.over]p4:
11892       //   If more than one function is selected, [...]
11893       if (Matches.size() > 1 && !eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates()) {
11894         if (FoundNonTemplateFunction)
11895           EliminateAllTemplateMatches();
11896         else
11897           EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate();
11898       }
11899     }
11900 
11901     if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA && Matches.size() > 1)
11902       EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches();
11903   }
11904 
11905   bool hasComplained() const { return HasComplained; }
11906 
11907 private:
11908   bool candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(const FunctionDecl *FD) {
11909     QualType Discard;
11910     return Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(TargetFunctionType, FD->getType()) ||
11911            S.IsFunctionConversion(FD->getType(), TargetFunctionType, Discard);
11912   }
11913 
11914   /// \return true if A is considered a better overload candidate for the
11915   /// desired type than B.
11916   bool isBetterCandidate(const FunctionDecl *A, const FunctionDecl *B) {
11917     // If A doesn't have exactly the correct type, we don't want to classify it
11918     // as "better" than anything else. This way, the user is required to
11919     // disambiguate for us if there are multiple candidates and no exact match.
11920     return candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(A) &&
11921            (!candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(B) ||
11922             compareEnableIfAttrs(S, A, B) == Comparison::Better);
11923   }
11924 
11925   /// \return true if we were able to eliminate all but one overload candidate,
11926   /// false otherwise.
11927   bool eliminiateSuboptimalOverloadCandidates() {
11928     // Same algorithm as overload resolution -- one pass to pick the "best",
11929     // another pass to be sure that nothing is better than the best.
11930     auto Best = Matches.begin();
11931     for (auto I = Matches.begin()+1, E = Matches.end(); I != E; ++I)
11932       if (isBetterCandidate(I->second, Best->second))
11933         Best = I;
11934 
11935     const FunctionDecl *BestFn = Best->second;
11936     auto IsBestOrInferiorToBest = [this, BestFn](
11937         const std::pair<DeclAccessPair, FunctionDecl *> &Pair) {
11938       return BestFn == Pair.second || isBetterCandidate(BestFn, Pair.second);
11939     };
11940 
11941     // Note: We explicitly leave Matches unmodified if there isn't a clear best
11942     // option, so we can potentially give the user a better error
11943     if (!llvm::all_of(Matches, IsBestOrInferiorToBest))
11944       return false;
11945     Matches[0] = *Best;
11946     Matches.resize(1);
11947     return true;
11948   }
11949 
11950   bool isTargetTypeAFunction() const {
11951     return TargetFunctionType->isFunctionType();
11952   }
11953 
11954   // [ToType]     [Return]
11955 
11956   // R (*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
11957   // R (&)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = false
11958   // R (S::*)(A) --> R (A), IsNonStaticMemberFunction = true
11959   void inline ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionTypeFromTargetType() {
11960     TargetFunctionType = S.ExtractUnqualifiedFunctionType(TargetType);
11961   }
11962 
11963   // return true if any matching specializations were found
11964   bool AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplateDecl* FunctionTemplate,
11965                                    const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
11966     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method
11967               = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl())) {
11968       // Skip non-static function templates when converting to pointer, and
11969       // static when converting to member pointer.
11970       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
11971         return false;
11972     }
11973     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
11974       return false;
11975 
11976     // C++ [over.over]p2:
11977     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
11978     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
11979     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
11980     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
11981     //   overloaded functions considered.
11982     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
11983     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
11984     if (Sema::TemplateDeductionResult Result
11985           = S.DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate,
11986                                       &OvlExplicitTemplateArgs,
11987                                       TargetFunctionType, Specialization,
11988                                       Info, /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
11989       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
11990       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
11991           .set(CurAccessFunPair, FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
11992                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
11993       return false;
11994     }
11995 
11996     // Template argument deduction ensures that we have an exact match or
11997     // compatible pointer-to-function arguments that would be adjusted by ICS.
11998     // This function template specicalization works.
11999     assert(S.isSameOrCompatibleFunctionType(
12000               Context.getCanonicalType(Specialization->getType()),
12001               Context.getCanonicalType(TargetFunctionType)));
12002 
12003     if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(Specialization))
12004       return false;
12005 
12006     Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(CurAccessFunPair, Specialization));
12007     return true;
12008   }
12009 
12010   bool AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(NamedDecl* Fn,
12011                                       const DeclAccessPair& CurAccessFunPair) {
12012     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
12013       // Skip non-static functions when converting to pointer, and static
12014       // when converting to member pointer.
12015       if (Method->isStatic() == TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12016         return false;
12017     }
12018     else if (TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction)
12019       return false;
12020 
12021     if (FunctionDecl *FunDecl = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Fn)) {
12022       if (S.getLangOpts().CUDA)
12023         if (FunctionDecl *Caller = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext))
12024           if (!Caller->isImplicit() && !S.IsAllowedCUDACall(Caller, FunDecl))
12025             return false;
12026       if (FunDecl->isMultiVersion()) {
12027         const auto *TA = FunDecl->getAttr<TargetAttr>();
12028         if (TA && !TA->isDefaultVersion())
12029           return false;
12030       }
12031 
12032       // If any candidate has a placeholder return type, trigger its deduction
12033       // now.
12034       if (completeFunctionType(S, FunDecl, SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12035                                Complain)) {
12036         HasComplained |= Complain;
12037         return false;
12038       }
12039 
12040       if (!S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FunDecl))
12041         return false;
12042 
12043       // If we're in C, we need to support types that aren't exactly identical.
12044       if (!S.getLangOpts().CPlusPlus ||
12045           candidateHasExactlyCorrectType(FunDecl)) {
12046         Matches.push_back(std::make_pair(
12047             CurAccessFunPair, cast<FunctionDecl>(FunDecl->getCanonicalDecl())));
12048         FoundNonTemplateFunction = true;
12049         return true;
12050       }
12051     }
12052 
12053     return false;
12054   }
12055 
12056   bool FindAllFunctionsThatMatchTargetTypeExactly() {
12057     bool Ret = false;
12058 
12059     // If the overload expression doesn't have the form of a pointer to
12060     // member, don't try to convert it to a pointer-to-member type.
12061     if (IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12062       return false;
12063 
12064     for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12065                                E = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12066          I != E; ++I) {
12067       // Look through any using declarations to find the underlying function.
12068       NamedDecl *Fn = (*I)->getUnderlyingDecl();
12069 
12070       // C++ [over.over]p3:
12071       //   Non-member functions and static member functions match
12072       //   targets of type "pointer-to-function" or "reference-to-function."
12073       //   Nonstatic member functions match targets of
12074       //   type "pointer-to-member-function."
12075       // Note that according to DR 247, the containing class does not matter.
12076       if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12077                                         = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Fn)) {
12078         if (AddMatchingTemplateFunction(FunctionTemplate, I.getPair()))
12079           Ret = true;
12080       }
12081       // If we have explicit template arguments supplied, skip non-templates.
12082       else if (!OvlExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs() &&
12083                AddMatchingNonTemplateFunction(Fn, I.getPair()))
12084         Ret = true;
12085     }
12086     assert(Ret || Matches.empty());
12087     return Ret;
12088   }
12089 
12090   void EliminateAllExceptMostSpecializedTemplate() {
12091     //   [...] and any given function template specialization F1 is
12092     //   eliminated if the set contains a second function template
12093     //   specialization whose function template is more specialized
12094     //   than the function template of F1 according to the partial
12095     //   ordering rules of 14.5.5.2.
12096 
12097     // The algorithm specified above is quadratic. We instead use a
12098     // two-pass algorithm (similar to the one used to identify the
12099     // best viable function in an overload set) that identifies the
12100     // best function template (if it exists).
12101 
12102     UnresolvedSet<4> MatchesCopy; // TODO: avoid!
12103     for (unsigned I = 0, E = Matches.size(); I != E; ++I)
12104       MatchesCopy.addDecl(Matches[I].second, Matches[I].first.getAccess());
12105 
12106     // TODO: It looks like FailedCandidates does not serve much purpose
12107     // here, since the no_viable diagnostic has index 0.
12108     UnresolvedSetIterator Result = S.getMostSpecialized(
12109         MatchesCopy.begin(), MatchesCopy.end(), FailedCandidates,
12110         SourceExpr->getBeginLoc(), S.PDiag(),
12111         S.PDiag(diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12112             << Matches[0].second->getDeclName(),
12113         S.PDiag(diag::note_ovl_candidate)
12114             << (unsigned)oc_function << (unsigned)ocs_described_template,
12115         Complain, TargetFunctionType);
12116 
12117     if (Result != MatchesCopy.end()) {
12118       // Make it the first and only element
12119       Matches[0].first = Matches[Result - MatchesCopy.begin()].first;
12120       Matches[0].second = cast<FunctionDecl>(*Result);
12121       Matches.resize(1);
12122     } else
12123       HasComplained |= Complain;
12124   }
12125 
12126   void EliminateAllTemplateMatches() {
12127     //   [...] any function template specializations in the set are
12128     //   eliminated if the set also contains a non-template function, [...]
12129     for (unsigned I = 0, N = Matches.size(); I != N; ) {
12130       if (Matches[I].second->getPrimaryTemplate() == nullptr)
12131         ++I;
12132       else {
12133         Matches[I] = Matches[--N];
12134         Matches.resize(N);
12135       }
12136     }
12137   }
12138 
12139   void EliminateSuboptimalCudaMatches() {
12140     S.EraseUnwantedCUDAMatches(dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(S.CurContext), Matches);
12141   }
12142 
12143 public:
12144   void ComplainNoMatchesFound() const {
12145     assert(Matches.empty());
12146     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_viable)
12147         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetFunctionType
12148         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12149     if (FailedCandidates.empty())
12150       S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12151                                   /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12152     else {
12153       // We have some deduction failure messages. Use them to diagnose
12154       // the function templates, and diagnose the non-template candidates
12155       // normally.
12156       for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = OvlExpr->decls_begin(),
12157                                  IEnd = OvlExpr->decls_end();
12158            I != IEnd; ++I)
12159         if (FunctionDecl *Fun =
12160                 dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()))
12161           if (!functionHasPassObjectSizeParams(Fun))
12162             S.NoteOverloadCandidate(*I, Fun, CRK_None, TargetFunctionType,
12163                                     /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12164       FailedCandidates.NoteCandidates(S, OvlExpr->getBeginLoc());
12165     }
12166   }
12167 
12168   bool IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12169     return TargetTypeIsNonStaticMemberFunction &&
12170       !OvlExprInfo.HasFormOfMemberPointer;
12171   }
12172 
12173   void ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction() const {
12174       // TODO: Should we condition this on whether any functions might
12175       // have matched, or is it more appropriate to do that in callers?
12176       // TODO: a fixit wouldn't hurt.
12177       S.Diag(OvlExpr->getNameLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_no_qualifier)
12178         << TargetType << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12179   }
12180 
12181   bool IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12182     return StaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer;
12183   }
12184 
12185   void ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer() const {
12186     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(),
12187            diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
12188         << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12189   }
12190 
12191   void ComplainOfInvalidConversion() const {
12192     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_not_func_ptrref)
12193         << OvlExpr->getName() << TargetType;
12194   }
12195 
12196   void ComplainMultipleMatchesFound() const {
12197     assert(Matches.size() > 1);
12198     S.Diag(OvlExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12199         << OvlExpr->getName() << OvlExpr->getSourceRange();
12200     S.NoteAllOverloadCandidates(OvlExpr, TargetFunctionType,
12201                                 /*TakingAddress=*/true);
12202   }
12203 
12204   bool hadMultipleCandidates() const { return (OvlExpr->getNumDecls() > 1); }
12205 
12206   int getNumMatches() const { return Matches.size(); }
12207 
12208   FunctionDecl* getMatchingFunctionDecl() const {
12209     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12210     return Matches[0].second;
12211   }
12212 
12213   const DeclAccessPair* getMatchingFunctionAccessPair() const {
12214     if (Matches.size() != 1) return nullptr;
12215     return &Matches[0].first;
12216   }
12217 };
12218 }
12219 
12220 /// ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction - Try to resolve the address of
12221 /// an overloaded function (C++ [over.over]), where @p From is an
12222 /// expression with overloaded function type and @p ToType is the type
12223 /// we're trying to resolve to. For example:
12224 ///
12225 /// @code
12226 /// int f(double);
12227 /// int f(int);
12228 ///
12229 /// int (*pfd)(double) = f; // selects f(double)
12230 /// @endcode
12231 ///
12232 /// This routine returns the resulting FunctionDecl if it could be
12233 /// resolved, and NULL otherwise. When @p Complain is true, this
12234 /// routine will emit diagnostics if there is an error.
12235 FunctionDecl *
12236 Sema::ResolveAddressOfOverloadedFunction(Expr *AddressOfExpr,
12237                                          QualType TargetType,
12238                                          bool Complain,
12239                                          DeclAccessPair &FoundResult,
12240                                          bool *pHadMultipleCandidates) {
12241   assert(AddressOfExpr->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12242 
12243   AddressOfFunctionResolver Resolver(*this, AddressOfExpr, TargetType,
12244                                      Complain);
12245   int NumMatches = Resolver.getNumMatches();
12246   FunctionDecl *Fn = nullptr;
12247   bool ShouldComplain = Complain && !Resolver.hasComplained();
12248   if (NumMatches == 0 && ShouldComplain) {
12249     if (Resolver.IsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction())
12250       Resolver.ComplainIsInvalidFormOfPointerToMemberFunction();
12251     else
12252       Resolver.ComplainNoMatchesFound();
12253   }
12254   else if (NumMatches > 1 && ShouldComplain)
12255     Resolver.ComplainMultipleMatchesFound();
12256   else if (NumMatches == 1) {
12257     Fn = Resolver.getMatchingFunctionDecl();
12258     assert(Fn);
12259     if (auto *FPT = Fn->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
12260       ResolveExceptionSpec(AddressOfExpr->getExprLoc(), FPT);
12261     FoundResult = *Resolver.getMatchingFunctionAccessPair();
12262     if (Complain) {
12263       if (Resolver.IsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer())
12264         Resolver.ComplainIsStaticMemberFunctionFromBoundPointer();
12265       else
12266         CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(AddressOfExpr, FoundResult);
12267     }
12268   }
12269 
12270   if (pHadMultipleCandidates)
12271     *pHadMultipleCandidates = Resolver.hadMultipleCandidates();
12272   return Fn;
12273 }
12274 
12275 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12276 /// resolve that function to a single function that can have its address taken.
12277 /// This will modify `Pair` iff it returns non-null.
12278 ///
12279 /// This routine can only succeed if from all of the candidates in the overload
12280 /// set for SrcExpr that can have their addresses taken, there is one candidate
12281 /// that is more constrained than the rest.
12282 FunctionDecl *
12283 Sema::resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair &Pair) {
12284   OverloadExpr::FindResult R = OverloadExpr::find(E);
12285   OverloadExpr *Ovl = R.Expression;
12286   bool IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12287   FunctionDecl *Result = nullptr;
12288   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12289   SmallVector<FunctionDecl *, 2> AmbiguousDecls;
12290 
12291   auto CheckMoreConstrained =
12292       [&] (FunctionDecl *FD1, FunctionDecl *FD2) -> Optional<bool> {
12293         SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> AC1, AC2;
12294         FD1->getAssociatedConstraints(AC1);
12295         FD2->getAssociatedConstraints(AC2);
12296         bool AtLeastAsConstrained1, AtLeastAsConstrained2;
12297         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD1, AC1, FD2, AC2, AtLeastAsConstrained1))
12298           return None;
12299         if (IsAtLeastAsConstrained(FD2, AC2, FD1, AC1, AtLeastAsConstrained2))
12300           return None;
12301         if (AtLeastAsConstrained1 == AtLeastAsConstrained2)
12302           return None;
12303         return AtLeastAsConstrained1;
12304       };
12305 
12306   // Don't use the AddressOfResolver because we're specifically looking for
12307   // cases where we have one overload candidate that lacks
12308   // enable_if/pass_object_size/...
12309   for (auto I = Ovl->decls_begin(), E = Ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12310     auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(I->getUnderlyingDecl());
12311     if (!FD)
12312       return nullptr;
12313 
12314     if (!checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD))
12315       continue;
12316 
12317     // We have more than one result - see if it is more constrained than the
12318     // previous one.
12319     if (Result) {
12320       Optional<bool> MoreConstrainedThanPrevious = CheckMoreConstrained(FD,
12321                                                                         Result);
12322       if (!MoreConstrainedThanPrevious) {
12323         IsResultAmbiguous = true;
12324         AmbiguousDecls.push_back(FD);
12325         continue;
12326       }
12327       if (!*MoreConstrainedThanPrevious)
12328         continue;
12329       // FD is more constrained - replace Result with it.
12330     }
12331     IsResultAmbiguous = false;
12332     DAP = I.getPair();
12333     Result = FD;
12334   }
12335 
12336   if (IsResultAmbiguous)
12337     return nullptr;
12338 
12339   if (Result) {
12340     SmallVector<const Expr *, 1> ResultAC;
12341     // We skipped over some ambiguous declarations which might be ambiguous with
12342     // the selected result.
12343     for (FunctionDecl *Skipped : AmbiguousDecls)
12344       if (!CheckMoreConstrained(Skipped, Result).hasValue())
12345         return nullptr;
12346     Pair = DAP;
12347   }
12348   return Result;
12349 }
12350 
12351 /// Given an overloaded function, tries to turn it into a non-overloaded
12352 /// function reference using resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate. This
12353 /// will perform access checks, diagnose the use of the resultant decl, and, if
12354 /// requested, potentially perform a function-to-pointer decay.
12355 ///
12356 /// Returns false if resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate fails.
12357 /// Otherwise, returns true. This may emit diagnostics and return true.
12358 bool Sema::resolveAndFixAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(
12359     ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool DoFunctionPointerConverion) {
12360   Expr *E = SrcExpr.get();
12361   assert(E->getType() == Context.OverloadTy && "SrcExpr must be an overload");
12362 
12363   DeclAccessPair DAP;
12364   FunctionDecl *Found = resolveAddressOfSingleOverloadCandidate(E, DAP);
12365   if (!Found || Found->isCPUDispatchMultiVersion() ||
12366       Found->isCPUSpecificMultiVersion())
12367     return false;
12368 
12369   // Emitting multiple diagnostics for a function that is both inaccessible and
12370   // unavailable is consistent with our behavior elsewhere. So, always check
12371   // for both.
12372   DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Found, E->getExprLoc());
12373   CheckAddressOfMemberAccess(E, DAP);
12374   Expr *Fixed = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, DAP, Found);
12375   if (DoFunctionPointerConverion && Fixed->getType()->isFunctionType())
12376     SrcExpr = DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Fixed, /*Diagnose=*/false);
12377   else
12378     SrcExpr = Fixed;
12379   return true;
12380 }
12381 
12382 /// Given an expression that refers to an overloaded function, try to
12383 /// resolve that overloaded function expression down to a single function.
12384 ///
12385 /// This routine can only resolve template-ids that refer to a single function
12386 /// template, where that template-id refers to a single template whose template
12387 /// arguments are either provided by the template-id or have defaults,
12388 /// as described in C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3.
12389 ///
12390 /// If no template-ids are found, no diagnostics are emitted and NULL is
12391 /// returned.
12392 FunctionDecl *
12393 Sema::ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(OverloadExpr *ovl,
12394                                                   bool Complain,
12395                                                   DeclAccessPair *FoundResult) {
12396   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12397   //   [...] [Note: any redundant set of parentheses surrounding the
12398   //   overloaded function name is ignored (5.1). ]
12399   // C++ [over.over]p1:
12400   //   [...] The overloaded function name can be preceded by the &
12401   //   operator.
12402 
12403   // If we didn't actually find any template-ids, we're done.
12404   if (!ovl->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
12405     return nullptr;
12406 
12407   TemplateArgumentListInfo ExplicitTemplateArgs;
12408   ovl->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12409   TemplateSpecCandidateSet FailedCandidates(ovl->getNameLoc());
12410 
12411   // Look through all of the overloaded functions, searching for one
12412   // whose type matches exactly.
12413   FunctionDecl *Matched = nullptr;
12414   for (UnresolvedSetIterator I = ovl->decls_begin(),
12415          E = ovl->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12416     // C++0x [temp.arg.explicit]p3:
12417     //   [...] In contexts where deduction is done and fails, or in contexts
12418     //   where deduction is not done, if a template argument list is
12419     //   specified and it, along with any default template arguments,
12420     //   identifies a single function template specialization, then the
12421     //   template-id is an lvalue for the function template specialization.
12422     FunctionTemplateDecl *FunctionTemplate
12423       = cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl());
12424 
12425     // C++ [over.over]p2:
12426     //   If the name is a function template, template argument deduction is
12427     //   done (14.8.2.2), and if the argument deduction succeeds, the
12428     //   resulting template argument list is used to generate a single
12429     //   function template specialization, which is added to the set of
12430     //   overloaded functions considered.
12431     FunctionDecl *Specialization = nullptr;
12432     TemplateDeductionInfo Info(FailedCandidates.getLocation());
12433     if (TemplateDeductionResult Result
12434           = DeduceTemplateArguments(FunctionTemplate, &ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12435                                     Specialization, Info,
12436                                     /*IsAddressOfFunction*/true)) {
12437       // Make a note of the failed deduction for diagnostics.
12438       // TODO: Actually use the failed-deduction info?
12439       FailedCandidates.addCandidate()
12440           .set(I.getPair(), FunctionTemplate->getTemplatedDecl(),
12441                MakeDeductionFailureInfo(Context, Result, Info));
12442       continue;
12443     }
12444 
12445     assert(Specialization && "no specialization and no error?");
12446 
12447     // Multiple matches; we can't resolve to a single declaration.
12448     if (Matched) {
12449       if (Complain) {
12450         Diag(ovl->getExprLoc(), diag::err_addr_ovl_ambiguous)
12451           << ovl->getName();
12452         NoteAllOverloadCandidates(ovl);
12453       }
12454       return nullptr;
12455     }
12456 
12457     Matched = Specialization;
12458     if (FoundResult) *FoundResult = I.getPair();
12459   }
12460 
12461   if (Matched &&
12462       completeFunctionType(*this, Matched, ovl->getExprLoc(), Complain))
12463     return nullptr;
12464 
12465   return Matched;
12466 }
12467 
12468 // Resolve and fix an overloaded expression that can be resolved
12469 // because it identifies a single function template specialization.
12470 //
12471 // Last three arguments should only be supplied if Complain = true
12472 //
12473 // Return true if it was logically possible to so resolve the
12474 // expression, regardless of whether or not it succeeded.  Always
12475 // returns true if 'complain' is set.
12476 bool Sema::ResolveAndFixSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12477                       ExprResult &SrcExpr, bool doFunctionPointerConverion,
12478                       bool complain, SourceRange OpRangeForComplaining,
12479                                            QualType DestTypeForComplaining,
12480                                             unsigned DiagIDForComplaining) {
12481   assert(SrcExpr.get()->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
12482 
12483   OverloadExpr::FindResult ovl = OverloadExpr::find(SrcExpr.get());
12484 
12485   DeclAccessPair found;
12486   ExprResult SingleFunctionExpression;
12487   if (FunctionDecl *fn = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(
12488                            ovl.Expression, /*complain*/ false, &found)) {
12489     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(fn, SrcExpr.get()->getBeginLoc())) {
12490       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12491       return true;
12492     }
12493 
12494     // It is only correct to resolve to an instance method if we're
12495     // resolving a form that's permitted to be a pointer to member.
12496     // Otherwise we'll end up making a bound member expression, which
12497     // is illegal in all the contexts we resolve like this.
12498     if (!ovl.HasFormOfMemberPointer &&
12499         isa<CXXMethodDecl>(fn) &&
12500         cast<CXXMethodDecl>(fn)->isInstance()) {
12501       if (!complain) return false;
12502 
12503       Diag(ovl.Expression->getExprLoc(),
12504            diag::err_bound_member_function)
12505         << 0 << ovl.Expression->getSourceRange();
12506 
12507       // TODO: I believe we only end up here if there's a mix of
12508       // static and non-static candidates (otherwise the expression
12509       // would have 'bound member' type, not 'overload' type).
12510       // Ideally we would note which candidate was chosen and why
12511       // the static candidates were rejected.
12512       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12513       return true;
12514     }
12515 
12516     // Fix the expression to refer to 'fn'.
12517     SingleFunctionExpression =
12518         FixOverloadedFunctionReference(SrcExpr.get(), found, fn);
12519 
12520     // If desired, do function-to-pointer decay.
12521     if (doFunctionPointerConverion) {
12522       SingleFunctionExpression =
12523         DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(SingleFunctionExpression.get());
12524       if (SingleFunctionExpression.isInvalid()) {
12525         SrcExpr = ExprError();
12526         return true;
12527       }
12528     }
12529   }
12530 
12531   if (!SingleFunctionExpression.isUsable()) {
12532     if (complain) {
12533       Diag(OpRangeForComplaining.getBegin(), DiagIDForComplaining)
12534         << ovl.Expression->getName()
12535         << DestTypeForComplaining
12536         << OpRangeForComplaining
12537         << ovl.Expression->getQualifierLoc().getSourceRange();
12538       NoteAllOverloadCandidates(SrcExpr.get());
12539 
12540       SrcExpr = ExprError();
12541       return true;
12542     }
12543 
12544     return false;
12545   }
12546 
12547   SrcExpr = SingleFunctionExpression;
12548   return true;
12549 }
12550 
12551 /// Add a single candidate to the overload set.
12552 static void AddOverloadedCallCandidate(Sema &S,
12553                                        DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
12554                                  TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12555                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12556                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12557                                        bool PartialOverloading,
12558                                        bool KnownValid) {
12559   NamedDecl *Callee = FoundDecl.getDecl();
12560   if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee))
12561     Callee = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Callee)->getTargetDecl();
12562 
12563   if (FunctionDecl *Func = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(Callee)) {
12564     if (ExplicitTemplateArgs) {
12565       assert(!KnownValid && "Explicit template arguments?");
12566       return;
12567     }
12568     // Prevent ill-formed function decls to be added as overload candidates.
12569     if (!dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(Func->getType()->getAs<FunctionType>()))
12570       return;
12571 
12572     S.AddOverloadCandidate(Func, FoundDecl, Args, CandidateSet,
12573                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12574                            PartialOverloading);
12575     return;
12576   }
12577 
12578   if (FunctionTemplateDecl *FuncTemplate
12579       = dyn_cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Callee)) {
12580     S.AddTemplateOverloadCandidate(FuncTemplate, FoundDecl,
12581                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, CandidateSet,
12582                                    /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false,
12583                                    PartialOverloading);
12584     return;
12585   }
12586 
12587   assert(!KnownValid && "unhandled case in overloaded call candidate");
12588 }
12589 
12590 /// Add the overload candidates named by callee and/or found by argument
12591 /// dependent lookup to the given overload set.
12592 void Sema::AddOverloadedCallCandidates(UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12593                                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12594                                        OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
12595                                        bool PartialOverloading) {
12596 
12597 #ifndef NDEBUG
12598   // Verify that ArgumentDependentLookup is consistent with the rules
12599   // in C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
12600   //
12601   //   Let X be the lookup set produced by unqualified lookup (3.4.1)
12602   //   and let Y be the lookup set produced by argument dependent
12603   //   lookup (defined as follows). If X contains
12604   //
12605   //     -- a declaration of a class member, or
12606   //
12607   //     -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
12608   //        using-declaration, or
12609   //
12610   //     -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
12611   //        template
12612   //
12613   //   then Y is empty.
12614 
12615   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12616     for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12617            E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
12618       assert(!(*I)->getDeclContext()->isRecord());
12619       assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(*I) ||
12620              !(*I)->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod());
12621       assert((*I)->getUnderlyingDecl()->isFunctionOrFunctionTemplate());
12622     }
12623   }
12624 #endif
12625 
12626   // It would be nice to avoid this copy.
12627   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12628   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12629   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12630     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12631     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12632   }
12633 
12634   for (UnresolvedLookupExpr::decls_iterator I = ULE->decls_begin(),
12635          E = ULE->decls_end(); I != E; ++I)
12636     AddOverloadedCallCandidate(*this, I.getPair(), ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12637                                CandidateSet, PartialOverloading,
12638                                /*KnownValid*/ true);
12639 
12640   if (ULE->requiresADL())
12641     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ULE->getName(), ULE->getExprLoc(),
12642                                          Args, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12643                                          CandidateSet, PartialOverloading);
12644 }
12645 
12646 /// Determine whether a declaration with the specified name could be moved into
12647 /// a different namespace.
12648 static bool canBeDeclaredInNamespace(const DeclarationName &Name) {
12649   switch (Name.getCXXOverloadedOperator()) {
12650   case OO_New: case OO_Array_New:
12651   case OO_Delete: case OO_Array_Delete:
12652     return false;
12653 
12654   default:
12655     return true;
12656   }
12657 }
12658 
12659 /// Attempt to recover from an ill-formed use of a non-dependent name in a
12660 /// template, where the non-dependent name was declared after the template
12661 /// was defined. This is common in code written for a compilers which do not
12662 /// correctly implement two-stage name lookup.
12663 ///
12664 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12665 static bool
12666 DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(Sema &SemaRef, SourceLocation FnLoc,
12667                        const CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
12668                        OverloadCandidateSet::CandidateSetKind CSK,
12669                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12670                        ArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12671                        bool *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = nullptr) {
12672   if (!SemaRef.inTemplateInstantiation() || !SS.isEmpty())
12673     return false;
12674 
12675   for (DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.CurContext; DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
12676     if (DC->isTransparentContext())
12677       continue;
12678 
12679     SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
12680 
12681     if (!R.empty()) {
12682       R.suppressDiagnostics();
12683 
12684       if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
12685         // Don't diagnose names we find in classes; we get much better
12686         // diagnostics for these from DiagnoseEmptyLookup.
12687         R.clear();
12688         if (DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup)
12689           *DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = true;
12690         return false;
12691       }
12692 
12693       OverloadCandidateSet Candidates(FnLoc, CSK);
12694       for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
12695         AddOverloadedCallCandidate(SemaRef, I.getPair(),
12696                                    ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args,
12697                                    Candidates, false, /*KnownValid*/ false);
12698 
12699       OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12700       if (Candidates.BestViableFunction(SemaRef, FnLoc, Best) != OR_Success) {
12701         // No viable functions. Don't bother the user with notes for functions
12702         // which don't work and shouldn't be found anyway.
12703         R.clear();
12704         return false;
12705       }
12706 
12707       // Find the namespaces where ADL would have looked, and suggest
12708       // declaring the function there instead.
12709       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet AssociatedNamespaces;
12710       Sema::AssociatedClassSet AssociatedClasses;
12711       SemaRef.FindAssociatedClassesAndNamespaces(FnLoc, Args,
12712                                                  AssociatedNamespaces,
12713                                                  AssociatedClasses);
12714       Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet SuggestedNamespaces;
12715       if (canBeDeclaredInNamespace(R.getLookupName())) {
12716         DeclContext *Std = SemaRef.getStdNamespace();
12717         for (Sema::AssociatedNamespaceSet::iterator
12718                it = AssociatedNamespaces.begin(),
12719                end = AssociatedNamespaces.end(); it != end; ++it) {
12720           // Never suggest declaring a function within namespace 'std'.
12721           if (Std && Std->Encloses(*it))
12722             continue;
12723 
12724           // Never suggest declaring a function within a namespace with a
12725           // reserved name, like __gnu_cxx.
12726           NamespaceDecl *NS = dyn_cast<NamespaceDecl>(*it);
12727           if (NS &&
12728               NS->getQualifiedNameAsString().find("__") != std::string::npos)
12729             continue;
12730 
12731           SuggestedNamespaces.insert(*it);
12732         }
12733       }
12734 
12735       SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12736         << R.getLookupName();
12737       if (SuggestedNamespaces.empty()) {
12738         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12739                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12740           << R.getLookupName() << 0;
12741       } else if (SuggestedNamespaces.size() == 1) {
12742         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12743                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12744           << R.getLookupName() << 1 << *SuggestedNamespaces.begin();
12745       } else {
12746         // FIXME: It would be useful to list the associated namespaces here,
12747         // but the diagnostics infrastructure doesn't provide a way to produce
12748         // a localized representation of a list of items.
12749         SemaRef.Diag(Best->Function->getLocation(),
12750                      diag::note_not_found_by_two_phase_lookup)
12751           << R.getLookupName() << 2;
12752       }
12753 
12754       // Try to recover by calling this function.
12755       return true;
12756     }
12757 
12758     R.clear();
12759   }
12760 
12761   return false;
12762 }
12763 
12764 /// Attempt to recover from ill-formed use of a non-dependent operator in a
12765 /// template, where the non-dependent operator was declared after the template
12766 /// was defined.
12767 ///
12768 /// Returns true if a viable candidate was found and a diagnostic was issued.
12769 static bool
12770 DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(Sema &SemaRef, OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
12771                                SourceLocation OpLoc,
12772                                ArrayRef<Expr *> Args) {
12773   DeclarationName OpName =
12774     SemaRef.Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
12775   LookupResult R(SemaRef, OpName, OpLoc, Sema::LookupOperatorName);
12776   return DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(SemaRef, OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec(), R,
12777                                 OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
12778                                 /*ExplicitTemplateArgs=*/nullptr, Args);
12779 }
12780 
12781 namespace {
12782 class BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII {
12783   Sema &SemaRef;
12784 public:
12785   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII(Sema &S) : SemaRef(S) {
12786     assert(SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr == false);
12787     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = true;
12788   }
12789 
12790   ~BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII() {
12791     SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr = false;
12792   }
12793 };
12794 
12795 }
12796 
12797 /// Attempts to recover from a call where no functions were found.
12798 static ExprResult
12799 BuildRecoveryCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12800                       UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12801                       SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12802                       MutableArrayRef<Expr *> Args,
12803                       SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12804                       bool EmptyLookup, bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
12805   // Do not try to recover if it is already building a recovery call.
12806   // This stops infinite loops for template instantiations like
12807   //
12808   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(t)) {}
12809   // template <typename T> auto foo(T t) -> decltype(foo(&t)) {}
12810   //
12811   if (SemaRef.IsBuildingRecoveryCallExpr)
12812     return ExprError();
12813   BuildRecoveryCallExprRAII RCE(SemaRef);
12814 
12815   CXXScopeSpec SS;
12816   SS.Adopt(ULE->getQualifierLoc());
12817   SourceLocation TemplateKWLoc = ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc();
12818 
12819   TemplateArgumentListInfo TABuffer;
12820   TemplateArgumentListInfo *ExplicitTemplateArgs = nullptr;
12821   if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
12822     ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TABuffer);
12823     ExplicitTemplateArgs = &TABuffer;
12824   }
12825 
12826   LookupResult R(SemaRef, ULE->getName(), ULE->getNameLoc(),
12827                  Sema::LookupOrdinaryName);
12828   bool DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup = EmptyLookup;
12829   if (!DiagnoseTwoPhaseLookup(
12830           SemaRef, Fn->getExprLoc(), SS, R, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal,
12831           ExplicitTemplateArgs, Args, &DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup)) {
12832     NoTypoCorrectionCCC NoTypoValidator{};
12833     FunctionCallFilterCCC FunctionCallValidator(SemaRef, Args.size(),
12834                                                 ExplicitTemplateArgs != nullptr,
12835                                                 dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(Fn));
12836     CorrectionCandidateCallback &Validator =
12837         AllowTypoCorrection
12838             ? static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(FunctionCallValidator)
12839             : static_cast<CorrectionCandidateCallback &>(NoTypoValidator);
12840     if (!DoDiagnoseEmptyLookup ||
12841         SemaRef.DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, Validator, ExplicitTemplateArgs,
12842                                     Args))
12843       return ExprError();
12844   }
12845 
12846   assert(!R.empty() && "lookup results empty despite recovery");
12847 
12848   // If recovery created an ambiguity, just bail out.
12849   if (R.isAmbiguous()) {
12850     R.suppressDiagnostics();
12851     return ExprError();
12852   }
12853 
12854   // Build an implicit member access expression if appropriate. Just drop the
12855   // casts and such from the call, we don't really care.
12856   ExprResult NewFn = ExprError();
12857   if ((*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember())
12858     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R,
12859                                                     ExplicitTemplateArgs, S);
12860   else if (ExplicitTemplateArgs || TemplateKWLoc.isValid())
12861     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, TemplateKWLoc, R, false,
12862                                         ExplicitTemplateArgs);
12863   else
12864     NewFn = SemaRef.BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
12865 
12866   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
12867     return ExprError();
12868 
12869   auto CallE =
12870       SemaRef.BuildCallExpr(/*Scope*/ nullptr, NewFn.get(), LParenLoc,
12871                             MultiExprArg(Args.data(), Args.size()), RParenLoc);
12872   if (CallE.isInvalid())
12873     return ExprError();
12874   // We now have recovered a callee. However, building a real call may lead to
12875   // incorrect secondary diagnostics if our recovery wasn't correct.
12876   // We keep the recovery behavior but suppress all following diagnostics by
12877   // using RecoveryExpr. We deliberately drop the return type of the recovery
12878   // function, and rely on clang's dependent mechanism to suppress following
12879   // diagnostics.
12880   return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(CallE.get()->getBeginLoc(),
12881                                     CallE.get()->getEndLoc(), {CallE.get()});
12882 }
12883 
12884 /// Constructs and populates an OverloadedCandidateSet from
12885 /// the given function.
12886 /// \returns true when an the ExprResult output parameter has been set.
12887 bool Sema::buildOverloadedCallSet(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12888                                   UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12889                                   MultiExprArg Args,
12890                                   SourceLocation RParenLoc,
12891                                   OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
12892                                   ExprResult *Result) {
12893 #ifndef NDEBUG
12894   if (ULE->requiresADL()) {
12895     // To do ADL, we must have found an unqualified name.
12896     assert(!ULE->getQualifier() && "qualified name with ADL");
12897 
12898     // We don't perform ADL for implicit declarations of builtins.
12899     // Verify that this was correctly set up.
12900     FunctionDecl *F;
12901     if (ULE->decls_begin() != ULE->decls_end() &&
12902         ULE->decls_begin() + 1 == ULE->decls_end() &&
12903         (F = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(*ULE->decls_begin())) &&
12904         F->getBuiltinID() && F->isImplicit())
12905       llvm_unreachable("performing ADL for builtin");
12906 
12907     // We don't perform ADL in C.
12908     assert(getLangOpts().CPlusPlus && "ADL enabled in C");
12909   }
12910 #endif
12911 
12912   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
12913   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts)) {
12914     *Result = ExprError();
12915     return true;
12916   }
12917 
12918   // Add the functions denoted by the callee to the set of candidate
12919   // functions, including those from argument-dependent lookup.
12920   AddOverloadedCallCandidates(ULE, Args, *CandidateSet);
12921 
12922   if (getLangOpts().MSVCCompat &&
12923       CurContext->isDependentContext() && !isSFINAEContext() &&
12924       (isa<FunctionDecl>(CurContext) || isa<CXXRecordDecl>(CurContext))) {
12925 
12926     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
12927     if (CandidateSet->empty() ||
12928         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best) ==
12929             OR_No_Viable_Function) {
12930       // In Microsoft mode, if we are inside a template class member function
12931       // then create a type dependent CallExpr. The goal is to postpone name
12932       // lookup to instantiation time to be able to search into type dependent
12933       // base classes.
12934       CallExpr *CE =
12935           CallExpr::Create(Context, Fn, Args, Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue,
12936                            RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
12937       CE->markDependentForPostponedNameLookup();
12938       *Result = CE;
12939       return true;
12940     }
12941   }
12942 
12943   if (CandidateSet->empty())
12944     return false;
12945 
12946   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
12947   return false;
12948 }
12949 
12950 // Guess at what the return type for an unresolvable overload should be.
12951 static QualType chooseRecoveryType(OverloadCandidateSet &CS,
12952                                    OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best) {
12953   llvm::Optional<QualType> Result;
12954   // Adjust Type after seeing a candidate.
12955   auto ConsiderCandidate = [&](const OverloadCandidate &Candidate) {
12956     if (!Candidate.Function)
12957       return;
12958     if (Candidate.Function->isInvalidDecl())
12959       return;
12960     QualType T = Candidate.Function->getReturnType();
12961     if (T.isNull())
12962       return;
12963     if (!Result)
12964       Result = T;
12965     else if (Result != T)
12966       Result = QualType();
12967   };
12968 
12969   // Look for an unambiguous type from a progressively larger subset.
12970   // e.g. if types disagree, but all *viable* overloads return int, choose int.
12971   //
12972   // First, consider only the best candidate.
12973   if (Best && *Best != CS.end())
12974     ConsiderCandidate(**Best);
12975   // Next, consider only viable candidates.
12976   if (!Result)
12977     for (const auto &C : CS)
12978       if (C.Viable)
12979         ConsiderCandidate(C);
12980   // Finally, consider all candidates.
12981   if (!Result)
12982     for (const auto &C : CS)
12983       ConsiderCandidate(C);
12984 
12985   if (!Result)
12986     return QualType();
12987   auto Value = Result.getValue();
12988   if (Value.isNull() || Value->isUndeducedType())
12989     return QualType();
12990   return Value;
12991 }
12992 
12993 /// FinishOverloadedCallExpr - given an OverloadCandidateSet, builds and returns
12994 /// the completed call expression. If overload resolution fails, emits
12995 /// diagnostics and returns ExprError()
12996 static ExprResult FinishOverloadedCallExpr(Sema &SemaRef, Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
12997                                            UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
12998                                            SourceLocation LParenLoc,
12999                                            MultiExprArg Args,
13000                                            SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13001                                            Expr *ExecConfig,
13002                                            OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
13003                                            OverloadCandidateSet::iterator *Best,
13004                                            OverloadingResult OverloadResult,
13005                                            bool AllowTypoCorrection) {
13006   if (CandidateSet->empty())
13007     return BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args,
13008                                  RParenLoc, /*EmptyLookup=*/true,
13009                                  AllowTypoCorrection);
13010 
13011   switch (OverloadResult) {
13012   case OR_Success: {
13013     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13014     SemaRef.CheckUnresolvedLookupAccess(ULE, (*Best)->FoundDecl);
13015     if (SemaRef.DiagnoseUseOfDecl(FDecl, ULE->getNameLoc()))
13016       return ExprError();
13017     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13018     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13019                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13020                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13021   }
13022 
13023   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13024     // Try to recover by looking for viable functions which the user might
13025     // have meant to call.
13026     ExprResult Recovery = BuildRecoveryCallExpr(SemaRef, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc,
13027                                                 Args, RParenLoc,
13028                                                 /*EmptyLookup=*/false,
13029                                                 AllowTypoCorrection);
13030     if (!Recovery.isInvalid())
13031       return Recovery;
13032 
13033     // If the user passes in a function that we can't take the address of, we
13034     // generally end up emitting really bad error messages. Here, we attempt to
13035     // emit better ones.
13036     for (const Expr *Arg : Args) {
13037       if (!Arg->getType()->isFunctionType())
13038         continue;
13039       if (auto *DRE = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(Arg->IgnoreParenImpCasts())) {
13040         auto *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
13041         if (FD &&
13042             !SemaRef.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(FD, /*Complain=*/true,
13043                                                        Arg->getExprLoc()))
13044           return ExprError();
13045       }
13046     }
13047 
13048     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13049         PartialDiagnosticAt(
13050             Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13051             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
13052                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13053         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13054     break;
13055   }
13056 
13057   case OR_Ambiguous:
13058     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13059         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13060                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
13061                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13062         SemaRef, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
13063     break;
13064 
13065   case OR_Deleted: {
13066     CandidateSet->NoteCandidates(
13067         PartialDiagnosticAt(Fn->getBeginLoc(),
13068                             SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_call)
13069                                 << ULE->getName() << Fn->getSourceRange()),
13070         SemaRef, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
13071 
13072     // We emitted an error for the unavailable/deleted function call but keep
13073     // the call in the AST.
13074     FunctionDecl *FDecl = (*Best)->Function;
13075     Fn = SemaRef.FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Fn, (*Best)->FoundDecl, FDecl);
13076     return SemaRef.BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, FDecl, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13077                                          ExecConfig, /*IsExecConfig=*/false,
13078                                          (*Best)->IsADLCandidate);
13079   }
13080   }
13081 
13082   // Overload resolution failed, try to recover.
13083   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> SubExprs = {Fn};
13084   SubExprs.append(Args.begin(), Args.end());
13085   return SemaRef.CreateRecoveryExpr(Fn->getBeginLoc(), RParenLoc, SubExprs,
13086                                     chooseRecoveryType(*CandidateSet, Best));
13087 }
13088 
13089 static void markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(Sema &S,
13090                                                 OverloadCandidateSet &CS) {
13091   for (auto I = CS.begin(), E = CS.end(); I != E; ++I) {
13092     if (I->Viable &&
13093         !S.checkAddressOfFunctionIsAvailable(I->Function, /*Complain=*/false)) {
13094       I->Viable = false;
13095       I->FailureKind = ovl_fail_addr_not_available;
13096     }
13097   }
13098 }
13099 
13100 /// BuildOverloadedCallExpr - Given the call expression that calls Fn
13101 /// (which eventually refers to the declaration Func) and the call
13102 /// arguments Args/NumArgs, attempt to resolve the function call down
13103 /// to a specific function. If overload resolution succeeds, returns
13104 /// the call expression produced by overload resolution.
13105 /// Otherwise, emits diagnostics and returns ExprError.
13106 ExprResult Sema::BuildOverloadedCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn,
13107                                          UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE,
13108                                          SourceLocation LParenLoc,
13109                                          MultiExprArg Args,
13110                                          SourceLocation RParenLoc,
13111                                          Expr *ExecConfig,
13112                                          bool AllowTypoCorrection,
13113                                          bool CalleesAddressIsTaken) {
13114   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Fn->getExprLoc(),
13115                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
13116   ExprResult result;
13117 
13118   if (buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, ULE, Args, LParenLoc, &CandidateSet,
13119                              &result))
13120     return result;
13121 
13122   // If the user handed us something like `(&Foo)(Bar)`, we need to ensure that
13123   // functions that aren't addressible are considered unviable.
13124   if (CalleesAddressIsTaken)
13125     markUnaddressableCandidatesUnviable(*this, CandidateSet);
13126 
13127   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13128   OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
13129       CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
13130 
13131   return FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc,
13132                                   ExecConfig, &CandidateSet, &Best,
13133                                   OverloadResult, AllowTypoCorrection);
13134 }
13135 
13136 static bool IsOverloaded(const UnresolvedSetImpl &Functions) {
13137   return Functions.size() > 1 ||
13138          (Functions.size() == 1 &&
13139           isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>((*Functions.begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
13140 }
13141 
13142 ExprResult Sema::CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass,
13143                                             NestedNameSpecifierLoc NNSLoc,
13144                                             DeclarationNameInfo DNI,
13145                                             const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13146                                             bool PerformADL) {
13147   return UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, NamingClass, NNSLoc, DNI,
13148                                       PerformADL, IsOverloaded(Fns),
13149                                       Fns.begin(), Fns.end());
13150 }
13151 
13152 /// Create a unary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13153 /// operator.
13154 ///
13155 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '*').
13156 ///
13157 /// \param Opc The UnaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13158 ///
13159 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13160 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13161 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13162 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13163 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13164 /// by CreateOverloadedUnaryOp().
13165 ///
13166 /// \param Input The input argument.
13167 ExprResult
13168 Sema::CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc, UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
13169                               const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13170                               Expr *Input, bool PerformADL) {
13171   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13172   assert(Op != OO_None && "Invalid opcode for overloaded unary operator");
13173   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13174   // TODO: provide better source location info.
13175   DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13176 
13177   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Input))
13178     return ExprError();
13179 
13180   Expr *Args[2] = { Input, nullptr };
13181   unsigned NumArgs = 1;
13182 
13183   // For post-increment and post-decrement, add the implicit '0' as
13184   // the second argument, so that we know this is a post-increment or
13185   // post-decrement.
13186   if (Opc == UO_PostInc || Opc == UO_PostDec) {
13187     llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13188     Args[1] = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy,
13189                                      SourceLocation());
13190     NumArgs = 2;
13191   }
13192 
13193   ArrayRef<Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, NumArgs);
13194 
13195   if (Input->isTypeDependent()) {
13196     if (Fns.empty())
13197       return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, Input, Opc, Context.DependentTy,
13198                                    VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, false,
13199                                    CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13200 
13201     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13202     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13203         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns);
13204     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13205       return ExprError();
13206     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), ArgsArray,
13207                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13208                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13209   }
13210 
13211   // Build an empty overload set.
13212   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
13213 
13214   // Add the candidates from the given function set.
13215   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13216 
13217   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13218   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13219 
13220   // Add candidates from ADL.
13221   if (PerformADL) {
13222     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, ArgsArray,
13223                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/nullptr,
13224                                          CandidateSet);
13225   }
13226 
13227   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13228   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray, CandidateSet);
13229 
13230   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13231 
13232   // Perform overload resolution.
13233   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13234   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13235   case OR_Success: {
13236     // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13237     FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13238 
13239     if (FnDecl) {
13240       Expr *Base = nullptr;
13241       // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13242       // operator.
13243 
13244       // Convert the arguments.
13245       if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13246         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
13247 
13248         ExprResult InputRes =
13249           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Input, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13250                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13251         if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13252           return ExprError();
13253         Base = Input = InputRes.get();
13254       } else {
13255         // Convert the arguments.
13256         ExprResult InputInit
13257           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
13258                                                       Context,
13259                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13260                                       SourceLocation(),
13261                                       Input);
13262         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
13263           return ExprError();
13264         Input = InputInit.get();
13265       }
13266 
13267       // Build the actual expression node.
13268       ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl, Best->FoundDecl,
13269                                                 Base, HadMultipleCandidates,
13270                                                 OpLoc);
13271       if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13272         return ExprError();
13273 
13274       // Determine the result type.
13275       QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13276       ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13277       ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13278 
13279       Args[0] = Input;
13280       CallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13281           Context, Op, FnExpr.get(), ArgsArray, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13282           CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13283 
13284       if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
13285         return ExprError();
13286 
13287       if (CheckFunctionCall(FnDecl, TheCall,
13288                             FnDecl->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
13289         return ExprError();
13290       return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), FnDecl);
13291     } else {
13292       // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13293       // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13294       // operator node.
13295       ExprResult InputRes = PerformImplicitConversion(
13296           Input, Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0], AA_Passing,
13297           CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13298       if (InputRes.isInvalid())
13299         return ExprError();
13300       Input = InputRes.get();
13301       break;
13302     }
13303   }
13304 
13305   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
13306     // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13307     // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13308     // defined too late to be candidates.
13309     if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, ArgsArray))
13310       // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13311       return ExprError();
13312 
13313     // No viable function; fall through to handling this as a
13314     // built-in operator, which will produce an error message for us.
13315     break;
13316 
13317   case OR_Ambiguous:
13318     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13319         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc,
13320                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
13321                                 << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13322                                 << Input->getType() << Input->getSourceRange()),
13323         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, ArgsArray,
13324         UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc), OpLoc);
13325     return ExprError();
13326 
13327   case OR_Deleted:
13328     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13329         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13330                                        << UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13331                                        << Input->getSourceRange()),
13332         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, ArgsArray, UnaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13333         OpLoc);
13334     return ExprError();
13335   }
13336 
13337   // Either we found no viable overloaded operator or we matched a
13338   // built-in operator. In either case, fall through to trying to
13339   // build a built-in operation.
13340   return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
13341 }
13342 
13343 /// Perform lookup for an overloaded binary operator.
13344 void Sema::LookupOverloadedBinOp(OverloadCandidateSet &CandidateSet,
13345                                  OverloadedOperatorKind Op,
13346                                  const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns,
13347                                  ArrayRef<Expr *> Args, bool PerformADL) {
13348   SourceLocation OpLoc = CandidateSet.getLocation();
13349 
13350   OverloadedOperatorKind ExtraOp =
13351       CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().AllowRewrittenCandidates
13352           ? getRewrittenOverloadedOperator(Op)
13353           : OO_None;
13354 
13355   // Add the candidates from the given function set. This also adds the
13356   // rewritten candidates using these functions if necessary.
13357   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(Fns, Args, CandidateSet);
13358 
13359   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13360   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13361   if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(Op))
13362     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]}, CandidateSet,
13363                                 OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13364 
13365   // In C++20, also add any rewritten member candidates.
13366   if (ExtraOp) {
13367     AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13368     if (CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().shouldAddReversed(ExtraOp))
13369       AddMemberOperatorCandidates(ExtraOp, OpLoc, {Args[1], Args[0]},
13370                                   CandidateSet,
13371                                   OverloadCandidateParamOrder::Reversed);
13372   }
13373 
13374   // Add candidates from ADL. Per [over.match.oper]p2, this lookup is not
13375   // performed for an assignment operator (nor for operator[] nor operator->,
13376   // which don't get here).
13377   if (Op != OO_Equal && PerformADL) {
13378     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13379     AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(OpName, OpLoc, Args,
13380                                          /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13381                                          CandidateSet);
13382     if (ExtraOp) {
13383       DeclarationName ExtraOpName =
13384           Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(ExtraOp);
13385       AddArgumentDependentLookupCandidates(ExtraOpName, OpLoc, Args,
13386                                            /*ExplicitTemplateArgs*/ nullptr,
13387                                            CandidateSet);
13388     }
13389   }
13390 
13391   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13392   //
13393   // FIXME: We don't add any rewritten candidates here. This is strictly
13394   // incorrect; a builtin candidate could be hidden by a non-viable candidate,
13395   // resulting in our selecting a rewritten builtin candidate. For example:
13396   //
13397   //   enum class E { e };
13398   //   bool operator!=(E, E) requires false;
13399   //   bool k = E::e != E::e;
13400   //
13401   // ... should select the rewritten builtin candidate 'operator==(E, E)'. But
13402   // it seems unreasonable to consider rewritten builtin candidates. A core
13403   // issue has been filed proposing to removed this requirement.
13404   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(Op, OpLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13405 }
13406 
13407 /// Create a binary operation that may resolve to an overloaded
13408 /// operator.
13409 ///
13410 /// \param OpLoc The location of the operator itself (e.g., '+').
13411 ///
13412 /// \param Opc The BinaryOperatorKind that describes this operator.
13413 ///
13414 /// \param Fns The set of non-member functions that will be
13415 /// considered by overload resolution. The caller needs to build this
13416 /// set based on the context using, e.g.,
13417 /// LookupOverloadedOperatorName() and ArgumentDependentLookup(). This
13418 /// set should not contain any member functions; those will be added
13419 /// by CreateOverloadedBinOp().
13420 ///
13421 /// \param LHS Left-hand argument.
13422 /// \param RHS Right-hand argument.
13423 /// \param PerformADL Whether to consider operator candidates found by ADL.
13424 /// \param AllowRewrittenCandidates Whether to consider candidates found by
13425 ///        C++20 operator rewrites.
13426 /// \param DefaultedFn If we are synthesizing a defaulted operator function,
13427 ///        the function in question. Such a function is never a candidate in
13428 ///        our overload resolution. This also enables synthesizing a three-way
13429 ///        comparison from < and == as described in C++20 [class.spaceship]p1.
13430 ExprResult Sema::CreateOverloadedBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
13431                                        BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
13432                                        const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS,
13433                                        Expr *RHS, bool PerformADL,
13434                                        bool AllowRewrittenCandidates,
13435                                        FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13436   Expr *Args[2] = { LHS, RHS };
13437   LHS=RHS=nullptr; // Please use only Args instead of LHS/RHS couple
13438 
13439   if (!getLangOpts().CPlusPlus20)
13440     AllowRewrittenCandidates = false;
13441 
13442   OverloadedOperatorKind Op = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
13443 
13444   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
13445   // expression.
13446   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
13447     if (Fns.empty()) {
13448       // If there are no functions to store, just build a dependent
13449       // BinaryOperator or CompoundAssignment.
13450       if (BinaryOperator::isCompoundAssignmentOp(Opc))
13451         return CompoundAssignOperator::Create(
13452             Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc, Context.DependentTy, VK_LValue,
13453             OK_Ordinary, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Context.DependentTy,
13454             Context.DependentTy);
13455       return BinaryOperator::Create(Context, Args[0], Args[1], Opc,
13456                                     Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
13457                                     OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13458     }
13459 
13460     // FIXME: save results of ADL from here?
13461     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13462     // TODO: provide better source location info in DNLoc component.
13463     DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(Op);
13464     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, OpLoc);
13465     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13466         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, Fns, PerformADL);
13467     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13468       return ExprError();
13469     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, Op, Fn.get(), Args,
13470                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, OpLoc,
13471                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13472   }
13473 
13474   // Always do placeholder-like conversions on the RHS.
13475   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
13476     return ExprError();
13477 
13478   // Do placeholder-like conversion on the LHS; note that we should
13479   // not get here with a PseudoObject LHS.
13480   assert(Args[0]->getObjectKind() != OK_ObjCProperty);
13481   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
13482     return ExprError();
13483 
13484   // If this is the assignment operator, we only perform overload resolution
13485   // if the left-hand side is a class or enumeration type. This is actually
13486   // a hack. The standard requires that we do overload resolution between the
13487   // various built-in candidates, but as DR507 points out, this can lead to
13488   // problems. So we do it this way, which pretty much follows what GCC does.
13489   // Note that we go the traditional code path for compound assignment forms.
13490   if (Opc == BO_Assign && !Args[0]->getType()->isOverloadableType())
13491     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13492 
13493   // If this is the .* operator, which is not overloadable, just
13494   // create a built-in binary operator.
13495   if (Opc == BO_PtrMemD)
13496     return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13497 
13498   // Build the overload set.
13499   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(
13500       OpLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator,
13501       OverloadCandidateSet::OperatorRewriteInfo(Op, AllowRewrittenCandidates));
13502   if (DefaultedFn)
13503     CandidateSet.exclude(DefaultedFn);
13504   LookupOverloadedBinOp(CandidateSet, Op, Fns, Args, PerformADL);
13505 
13506   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13507 
13508   // Perform overload resolution.
13509   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13510   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
13511     case OR_Success: {
13512       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13513       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13514 
13515       bool IsReversed = Best->isReversed();
13516       if (IsReversed)
13517         std::swap(Args[0], Args[1]);
13518 
13519       if (FnDecl) {
13520         Expr *Base = nullptr;
13521         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13522         // operator.
13523 
13524         OverloadedOperatorKind ChosenOp =
13525             FnDecl->getDeclName().getCXXOverloadedOperator();
13526 
13527         // C++2a [over.match.oper]p9:
13528         //   If a rewritten operator== candidate is selected by overload
13529         //   resolution for an operator@, its return type shall be cv bool
13530         if (Best->RewriteKind && ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual &&
13531             !FnDecl->getReturnType()->isBooleanType()) {
13532           bool IsExtension =
13533               FnDecl->getReturnType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType();
13534           Diag(OpLoc, IsExtension ? diag::ext_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool
13535                                   : diag::err_ovl_rewrite_equalequal_not_bool)
13536               << FnDecl->getReturnType() << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13537               << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13538           Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
13539           if (!IsExtension)
13540             return ExprError();
13541         }
13542 
13543         if (AllowRewrittenCandidates && !IsReversed &&
13544             CandidateSet.getRewriteInfo().isReversible()) {
13545           // We could have reversed this operator, but didn't. Check if some
13546           // reversed form was a viable candidate, and if so, if it had a
13547           // better conversion for either parameter. If so, this call is
13548           // formally ambiguous, and allowing it is an extension.
13549           llvm::SmallVector<FunctionDecl*, 4> AmbiguousWith;
13550           for (OverloadCandidate &Cand : CandidateSet) {
13551             if (Cand.Viable && Cand.Function && Cand.isReversed() &&
13552                 haveSameParameterTypes(Context, Cand.Function, FnDecl, 2)) {
13553               for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0; ArgIdx < 2; ++ArgIdx) {
13554                 if (CompareImplicitConversionSequences(
13555                         *this, OpLoc, Cand.Conversions[ArgIdx],
13556                         Best->Conversions[ArgIdx]) ==
13557                     ImplicitConversionSequence::Better) {
13558                   AmbiguousWith.push_back(Cand.Function);
13559                   break;
13560                 }
13561               }
13562             }
13563           }
13564 
13565           if (!AmbiguousWith.empty()) {
13566             bool AmbiguousWithSelf =
13567                 AmbiguousWith.size() == 1 &&
13568                 declaresSameEntity(AmbiguousWith.front(), FnDecl);
13569             Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed)
13570                 << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13571                 << Args[0]->getType() << Args[1]->getType() << AmbiguousWithSelf
13572                 << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13573             if (AmbiguousWithSelf) {
13574               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13575                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_self);
13576             } else {
13577               Diag(FnDecl->getLocation(),
13578                    diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_selected_candidate);
13579               for (auto *F : AmbiguousWith)
13580                 Diag(F->getLocation(),
13581                      diag::note_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary_reversed_candidate);
13582             }
13583           }
13584         }
13585 
13586         // Convert the arguments.
13587         if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13588           // Best->Access is only meaningful for class members.
13589           CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
13590 
13591           ExprResult Arg1 =
13592             PerformCopyInitialization(
13593               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13594                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13595               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13596           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13597             return ExprError();
13598 
13599           ExprResult Arg0 =
13600             PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13601                                                 Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13602           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13603             return ExprError();
13604           Base = Args[0] = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13605           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13606         } else {
13607           // Convert the arguments.
13608           ExprResult Arg0 = PerformCopyInitialization(
13609             InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13610                                                    FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13611             SourceLocation(), Args[0]);
13612           if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13613             return ExprError();
13614 
13615           ExprResult Arg1 =
13616             PerformCopyInitialization(
13617               InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
13618                                                      FnDecl->getParamDecl(1)),
13619               SourceLocation(), Args[1]);
13620           if (Arg1.isInvalid())
13621             return ExprError();
13622           Args[0] = LHS = Arg0.getAs<Expr>();
13623           Args[1] = RHS = Arg1.getAs<Expr>();
13624         }
13625 
13626         // Build the actual expression node.
13627         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
13628                                                   Best->FoundDecl, Base,
13629                                                   HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
13630         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
13631           return ExprError();
13632 
13633         // Determine the result type.
13634         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
13635         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
13636         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
13637 
13638         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
13639             Context, ChosenOp, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, OpLoc,
13640             CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Best->IsADLCandidate);
13641 
13642         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall,
13643                                 FnDecl))
13644           return ExprError();
13645 
13646         ArrayRef<const Expr *> ArgsArray(Args, 2);
13647         const Expr *ImplicitThis = nullptr;
13648         // Cut off the implicit 'this'.
13649         if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl)) {
13650           ImplicitThis = ArgsArray[0];
13651           ArgsArray = ArgsArray.slice(1);
13652         }
13653 
13654         // Check for a self move.
13655         if (Op == OO_Equal)
13656           DiagnoseSelfMove(Args[0], Args[1], OpLoc);
13657 
13658         checkCall(FnDecl, nullptr, ImplicitThis, ArgsArray,
13659                   isa<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl), OpLoc, TheCall->getSourceRange(),
13660                   VariadicDoesNotApply);
13661 
13662         ExprResult R = MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
13663         if (R.isInvalid())
13664           return ExprError();
13665 
13666         R = CheckForImmediateInvocation(R, FnDecl);
13667         if (R.isInvalid())
13668           return ExprError();
13669 
13670         // For a rewritten candidate, we've already reversed the arguments
13671         // if needed. Perform the rest of the rewrite now.
13672         if ((Best->RewriteKind & CRK_DifferentOperator) ||
13673             (Op == OO_Spaceship && IsReversed)) {
13674           if (Op == OO_ExclaimEqual) {
13675             assert(ChosenOp == OO_EqualEqual && "unexpected operator name");
13676             R = CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, UO_LNot, R.get());
13677           } else {
13678             assert(ChosenOp == OO_Spaceship && "unexpected operator name");
13679             llvm::APSInt Zero(Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy), false);
13680             Expr *ZeroLiteral =
13681                 IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, Zero, Context.IntTy, OpLoc);
13682 
13683             Sema::CodeSynthesisContext Ctx;
13684             Ctx.Kind = Sema::CodeSynthesisContext::RewritingOperatorAsSpaceship;
13685             Ctx.Entity = FnDecl;
13686             pushCodeSynthesisContext(Ctx);
13687 
13688             R = CreateOverloadedBinOp(
13689                 OpLoc, Opc, Fns, IsReversed ? ZeroLiteral : R.get(),
13690                 IsReversed ? R.get() : ZeroLiteral, PerformADL,
13691                 /*AllowRewrittenCandidates=*/false);
13692 
13693             popCodeSynthesisContext();
13694           }
13695           if (R.isInvalid())
13696             return ExprError();
13697         } else {
13698           assert(ChosenOp == Op && "unexpected operator name");
13699         }
13700 
13701         // Make a note in the AST if we did any rewriting.
13702         if (Best->RewriteKind != CRK_None)
13703           R = new (Context) CXXRewrittenBinaryOperator(R.get(), IsReversed);
13704 
13705         return R;
13706       } else {
13707         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
13708         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
13709         // operator node.
13710         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13711             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
13712             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13713         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
13714           return ExprError();
13715         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
13716 
13717         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
13718             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
13719             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
13720         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
13721           return ExprError();
13722         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
13723         break;
13724       }
13725     }
13726 
13727     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
13728       // C++ [over.match.oper]p9:
13729       //   If the operator is the operator , [...] and there are no
13730       //   viable functions, then the operator is assumed to be the
13731       //   built-in operator and interpreted according to clause 5.
13732       if (Opc == BO_Comma)
13733         break;
13734 
13735       // When defaulting an 'operator<=>', we can try to synthesize a three-way
13736       // compare result using '==' and '<'.
13737       if (DefaultedFn && Opc == BO_Cmp) {
13738         ExprResult E = BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(OpLoc, Fns, Args[0],
13739                                                           Args[1], DefaultedFn);
13740         if (E.isInvalid() || E.isUsable())
13741           return E;
13742       }
13743 
13744       // For class as left operand for assignment or compound assignment
13745       // operator do not fall through to handling in built-in, but report that
13746       // no overloaded assignment operator found
13747       ExprResult Result = ExprError();
13748       StringRef OpcStr = BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc);
13749       auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates,
13750                                                    Args, OpLoc);
13751       if (Args[0]->getType()->isRecordType() &&
13752           Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign) {
13753         Diag(OpLoc,  diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
13754              << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13755              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13756         if (Args[0]->getType()->isIncompleteType()) {
13757           Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_assign_lhs_incomplete)
13758             << Args[0]->getType()
13759             << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange();
13760         }
13761       } else {
13762         // This is an erroneous use of an operator which can be overloaded by
13763         // a non-member function. Check for non-member operators which were
13764         // defined too late to be candidates.
13765         if (DiagnoseTwoPhaseOperatorLookup(*this, Op, OpLoc, Args))
13766           // FIXME: Recover by calling the found function.
13767           return ExprError();
13768 
13769         // No viable function; try to create a built-in operation, which will
13770         // produce an error. Then, show the non-viable candidates.
13771         Result = CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13772       }
13773       assert(Result.isInvalid() &&
13774              "C++ binary operator overloading is missing candidates!");
13775       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Args, Cands, OpcStr, OpLoc);
13776       return Result;
13777     }
13778 
13779     case OR_Ambiguous:
13780       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13781           PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
13782                                          << BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc)
13783                                          << Args[0]->getType()
13784                                          << Args[1]->getType()
13785                                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13786                                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13787           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13788           OpLoc);
13789       return ExprError();
13790 
13791     case OR_Deleted:
13792       if (isImplicitlyDeleted(Best->Function)) {
13793         FunctionDecl *DeletedFD = Best->Function;
13794         DefaultedFunctionKind DFK = getDefaultedFunctionKind(DeletedFD);
13795         if (DFK.isSpecialMember()) {
13796           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_special_oper)
13797             << Args[0]->getType() << DFK.asSpecialMember();
13798         } else {
13799           assert(DFK.isComparison());
13800           Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_deleted_comparison)
13801             << Args[0]->getType() << DeletedFD;
13802         }
13803 
13804         // The user probably meant to call this special member. Just
13805         // explain why it's deleted.
13806         NoteDeletedFunction(DeletedFD);
13807         return ExprError();
13808       }
13809       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
13810           PartialDiagnosticAt(
13811               OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
13812                          << getOperatorSpelling(Best->Function->getDeclName()
13813                                                     .getCXXOverloadedOperator())
13814                          << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
13815                          << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
13816           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, BinaryOperator::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
13817           OpLoc);
13818       return ExprError();
13819   }
13820 
13821   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
13822   return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Args[0], Args[1]);
13823 }
13824 
13825 ExprResult Sema::BuildSynthesizedThreeWayComparison(
13826     SourceLocation OpLoc, const UnresolvedSetImpl &Fns, Expr *LHS, Expr *RHS,
13827     FunctionDecl *DefaultedFn) {
13828   const ComparisonCategoryInfo *Info =
13829       Context.CompCategories.lookupInfoForType(DefaultedFn->getReturnType());
13830   // If we're not producing a known comparison category type, we can't
13831   // synthesize a three-way comparison. Let the caller diagnose this.
13832   if (!Info)
13833     return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13834 
13835   // If we ever want to perform this synthesis more generally, we will need to
13836   // apply the temporary materialization conversion to the operands.
13837   assert(LHS->isGLValue() && RHS->isGLValue() &&
13838          "cannot use prvalue expressions more than once");
13839   Expr *OrigLHS = LHS;
13840   Expr *OrigRHS = RHS;
13841 
13842   // Replace the LHS and RHS with OpaqueValueExprs; we're going to refer to
13843   // each of them multiple times below.
13844   LHS = new (Context)
13845       OpaqueValueExpr(LHS->getExprLoc(), LHS->getType(), LHS->getValueKind(),
13846                       LHS->getObjectKind(), LHS);
13847   RHS = new (Context)
13848       OpaqueValueExpr(RHS->getExprLoc(), RHS->getType(), RHS->getValueKind(),
13849                       RHS->getObjectKind(), RHS);
13850 
13851   ExprResult Eq = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_EQ, Fns, LHS, RHS, true, true,
13852                                         DefaultedFn);
13853   if (Eq.isInvalid())
13854     return ExprError();
13855 
13856   ExprResult Less = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, LHS, RHS, true,
13857                                           true, DefaultedFn);
13858   if (Less.isInvalid())
13859     return ExprError();
13860 
13861   ExprResult Greater;
13862   if (Info->isPartial()) {
13863     Greater = CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, BO_LT, Fns, RHS, LHS, true, true,
13864                                     DefaultedFn);
13865     if (Greater.isInvalid())
13866       return ExprError();
13867   }
13868 
13869   // Form the list of comparisons we're going to perform.
13870   struct Comparison {
13871     ExprResult Cmp;
13872     ComparisonCategoryResult Result;
13873   } Comparisons[4] =
13874   { {Eq, Info->isStrong() ? ComparisonCategoryResult::Equal
13875                           : ComparisonCategoryResult::Equivalent},
13876     {Less, ComparisonCategoryResult::Less},
13877     {Greater, ComparisonCategoryResult::Greater},
13878     {ExprResult(), ComparisonCategoryResult::Unordered},
13879   };
13880 
13881   int I = Info->isPartial() ? 3 : 2;
13882 
13883   // Combine the comparisons with suitable conditional expressions.
13884   ExprResult Result;
13885   for (; I >= 0; --I) {
13886     // Build a reference to the comparison category constant.
13887     auto *VI = Info->lookupValueInfo(Comparisons[I].Result);
13888     // FIXME: Missing a constant for a comparison category. Diagnose this?
13889     if (!VI)
13890       return ExprResult((Expr*)nullptr);
13891     ExprResult ThisResult =
13892         BuildDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec(), DeclarationNameInfo(), VI->VD);
13893     if (ThisResult.isInvalid())
13894       return ExprError();
13895 
13896     // Build a conditional unless this is the final case.
13897     if (Result.get()) {
13898       Result = ActOnConditionalOp(OpLoc, OpLoc, Comparisons[I].Cmp.get(),
13899                                   ThisResult.get(), Result.get());
13900       if (Result.isInvalid())
13901         return ExprError();
13902     } else {
13903       Result = ThisResult;
13904     }
13905   }
13906 
13907   // Build a PseudoObjectExpr to model the rewriting of an <=> operator, and to
13908   // bind the OpaqueValueExprs before they're (repeatedly) used.
13909   Expr *SyntacticForm = BinaryOperator::Create(
13910       Context, OrigLHS, OrigRHS, BO_Cmp, Result.get()->getType(),
13911       Result.get()->getValueKind(), Result.get()->getObjectKind(), OpLoc,
13912       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13913   Expr *SemanticForm[] = {LHS, RHS, Result.get()};
13914   return PseudoObjectExpr::Create(Context, SyntacticForm, SemanticForm, 2);
13915 }
13916 
13917 ExprResult
13918 Sema::CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(SourceLocation LLoc,
13919                                          SourceLocation RLoc,
13920                                          Expr *Base, Expr *Idx) {
13921   Expr *Args[2] = { Base, Idx };
13922   DeclarationName OpName =
13923       Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Subscript);
13924 
13925   // If either side is type-dependent, create an appropriate dependent
13926   // expression.
13927   if (Args[0]->isTypeDependent() || Args[1]->isTypeDependent()) {
13928 
13929     CXXRecordDecl *NamingClass = nullptr; // lookup ignores member operators
13930     // CHECKME: no 'operator' keyword?
13931     DeclarationNameInfo OpNameInfo(OpName, LLoc);
13932     OpNameInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
13933     ExprResult Fn = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(
13934         NamingClass, NestedNameSpecifierLoc(), OpNameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
13935     if (Fn.isInvalid())
13936       return ExprError();
13937     // Can't add any actual overloads yet
13938 
13939     return CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Subscript, Fn.get(), Args,
13940                                        Context.DependentTy, VK_RValue, RLoc,
13941                                        CurFPFeatureOverrides());
13942   }
13943 
13944   // Handle placeholders on both operands.
13945   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[0]))
13946     return ExprError();
13947   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Args[1]))
13948     return ExprError();
13949 
13950   // Build an empty overload set.
13951   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LLoc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
13952 
13953   // Subscript can only be overloaded as a member function.
13954 
13955   // Add operator candidates that are member functions.
13956   AddMemberOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13957 
13958   // Add builtin operator candidates.
13959   AddBuiltinOperatorCandidates(OO_Subscript, LLoc, Args, CandidateSet);
13960 
13961   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
13962 
13963   // Perform overload resolution.
13964   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
13965   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, LLoc, Best)) {
13966     case OR_Success: {
13967       // We found a built-in operator or an overloaded operator.
13968       FunctionDecl *FnDecl = Best->Function;
13969 
13970       if (FnDecl) {
13971         // We matched an overloaded operator. Build a call to that
13972         // operator.
13973 
13974         CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LLoc, Args[0], Args[1], Best->FoundDecl);
13975 
13976         // Convert the arguments.
13977         CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(FnDecl);
13978         ExprResult Arg0 =
13979           PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Args[0], /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
13980                                               Best->FoundDecl, Method);
13981         if (Arg0.isInvalid())
13982           return ExprError();
13983         Args[0] = Arg0.get();
13984 
13985         // Convert the arguments.
13986         ExprResult InputInit
13987           = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
13988                                                       Context,
13989                                                       FnDecl->getParamDecl(0)),
13990                                       SourceLocation(),
13991                                       Args[1]);
13992         if (InputInit.isInvalid())
13993           return ExprError();
13994 
13995         Args[1] = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
13996 
13997         // Build the actual expression node.
13998         DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(OpName, LLoc);
13999         OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LLoc, RLoc));
14000         ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FnDecl,
14001                                                   Best->FoundDecl,
14002                                                   Base,
14003                                                   HadMultipleCandidates,
14004                                                   OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14005                                                   OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14006         if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14007           return ExprError();
14008 
14009         // Determine the result type
14010         QualType ResultTy = FnDecl->getReturnType();
14011         ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14012         ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14013 
14014         CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14015             Context, OO_Subscript, FnExpr.get(), Args, ResultTy, VK, RLoc,
14016             CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14017         if (CheckCallReturnType(FnDecl->getReturnType(), LLoc, TheCall, FnDecl))
14018           return ExprError();
14019 
14020         if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14021                               Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14022           return ExprError();
14023 
14024         return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14025       } else {
14026         // We matched a built-in operator. Convert the arguments, then
14027         // break out so that we will build the appropriate built-in
14028         // operator node.
14029         ExprResult ArgsRes0 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14030             Args[0], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[0], Best->Conversions[0],
14031             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14032         if (ArgsRes0.isInvalid())
14033           return ExprError();
14034         Args[0] = ArgsRes0.get();
14035 
14036         ExprResult ArgsRes1 = PerformImplicitConversion(
14037             Args[1], Best->BuiltinParamTypes[1], Best->Conversions[1],
14038             AA_Passing, CCK_ForBuiltinOverloadedOp);
14039         if (ArgsRes1.isInvalid())
14040           return ExprError();
14041         Args[1] = ArgsRes1.get();
14042 
14043         break;
14044       }
14045     }
14046 
14047     case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14048       PartialDiagnostic PD = CandidateSet.empty()
14049           ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14050              << Args[0]->getType() << /*subscript*/ 0
14051              << Args[0]->getSourceRange() << Args[1]->getSourceRange())
14052           : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_subscript)
14053              << Args[0]->getType() << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14054              << Args[1]->getSourceRange());
14055       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PD), *this,
14056                                   OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14057       return ExprError();
14058     }
14059 
14060     case OR_Ambiguous:
14061       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14062           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_binary)
14063                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getType()
14064                                         << Args[1]->getType()
14065                                         << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14066                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14067           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14068       return ExprError();
14069 
14070     case OR_Deleted:
14071       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14072           PartialDiagnosticAt(LLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14073                                         << "[]" << Args[0]->getSourceRange()
14074                                         << Args[1]->getSourceRange()),
14075           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args, "[]", LLoc);
14076       return ExprError();
14077     }
14078 
14079   // We matched a built-in operator; build it.
14080   return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Args[0], LLoc, Args[1], RLoc);
14081 }
14082 
14083 /// BuildCallToMemberFunction - Build a call to a member
14084 /// function. MemExpr is the expression that refers to the member
14085 /// function (and includes the object parameter), Args/NumArgs are the
14086 /// arguments to the function call (not including the object
14087 /// parameter). The caller needs to validate that the member
14088 /// expression refers to a non-static member function or an overloaded
14089 /// member function.
14090 ExprResult
14091 Sema::BuildCallToMemberFunction(Scope *S, Expr *MemExprE,
14092                                 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14093                                 MultiExprArg Args,
14094                                 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
14095   assert(MemExprE->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy ||
14096          MemExprE->getType() == Context.OverloadTy);
14097 
14098   // Dig out the member expression. This holds both the object
14099   // argument and the member function we're referring to.
14100   Expr *NakedMemExpr = MemExprE->IgnoreParens();
14101 
14102   // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
14103   if (BinaryOperator *op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14104     assert(op->getType() == Context.BoundMemberTy);
14105     assert(op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD || op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI);
14106 
14107     QualType fnType =
14108       op->getRHS()->getType()->castAs<MemberPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14109 
14110     const FunctionProtoType *proto = fnType->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14111     QualType resultType = proto->getCallResultType(Context);
14112     ExprValueKind valueKind = Expr::getValueKindForType(proto->getReturnType());
14113 
14114     // Check that the object type isn't more qualified than the
14115     // member function we're calling.
14116     Qualifiers funcQuals = proto->getMethodQuals();
14117 
14118     QualType objectType = op->getLHS()->getType();
14119     if (op->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI)
14120       objectType = objectType->castAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
14121     Qualifiers objectQuals = objectType.getQualifiers();
14122 
14123     Qualifiers difference = objectQuals - funcQuals;
14124     difference.removeObjCGCAttr();
14125     difference.removeAddressSpace();
14126     if (difference) {
14127       std::string qualsString = difference.getAsString();
14128       Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_pointer_to_member_call_drops_quals)
14129         << fnType.getUnqualifiedType()
14130         << qualsString
14131         << (qualsString.find(' ') == std::string::npos ? 1 : 2);
14132     }
14133 
14134     CXXMemberCallExpr *call = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14135         Context, MemExprE, Args, resultType, valueKind, RParenLoc,
14136         CurFPFeatureOverrides(), proto->getNumParams());
14137 
14138     if (CheckCallReturnType(proto->getReturnType(), op->getRHS()->getBeginLoc(),
14139                             call, nullptr))
14140       return ExprError();
14141 
14142     if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(call, op, nullptr, proto, Args, RParenLoc))
14143       return ExprError();
14144 
14145     if (CheckOtherCall(call, proto))
14146       return ExprError();
14147 
14148     return MaybeBindToTemporary(call);
14149   }
14150 
14151   if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(NakedMemExpr))
14152     return CallExpr::Create(Context, MemExprE, Args, Context.VoidTy, VK_RValue,
14153                             RParenLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14154 
14155   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14156   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14157     return ExprError();
14158 
14159   MemberExpr *MemExpr;
14160   CXXMethodDecl *Method = nullptr;
14161   DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = DeclAccessPair::make(nullptr, AS_public);
14162   NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = nullptr;
14163   if (isa<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14164     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14165     Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemExpr->getMemberDecl());
14166     FoundDecl = MemExpr->getFoundDecl();
14167     Qualifier = MemExpr->getQualifier();
14168     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14169   } else {
14170     UnresolvedMemberExpr *UnresExpr = cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr);
14171     Qualifier = UnresExpr->getQualifier();
14172 
14173     QualType ObjectType = UnresExpr->getBaseType();
14174     Expr::Classification ObjectClassification
14175       = UnresExpr->isArrow()? Expr::Classification::makeSimpleLValue()
14176                             : UnresExpr->getBase()->Classify(Context);
14177 
14178     // Add overload candidates
14179     OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14180                                       OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14181 
14182     // FIXME: avoid copy.
14183     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
14184     if (UnresExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
14185       UnresExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
14186       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
14187     }
14188 
14189     for (UnresolvedMemberExpr::decls_iterator I = UnresExpr->decls_begin(),
14190            E = UnresExpr->decls_end(); I != E; ++I) {
14191 
14192       NamedDecl *Func = *I;
14193       CXXRecordDecl *ActingDC = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Func->getDeclContext());
14194       if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(Func))
14195         Func = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(Func)->getTargetDecl();
14196 
14197 
14198       // Microsoft supports direct constructor calls.
14199       if (getLangOpts().MicrosoftExt && isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func)) {
14200         AddOverloadCandidate(cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), Args,
14201                              CandidateSet,
14202                              /*SuppressUserConversions*/ false);
14203       } else if ((Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Func))) {
14204         // If explicit template arguments were provided, we can't call a
14205         // non-template member function.
14206         if (TemplateArgs)
14207           continue;
14208 
14209         AddMethodCandidate(Method, I.getPair(), ActingDC, ObjectType,
14210                            ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14211                            /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14212       } else {
14213         AddMethodTemplateCandidate(
14214             cast<FunctionTemplateDecl>(Func), I.getPair(), ActingDC,
14215             TemplateArgs, ObjectType, ObjectClassification, Args, CandidateSet,
14216             /*SuppressUserConversions=*/false);
14217       }
14218     }
14219 
14220     DeclarationName DeclName = UnresExpr->getMemberName();
14221 
14222     UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14223 
14224     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14225     switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UnresExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14226                                             Best)) {
14227     case OR_Success:
14228       Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14229       FoundDecl = Best->FoundDecl;
14230       CheckUnresolvedMemberAccess(UnresExpr, Best->FoundDecl);
14231       if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14232         return ExprError();
14233       // If FoundDecl is different from Method (such as if one is a template
14234       // and the other a specialization), make sure DiagnoseUseOfDecl is
14235       // called on both.
14236       // FIXME: This would be more comprehensively addressed by modifying
14237       // DiagnoseUseOfDecl to accept both the FoundDecl and the decl
14238       // being used.
14239       if (Method != FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14240                       DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Method, UnresExpr->getNameLoc()))
14241         return ExprError();
14242       break;
14243 
14244     case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14245       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14246           PartialDiagnosticAt(
14247               UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14248               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14249                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14250           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14251       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
14252       return ExprError();
14253 
14254     case OR_Ambiguous:
14255       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14256           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14257                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_member_call)
14258                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14259           *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14260       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
14261       return ExprError();
14262 
14263     case OR_Deleted:
14264       CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14265           PartialDiagnosticAt(UnresExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14266                               PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_member_call)
14267                                   << DeclName << MemExprE->getSourceRange()),
14268           *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14269       // FIXME: Leaking incoming expressions!
14270       return ExprError();
14271     }
14272 
14273     MemExprE = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(MemExprE, FoundDecl, Method);
14274 
14275     // If overload resolution picked a static member, build a
14276     // non-member call based on that function.
14277     if (Method->isStatic()) {
14278       return BuildResolvedCallExpr(MemExprE, Method, LParenLoc, Args,
14279                                    RParenLoc);
14280     }
14281 
14282     MemExpr = cast<MemberExpr>(MemExprE->IgnoreParens());
14283   }
14284 
14285   QualType ResultType = Method->getReturnType();
14286   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultType);
14287   ResultType = ResultType.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14288 
14289   assert(Method && "Member call to something that isn't a method?");
14290   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14291   CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall = CXXMemberCallExpr::Create(
14292       Context, MemExprE, Args, ResultType, VK, RParenLoc,
14293       CurFPFeatureOverrides(), Proto->getNumParams());
14294 
14295   // Check for a valid return type.
14296   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), MemExpr->getMemberLoc(),
14297                           TheCall, Method))
14298     return ExprError();
14299 
14300   // Convert the object argument (for a non-static member function call).
14301   // We only need to do this if there was actually an overload; otherwise
14302   // it was done at lookup.
14303   if (!Method->isStatic()) {
14304     ExprResult ObjectArg =
14305       PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(MemExpr->getBase(), Qualifier,
14306                                           FoundDecl, Method);
14307     if (ObjectArg.isInvalid())
14308       return ExprError();
14309     MemExpr->setBase(ObjectArg.get());
14310   }
14311 
14312   // Convert the rest of the arguments
14313   if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, MemExpr, Method, Proto, Args,
14314                               RParenLoc))
14315     return ExprError();
14316 
14317   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14318 
14319   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14320     return ExprError();
14321 
14322   // In the case the method to call was not selected by the overloading
14323   // resolution process, we still need to handle the enable_if attribute. Do
14324   // that here, so it will not hide previous -- and more relevant -- errors.
14325   if (auto *MemE = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedMemExpr)) {
14326     if (const EnableIfAttr *Attr =
14327             CheckEnableIf(Method, LParenLoc, Args, true)) {
14328       Diag(MemE->getMemberLoc(),
14329            diag::err_ovl_no_viable_member_function_in_call)
14330           << Method << Method->getSourceRange();
14331       Diag(Method->getLocation(),
14332            diag::note_ovl_candidate_disabled_by_function_cond_attr)
14333           << Attr->getCond()->getSourceRange() << Attr->getMessage();
14334       return ExprError();
14335     }
14336   }
14337 
14338   if ((isa<CXXConstructorDecl>(CurContext) ||
14339        isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)) &&
14340       TheCall->getMethodDecl()->isPure()) {
14341     const CXXMethodDecl *MD = TheCall->getMethodDecl();
14342 
14343     if (isa<CXXThisExpr>(MemExpr->getBase()->IgnoreParenCasts()) &&
14344         MemExpr->performsVirtualDispatch(getLangOpts())) {
14345       Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(),
14346            diag::warn_call_to_pure_virtual_member_function_from_ctor_dtor)
14347           << MD->getDeclName() << isa<CXXDestructorDecl>(CurContext)
14348           << MD->getParent();
14349 
14350       Diag(MD->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_previous_decl) << MD->getDeclName();
14351       if (getLangOpts().AppleKext)
14352         Diag(MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), diag::note_pure_qualified_call_kext)
14353             << MD->getParent() << MD->getDeclName();
14354     }
14355   }
14356 
14357   if (CXXDestructorDecl *DD =
14358           dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(TheCall->getMethodDecl())) {
14359     // a->A::f() doesn't go through the vtable, except in AppleKext mode.
14360     bool CallCanBeVirtual = !MemExpr->hasQualifier() || getLangOpts().AppleKext;
14361     CheckVirtualDtorCall(DD, MemExpr->getBeginLoc(), /*IsDelete=*/false,
14362                          CallCanBeVirtual, /*WarnOnNonAbstractTypes=*/true,
14363                          MemExpr->getMemberLoc());
14364   }
14365 
14366   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall),
14367                                      TheCall->getMethodDecl());
14368 }
14369 
14370 /// BuildCallToObjectOfClassType - Build a call to an object of class
14371 /// type (C++ [over.call.object]), which can end up invoking an
14372 /// overloaded function call operator (@c operator()) or performing a
14373 /// user-defined conversion on the object argument.
14374 ExprResult
14375 Sema::BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(Scope *S, Expr *Obj,
14376                                    SourceLocation LParenLoc,
14377                                    MultiExprArg Args,
14378                                    SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
14379   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Obj))
14380     return ExprError();
14381   ExprResult Object = Obj;
14382 
14383   UnbridgedCastsSet UnbridgedCasts;
14384   if (checkArgPlaceholdersForOverload(*this, Args, UnbridgedCasts))
14385     return ExprError();
14386 
14387   assert(Object.get()->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14388          "Requires object type argument");
14389 
14390   // C++ [over.call.object]p1:
14391   //  If the primary-expression E in the function call syntax
14392   //  evaluates to a class object of type "cv T", then the set of
14393   //  candidate functions includes at least the function call
14394   //  operators of T. The function call operators of T are obtained by
14395   //  ordinary lookup of the name operator() in the context of
14396   //  (E).operator().
14397   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(LParenLoc,
14398                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14399   DeclarationName OpName = Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call);
14400 
14401   if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Object.get()->getType(),
14402                           diag::err_incomplete_object_call, Object.get()))
14403     return true;
14404 
14405   const auto *Record = Object.get()->getType()->castAs<RecordType>();
14406   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, LParenLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14407   LookupQualifiedName(R, Record->getDecl());
14408   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14409 
14410   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14411        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14412     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Object.get()->getType(),
14413                        Object.get()->Classify(Context), Args, CandidateSet,
14414                        /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14415   }
14416 
14417   // C++ [over.call.object]p2:
14418   //   In addition, for each (non-explicit in C++0x) conversion function
14419   //   declared in T of the form
14420   //
14421   //        operator conversion-type-id () cv-qualifier;
14422   //
14423   //   where cv-qualifier is the same cv-qualification as, or a
14424   //   greater cv-qualification than, cv, and where conversion-type-id
14425   //   denotes the type "pointer to function of (P1,...,Pn) returning
14426   //   R", or the type "reference to pointer to function of
14427   //   (P1,...,Pn) returning R", or the type "reference to function
14428   //   of (P1,...,Pn) returning R", a surrogate call function [...]
14429   //   is also considered as a candidate function. Similarly,
14430   //   surrogate call functions are added to the set of candidate
14431   //   functions for each conversion function declared in an
14432   //   accessible base class provided the function is not hidden
14433   //   within T by another intervening declaration.
14434   const auto &Conversions =
14435       cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Record->getDecl())->getVisibleConversionFunctions();
14436   for (auto I = Conversions.begin(), E = Conversions.end(); I != E; ++I) {
14437     NamedDecl *D = *I;
14438     CXXRecordDecl *ActingContext = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
14439     if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
14440       D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
14441 
14442     // Skip over templated conversion functions; they aren't
14443     // surrogates.
14444     if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
14445       continue;
14446 
14447     CXXConversionDecl *Conv = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(D);
14448     if (!Conv->isExplicit()) {
14449       // Strip the reference type (if any) and then the pointer type (if
14450       // any) to get down to what might be a function type.
14451       QualType ConvType = Conv->getConversionType().getNonReferenceType();
14452       if (const PointerType *ConvPtrType = ConvType->getAs<PointerType>())
14453         ConvType = ConvPtrType->getPointeeType();
14454 
14455       if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = ConvType->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
14456       {
14457         AddSurrogateCandidate(Conv, I.getPair(), ActingContext, Proto,
14458                               Object.get(), Args, CandidateSet);
14459       }
14460     }
14461   }
14462 
14463   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14464 
14465   // Perform overload resolution.
14466   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14467   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14468                                           Best)) {
14469   case OR_Success:
14470     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the appropriate call
14471     // below.
14472     break;
14473 
14474   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14475     PartialDiagnostic PD =
14476         CandidateSet.empty()
14477             ? (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_oper)
14478                << Object.get()->getType() << /*call*/ 1
14479                << Object.get()->getSourceRange())
14480             : (PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_object_call)
14481                << Object.get()->getType() << Object.get()->getSourceRange());
14482     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14483         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(), PD), *this,
14484         OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14485     break;
14486   }
14487   case OR_Ambiguous:
14488     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14489         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14490                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_object_call)
14491                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14492                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14493         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14494     break;
14495 
14496   case OR_Deleted:
14497     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14498         PartialDiagnosticAt(Object.get()->getBeginLoc(),
14499                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_object_call)
14500                                 << Object.get()->getType()
14501                                 << Object.get()->getSourceRange()),
14502         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14503     break;
14504   }
14505 
14506   if (Best == CandidateSet.end())
14507     return true;
14508 
14509   UnbridgedCasts.restore();
14510 
14511   if (Best->Function == nullptr) {
14512     // Since there is no function declaration, this is one of the
14513     // surrogate candidates. Dig out the conversion function.
14514     CXXConversionDecl *Conv
14515       = cast<CXXConversionDecl>(
14516                          Best->Conversions[0].UserDefined.ConversionFunction);
14517 
14518     CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr,
14519                               Best->FoundDecl);
14520     if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Best->FoundDecl, LParenLoc))
14521       return ExprError();
14522     assert(Conv == Best->FoundDecl.getDecl() &&
14523              "Found Decl & conversion-to-functionptr should be same, right?!");
14524     // We selected one of the surrogate functions that converts the
14525     // object parameter to a function pointer. Perform the conversion
14526     // on the object argument, then let BuildCallExpr finish the job.
14527 
14528     // Create an implicit member expr to refer to the conversion operator.
14529     // and then call it.
14530     ExprResult Call = BuildCXXMemberCallExpr(Object.get(), Best->FoundDecl,
14531                                              Conv, HadMultipleCandidates);
14532     if (Call.isInvalid())
14533       return ExprError();
14534     // Record usage of conversion in an implicit cast.
14535     Call = ImplicitCastExpr::Create(
14536         Context, Call.get()->getType(), CK_UserDefinedConversion, Call.get(),
14537         nullptr, VK_RValue, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14538 
14539     return BuildCallExpr(S, Call.get(), LParenLoc, Args, RParenLoc);
14540   }
14541 
14542   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(LParenLoc, Object.get(), nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14543 
14544   // We found an overloaded operator(). Build a CXXOperatorCallExpr
14545   // that calls this method, using Object for the implicit object
14546   // parameter and passing along the remaining arguments.
14547   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14548 
14549   // An error diagnostic has already been printed when parsing the declaration.
14550   if (Method->isInvalidDecl())
14551     return ExprError();
14552 
14553   const auto *Proto = Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>();
14554   unsigned NumParams = Proto->getNumParams();
14555 
14556   DeclarationNameInfo OpLocInfo(
14557                Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Call), LParenLoc);
14558   OpLocInfo.setCXXOperatorNameRange(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
14559   ExprResult NewFn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14560                                            Obj, HadMultipleCandidates,
14561                                            OpLocInfo.getLoc(),
14562                                            OpLocInfo.getInfo());
14563   if (NewFn.isInvalid())
14564     return true;
14565 
14566   // The number of argument slots to allocate in the call. If we have default
14567   // arguments we need to allocate space for them as well. We additionally
14568   // need one more slot for the object parameter.
14569   unsigned NumArgsSlots = 1 + std::max<unsigned>(Args.size(), NumParams);
14570 
14571   // Build the full argument list for the method call (the implicit object
14572   // parameter is placed at the beginning of the list).
14573   SmallVector<Expr *, 8> MethodArgs(NumArgsSlots);
14574 
14575   bool IsError = false;
14576 
14577   // Initialize the implicit object parameter.
14578   ExprResult ObjRes =
14579     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Object.get(), /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14580                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14581   if (ObjRes.isInvalid())
14582     IsError = true;
14583   else
14584     Object = ObjRes;
14585   MethodArgs[0] = Object.get();
14586 
14587   // Check the argument types.
14588   for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumParams; i++) {
14589     Expr *Arg;
14590     if (i < Args.size()) {
14591       Arg = Args[i];
14592 
14593       // Pass the argument.
14594 
14595       ExprResult InputInit
14596         = PerformCopyInitialization(InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(
14597                                                     Context,
14598                                                     Method->getParamDecl(i)),
14599                                     SourceLocation(), Arg);
14600 
14601       IsError |= InputInit.isInvalid();
14602       Arg = InputInit.getAs<Expr>();
14603     } else {
14604       ExprResult DefArg
14605         = BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(LParenLoc, Method, Method->getParamDecl(i));
14606       if (DefArg.isInvalid()) {
14607         IsError = true;
14608         break;
14609       }
14610 
14611       Arg = DefArg.getAs<Expr>();
14612     }
14613 
14614     MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg;
14615   }
14616 
14617   // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
14618   if (Proto->isVariadic()) {
14619     // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
14620     for (unsigned i = NumParams, e = Args.size(); i < e; i++) {
14621       ExprResult Arg = DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Args[i], VariadicMethod,
14622                                                         nullptr);
14623       IsError |= Arg.isInvalid();
14624       MethodArgs[i + 1] = Arg.get();
14625     }
14626   }
14627 
14628   if (IsError)
14629     return true;
14630 
14631   DiagnoseSentinelCalls(Method, LParenLoc, Args);
14632 
14633   // Once we've built TheCall, all of the expressions are properly owned.
14634   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14635   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14636   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14637 
14638   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall = CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(
14639       Context, OO_Call, NewFn.get(), MethodArgs, ResultTy, VK, RParenLoc,
14640       CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14641 
14642   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), LParenLoc, TheCall, Method))
14643     return true;
14644 
14645   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall, Proto))
14646     return true;
14647 
14648   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall), Method);
14649 }
14650 
14651 /// BuildOverloadedArrowExpr - Build a call to an overloaded @c operator->
14652 ///  (if one exists), where @c Base is an expression of class type and
14653 /// @c Member is the name of the member we're trying to find.
14654 ExprResult
14655 Sema::BuildOverloadedArrowExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation OpLoc,
14656                                bool *NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14657   assert(Base->getType()->isRecordType() &&
14658          "left-hand side must have class type");
14659 
14660   if (checkPlaceholderForOverload(*this, Base))
14661     return ExprError();
14662 
14663   SourceLocation Loc = Base->getExprLoc();
14664 
14665   // C++ [over.ref]p1:
14666   //
14667   //   [...] An expression x->m is interpreted as (x.operator->())->m
14668   //   for a class object x of type T if T::operator->() exists and if
14669   //   the operator is selected as the best match function by the
14670   //   overload resolution mechanism (13.3).
14671   DeclarationName OpName =
14672     Context.DeclarationNames.getCXXOperatorName(OO_Arrow);
14673   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(Loc, OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Operator);
14674 
14675   if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, Base->getType(),
14676                           diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag, Base))
14677     return ExprError();
14678 
14679   LookupResult R(*this, OpName, OpLoc, LookupOrdinaryName);
14680   LookupQualifiedName(R, Base->getType()->castAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
14681   R.suppressDiagnostics();
14682 
14683   for (LookupResult::iterator Oper = R.begin(), OperEnd = R.end();
14684        Oper != OperEnd; ++Oper) {
14685     AddMethodCandidate(Oper.getPair(), Base->getType(), Base->Classify(Context),
14686                        None, CandidateSet, /*SuppressUserConversion=*/false);
14687   }
14688 
14689   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14690 
14691   // Perform overload resolution.
14692   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14693   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, OpLoc, Best)) {
14694   case OR_Success:
14695     // Overload resolution succeeded; we'll build the call below.
14696     break;
14697 
14698   case OR_No_Viable_Function: {
14699     auto Cands = CandidateSet.CompleteCandidates(*this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14700     if (CandidateSet.empty()) {
14701       QualType BaseType = Base->getType();
14702       if (NoArrowOperatorFound) {
14703         // Report this specific error to the caller instead of emitting a
14704         // diagnostic, as requested.
14705         *NoArrowOperatorFound = true;
14706         return ExprError();
14707       }
14708       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
14709         << BaseType << Base->getSourceRange();
14710       if (BaseType->isRecordType() && !BaseType->isPointerType()) {
14711         Diag(OpLoc, diag::note_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
14712           << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
14713       }
14714     } else
14715       Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ovl_no_viable_oper)
14716         << "operator->" << Base->getSourceRange();
14717     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(*this, Base, Cands);
14718     return ExprError();
14719   }
14720   case OR_Ambiguous:
14721     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14722         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_oper_unary)
14723                                        << "->" << Base->getType()
14724                                        << Base->getSourceRange()),
14725         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Base);
14726     return ExprError();
14727 
14728   case OR_Deleted:
14729     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14730         PartialDiagnosticAt(OpLoc, PDiag(diag::err_ovl_deleted_oper)
14731                                        << "->" << Base->getSourceRange()),
14732         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Base);
14733     return ExprError();
14734   }
14735 
14736   CheckMemberOperatorAccess(OpLoc, Base, nullptr, Best->FoundDecl);
14737 
14738   // Convert the object parameter.
14739   CXXMethodDecl *Method = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Best->Function);
14740   ExprResult BaseResult =
14741     PerformObjectArgumentInitialization(Base, /*Qualifier=*/nullptr,
14742                                         Best->FoundDecl, Method);
14743   if (BaseResult.isInvalid())
14744     return ExprError();
14745   Base = BaseResult.get();
14746 
14747   // Build the operator call.
14748   ExprResult FnExpr = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, Method, Best->FoundDecl,
14749                                             Base, HadMultipleCandidates, OpLoc);
14750   if (FnExpr.isInvalid())
14751     return ExprError();
14752 
14753   QualType ResultTy = Method->getReturnType();
14754   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14755   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14756   CXXOperatorCallExpr *TheCall =
14757       CXXOperatorCallExpr::Create(Context, OO_Arrow, FnExpr.get(), Base,
14758                                   ResultTy, VK, OpLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14759 
14760   if (CheckCallReturnType(Method->getReturnType(), OpLoc, TheCall, Method))
14761     return ExprError();
14762 
14763   if (CheckFunctionCall(Method, TheCall,
14764                         Method->getType()->castAs<FunctionProtoType>()))
14765     return ExprError();
14766 
14767   return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
14768 }
14769 
14770 /// BuildLiteralOperatorCall - Build a UserDefinedLiteral by creating a call to
14771 /// a literal operator described by the provided lookup results.
14772 ExprResult Sema::BuildLiteralOperatorCall(LookupResult &R,
14773                                           DeclarationNameInfo &SuffixInfo,
14774                                           ArrayRef<Expr*> Args,
14775                                           SourceLocation LitEndLoc,
14776                                        TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
14777   SourceLocation UDSuffixLoc = SuffixInfo.getCXXLiteralOperatorNameLoc();
14778 
14779   OverloadCandidateSet CandidateSet(UDSuffixLoc,
14780                                     OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14781   AddNonMemberOperatorCandidates(R.asUnresolvedSet(), Args, CandidateSet,
14782                                  TemplateArgs);
14783 
14784   bool HadMultipleCandidates = (CandidateSet.size() > 1);
14785 
14786   // Perform overload resolution. This will usually be trivial, but might need
14787   // to perform substitutions for a literal operator template.
14788   OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14789   switch (CandidateSet.BestViableFunction(*this, UDSuffixLoc, Best)) {
14790   case OR_Success:
14791   case OR_Deleted:
14792     break;
14793 
14794   case OR_No_Viable_Function:
14795     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14796         PartialDiagnosticAt(UDSuffixLoc,
14797                             PDiag(diag::err_ovl_no_viable_function_in_call)
14798                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14799         *this, OCD_AllCandidates, Args);
14800     return ExprError();
14801 
14802   case OR_Ambiguous:
14803     CandidateSet.NoteCandidates(
14804         PartialDiagnosticAt(R.getNameLoc(), PDiag(diag::err_ovl_ambiguous_call)
14805                                                 << R.getLookupName()),
14806         *this, OCD_AmbiguousCandidates, Args);
14807     return ExprError();
14808   }
14809 
14810   FunctionDecl *FD = Best->Function;
14811   ExprResult Fn = CreateFunctionRefExpr(*this, FD, Best->FoundDecl,
14812                                         nullptr, HadMultipleCandidates,
14813                                         SuffixInfo.getLoc(),
14814                                         SuffixInfo.getInfo());
14815   if (Fn.isInvalid())
14816     return true;
14817 
14818   // Check the argument types. This should almost always be a no-op, except
14819   // that array-to-pointer decay is applied to string literals.
14820   Expr *ConvArgs[2];
14821   for (unsigned ArgIdx = 0, N = Args.size(); ArgIdx != N; ++ArgIdx) {
14822     ExprResult InputInit = PerformCopyInitialization(
14823       InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, FD->getParamDecl(ArgIdx)),
14824       SourceLocation(), Args[ArgIdx]);
14825     if (InputInit.isInvalid())
14826       return true;
14827     ConvArgs[ArgIdx] = InputInit.get();
14828   }
14829 
14830   QualType ResultTy = FD->getReturnType();
14831   ExprValueKind VK = Expr::getValueKindForType(ResultTy);
14832   ResultTy = ResultTy.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
14833 
14834   UserDefinedLiteral *UDL = UserDefinedLiteral::Create(
14835       Context, Fn.get(), llvm::makeArrayRef(ConvArgs, Args.size()), ResultTy,
14836       VK, LitEndLoc, UDSuffixLoc, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14837 
14838   if (CheckCallReturnType(FD->getReturnType(), UDSuffixLoc, UDL, FD))
14839     return ExprError();
14840 
14841   if (CheckFunctionCall(FD, UDL, nullptr))
14842     return ExprError();
14843 
14844   return CheckForImmediateInvocation(MaybeBindToTemporary(UDL), FD);
14845 }
14846 
14847 /// Build a call to 'begin' or 'end' for a C++11 for-range statement. If the
14848 /// given LookupResult is non-empty, it is assumed to describe a member which
14849 /// will be invoked. Otherwise, the function will be found via argument
14850 /// dependent lookup.
14851 /// CallExpr is set to a valid expression and FRS_Success returned on success,
14852 /// otherwise CallExpr is set to ExprError() and some non-success value
14853 /// is returned.
14854 Sema::ForRangeStatus
14855 Sema::BuildForRangeBeginEndCall(SourceLocation Loc,
14856                                 SourceLocation RangeLoc,
14857                                 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
14858                                 LookupResult &MemberLookup,
14859                                 OverloadCandidateSet *CandidateSet,
14860                                 Expr *Range, ExprResult *CallExpr) {
14861   Scope *S = nullptr;
14862 
14863   CandidateSet->clear(OverloadCandidateSet::CSK_Normal);
14864   if (!MemberLookup.empty()) {
14865     ExprResult MemberRef =
14866         BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Range, Range->getType(), Loc,
14867                                  /*IsPtr=*/false, CXXScopeSpec(),
14868                                  /*TemplateKWLoc=*/SourceLocation(),
14869                                  /*FirstQualifierInScope=*/nullptr,
14870                                  MemberLookup,
14871                                  /*TemplateArgs=*/nullptr, S);
14872     if (MemberRef.isInvalid()) {
14873       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14874       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14875     }
14876     *CallExpr = BuildCallExpr(S, MemberRef.get(), Loc, None, Loc, nullptr);
14877     if (CallExpr->isInvalid()) {
14878       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14879       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14880     }
14881   } else {
14882     ExprResult FnR = CreateUnresolvedLookupExpr(/*NamingClass=*/nullptr,
14883                                                 NestedNameSpecifierLoc(),
14884                                                 NameInfo, UnresolvedSet<0>());
14885     if (FnR.isInvalid())
14886       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14887     UnresolvedLookupExpr *Fn = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(FnR.get());
14888 
14889     bool CandidateSetError = buildOverloadedCallSet(S, Fn, Fn, Range, Loc,
14890                                                     CandidateSet, CallExpr);
14891     if (CandidateSet->empty() || CandidateSetError) {
14892       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14893       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14894     }
14895     OverloadCandidateSet::iterator Best;
14896     OverloadingResult OverloadResult =
14897         CandidateSet->BestViableFunction(*this, Fn->getBeginLoc(), Best);
14898 
14899     if (OverloadResult == OR_No_Viable_Function) {
14900       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14901       return FRS_NoViableFunction;
14902     }
14903     *CallExpr = FinishOverloadedCallExpr(*this, S, Fn, Fn, Loc, Range,
14904                                          Loc, nullptr, CandidateSet, &Best,
14905                                          OverloadResult,
14906                                          /*AllowTypoCorrection=*/false);
14907     if (CallExpr->isInvalid() || OverloadResult != OR_Success) {
14908       *CallExpr = ExprError();
14909       return FRS_DiagnosticIssued;
14910     }
14911   }
14912   return FRS_Success;
14913 }
14914 
14915 
14916 /// FixOverloadedFunctionReference - E is an expression that refers to
14917 /// a C++ overloaded function (possibly with some parentheses and
14918 /// perhaps a '&' around it). We have resolved the overloaded function
14919 /// to the function declaration Fn, so patch up the expression E to
14920 /// refer (possibly indirectly) to Fn. Returns the new expr.
14921 Expr *Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(Expr *E, DeclAccessPair Found,
14922                                            FunctionDecl *Fn) {
14923   if (ParenExpr *PE = dyn_cast<ParenExpr>(E)) {
14924     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(PE->getSubExpr(),
14925                                                    Found, Fn);
14926     if (SubExpr == PE->getSubExpr())
14927       return PE;
14928 
14929     return new (Context) ParenExpr(PE->getLParen(), PE->getRParen(), SubExpr);
14930   }
14931 
14932   if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)) {
14933     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ICE->getSubExpr(),
14934                                                    Found, Fn);
14935     assert(Context.hasSameType(ICE->getSubExpr()->getType(),
14936                                SubExpr->getType()) &&
14937            "Implicit cast type cannot be determined from overload");
14938     assert(ICE->path_empty() && "fixing up hierarchy conversion?");
14939     if (SubExpr == ICE->getSubExpr())
14940       return ICE;
14941 
14942     return ImplicitCastExpr::Create(Context, ICE->getType(), ICE->getCastKind(),
14943                                     SubExpr, nullptr, ICE->getValueKind(),
14944                                     CurFPFeatureOverrides());
14945   }
14946 
14947   if (auto *GSE = dyn_cast<GenericSelectionExpr>(E)) {
14948     if (!GSE->isResultDependent()) {
14949       Expr *SubExpr =
14950           FixOverloadedFunctionReference(GSE->getResultExpr(), Found, Fn);
14951       if (SubExpr == GSE->getResultExpr())
14952         return GSE;
14953 
14954       // Replace the resulting type information before rebuilding the generic
14955       // selection expression.
14956       ArrayRef<Expr *> A = GSE->getAssocExprs();
14957       SmallVector<Expr *, 4> AssocExprs(A.begin(), A.end());
14958       unsigned ResultIdx = GSE->getResultIndex();
14959       AssocExprs[ResultIdx] = SubExpr;
14960 
14961       return GenericSelectionExpr::Create(
14962           Context, GSE->getGenericLoc(), GSE->getControllingExpr(),
14963           GSE->getAssocTypeSourceInfos(), AssocExprs, GSE->getDefaultLoc(),
14964           GSE->getRParenLoc(), GSE->containsUnexpandedParameterPack(),
14965           ResultIdx);
14966     }
14967     // Rather than fall through to the unreachable, return the original generic
14968     // selection expression.
14969     return GSE;
14970   }
14971 
14972   if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(E)) {
14973     assert(UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf &&
14974            "Can only take the address of an overloaded function");
14975     if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)) {
14976       if (Method->isStatic()) {
14977         // Do nothing: static member functions aren't any different
14978         // from non-member functions.
14979       } else {
14980         // Fix the subexpression, which really has to be an
14981         // UnresolvedLookupExpr holding an overloaded member function
14982         // or template.
14983         Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
14984                                                        Found, Fn);
14985         if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
14986           return UnOp;
14987 
14988         assert(isa<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)
14989                && "fixed to something other than a decl ref");
14990         assert(cast<DeclRefExpr>(SubExpr)->getQualifier()
14991                && "fixed to a member ref with no nested name qualifier");
14992 
14993         // We have taken the address of a pointer to member
14994         // function. Perform the computation here so that we get the
14995         // appropriate pointer to member type.
14996         QualType ClassType
14997           = Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Method->getDeclContext()));
14998         QualType MemPtrType
14999           = Context.getMemberPointerType(Fn->getType(), ClassType.getTypePtr());
15000         // Under the MS ABI, lock down the inheritance model now.
15001         if (Context.getTargetInfo().getCXXABI().isMicrosoft())
15002           (void)isCompleteType(UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), MemPtrType);
15003 
15004         return UnaryOperator::Create(
15005             Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf, MemPtrType, VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary,
15006             UnOp->getOperatorLoc(), false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15007       }
15008     }
15009     Expr *SubExpr = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(UnOp->getSubExpr(),
15010                                                    Found, Fn);
15011     if (SubExpr == UnOp->getSubExpr())
15012       return UnOp;
15013 
15014     return UnaryOperator::Create(Context, SubExpr, UO_AddrOf,
15015                                  Context.getPointerType(SubExpr->getType()),
15016                                  VK_RValue, OK_Ordinary, UnOp->getOperatorLoc(),
15017                                  false, CurFPFeatureOverrides());
15018   }
15019 
15020   if (UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(E)) {
15021     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15022     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15023     if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15024       ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15025       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15026     }
15027 
15028     DeclRefExpr *DRE =
15029         BuildDeclRefExpr(Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, ULE->getNameInfo(),
15030                          ULE->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15031                          ULE->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15032     DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(ULE->getNumDecls() > 1);
15033     return DRE;
15034   }
15035 
15036   if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(E)) {
15037     // FIXME: avoid copy.
15038     TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer, *TemplateArgs = nullptr;
15039     if (MemExpr->hasExplicitTemplateArgs()) {
15040       MemExpr->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TemplateArgsBuffer);
15041       TemplateArgs = &TemplateArgsBuffer;
15042     }
15043 
15044     Expr *Base;
15045 
15046     // If we're filling in a static method where we used to have an
15047     // implicit member access, rewrite to a simple decl ref.
15048     if (MemExpr->isImplicitAccess()) {
15049       if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15050         DeclRefExpr *DRE = BuildDeclRefExpr(
15051             Fn, Fn->getType(), VK_LValue, MemExpr->getNameInfo(),
15052             MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), Found.getDecl(),
15053             MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), TemplateArgs);
15054         DRE->setHadMultipleCandidates(MemExpr->getNumDecls() > 1);
15055         return DRE;
15056       } else {
15057         SourceLocation Loc = MemExpr->getMemberLoc();
15058         if (MemExpr->getQualifier())
15059           Loc = MemExpr->getQualifierLoc().getBeginLoc();
15060         Base =
15061             BuildCXXThisExpr(Loc, MemExpr->getBaseType(), /*IsImplicit=*/true);
15062       }
15063     } else
15064       Base = MemExpr->getBase();
15065 
15066     ExprValueKind valueKind;
15067     QualType type;
15068     if (cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Fn)->isStatic()) {
15069       valueKind = VK_LValue;
15070       type = Fn->getType();
15071     } else {
15072       valueKind = VK_RValue;
15073       type = Context.BoundMemberTy;
15074     }
15075 
15076     return BuildMemberExpr(
15077         Base, MemExpr->isArrow(), MemExpr->getOperatorLoc(),
15078         MemExpr->getQualifierLoc(), MemExpr->getTemplateKeywordLoc(), Fn, Found,
15079         /*HadMultipleCandidates=*/true, MemExpr->getMemberNameInfo(),
15080         type, valueKind, OK_Ordinary, TemplateArgs);
15081   }
15082 
15083   llvm_unreachable("Invalid reference to overloaded function");
15084 }
15085 
15086 ExprResult Sema::FixOverloadedFunctionReference(ExprResult E,
15087                                                 DeclAccessPair Found,
15088                                                 FunctionDecl *Fn) {
15089   return FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E.get(), Found, Fn);
15090 }
15091